Toshiba 2550 Service Manual
Toshiba 2550 Service Manual
Toshiba 2550 Service Manual
e-STUDIO2050C/2550C
e-STUDIO2051C/2551C
Model: FC-2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
Publish Date: May 2012
File No. SME120010A0
R120121L1800-TTEC
Ver01_2012-06
Trademarks
Be sure not to hold the movable parts or units (e.g. the control panel, ADU or RADF) when
transporting the equipment.
Be sure to use a dedicated outlet with AC 110V/15A, 120V/12A, 220-240V/8A for its power
source.
The equipment must be grounded for safety.
Select a suitable place for installation. Avoid excessive heat, high humidity, dust, vibration and
direct sunlight.
Provide proper ventilation since the equipment emits a slight amount of ozone.
To insure adequate working space for the copying operation, keep a minimum clearance of 30
cm (11.8) on the left, 80 cm (32) on the right and 20 cm (7.9) on the rear.
The equipment shall be installed near the socket outlet and shall be accessible.
Be sure to fix and plug in the power cable securely after the installation so that no one trips over
it.
If the unpacking place and where the equipment is to be installed differ, perform image quality
adjustment (automatic gamma adjustment) according to the temperature and humidity of the
place of installation and the paper to be used.
Before using the antistatic wrist strap, unplug the power cable of the equipment and
make sure that there are no charged objects which are not insulated in the vicinity.
Be sure not to touch high-temperature sections such as the fuser unit, damp heater and areas
around them.
Be sure not to touch high-voltage sections such as the chargers, transfer belt, 2nd transfer roller,
developer, high-voltage transformer, and power supply unit. Especially, the board of these
components should not be touched since the electric charge may remain in the capacitors, etc.
on them even after the power is turned OFF.
Make sure that the equipment will not operate before touching potentially dangerous places (e.g.
rotating/operating sections such as gears, belts pulleys, and fans).
Be careful when removing the covers since there might be the parts with very sharp edges
underneath.
When servicing the equipment with the power turned ON, be sure not to touch live sections and
rotating/operating sections.
Use designated jigs and tools.
Use recommended measuring instruments or equivalents.
Return the equipment to the original state and check the operation when the service is finished.
Be very careful to treat the touch panel gently and never hit it. Breaking the surface could cause
malfunctions.
4. Cautionary Labels
- During servicing, be sure to check the rating plate and cautionary labels to see if there is any dirt
on their surface and if they are properly stuck to the equipment.
[3]
[2]
[1]
[6]
[4]
[5]
[4]
Caution:
Dispose of used batteries and IC-RAMs including lithium batteries according to this manual.
Attention:
Se dbarrasser de batteries et IC-RAMs uss y compris les batteries en lithium selon ce manuel.
Vorsicht:
Entsorgung der gebrauchten Batterien und IC-RAMs (inclusive der Lithium-Batterie) nach diesem
Handbuch.
Beim Transportieren des Gerts nicht an den beweglichen Teilen oder Einheiten (z.B. das
Bedienungsfeld, die Duplexeinheit oder die automatische Dokumentenzufhrung) halten.
Eine spezielle Steckdose mit Stromversorgung von AC 110V/15A, 120V/12A, 220-240V/8A als
Stromquelle verwenden.
Das Gert ist aus Sicherheitsgrnden zu erden.
Einen geeigneten Standort fr die Installation whlen. Standorte mit zuviel Hitze, hoher Luftfeuchtigkeit,
Staub, Vibrieren und direkter Sonneneinstrahlung sind zu vermeiden.
Fr ausreichende Belftung sorgen, da das Gert etwas Ozon abgibt.
Um einen optimalen Kopierbetrieb zu gewhrleisten, muss ein Abstand von mindestens 80 cm links, 80
cm rechts und 20 cm dahinter eingehalten werden.
Das Gert ist in der Nhe der Steckdose zu installieren; diese muss leicht zu erreichen sein.
Nach der Installation muss das Netzkabel richtig hineingesteckt und befestigt werden, damit niemand
darber stolpern kann.
Falls der Auspackungsstandort und der Installationsstandort des Gerts verschieden sind, die
Bildqualittsjustierung (automatische Gammajustierung) je nach der Temperatur und Luftfeuchtigkeit
des Installationsstandorts und der Papiersorte, die verwendet wird, durchfhren.
Vor Benutzung der Manschette der Bettigung des Armbandes, das Netzkabel des
Gertes herausziehen und prfen, dass es in der Nhe keine geladenen
Gegenstnde, die nicht isoliert sind, gibt.
Auf keinen Fall Hochtemperaturbereiche, wie die Fixiereinheit, die Heizquelle und die umliegenden
Bereiche, berhren.
Auf keinen Fall Hochspannungsbereiche, wie die Ladeeinheiten, das Transferband, die zweite
Transferwalze, die Entwicklereinheit, den Hochspannungstransformator und das Netzgert, berhren.
Insbesondere sollten die Platinen dieser Komponenten nicht berhrt werden, da die Kondensatoren
usw. auch nach dem Ausschalten des Gerts noch elektrisch geladen sein knnen.
Vor dem Berhren potenziell gefhrlicher Bereiche (z. B. drehbare oder betriebsrelevante Bereiche,
wie Zahnrder, Riemen, Riemenscheiben und Lfter) sicherstellen, dass das Gert sich nicht bedienen
lsst.
Beim Entfernen von Abdeckungen vorsichtig vorgehen, da sich darunter scharfkantige Komponenten
befinden knnen.
Bei Wartungsarbeiten am eingeschalteten Gert drfen keine unter Strom stehenden, drehbaren oder
betriebsrelevanten Bereiche berhrt werden.
Ausschlielich vorgesehene Werkzeuge und Hilfsmittel verwenden.
Empfohlene oder gleichwertige Messgerte verwenden.
Nach Abschluss der Wartungsarbeiten das Gert in den ursprnglichen Zustand zurck versetzen und
den einwandfreien Betrieb berprfen.
Das berhrungsempfindliche Bedienungsfeld stets vorsichtig handhaben und keinen Sten
aussetzen. Wenn die Oberflche beschdigt wird, kann dies zu Funktionsstrungen fhren.
3. Sicherheitsrelevante Wartungsteile
Der Leistungsschutzschalter, der Trschalter, die Sicherung, der Thermostat, die Thermosicherung,
der Thermistor, die IC-RAMs einschlielich der Lithiumakkus usw. sind besonders sicherheitsrelevant.
Sie mssen unbedingt korrekt gehandhabt und installiert werden. Wenn diese Teile kurzgeschlossen
und funktionsunfhig werden, kann dies zu schwerwiegenden Schden, wie einem Abbrand, fhren.
Kurzschlsse sind zu vermeiden, und es sind ausschlielich Teile zu verwenden, die von der Toshiba
TEC Corporation empfohlen sind.
4. Warnetiketten
Im Rahmen der Wartung unbedingt das Leistungsschild und die Etiketten mit Warnhinweisen
berprfen [z. B. Unplug the power cable during service (Netzkabel vor Beginn der Wartungsarbeiten
abziehen), CAUTION. HOT (VORSICHT, HEISS), CAUTION. HIGH VOLTAGE (VORSICHT,
HOCHSPANNUNG), CAUTION. LASER BEAM (VORSICHT, LASER) usw.], um sicherzustellen,
dass sie nicht verschmutzt sind und korrekt am Gert angebracht sind.
5. Entsorgung des Gerts, der Verbrauchs- und Verpackungsmaterialien, alter Akkus und IC-RAMs
In Bezug auf die Entsorgung und Wiederverwertung des Gerts, der Verbrauchs- und
Verpackungsmaterialien, alter Akkus und IC-RAMs, einschlielich Lithiumakkus, sind die einschlgigen
nationalen oder regionalen Vorschriften zu befolgen.
Caution:
Dispose of used batteries and IC-RAMs including lithium batteries according to this manual.
Attention:
Se dbarrasser de batteries et IC-RAMs uss y compris les batteries en lithium selon ce manuel.
Vorsicht:
Entsorgung der gebrauchten Batterien und IC-RAMs (inclusive der Lithium-Batterie) nach diesem
Handbuch.
CONTENTS
1. FEATURE...................................................................................................................... 1-1
1.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
3.11
3.12
3.13
3.14
3.15
3.16
3.17
4.2
4.3
Covers............................................................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.1
Front cover......................................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.2
Left cover ........................................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.3
Receiving tray .................................................................................................... 4-2
4.1.4
Tray rear cover .................................................................................................. 4-2
4.1.5
Left top cover ..................................................................................................... 4-2
4.1.6
Left rear cover.................................................................................................... 4-3
4.1.7
Right top cover................................................................................................... 4-3
4.1.8
Right front cover ................................................................................................ 4-3
4.1.9
Right rear cover ................................................................................................. 4-4
4.1.10 Front top cover................................................................................................... 4-4
4.1.11 Front right cover................................................................................................. 4-4
4.1.12 Rear top cover ................................................................................................... 4-5
4.1.13 Rear cover ......................................................................................................... 4-5
4.1.14 Front cover switch (SW1) .................................................................................. 4-5
4.1.15 Front cover interlock switch (SW2) .................................................................... 4-6
Control Panel .................................................................................................................... 4-7
4.2.1
Control panel unit............................................................................................... 4-7
4.2.2
KEY board ......................................................................................................... 4-8
4.2.3
DSP board ......................................................................................................... 4-8
4.2.4
Touch panel ....................................................................................................... 4-9
Scanner Unit ................................................................................................................... 4-11
4.3.1
Original glass ................................................................................................... 4-11
4.3.2
Lens cover ....................................................................................................... 4-11
4.3.3
Automatic original detection sensor 1, 2 (S24, S25)........................................ 4-12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.3.4
CCD driving PC board ..................................................................................... 4-13
4.3.5
Carriage home position sensor (S23) .............................................................. 4-14
4.3.6
Exposure lamp (EXP) ...................................................................................... 4-15
4.3.7
Scan motor (M1) .............................................................................................. 4-16
4.3.8
Platen sensor (S21, S22)................................................................................. 4-17
4.3.9
Carriage-1........................................................................................................ 4-18
4.3.10 Carriage wire, carriage-2 ................................................................................. 4-20
4.3.11 Scanner damp heater ...................................................................................... 4-23
LED Unit.......................................................................................................................... 4-24
4.4.1
LED Tray.......................................................................................................... 4-24
4.4.2
Discharge LED................................................................................................. 4-27
4.4.3
LED printer head.............................................................................................. 4-28
4.4.4
LED spacer ...................................................................................................... 4-34
Paper Feeding System.................................................................................................... 4-35
4.5.1
Bypass unit ...................................................................................................... 4-35
4.5.2
Bypass feed roller ............................................................................................ 4-37
4.5.3
Bypass separation pad .................................................................................... 4-37
4.5.4
Paper width detection PC board (S17) ............................................................ 4-38
4.5.5
Bypass feed sensor (S16) ............................................................................... 4-38
4.5.6
Bypass paper feed clutch (CLT4) .................................................................... 4-39
4.5.7
Drawer feed roller ............................................................................................ 4-40
4.5.8
Drawer separation pad .................................................................................... 4-40
4.5.9
1st drawer empty sensor (S5).......................................................................... 4-41
4.5.10 1st drawer size detection switch-1, -2 (SW6, SW7)......................................... 4-42
4.5.11 1st drawer detection switch (SW8) .................................................................. 4-42
4.5.12 Side cover switch (SW5).................................................................................. 4-42
4.5.13 Registration sensor (S19), feed sensor (S20) ................................................. 4-43
4.5.14 Registration clutch (CLT1) ............................................................................... 4-45
4.5.15 Registration roller............................................................................................. 4-46
4.5.16 Paper feed drive gear ...................................................................................... 4-47
Developer Unit, Cleaner.................................................................................................. 4-49
4.6.1
Waste toner box............................................................................................... 4-49
4.6.2
Developer unit.................................................................................................. 4-49
4.6.3
Developer material........................................................................................... 4-50
4.6.4
Doctor blade .................................................................................................... 4-56
4.6.5
Auto-toner sensor (S1, S2, S3, S4) ................................................................. 4-56
4.6.6
Development sleeve ........................................................................................ 4-57
4.6.7
Mixer ................................................................................................................ 4-58
4.6.8
Cleaner unit ..................................................................................................... 4-59
4.6.9
Main charger.................................................................................................... 4-60
4.6.10 Drum ................................................................................................................ 4-62
4.6.11 Drum cleaning blade ........................................................................................ 4-63
4.6.12 Waste toner unit gear ...................................................................................... 4-63
4.6.13 Main charger grid............................................................................................. 4-64
4.6.14 Main charger cleaner ....................................................................................... 4-65
4.6.15 Needle electrode.............................................................................................. 4-65
4.6.16 New/old drum detection switches (SW9, SW10, SW11, SW12) and new/old
developer unit detection switches (SW13, SW14, SW15, SW16) ................... 4-65
4.6.17 Drum thermistor (THM4) .................................................................................. 4-69
4.6.18 Temperature/humidity sensor (S10) ................................................................ 4-69
4.6.19 Waste toner paddle rotation detection sensor (S9) ......................................... 4-70
4.6.20 Waste toner paddle motor (M7) ....................................................................... 4-70
4.6.21 Drum switching detection sensor (S11) ........................................................... 4-71
4.6.22 Drum switching motor (M3).............................................................................. 4-72
4.6.23 Paper feeding/developer unit drive motor (M2) ............................................... 4-73
4.6.24 Paper feeding/developer drive unit .................................................................. 4-74
4.6.25 Developer unit (K) drive gear ........................................................................... 4-74
4.6.26 Toner motor assembly ..................................................................................... 4-75
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
4.7
4.8
4.9
4.10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
4.10.8
4.11
ADU drive unit/ADU entrance sensor (S14)/ADU exit sensor (S15)/ADU motor
(M12) ............................................................................................................. 4-119
4.10.9 Side cover interlock switch (SW3) ................................................................. 4-120
Removal and Installation of Options ............................................................................. 4-121
4.11.1 MR-3024 (Reversing Automatic Document Feeder)...................................... 4-121
4.11.2 KD-1032 (Paper Feed Pedestal) ................................................................... 4-123
4.11.3 KD-1031 (Large Capacity Feeder)................................................................. 4-126
4.11.4 MY-1040 (Paper Feed Unit)........................................................................... 4-130
4.11.5 KN-2550 (Bridge Kit)...................................................................................... 4-135
4.11.6 MJ-1036 (Inner Finisher) ............................................................................... 4-137
4.11.7 MJ-1037 (Saddle Stitch Finisher) .................................................................. 4-140
4.11.8 MJ-5004 (Job Separator) ............................................................................... 4-142
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
5.9
5.10
5.11
5.12
5.13
5.14
5.15
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.1.9
Image dimensional adjustment in the copy/printer/fax function ....................... 6-27
Image Quality Adjustment (Copying Function)................................................................ 6-28
6.2.1
Automatic gamma adjustment ......................................................................... 6-28
6.2.2
Density adjustment .......................................................................................... 6-30
6.2.3
Color balance adjustment ................................................................................ 6-31
6.2.4
Gamma balance adjustment............................................................................ 6-34
6.2.5
Background adjustment ................................................................................... 6-35
6.2.6
Judgment threshold for ACS (common for copy and scan) ............................. 6-35
6.2.7
Sharpness adjustment ..................................................................................... 6-36
6.2.8
Setting range correction................................................................................... 6-37
6.2.9
Adjustment of smudged/faint text .................................................................... 6-37
6.2.10 Color Adjustment of Marker ............................................................................. 6-38
6.2.11 LED emission level adjustment........................................................................ 6-39
6.2.12 Maximum toner density adjustment to paper type ........................................... 6-39
6.2.13 Maximum text density adjustment ................................................................... 6-40
6.2.14 Text/Photo reproduction level adjustment ....................................................... 6-40
6.2.15 Black header density level adjustment ............................................................ 6-41
6.2.16 Black area adjustment in twin color copy mode............................................... 6-41
6.2.17 Judgment threshold adjustment for blank originals
(common for copy and scan) ........................................................................... 6-42
6.2.18 Background offsetting adjustment for RADF (common for copy, scan and fax)6-42
6.2.19 Twin color copy / mono color copy adjustment ................................................ 6-43
6.2.20 Maximum density adjustment for each paper type .......................................... 6-44
6.2.21 Color reproduction selection ............................................................................ 6-45
6.2.22 Hue adjustment................................................................................................ 6-46
6.2.23 Saturation adjustment...................................................................................... 6-49
Image Quality Adjustment (Printing Function)................................................................. 6-51
6.3.1
Automatic gamma adjustment ......................................................................... 6-51
6.3.2
Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)...................................................... 6-54
6.3.3
Color balance adjustment ................................................................................ 6-56
6.3.4
Adjustment of faint text .................................................................................... 6-58
6.3.5
Upper limit value in the Toner Saving Mode .................................................... 6-58
6.3.6
Maximum toner density adjustment (OHP) ...................................................... 6-59
6.3.7
Fine line enhancement switchover .................................................................. 6-59
6.3.8
PureBlack/PureGray threshold adjustment (PCL) ......................................... 6-59
6.3.9
PureBlack/PureGray threshold adjustment (Twin color mode) ..................... 6-60
6.3.10 PureBlack/PureGray threshold adjustment (PS) ........................................... 6-60
6.3.11 PureBlack/PureGray threshold adjustment (XPS)......................................... 6-60
6.3.12 Toner limit threshold adjustment...................................................................... 6-61
6.3.13 Screen switchover ........................................................................................... 6-62
6.3.14 Sharpness adjustment ..................................................................................... 6-62
6.3.15 Thin line width lower limit adjustment .............................................................. 6-63
6.3.16 Offsetting adjustment for background processing ........................................... 6-64
6.3.17 Color/black judgment setting for twin color printing images............................. 6-64
6.3.18 LED emission level adjustment........................................................................ 6-65
6.3.19 Density adjustment of graphic lines (1200 dpi) ................................................ 6-66
Image Quality Adjustment (Scanning Function).............................................................. 6-67
6.4.1
Gamma balance adjustment............................................................................ 6-67
6.4.2
Density adjustment .......................................................................................... 6-68
6.4.3
Background adjustment (Color Mode) ............................................................. 6-69
6.4.4
Background adjustment (Black/Grayscale)...................................................... 6-70
6.4.5
Judgment threshold for ACS (common for copy and network scan) ............... 6-70
6.4.6
Sharpness adjustment ..................................................................................... 6-71
6.4.7
Fine adjustment of black density ..................................................................... 6-72
6.4.8
RGB conversion method selection .................................................................. 6-72
6.4.9
Adjustment of saturation .................................................................................. 6-73
6.4.10 Background offsetting adjustment for RADF (common for copy, scan and fax)6-73
6.4.11 Adjustment of the capacity and image quality of SlimPDF .............................. 6-74
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
6.4.12
6.4.13
6.5
6.6
6.7
6.8
6.9
6.10
6.11
6.12
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
7.7
7.8
7.9
7.10
7.11
8.3
8.4
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
8.5
8.4.7
The equipment does not start after the power has been turned ON.............. 8-209
Troubleshooting for the Image ...................................................................................... 8-211
8.5.1
Color deviation............................................................................................... 8-211
8.5.2
Uneven pitch and jitter image ........................................................................ 8-213
8.5.3
Poor image density, color reproduction and gray balance............................. 8-215
8.5.4
Background fogging ...................................................................................... 8-217
8.5.5
Moire /lack of sharpness ................................................................................ 8-219
8.5.6
Toner offset.................................................................................................... 8-221
8.5.7
Blurred image ................................................................................................ 8-223
8.5.8
Poor fusing..................................................................................................... 8-224
8.5.9
Blank print...................................................................................................... 8-226
8.5.10 Solid print....................................................................................................... 8-228
8.5.11 White banding (in feeding direction) .............................................................. 8-230
8.5.12 White banding (at right angles to feeding direction) ...................................... 8-232
8.5.13 Skew (slantwise copying) .............................................................................. 8-233
8.5.14 Color banding (in feeding direction) ............................................................... 8-235
8.5.15 Color banding (at right angles to feeding direction) ....................................... 8-237
8.5.16 White spots .................................................................................................... 8-238
8.5.17 Poor transfer .................................................................................................. 8-240
8.5.18 Uneven image density 1 (in feeding direction)............................................... 8-242
8.5.19 Uneven image density 1 (at right angles to feeding direction) ....................... 8-244
8.5.20 Uneven image density 2 ................................................................................ 8-245
8.5.21 Faded image (low density)............................................................................. 8-247
8.5.22 Image dislocation in feeding direction............................................................ 8-248
8.5.23 Image jittering ................................................................................................ 8-249
8.5.24 Poor cleaning................................................................................................. 8-250
8.5.25 Uneven light distribution ................................................................................ 8-252
8.5.26 Blotched image .............................................................................................. 8-253
8.5.27 Stain on the paper back side ......................................................................... 8-254
8.5.28 White void in the halftone .............................................................................. 8-256
8.5.29 Paper wrinkle ................................................................................................. 8-257
8.5.30 White void in the halftone .............................................................................. 8-259
8.5.31 Faint image .................................................................................................... 8-260
8.5.32 Toner scattering ............................................................................................. 8-261
8.5.33 Feathered image............................................................................................ 8-263
9.2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
9.3
9.2.7
Procedures and settings when replacing the Lens unit .................................. 9-39
9.2.8
Firmware confirmation after the PC board/HDD replacement ......................... 9-39
9.2.9
License re-registration using the one-time dongle ........................................... 9-40
Precautions for Installation of GP-1070 and Disposal of HDD/SSD/Board..................... 9-42
9.3.1
Precautions for Installation of GP-1070 ........................................................... 9-42
9.3.2
Precautions when disposing of HDD/SSD ....................................................... 9-42
9.3.3
Precautions when disposing of the SYS board................................................ 9-42
9.3.4
Precautions when disposing of the SRAM board (for SYS board) ................. 9-42
10.2
12.2
12.3
Outline............................................................................................................................. 13-1
Signal .............................................................................................................................. 13-1
13.2.1 Pin Layout........................................................................................................ 13-1
13.2.2 Details of the signals........................................................................................ 13-3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
10
13.3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
CONTENTS
12
1.
FEATURE
1.1
Pursuing usability
Maintenance work such as the replacement of supplies can be done more easily and efficiently.
A new automatic paper size detection mechanism for drawers is adopted.
Improving serviceability
Developer material is pre-filled in each developer unit.
Efficiency of serviceability such as the replacement of supplies is improved.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FEATURE
1-1
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FEATURE
1-2
2.
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
Notes: In this document, a model name is replaced with an alias as follows:
Model name
e-STUDIO2050C
e-STUDIO2550C
e-STUDIO2051C
e-STUDIO2551C
2.1
2.1.1
Alias
20ppm
25ppm
LL20ppm
LL25ppm
Specifications
General
Type
Original glass
Color
Copy process
Developing system
Fixing method
Photosensor type
Original scanning sensor
Scanning light source
Resolution
Scanning
Writing
Gradation
Paper feeding
Paper supply
Drawer
Bypass feeding
PFU (optional)
PFP (optional)
LCF (optional)
Paper size
Drawer
Desktop type
(Console type: when optional Paper Feed Pedestal (PFP) or
optional Large Capacity Feeder (LCF) is installed.)
Fixed
Full color, Twin color, Mono color
Indirect electrophotographic method (dry)
2-component magnetic brush developing
Roller fusing system
OPC
Linear CCD sensor
LED
600 dpi x 600 dpi
600 dpi x 600 dpi (color print / Photo / gray scale)
256
1 drawer + Bypass feeding + PFU (optional)
1 drawer + Bypass feeding + PFU+ PFP 1 drawer (optional)
1 drawer + Bypass feeding + PFU+ PFP 2 drawers (optional)
1 drawer + Bypass feeding + PFU+ LCF (optional)
Stack height 28 mm,
Approx. 250 sheets (80 g/m2, 21.3 lb. Bond),
Approx. 200 sheets (105 g/m2, 28 lb. Bond)
Stack height 11 mm,
Approx. 100 sheets (80 g/m2, 21.3 lb. Bond),
Approx. 80 sheets (105 g/m2, 28 lb. Bond)
Stack height 60.5 mm,
Approx. 550 sheets (80 g/m2, 21.3 lb. Bond),
Approx. 500 sheets (105 g/m2, 28 lb. Bond)
Stack height 60.5 mm,
Approx. 550 sheets (80 g/m2, 21.3 lb. Bond),
Approx. 500 sheets (105 g/m2, 28 lb. Bond)
Stack height 110 mm,
Approx. 2000 sheets (80 g/m2, 21.3 lb. Bond),
Approx. 1660 sheets (105 g/m2, 28 lb. Bond)
A3, A4, A4-R, A5-R, B4, B5, B5-R, FOLIO, 8K, 16K, 16K-R,
LD, LG, LT, LT-R, ST-R, COMPUTER, 13"LG, 8.5" x 8.5",
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-1
Bypass feeding
PFU (optional)
Paper type
Paper weight
Drawers /
PFP (optional)
LCF (optional)
Drawer
Bypass feeding
PFU (optional)
PFP (optional)
LCF (optional)
Drawer /
PFU (optional)/
PFP (optional)
Bypass feeding
LCF (optional)
Automatic
duplexing unit
Type
Acceptable paper
size
Acceptable paper
weight
Toner supply
Density control
Total counter
Memory
(RAM)
Main memory
Page Memory
SSD
HDD
Account Codes
Department Codes
Machine version
A3, A4, A4-R, A5-R, B4, B5, B5-R, FOLIO, 8K, 16K, 16K-R,
LD, LG, LT, LT-R, ST-R, COMPUTER, 13"LG, 8.5" x 8.5",
Non-standard:
Paper size within 100 - 297 mm (3.9 - 11.7") (Length), 148 432 mm (5.8 - 17") (Width)
A3, A4, A4-R, A5-R, B4, B5, B5-R, FOLIO, 8K, 16K, 16K-R,
LD, LG, LT, LT-R, ST-R, COMPUTER, 13"LG, 8.5" x 8.5",
A3, A4, A4-R, A5-R, B4, B5, B5-R, FOLIO, 8K, 16K, 16K-R,
LD, LG, LT, LT-R, ST-R, COMPUTER, 13"LG, 8.5" x 8.5",
A4, LT
Plain paper, Recycled paper, Thick 1
Plain paper, Recycled paper, Thick 1, Thick 2, Sticker labels,
OHP film, Tab paper, Water proof paper, Extra large paper
Plain paper, Recycled paper, Thick 1
Plain paper, Recycled paper, Thick 1, Thick 2
Plain paper, Recycled paper
60g/m2 to 163 g/m2 (16 lb. Bond to 90 lb. Index)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-2
Warm-up time
Power requirements
Power consumption
Weight
Dimensions of the equipment
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-3
2.1.2
[1]
Copy
Copy specifications
Storage capacity
Original glass Original scanning
system
Original type
Original size
Original scanning
Reversing
system
Automatic
Document
Original type
Feeder
(optional)
Original size
Eliminated
portion
Memory is full
Flat surface scanning system
(the left rear corner used as guide to place originals)
Sheets, books
Max. A3/LD
Fixed scanning system by feeding the original
(the center used as guide to place originals)
Sheets (carbon, bounded or stapled originals cannot be
accepted)
A3, A4, A4-R, A5-R, B4, B5, B5-R, FOLIO,
LD, LG, LT, LT-R, ST-R, COMPUTER
Original paper
weight
Original capacity
Black copy
Color copy
Multiple copying
Black
Color
Black
Color
A4, LT
B5, A5-R, ST-R
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R
B4, LG, FOLIO,
COMPUTER
A3, LD
Bypass feed
Drawer
Size specified
20 (20)
20 (20)
Size not
specified
9 (9)
PFP
LCF
(A4/LT only)
20 (20)
20 (20)
-
15 (15)
15 (15)
9(9)
15 (15)
12 (12)
12 (12)
9 (9)
12 (12)
10 (10)
10 (10)
9 (9)
10 (10)
25ppm/LL25ppm
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-4
Paper supply
Paper size
A4, LT
B5, A5-R, ST-R
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R
B4, LG, FOLIO,
COMPUTER
A3, LD
*
*
*
*
Drawer
25 (25)
Bypass feed
Size not
Size specified
specified
25 (25)
11 (11)
PFP
LCF
(A4/LT only)
25 (25)
25 (25)
-
18(18)
15 (15)
18(18)
15 (15)
11 (11)
11 (11)
20 (20)
17 (17)
12 (12)
12 (12)
11 (11)
15 (15)
[ 3-2 ]
Thick 1/Thick 2
A4, LT
B5, A5-R, ST-R
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R
B4, LG, FOLIO,
COMPUTER
A3, LD
*
*
*
Drawer
17.5 (17.5)
Bypass feed
Size not
Size specified
specified
16.5 (16.5)
7 (7)
PFP
LCF
(A4/LT only)
16.5 (16.5)
13 (13)
12.5 (12.5)
7 (7)
12.5 (12.5)
10.5 (10.5)
10 (10)
7 (7)
10 (10)
8.5 (8.5)
8 (8)
7 (7)
8 (8)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-5
Drawer
A4, LT
A3, LD
*
*
*
Bypass feed
Size not
Size specified
specified
14.5 (14.5)
-
7.5 (7.5)
Sec.
20ppm/LL20ppm
Single-sided originals
Single-sided copies
3 sets
Single-sided originals
Double-sided copies
3 sets
Double-sided originals
Double-sided copies
Double-sided originals
Single-sided copies
LCF
(A4/LT only)
[4]
*
*
PFP
1 set
5 sets
1 set
5 sets
1 set
3 sets
5 sets
1 set
3 sets
5 sets
37.7 (39.6)
107.4 (109.3)
177 (178.9)
43.6 (46.6)
90.8 (93.7)
137.9 (140.9)
84.5 (88.6)
190.7 (194.7)
296.8 (300.8)
74.5 (77.1)
193.8 (196.4)
313 (315.6)
25ppmLL25ppm
32.5 (34.5)
83.2 (85.1)
131.6 (133.5)
42.2 (45.2)
89.8 (92.8)
140.4 (143.4)
83.9 (87.9)
179.9 (183.9)
277.3 (281.3)
73.8 (76.4)
171 (173.6)
265.1 (267.7)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-6
2.1.3
Resolution
Black
Color
Eliminated portion
Black / Color
Interface
Standard
Optional
2.1.4
Scan
Scanning speed
Resolution
Scan mode
File formats
*
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-7
2.1.5
[1]
Internet Fax
Resolution
Scanning
Address book
Transmission
Features
[2]
TX Resolution
< dots/mm >
Original
Document
Size
Speed
Standard (8 x 3.85),
Fine (8 x 7.7),
A3, B4, A4, A4-R, A5, B5, B5-R, A5-R, LT, LT-R, LG, LD, ST,
ST-R, Computer, Folio
TIFF-FX (Profile S, F, J)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-8
2.1.6
Category
HDD
Copy
Box
Scan
FAX
Unit
SSD
HDD *1
SSD or HDD
Memory copy
e-Filing
GB
GB
GB
Public box
User box
Folders per box
Documents per
box
Pages per
document
Number of
maximum jobs
Scan to File
Pages per job
Number of
maximum jobs
FAX Transmission
Box
Box
Folder
Docu
ment
Page
160
30
80 (Shared with e-filing/
Strage file)
1
200
100
400
200
Job
899
GB
Page
Job
8
1.9
-
80
1000
899 (Except Print/FAX/
interrupt)
1 (Shared with Rx and
Tx)
1 (Shared with Rx and
Tx)
25
Storage full
1000
FAX Reception
GB
GB
Job
Job
Storage full
399 (Except Print/FAX/
interrupt)
0.1 (Shared with Rx
and Tx)
0.1 (Shared with Rx
and Tx)
0.9
Storage full
500
GB
Job
Job
GB
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2-9
2.1.7
Compatibility
TX Resolution
PSTN
Internet Fax
Original Document Size
Mail Box
User defined
Routed document
Send to eformat
Filing
Send to File
(SMB)
Send to FTP
Send to Email
Send to I-Fax
Send to
PSTN-FAX
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 10
2.2
Accessories
Unpacking/Setup instruction
1 set
Operators manual
1 set
Power cable
Warranty sheet
Setup report
Rubber plug (small)
2 pcs.
DVD-ROM
Approval sheet
*
Machine version
NAD:
North America, Brazil
MJD:
Europe
AUD:
Australia
ASD:
Asia, Hong Kong, Latin America
TWD:
Taiwan
SAD:
Saudi Arabia
ASU:
Saudi Arabia, Asia
CND:
China
KRD:
Korea
ARD:
Argentina
JPD:
Japan
Notes:
Check that the above accessories are correctly co-packed at the time of unpacking.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 11
Staple Cartridge
STAPLE-2000
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 12
Drawer Module
MY-1039/C
Job Separator
MJ-5004/C
Bridge Kit
KN-2550/C
Manual Pocket
KK-1660/-C
Inner Finisher
MJ-1036/C
FAX Unit
GD-1320
NA/EU/AU/AS/TW/C
Saddle stitch
Finisher
MJ-1037/C
Reversing Automatic
Document Feeder (RADF)
MR-3024/C
Paper Feed
Pedestal (PFP)
KD-1032/C
Original Cover
KA-1640PC/-C
Large Capacity
Feeder (LCF)
KD-1031 A4/LT/A4-C
Paper Feed
Unit (PFU)
MY-1040/C
Wireless LAN
module
GN-1060/C
Antenna
GN-3010/C
Desk
MH-2050
Hardcopy
Security kit
GP-1190A
Unicode Font
Enabler
GS-1007
IP Sec Enabler
GP-1080
Paper Feed
Controler
GH-1080/C
HDD
GE-1220/GE-1220C
e-BRIDGE ID Gate
KP-2005/C
e-BRIDGE ID Gate
KP-2004
Work Table
KK-4550
2.3.1
Accessible
Arm
KK-2550
2.3
System List
20ppm/25ppm
Fig. 2-1
Notes:
The paper feed controler (GH-1080/C) is necessary for installation of the paper feed unit (MY1040/C), paper feed pedestal (KD-1032/C) and large capacity feeder (KD-1031 A4/LT/A4-C).
The bridge kit (KN-2550) is necessary for installation of the finisher (MJ-1037/C).
The finisher (MJ-1037/C) is necessary for installation of the hole punch unit (MJ-6008N/E/F/S/
E-C).
The finisher (MJ-1036/C) is necessary for installation of the hole punch unit (MJ-6007N/E/F/S/
E-C).
The antenna (GN-3010) is necessary to enable the wireless LAN module (GN-1060/C).
The unicode font enabler (GS-1007), data overwrite enabler (GP-1070) and hardcopy
security kit(GP-1190A) is necessary to enable the HDD (GE-1220).
GE-1220 is ADI-HDD (security HDD) and GE-1220C is SATA-HDD (normal HDD).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 13
Job Separator
MJ-5004/C
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 14
Drawer Module
MY-1039/C
Desk
MH-2050
Paper Feed
Unitl (PFU)
MY-1040/C
Manual Pocket
KK-1660/-C
Original Cover
KA-1640PC/-C
Paper Feed
Pedestal (PFP)
KD-1032/C
Reversing Automatic
Document Feeder (RADF)
MR-3024/C
FAX Unit
GD-1320
NA/EU/AU/AS/TW/C
Accessible
Arm
KK-2550
Paper Feed
Controler
GH-1080/C
e-BRIDGE ID Gate
KP-2005/C
e-BRIDGE ID Gate
KP-2004
Work Table
KK-4550
2.3.2
LL20ppm/LL25ppm
Fig. 2-2
2.4
Supplies
Drum
OD-FC30
OD-FC30C (for China)
2
Developer material (K)
D-FC30-K
D-FC30-Y
D-FC30-M
D-FC30-C
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 15
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2 - 16
3.
3.1
Sectional View
3.1.1
Front side
3
[1]
[2]
[23]
[24]
[25]
[26]
[22] [21]
[20]
[3]
[4]
[19]
[5]
[18]
[17]
[16]
[6]
[10]
[7]
[11]
[8]
[12]
[9]
[13]
[14]
[15]
Fig. 3-1
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Scanner unit
Inner tray
Transfer belt
Transfer belt cleaning unit
Waste toner box
Drum (Y)
Drum (M)
Drum (C)
Drum (K)
Developer unit (Y)
Developer unit (M)
Developer unit (C)
Developer unit (K)
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
1st drawer
Bypass feed tray
Main power switch
Registration roller
Image quality control unit
2nd transfer roller
Automatic duplexing unit (ADU) *1
Exit unit
Fuser unit
Toner (Y)
Toner (M)
Toner (C)
Toner (K)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-2
3.1.2
Rear side
M1
3
SYS
LGC
M5
M12
M4
F3
M11
F1
M10
M9
M8
M6
HVT
CLT3
CLT1
M3
M2
PS
CLT2
F2
Fig. 3-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-3
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M8
M9
M10
M11
M12
Scan motor
Feed/Developer motor
Mono/color switching motor
Fuser motor
Exit/Rev motor
Drum/TBU motor
Toner motor-Y
Toner motor-M
Toner motor-C
Toner motor-K
ADU motor
CLT1
CLT2
CLT3
F1
F2
F3
SYS
LGC
HVT
PS
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
Registration clutch
Feed clutch
1st transfer clutch
SYS board cooling fan
Ozone exhaust fan
Ozone suctioning fan
System control PC board (SYS board)
Logic PC board (LGC board)
High-voltage transformer
Switching regulator
3-4
3.2
M1
S23
CCD
S21
S22
KEY
EXP
S25
TCP
S24
DSP
Fig. 3-3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-5
CTIF
CTRG
M11
CTRG
M10
CTRG
M9
CTRG
M8
S9
M7
Fig. 3-4
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-6
M6
CLT3
M3
S12
SW10
S11
SW9
SW14
SW13
S3
S4
SW12
SW11
SW16
SW15
S1
S2
THM4
Fig. 3-5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-7
LED4
LED3
LED2
LED1
S10
ERS-K
ERS-C
ERS-M
ERS-Y
Fig. 3-6
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-8
3
M5
M4
THM2
S13
LAMP1,
LAMP2
THM1
THMO1
THMO2
THM3
Fig. 3-7
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3-9
S8
SOL1
S6
S7
Fig. 3-8
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 10
CLT2
CLT1
S18
M2
S19
SW8
SW6
SW7
S20
S5
Fig. 3-9
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 11
M12
ADU
S14
S15
S17
CLT4
S16
Fig. 3-10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 12
[I]
SSD
LGC
SYS
EEPROM
PS
F3
HVT
SW4
INLET
SRAM
F1
Main Memory
F2
CFD
Fig. 3-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 13
[J]
SW5
DH1
SW3
SW2
SW1
THMO4
DH3
DH2
THMO3
Fig. 3-12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 14
3.3
The column P-I shows the page and item number in the parts list.
3.3.1
Symbol
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
Motors, fans
Name
SCAN-MOT
Scan motor
FEED/DEV-MOT
Paper feeding/developer unit
drive motor
DRM-SW-MOT
Mono/color switching motor
FUS-MOT
Fuser motor
EXIT-MOT
Exit motor
DRM/TBU-MOT
Drum / TBU motor
USD-TNR-MOT
Waste toner paddle motor
M8
TNR-MOT-Y
Toner motor-Y
M9
TNR-MOT-M
Toner motor-M
M10
TNR-MOT-C
Toner motor-C
M11
TNR-MOT-K
Toner motor-K
M12
ADU-MOT
ADU motor
SYS-FAN-MOT
SYS/HDD cooling fan
OZN-FAN-MOT
Ozone exhaust fan
PS-FAN-MOT
PS cooling/Ozone suctioning fan
F1
F2
F3
3.3.2
Symbol
S1
S2
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-3
19-8
Fig. 3-3
17-35
Fig. 3-5
17-39
Fig. 3-7
18-7
Fig. 3-7
18-14
Fig. 3-5
15-43
Fig. 3-4
24-9
Fig. 3-4
36-7
Fig. 3-4
36-7
Fig. 3-4
36-7
Fig. 3-4
36-7
Fig. 3-10
41-16
Fig. 3-11
9-11
Fig. 3-11
7-6
Fig. 3-11
5-6
ATTNR-SNR-K
Auto-toner sensor-K
ATTNR-SNR-C
Auto-toner sensor-C
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-5
33-4
Fig. 3-5
33-4
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 15
Symbol
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
Name
ATTNR-SNR-M
Auto-toner sensor-M
ATTNR-SNR-Y
Auto-toner sensor-Y
CST1-EMP-SNR
1st drawer empty sensor
RGST-PASS-SNR
Registration pass sensor
IMG-POS-SNR-F
Image quality sensor (Front)
S8
IMG-POS-SNR-R
Image quality sensor (Rear) /
Image position aligning sensor
S9
USD-TNR-PDL-SNR
Waste toner paddle rotation
detection sensor
TEMP/HUMI-SNR
Temperature/humidity sensor
S10
S11
S12
S13
S14
S15
S16
S17
S18
S19
S20
S21
S22
DRM-SW-SNR
Drum switching detection sensor
1ST-TRNS-SW-SNR
1st transfer roller status detection
sensor
EXIT-SNR
Exit sensor
ADU-U-SNR
ADU entrance sensor
ADU-L-SNR
ADU exit sensor
SFB-FEED-SNR
Bypass feed sensor
PWA-F-SFB
Paper width detection PC board
(SFB board)
CLNG-SNR
Paper clinging detection sensor
RGST-SNR
Registration sensor
TRANS-SNR
Feed sensor
PLTN-SNR1
Platen sensor-1
PLTN-SNR2
Platen sensor-2
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-5
33-4
Fig. 3-5
33-4
Fig. 3-9
4-6
Fig. 3-8
14-5
Fig. 3-8
14-6
Fig. 3-8
14-6
Fig. 3-4
24-4
Fig. 3-6
5-34
Fig. 3-5
17-36
Fig. 3-5
16-5
Fig. 3-7
39-25
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
Fig. 3-9
14-19
Fig. 3-9
13-5
Fig. 3-9
13-5
Fig. 3-3
19-13
Fig. 3-3
19-13
3 - 16
Symbol
S23
S24
S25
SW1
SW2
Name
HOME-SNR
Carriage home position sensor
APS1
Automatic original detection
sensor-1
APS2
Automatic original detection
sensor-2
FRT-COV-SW
Front cover switch
F-COV-INTLCK-SW
Front cover interlock switch
SW3
S-COV-INTLCK-SW
Side cover interlock switch
SW4
MAIN-SW
Main power switch
SIDE-COV-SW
Side cover switch
CST-SIZE1-SW
1st drawer size detection switch-1
CST-SIZE2-SW
1st drawer size detection switch-2
CST1-SW
1st drawer detection switch
Y-DRUM-SW
Y drum old/new detection switch
M-DRUM-SW
M drum old/new detection switch
C-DRUM-SW
C drum old/new detection switch
K-DRUM-SW
K drum old/new detection switch
Y-DEV-SW
Y developer unit old/new detection
switch
M-DEV-SW
M developer unit old/new detection
switch
C-DEV-SW
C developer unit old/new detection
switch
SW5
SW6
SW7
SW8
SW9
SW10
SW11
SW12
SW13
SW14
SW15
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-3
10-5
Fig. 3-3
10-12
Fig. 3-3
10-12
Fig. 3-9
7-2
Fig. 3-9
7-2
Fig. 3-9
6-39
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Fig. 3-5
31-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 17
Symbol
SW16
3.3.3
Name
Function
K-DEV-SW
K developer unit old/new detection
switch
CLT2
CLT3
CLT4
3.3.4
Symbol
SOL1
3.3.5
Symbol
CCD
DSP
KEY
CTIF
CTRG
ADU
CFD
SYS
LGC
P-I
Fig. 3-5
31-2
Remarks
P-I
Symbol
CLT1
Remarks
Name
RGST-CLT
Registration clutch
FEED-CLT
Feed clutch
1ST-TRNS-CLT
1st transfer contact/release clutch
SFB-FEED-CLT
Bypass feed clutch
Function
Fig. 3-9
17-45
Fig. 3-9
17-15
Fig. 3-5
15-40
Solenoids
Name
SNR-SHUT-SOL
Sensor shutter solenoid
Function
Remarks
Fig. 3-5
P-I
14-32
PC boards
Name
PWA-F-CCD
CCD driving PC board (CCD
board)
PWA-F-DSP
Display PC board (DSP board)
PWA-F-KEY
Key PC board (KEY board)
PWA-F-CTIF
Toner cartridge interface PC
board (CTIF board)
PWA-F-CTRG
Toner cartridge PC board (CTRG
board))
PWA-F-ADU
ADU control PC board (ADU
board)
PWA-F-CFD
Feed control PC board (CFD
board)
PWA-F-SYS
System control PC board (SYS
board)
PWA-F-LGC
Logic PC board (LGC board)
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-3
10-9
3-21
Fig. 3-3
3-22
Fig. 3-4
36-2
Fig. 3-4
Fig. 3-10
41-16
Fig. 3-11
6-1
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
9-19
9-9
3 - 18
Symbol
SRAM
3.3.6
Symbol
EXP
LED1
LED2
LED3
LED4
ERS-Y
ERS-M
ERS-C
ERS-K
LAMP1
LAMP2
DH1
DH2
DH3
3.3.7
Symbol
THM1
THM2
THM3
THM4
THMO1
Name
PWA-F-SRAM
SRAM board
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-11
9-13
LP-EXPO
Exposure lamp
LP-LED-Y
LED print head-Y
LP--LED-M
LED print head-M
LP--LED-C
LED print head-C
LP--LED-K
LED print head-K
LP-ERS-Y
Discharge LED-Y
LP-ERS-M
Discharge LED-M
LP-ERS-C
Discharge LED-C
LP-ERS-K
Discharge LED-K
LP-HTR-C
Center heater lamp
LP-HTR-S
Side heater lamp
SCN-DH-L
Scanner damp heater
DRM-DH-L
Drum damp heater (Left)
DRM-DH-R
Drum damp heater (Right)
Function
Remarks
P-I
Exposing originals
Fig. 3-3
11-3
Fig. 3-6
31-21
Fig. 3-6
31-21
Fig. 3-6
31-21
Fig. 3-6
31-21
Fig. 3-6
31-15
Fig. 3-6
31-15
Fig. 3-6
31-15
Fig. 3-6
31-15
Fig. 3-7
37-8
Fig. 3-7
37-8
Fig. 3-12
10-17
Fig. 3-12
4-20
Fig. 3-12
4-19
Remarks
P-I
Thermistors, thermostats
Name
THMS-FR-C
Fuser roller center thermistor
THMS-FR-S
Fuser roller side thermistor
THMS-FR-E
Fuser roller edge thermistor
THMS-DRM
Drum thermistor
THERMO-FR-C
Fuser roller center thermostat
Function
Fig. 3-6
38-4
Fig. 3-6
38-4
Fig. 3-7
38-4
Fig. 3-7
31-11
Fig. 3-7
37-6
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 19
Symbol
THMO2
THMO3
THMO4
3.3.8
Symbol
TCP
EEPRO
M
SSD
Main
memory
Name
THERMO-FR-S
Fuser roller rear thermostat
THERMO-DRM-DH-L
Drum damp heater thermostat
(Left)
THERMO-DRM-DH-R
Drum damp heater thermostat
(Right)
Function
Remarks
P-I
Fig. 3-7
37-6
Fig. 3-12
4-22
Fig. 3-12
4-21
Function
Remarks
P-I
Others
Name
TCP
Touch panel
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable
Programmable Read Only
Memory
SSD
Solid State Drive
Main memory
PS
PS-ACC
Switching regulator
HVT
PS-HVT
High-voltage transformer
Fig. 3-3
3-29
Fig. 3-11
9-14
Fig. 3-11
9-18
Fig. 3-11
9-20
Fig. 3-11
4-17
Fig. 3-11
8-17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 20
3.4
Copy Process
2
8
Original exposure
Fusing
Paper exit
LED lamp
Hearter lamps
CCD
1st transfer
7
2nd transfer
Image processing
Toner
Carrier
Photoconductive drum
Black development
9
Cleaning
10
Data writing
Bypass feeding
LED head
Drawer feeding
Charger (grid voltage)
PFP/LCF feeding
Fig. 3-13
(1)
(6)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(8)
(9)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 21
3.5
1.
Drum
Photoconducti
Sensitivity
ve drum
e-STUDIO2040C/2540C/3040C/
3540C/4540C
2. Charging
Scorotron type
-300 to -1200 V (grid voltage)
(adjusting by image quality
control)
3. Data writing Light source Semiconductor laser
Light
amount
4. Image control
5.
Development
Magnetic
roller
Auto-toner
detection
Toner
supply
Tonerempty
detection
Toner
Developer
material
Developer
bias
6. Transfer
1st transfer
2nd
transfer:
7. Separation
Method
8.
Photoconducti Recovered
ve drum
toner
cleaning
20ppm/25ppm/LL20ppm/LL25ppm
3.5 nJ/mm2
Image quality control by
detecting toner adhesion amount
One magnetic roller
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 22
Process
e-STUDIO2040C/2540C/3040C/
3540C/4540C
Blade cleaning
LED array (red)
Belt fusing system
Heat roller:
Aluminium roller (30)
(Heater lamp: 600 W x 2)
(Heater lamp: 280 W x 1 (eSTUDIO4540C)
Fuser belt:
PFA tube belt (60)
Fuser roller:
Sponge roller (38)
Pressure roller:
Silicon rubber roller,
(Surface-PFA tube)(40)
(Heater lamp: 280 W x 1)
Cleaning
Heater
temperature
Heater
None
ON/OFF control and power
control by thermistor
Heater lamp
20ppm/25ppm/LL20ppm/LL25ppm
3
-
Fuser roller:
Aluminum rubber coated roller,
(Surface-PFA tube)(30)
(Heater lamp: 570 W x 2))
Pressure roller:
Silicon rubber roller,
(Surface-PFA tube)(30)
(Heater lamp: -)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 23
3.6
General Operation
3.6.1
Overview of Operation
Operation of equipment
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 24
3.6.2
Description of Operation
[ 1 ] Warming-up
1. Initialization
Power ON
Heater lamps (LAMP1, LAMP2) ON
Set number 1, reproduction ratio 100% and Wait Warming Up are displayed.
Fan motors ON
Initialization of feeding system
- Each drawer tray goes up.
Pre-running operation is stopped after five seconds.
- Drum/TBU motor (M6) is turned ON.
- Mono/color switching motor (M3) is turned ON and OFF.
Cleaning of transfer belt
- (Performs color registration control.)*1
- (Performs image quality control.)*1
- Drum/TBU motor (M6) is turned OFF.
Initialization of scanning system
- The carriage moves to the home position.
- The carriage moves to the peak detection position.
- The exposure lamp (EXP) is turned ON.
- Peak detection (white color is detected by the shading correction plate)
- The exposure lamp (EXP) is turned OFF.
- Pre-scanning <forward/backward> moves by 420 mm <A3 (landscape)>.
READY (WARMING UP) is displayed.
2. Pre-running operation
Pre-running operation is started when the temperature of the fuser roller surface reaches a certain
level.
Fuser motor (M4) is turned ON.
- Fuser roller rotation.
Fuser motor (M4) is turned OFF.
- Fuser roller rotation stop.
3. When the temperature of the fuser roller surface becomes sufficient for fusing,
READY is displayed.
*1: Image quality control and color registration control should be performed only at change of
environment or periodical performing timing.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 25
3 - 26
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 27
[ 5 ] Interruption copying
1. Press the [INTERRUPT] button
LED INTERRUPT is turned ON.
Copying operation in progress is temporarily stopped, and the carriages-1 and -2 return to
appropriate positions.
Job interrupted job 1 saved is displayed.
Automatic density and reproduction ratio 100% are set. Set number remains the same.
2. Select the desired copy condition
3. After interruption copying is finished:
Press interrupt to resume job 1 is displayed.
LED INTERRUPT is turned OFF by pressing the [INTERRUPT] button, and the equipment
returns to the status before the interruption.
Ready to resume job 1 is displayed.
4. Press the [START] button
The copying operation before the interruption is resumed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 28
3.6.3
Detection of Abnormality
When something abnormal has occurred in the equipment, symbols corresponding to the type of
abnormality are displayed.
[ 1 ] Types of abnormality
1. Abnormality cleared without turning OFF the door switch
(A) Add paper
(B) Paper misfeed in bypass
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 29
[ 2 ] Description of abnormality
[A] Add paper
[In case of the equipment drawer or PFP drawer] (When drawer is not installed)
Drawer not detected
No paper
When the power is turned ON or LCF drawer is inserted (When the power is turned ON or
equipment/PFP drawers are inserted).
LCF performs initialization.
At this time, the tray-up sensor and LCF empty sensor are OFF.
When the tray-up sensor is not turned ON in a fixed period of time it means that
the tray is in abnormal condition
Add paper is displayed regardless of presence/absence of paper.
Cleared by turning the power ON/OFF
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 30
ON:
OFF:
Empty sensor turned OFF during the copying in spite of the tray-up sensor is ON
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 31
Bypass misfeeding
Solution: The bypass sensor (S16) is turned OFF by removing the paper from the bypass tray.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 32
ON
Registration clutch
Fixed time
ON
Exit sensor
Timer
0
Fixed time
Fig. 3-14
Registration clutch
OFF
Fixed time.
Exit sensor
ON
Timer
Fixed time
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 33
Paper jam (E220, E310, E320, E340 to E360, E3D0 and E3E0: Error code defers depending on
the paper source.)
[D] No toner in the cartridge
Control circuit Install new ** toner cartridge is displayed: the copying operation disabled
Solution
:
Open the front cover and replace the toner cartridge with new one.
Toner is supplied copying operation enabled
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 34
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 35
Rotation of the paddle has not been detected for a specified period
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 36
3.7
3.7.1
Control Panel
General Description
The control panel consists of button switches and touch-panel switches to operate the equipment and
select various modes, and LEDs and an LCD to display the state of the equipment or the messages.
When the operators attention is required, graphic symbols light or blink with messages explaining the
condition of the equipment in the LCD panel. When paper jams and Call for service occur, error codes
are also displayed to notify users of the problem.
A color LCD is used in this equipment so that visibility and operability are improved.
The [ON/OFF] button is placed on the control panel of this equipment. Use this button instead of the
main power switch to turn ON/OFF the power.
Press the [ON/OFF] button for 1 second or more to turn ON/OFF the power of the equipment.
Also, the [ON/OFF] button can be used in the following manner for example: press the [ON/OFF] button
while holding down the [0] and [5] buttons simultaneously to activate the Adjustment Mode (05).
However, if the equipment is in the super sleep mode, use the main power switch.
20ppm/25ppm
Fig. 3-16
LL20ppm/LL25ppm
Fig. 3-17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 37
3.7.2
[1]
[ 1-1 ]
Description of Operation
Fig. 3-18
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 38
3.8
Scanner
3.8.1
General Description
In the scanning section of this equipment, the surface of an original is irradiated with a direct light and
the reflected light is led through mirrors, a lens and a slit to CCD where optical-to-electrical conversion
is performed, converting the optical image data into an electrical (analog) signal. This analog signal is
changed to a digital signal, which then undertakes various corrective processes necessary for image
formation. After that, arithmetic operation is performed on the digital signal, which is then transmitted to
the data writing section.
In this equipment, a reduction-type CCD for color processing is used. What this CCD differs from blackand-white CCDs is that its devices are arranged in 3 lines and covered with color filters (Red, Green,
and Blue). These lines are composed with 3-line color devices and black-and-white device with no filter.
[1]
[2]
[6]
[12]
[7]
[11]
[10] [9]
[8]
Fig. 3-19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 39
3.8.2
Construction
Scanner
Original glass
Carriage-1
Carriage-2
Lens unit
Automatic original
detection sensor
(S24, S25)
Driving section
Other
Original glass
RADF original glass
Exposure lamp (EXP)
Reflector
Mirror-1
Mirror-2
Mirror-3
Lens
CCD driving PC board (CCD)
20ppm/25ppm only
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 40
3.8.3
Functions
The following shows the construction and purpose of the scanning system:
1. Original glass
This is a glass for placing original. The light from the exposure lamp (EXP) is irradiated to the
original through this glass.
The ADF original glass is used when original is read with the Automatic Document Feeder. Original
is transported on the ADF original glass by the Automatic Document Feeder, and the transported
original is read under the ADF original glass by the carriage. Do not use such solvents as alcohol
when cleaning the surface of the ADF original glass, because it is coated so as not to be scratched
by originals.
2. Carriage-1
Carriage-1 consists of the exposure lamp (EXP), reflector, mirror-1, etc. It is driven by the scan
motor (M1) and scans an original on the glass.
[4]
[5]
[1]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[3]
[3]
Fig. 3-20
Reflector
This is a plate to efficiently direct the light from the exposure lamp (EXP) to the surface of the
original on the glass.
Mirror-1
This mirror directs the light reflected from the original to the mirror-2 described later.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 41
3. Carriage-2
Carriage-2 mainly consists of the mirror-2, mirror-3, etc. and directs the reflected light from the
mirror-1 through the mirrors-2 and -3 to the lens.
This carriage is driven by the same scan motor (M1) as that for the carriage-1 at half the scanning
speed of the carriage-1 (The scanning distance is also half that of the carriage-1).
[1]
[2]
Fig. 3-21
[1] Mirror-2
[2] Mirror-3
4. Lens unit
The light reflected from the mirror-3 is led to the CCD placed at the focal point of the lens which is
fixed in a position.
5. CCD driving PC board (CCD)
Processes such as signal amplification, signal integration and A/D conversion are applied on the
electrical signal which was converted by CCD.
[2]
[1]
Fig. 3-22
[1] Lens
[2] CCD board
6. Automatic original detection sensor (S1, S2)
The size of an original placed on the glass is instantly detected using the automatic original
detection sensors (S1, S2) fixed on the base frame without moving the carriage-1.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 42
3.8.4
Description of Operation
[ 1 ] Scanning operation
[2]
[1]
[3]
[7]
[6]
[4]
[5]
Fig. 3-23
Carriage speed
The Carriage speed of the original placed on the original glass in the color mode is the same as
that in the black mode.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 43
3.8.5
In this equipment, detection of original sizes is performed with the combination of a CCD and the
automatic original detection sensors-1 and -2 (S24 and S25).
A size in the primary scanning direction is detected by the CCD while that in the secondary scanning
direction is detected by the sensors.
S25
S24
S21
S22
Fig. 3-24
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 44
[ 2 ] Detection points
Sensor detection points [A4, K Series]
Size 1
3
S24
Size 2
A5-R
Size 3
Size 4
B5-R
16K-R
Size 5
A5
Size 6
A4-R
B4
B5
16K
Size 7
8K
A4
Size 8
A3
Fig. 3-25
S25
S24
Size 1
Size 2
ST-R
ST
Size 3
LT-R
LT
LG
LD
Fig. 3-26
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 45
3.9
Writing Section
3.9.1
General Description
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
[12]
[11]
[10]
[9]
[8]
[7]
[6]
[5]
Fig. 3-27
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 46
3.9.2
An LED print head, which uses an LED (light-emitting diode) as a light source, is equipped for each
color, Y, M, C and K.
The LED light from the LED print head is emitted to the drum through a lens.
A gap between the LED print head and the drum in each color is kept constant with an LED gap spacer.
If this gap is not at the specified value, a focus error may occur, resulting blurring on images.
Therefore an LED gap spacer is a PM part due to possible difference in the gap caused by friction.
Also a dirty lens may cause image troubles such as blurring.
[3]
[3]
[2]
[5]
[1]
[4]
[1]
Fig. 3-28
5V Power
Contorol signal
5V Power
LGC Board
Contorol signal
5V Power
Contorol signal
5V Power
Contorol signal
Fig. 3-29
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 47
3.9.3
The LED print head is contacted or released by the LED print head contact/release lever.
When this lever is held down to the front side of this equipment, the link arm is slid to the front side
together with the lever.
Since the LED print head is positioned by the guide of the link arm, it is lowered (released) as the guide
is lowered.
A gap between the LED print head and the drum in a contacting status is kept at a specified value by
the LED gap spacer.
[1]
[4]
[5]
[5]
[2]
[3]
Fig. 3-30
[1] Drum
[2] LED print head
[3] Link arm
[4] LED print head contact/release lever
[5] LED gap spacer
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 48
3.9.4
Driving Section
[1]
3
[4]
[3]
[5]
[2]
Fig. 3-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 49
[2]
[1]
[12]
[4]
[3]
[8]
[12 ]
[7]
[11]
[6]
[10]
[5]
[9]
Fig. 3-32
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 50
[3]
[1]
[2]
[4]
Fig. 3-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 51
B: Color mode
[3]
[5]
[6]
[2]
[1]
[8]
[7]
[4]
Fig. 3-34
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 52
General Descriptions
This chapter explains how the system works to pick up paper from the drawer or bypass tray and
transport it to the 2nd transfer position.
The paper feeding system mainly consists of the feed roller, registration roller, bypass paper sensor
(S16), drawer empty sensor (S5), bypass feed sensor (S16), registration sensor (S19) and drive
system for these components. The feed/DEV motor (M2) drives the above rollers.
[5]
[1]
[4]
[6]
[3]
[7]
[2]
[8]
[9]
[14]
[13]
[12]
[11]
[10]
Fig. 3-35
[1] Drawer
[2] Feed sensor
[3] Registration sensor
[4] Registration roller
[5] Registration pass sensor
[6] Bypass feed roller
[7] Bypass feed sensor
[8] Bypass tray
[9] Separation pad
[10] Bypass separation pad
[11] Paper feed roller
[12] 1st drawer detection switch
[13] 1st drawer empty sensor
[14] 1st drawer size detection switch
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 53
3.10.2
Composition
Feeding system
Feed clutch
1st drawer empty sensor
1st drawer detection switch
Bypass unit
Feed/DEV motor
Registration clutch
Registration roller
Registration sensor
CLT2
S
SW8
PM parts
PM parts
S16
SFB
CLT4
M2
CLT1
S19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 54
3.10.3
Functions
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 55
3.10.4
Description of Operation
[ 1 ] Drive of rollers
The drive of each motor in the paper feeding area activates the paper transfer roller as follows.
Registration roller
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 56
3
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Fig. 3-36
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 57
[ 3 ] Separation of paper
This model is equipped with a separation pad which works to prevent multiple paper feeding. The
separation pad is pushed to the main paper feed roller by the spring force.
When two or more sheets of paper are fed, since the friction between two sheets of paper is smaller
than that between a sheet and the separation pad, the lower sheets are not transported any further
while the uppermost one is transported by the main paper feed roller.
[1]
A
[2]
B
Fig. 3-37
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 58
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Fig. 3-38
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 59
[ 5 ] Separation of paper
This model is equipped with a separation pad which works to prevent multiple paper feeding. The
separation pad is pushed to the main paper feed roller by the spring force.
When two or more sheets of paper are fed, since the friction between two sheets of paper is smaller
than that between a sheet and the separation pad, the lower sheets are not transported any further
while the uppermost one is transported by the main paper feed roller.
[1]
[2]
[3]
Fig. 3-39
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 60
[ 6 ] General operation
[A] From power-ON to ready status
1. If either of the sensors on the transport path is ON (means there is paper on the transport path)
when the equipment is turned ON, it is determined that a paper jam has occurred and no operation
is enabled until the paper is removed.
[B] Ready status
1. When a drawer is inserted or removed at ready status, to check the availability of paper.
[C] Bypass feeding
The bypass paper sensor (S16) detects availability of paper.
The bypass feed clutch (CLT4) is turned ON and then the bypass pickup roller, bypass feed roller
and bypass transport roller are rotated and start feeding.
The leading edge of paper turns ON the registration sensor (S19) and the paper is aligned by the
registration roller.
The bypass feed clutch (CLT4) is turned OFF, and then the bypass pickup roller, bypass feed roller
and bypass transport roller are stopped.
The registration clutch (CLT1) is turned ON and the paper is transported to the 2nd transfer position.
[D] Drawer feeding
[D-1] 1st drawer
The feed clutch (CLT3) is turned ON, and the feed roller is rotated to start feeding paper.
Passing of the leading edge of the paper turns ON the registration sensor (S19) and the paper is
aligned by the registration roller.
The registration clutch (CLT1) is turned ON and the paper is transported to the 2nd transfer position.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 61
General description
There are 4 cleaner units and 4 developer units, corresponding to the image forming process of the Y,
M, C and K colors. The main charger unit is installed with the cleaner units, while the discharge LEDs
are installed on the equipment side (EPU tray).
This chapter explains about the process unit and parts around this unit which are provided for image
formation. Except the developer unit, which is one of units composing the process unit, is described in
chapter 3.12 in detail.
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[10] [7]
[11]
[8]
[12] [9]
[14]
[13]
Fig. 3-40
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 62
[1]
[14]
[2]
[3]
[13]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
[12]
[1] Drum
[2] Drum cleaner unit
[3] Toner recovery auger
[4] Cleaning blade
[5] Needle electrode cleaner
[6] Discharge LED
[7] Needle electrode
[8] Main charger unit
[9] Main charger grid
[10] LED print head
[11] Mixer
[12] Auto-toner sensor
[13] Doctor blade
[14] Developer sleeve (Magnetic roller)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 63
3.11.2
Composition
Drum
Cleaning blade
Recovery blade
Toner recovery auger
Main charger grid
Needle electrode
Needle electrode
cleaner
Developer unit
Drum thermistor
Discharge LED
Temperature/Humidity
sensor
Ozone filter
Ozone exhaust fan
High-voltage transformer
Drum/TBU motor
Mono/color switching
motor
PM parts
PM parts
PM parts
PM parts
PM parts
Ch. 3.12
THM4
ERS-Y, -M, -C, -K
S10
F2
M6
M3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 64
3.11.3
Functions
1. Drum
Drum is made of a cylindrical aluminum base coated with thin film of organic photoconductive
substance. Photoconductive object becomes insulative (high electrical resistance) when it is not
exposed to lights and becomes conductive (low electrical resistance) when it is exposed to lights.
This object is called photoconductor.
2. Drum cleaner unit
- Cleaning blade
This blade is pressed against the drum surface with a constant force by pressure springs, and
scrapes off the residual toner on the drum surface.
- Recovery blade
This blade prevents the toner which was scraped off by the cleaning blade from being scattered
to the outside.
- Toner recovery auger
This auger carries the residual toner scraped off to the waste toner box.
3. Main charger
The main charger in this equipment consists of a metal rod with U-shaped section, insulated
terminals at both ends of the rod and a needle electrode attached between them. When a high
voltage is applied to the needle electrode, the air around it is charged (ionized). The ionized air then
flows into the drum causing it to be charged. This phenomenon is called corona discharge. At the
same time, a control bias is applied to the main charger grid to control the charging amount. In a
dark place, negative charge is evenly applied onto the drum surface by the corona discharge and
this grid. In addition, a cleaner is installed to clean up the dust attached on the needle electrode.
- Needle electrode
The needle electrode has aligned needles and their points perform the corona discharge.
These points (electrodes) discharge toward the drum in one direction to realize the more
efficient discharging comparing to the charger wire which discharges in a radial direction.
Therefore, the needle electrode enables to reduce the ozone amount.
4. Drum thermistor (THM4)
Since the photoconductive characteristic of the drum surface changes depending on the
temperature of the drum surface, the drum thermistor detects the temperature of the drum surface
and controls to gain the charging potential according to the environment.
5. Discharge LED (ERS-Y, ERS-M, ERS-C, ERS-K)
Discharge is a process to decrease or eliminate the static electricity on the drum surface.
The electrical resistance of the photosensitive layer is decreased by the light, and the residual
charge on the drum surface is neutralized and eliminated (cleaned). Electrical potential of the drum
surface is fixed to a certain amount before the drum is charged.
6. Temperature/humidity sensor (S10)
This sensor measures the environment inside the equipment. The values of the temperature and
humidity detected inside the equipment are output to the LGC board.
7. Ozone filter
Ozone produced by corona discharge of the main charger is exhausted through this filter.
The catalyzer of the ozone filter degrades the ozone.
8. Ozone exhaust fan (F2)
This fan exhausts air through the ozone filter-1.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 65
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 66
3.11.4
When the conditions of the accumulated number of outputs are met, the equipment is shifted to the
drum driving sleep mode, in which the photoconductive drum is rotated without exposure several times.
This mode prevents the photoconductive drum from being contaminated with ozone exhausted inside
of the equipment.
[ 1 ] Function
In the standby mode, the photoconductive drum is rotated without exposure according to the specified
number of times. The more rotations without exposure increase, the more drive count increases.
Consequently, this may reduce the life of the drum.
To prevent a reduction in the life, the drum is rotated without exposure normally once. It is rotated
without exposure several times only under certain conditions.
08-2381
08-2382
08-2383
08-2385
Case in which the equipment needs to be shifted to the drum driving sleep mode
frequently
When uneven density image problem in 94 mm pitch (the circumference of the drum) must be corrected
Set a value smaller than "7" (default) for 08-2385.
Notes:
If MCV (monthly copy volume) is relatively small, the drive count tends to increase quickly when
you set the equipment to shift the drum driving sleep mode often, resulting in a shorter life
[ 3-2 ]
Case in which the equipment needs to be shifted to the drum driving sleep mode
frequently
A: When uneven density image problem in 94 mm pitch (the circumference of the drum) must be
corrected
The ozone exhaust fan keeps rotating for 1 minute after printing is finished. The rotation noise is not
so annoying during this period. Therefore set "0" or "1" for 08-2383 so that the rotation of all drums
without exposure will be finished within 1 minute.
B: When MCV is relatively small (e.g.; 1k)
Set "20" for 08-2385 to reduce the number of times to shift the drum driving sleep mode, or set "0" or
"1" for 08-2383 to reduce the number of drum rotations without exposure.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 67
General Description
This chapter describes the development (developer unit) which is a process of making toner adhere to
the drum.
The developer material which is comprised of a mixture of toner and carrier, and is filled in the
developer unit of each color. The toner is charged to a negative polarity and the carrier to a positive
polarity, due to the friction with each other caused by mixing in the developer unit. The charged toner is
supplied to the photoconductive drum surface by means of a magnetic roller, allowing it to adhere to the
areas on the drum surface where the potential is lower than the developer bias which is applied to the
magnetic roller. Through this process, the latent images are formed on the photoconductive drum
surface.
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[10] [7]
[11]
[8]
[12] [9]
[13]
Fig. 3-42
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 68
3.12.2
Composition
Developer material
Mixer
Developer sleeve
(Magnetic roller)
Doctor blade
Auto-toner sensor
Paper feeding/
developer unit drive
motor
Ch. 3.11
Ch. 3.11
PM parts
3
S1, S2, S3, S4
M2
[1]
[14]
[2]
[3]
[13]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
[12]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 69
3.12.3
Functions
1. Developer material
The developer material consists of the carrier and toner. Since the developer material deteriorates
after a long time use, periodic replacements are needed.
2. Mixer
The carrier and toner are frictionized each other when the developer material is stirred. Then the
carrier is positively charged (+) and the toner is negatively charged (), and the toner is adhered by
the electrostatic force.
3. Developer sleeve (Magnetic roller)
These aluminum rollers have magnets inside. The developer material is pulled by these magnets to
form a magnetic brush. The magnets are fixed at their position so only the sleeve rotates. By this
rotation, the developer material is transported to the developer sleeve.
Then the magnetic brush formed at the developer sleeve sweeps over the drum surface and thus
development is performed.
4. Doctor blade
The doctor blade controls the amount of the developer material from the developer sleeve so that
the magnetic brush of the developer material can contact with the drum surface properly.
5. Auto-toner sensor (S1, S2, S3, S4)
To print out a precise image, the proportion (toner density ratio) of the carrier and the toner in the
developer material needs to be always constant. The magnetic bridge circuit in the black auto-toner
sensor detects the toner ratio in the developer material. This sensor supplies the toner from the
toner cartridge.
6. Paper feeding/developer unit drive motor (M2)
This motor rotates the Y, M, C, K developer units. The drive of the motor is transmitted to each
developer unit by gears in the following 2 lines: Developer motor K developer unit, developer
motor C developer unit M developer unit Y developer unit
7. Toner motor (M8, M9, M10, M11)
These motors drive the paddles and auger in the toner cartridge and transport the toner filled in the
cartridge to the developer unit. Each toner cartridge of Y, M, C and K mounts one toner motor
correspondingly.
8. Waste toner paddle motor (M7)
This motor rotates the paddles mounted in the Waste toner box to level the Waste toner
accumulated in the waste toner box.
9. Waste toner box
This collects the residual toner scraped off on the drum surface by the cleaning blade and residual
toner scraped off on the transfer belt by the transfer belt cleaning blade.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 70
3.12.4
An IC chip is embedded in this board. Data such as identification information for the recommended
TOSHIBA toner cartridge, thresholds to determine if the cartridge is nearly empty, and controlling data
for the image quality to be optimal according to the toner characteristics are written in this chip.
To measure the amount of toner remaining in the cartridge, when the value of the counter for the period
of the toner cartridge rotation time (08-6246) is updated, this equipment writes the updated value into
the toner cartridge PC board (CTRG).
These data written in the toner cartridge PC board (CTRG) enable the functions below, and accordingly
this equipment operates as shown below.
Data reading is performed every time when the power is turned ON, the front cover is closed, a job is
finished and the equipment has recovered from the sleep mode.
[ 2 ] Functions
[ 3 ] Operations
AA sign of the status in which the toner cartridge is nearly empty (displayed by the behavior of the toner
lamp) appears when the counter value for the toner cartridge rotation time has exceeded the threshold
previously written in the toner cartridge PC board (CTRG).
When a used cartridge refilled with new toner is used, a sign of the status that the toner cartridge is
empty appears because information for determining the empty status is already written in the toner
cartridge PC board (CTRG).
When a non-recommended toner cartridge is used, Toner not recognized appears on the touch panel,
and then the equipment may stop normal operations. The toner remaining display function, the toner
remaining check function, the automatic remote supply order to TOSHIBA sales representatives and
the image optimization function may be disabled either.
The toner near-empty status threshold setting (08-5155) is provided to adjust the timing for displaying
the toner near-empty status as follows.
The toner near-empty status threshold setting (08-5155)
0: The period from the appearance of the toner near-empty sign to the actual complete consumption of
the toner is set to the long.
1: Normal (Default)
2: The period from the appearance of the toner near-empty sign to the actual complete consumption of
the toner is set to the short.
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 71
3.12.5
The waste toner box is installed inside of the front cover, and collects waste toner discharged from a
cleaner for each color and the transfer belt cleaner.
The front cover is designed not to be closed without installing the waste toner box in this equipment.
The paddle embedded in the waste toner box is rotated by the waste toner paddle motor (M7).
The rotation status of the paddle is detected by the waste toner paddle rotation detection sensor (S9).
In this equipment, a sensor detecting the full status of waste toner is not equipped.
Instead, the waste toner box full is judged when the waste toner has been accumulated in the box and
the rotation of the paddle has not been detected for a specified period.
[1]
[1]
[3]
[6]
[2]
[4]
[5]
[3]
[4]
[6]
[5]
Fig. 3-44
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 72
General Descriptions
Transfer is a process of decaling a toner image from the photoconductive drum onto paper.
A toner image formed on the photoconductive drum is temporarily transferred onto the transfer belt,
and the toner image is then transferred from the transfer belt onto paper. The first transfer from the
drum to the transfer belt is called the 1st transfer, and the second transfer from the transfer belt to paper
is called the 2nd transfer. To form a color image, the images of yellow (Y), magenta (M), cyan (C) and
black (K) are transferred and overlaid on the transfer belt in order, and then the overlaid images are
transferred onto paper.
After the completion of the 2nd transfer, the residual toner on the transfer belt is scraped off by the
transfer belt cleaning blade and then transported to the waste toner box.
[11]
[3]
[1]
[6]
[2]
[14]
[13]
[12]
[4]
[7]
[8]
[9]
[5]
Fig. 3-45
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 73
3.13.2
Composition
Transfer belt
1st transfer roller
Drive roller
Tension roller
2nd transfer facing roller
Lift roller
Idling roller
1st transfer roller cam motor
1st transfer roller status detection sensor
Transfer belt cleaning blade
Waste toner auger
2nd transfer roller
Paper clinging detection sensor
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
Y, M, C, K
M8
S15
PM parts
S18
S7 / S8
3 - 74
General Description
Two image position aligning sensors are mounted inside of the 2nd transfer front guide beneath the
transfer belt.
The image position aligning sensor on the rear side combines its own functions with those of the image
quality sensors.
At this control, image forming conditions are automatically adjusted so as to minimize the change in the
image density or tone reproduction caused by the fluctuation of working environment or life of supply
items.
At first, the image quality sensor (S18) operates to output reflected light amount voltage when no toner
image is formed on the transfer belt. The output voltage is then converted analog-to-digital to be output
as the reflected light amount signal. The light source amount voltage of the sensor is adjusted to
correspond with the value set in advance and the output value of reflected light amount signal at this
adjustment is stored. This output value is considered as the reading of the belt surface. Next, the
sensor outputs the reflected light amount signal when a test pattern is developed on the transfer belt.
This output value is considered as the reading of the toner image.
The difference between the reading of the transfer belt and that of the toner image is defined as toner
adhesion amount. Image forming conditions are determined in approximating this toner adhesion
amount to the value set in advance.
[4]
[1], [2]
[3]
Fig. 3-46
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 75
General Description
Toner is fused by applying heat and pressure on the transferred image on the paper which is transported to the fuser unit. The paper is then transported to the inner tray, paper exiting options or ADU.
The fuser unit consists of the heater lamps, heat roller, fuser roller, pressure roller, separation fingers,
thermistors, thermostats, etc.
The heat roller, fuser roller and pressure roller in the fuser unit are driven by the fuser motor, and the
exit roller is driven by the exit motor.
[13]
[11]
[12]
[1]
[10]
[2], [3]
[9]
[4]
[5]
[8]
[6], [7]
Fig. 3-47
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 76
3.15.2
Composition
LAMP1 (570 W)
LAMP2 (570 W)
THM1
THM2
THM3
THMO1
THMO2
M4
S13
M5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 77
3.15.3
Fuser unit
Switching regulator
L
N
AC-DC
power
supply
Cover interlock
switch
Heat roller
edge
thermistor
Heat roller
center
thermistor
LGC board
A/D
converter
Main switch
Relay
Heat roller
side
thermistor
+5VSW
ASIC
Heater lamp
control circuit
AC line
DC line
RLYON signal
Fig. 3-48
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 78
[ 1-2 ]
If the error codes [C411] to [C452] are displayed and still not cleared even though the thermistor,
thermostat and heater lamp have been repaired (and the power ON/OFF does not clear the error),
check the Setting Mode (08-2002) to set the fuser unit error status counter to 0.
Remarks:
The fuser unit error status counter (Setting Mode (08-2002)) never has values other than 0 to 62.
If the heater lamps do not turn ON and the service call [C411] or [C412] is displayed immediately
after the power is ON, ensure the fuser unit error status counter is 62 or over. If it is 62 or over, be
sure to check the thermistor, thermostat and heater lamp. Reset the counter to 0 after repairing
them, then turn ON the power.
If the fuser unit error status counter is g62h or more, EEPROM or its data may have been ruined
due to leakage from the chargers.
Check the bias, high-voltage transformers and needle electrodes for defects, and also look through
all the data in EEPROM.
When the thermistors detect overheating, the engine CPU decides the error code and counter value
of the fuser unit error status. After turning OFF each output (the heater lamp, exposure lamp, control
panel display, motors and so on), the engine CPU turns OFF the power to protect the fuser unit.
Error code: C449, C468 ([C] and [8])
Counter value of the fuser unit error status: 8, 9, 18 to 23, 25 to 29 (08-2002)
Thermistors continue detecting the abnormal temperature even after the error codes and counter
values are decided. Even if the power is turned ON immediately, it is automatically turned OFF again
when the surface temperature of the fuser belt is still higher than the abnormal temperature
detected.
Wait until the surface temperature of the fuser belt is lowered enough, and turn ON the power to
check the counter value while it is turned OFF again. After confirming that it is the fuser unit
abnormality, correct the abnormality and reset the counter value (08-2002) to 0 to start up the
equipment normally.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 79
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 80
Check
timing
Power ON
Detecting
40C
Ready
temperatu
re is
detected
(Center or
Side)
During
ready
During
printing
At energy
saving
mode
Con
ditio
n
Temperature judged
Center
200C
or above
40C
or below
150C
or above
150C
or above
--200C
or above
40C
or below
Error
code
Fuser roller
thermistor
Side
200C
or above
150C
or above
40C
or below
--150C
or above
200C
or above
40C
or below
Edge
230C
or above
---
Counter
(082002)
C449
C412
C449
19
C411
C412
C450
(1)
2
(38)
C451
41
C450
C452
(48)
50
C449
22
C445
C446
(5)
6
C450
(38)
C451
41
C450
C452
(48)
50
C449
23
C447
C449
25
C447
24
C449
27
Error
judging
timing
Power ON
--40C
or below
40C
or below
230C
or above
40C
or below
On usual
On usual
On usual
On usual
On usual
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 81
Check
timing
At paper
jam
*
*
Con
ditio
n
Temperature judged
Center
200C
or above
Error
code
Fuser roller
thermistor
Side
200C
or above
Edge
230C
or above
C449
Counter
(082002)
29
Error
judging
timing
On usual
The figures in the Condition field denote the priority of error checking.
The figures in the Error code and Counter fields with parentheses denote that an error status has
not yet been determined (= error status is detected only once).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 82
General Description
The Automatic Duplexing Unit (ADU) is a unit to automatically print on both sides of paper. A
switchback method using the exit roller is adopted for the ADU of this equipment.
A sheet of paper is switchbacked by the exit roller right after the printing operation (fusing operation) on
one side is completed, and the reversed sheet is transported to the registration section for the other
side of the sheet to be printed.
The ADU mainly consists of the transport rollers and their drive system, paper guide and ADU entrance
/ exit sensor.
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[6]
[5]
Fig. 3-49
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 83
3.16.2
Composition
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 84
3.16.3
Drive of ADU
When the ADU motor (M12) rotates, the upper transport roller and lower transport roller are rotated
driven by the gears and belt.
[1]
3
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
Fig. 3-50
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 85
3.16.4
Description of Operations
The back side printing (recording data of the back side of paper) is performed first by selecting duplex
printing mode and pressing the [START] button. When the trailing edge of the paper passes the exit
gate, the paper is switchbacked by the exit roller and transported into the ADU (the exit gate is closed
with its own weight), and then the switchbacked paper is transported with acceleration. The
transportation decelerates when the ADU exit sensor (S15) detects the paper. The front side printing
(recording data of the front side of paper) is performed at the registration section. The paper passes
through the exit gate again and is transported to the inner tray to complete duplex printing.
There are three methods of judging a paper jam: (1) whether the ADU entrance sensor (S14) is turned
ON or not in a specified period of time after the switchback to the ADU started (E510). (2) whether the
ADU exit sensor (S15) is turned ON or not in a specified period of time after the ADU entrance sensor
(S14) is turned ON (E520). (3) whether the registration sensor (S19) is turned ON or not in a specified
period of time after the paper feeding from the ADU to the equipment (E110).
If the ADU is opened during duplex printing, the ADU motor (M12) is stopped, namely, ADU open jam
occurs (E430).
The equipment is never to be stopped during printing by interruption in any case except paper jam or
service call, if paper remains in the ADU.
The operation of the duplex printing differs depending on the size of the paper; single-paper circulation
and alternateness circulation. The figures in the following pages show the circulating operations during
duplex copying. The numbers in the figures indicate the page numbers.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 86
1. Single-paper circulation
With the paper larger than A4/LT size, duplex printing (back-side printingfront-side printing) is
performed for one sheet at a time as shown below.
Fig. 3-51
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 87
General description
The power supply unit consists of AC filters, insulation-type DC output circuits and heater lamp control
circuits in order to supply stable DC and AC voltage to each electric part of this equipment.
3.17.2
Functions
The power supply unit consists of the AC filter, insulation type DC output circuits and heater lamp
control circuit.
1. AC filter
Eliminates noise from the outside and prevents the noise generated by the equipment from leaking
to the outside.
2. DC output circuits
Converts AC voltage input from outside to DC voltage and supplies it to each electric part. The DC
voltage is divided into the following two lines.
a. Main power switch line:
Power supply used in the entire equipment during image forming process. Two kinds of voltage
(+5VS and +12 VA) are output when the main power switch of the equipment is turned ON.
b. Cover switch line:
Power supply used in the entire equipment during image forming process, being supplied via the
cover switch. The voltage (+24 VD) is output only when the main power switch of the equipment is
turned ON and two covers (front cover and automatic duplexing unit) are closed.
3. Heater lamp control circuit
TRC (Triac) is driven by the heater control signal (SLAMP-ON, CLAMP-ON) from the LGC board
and then AC power is supplied to each heater lamp (center heater lamp, side heater lamp) in the
fuser unit.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 88
3.17.3
When the Super sleep mode is set to be disabled on the control panel, TopAccess and with the
code 08-8543
When the Wireless LAN Module, Bluetooth Module, e-BRIDGE ID Gate or Data Overwrite
Enabler is installed, or when the IPsec Enabler is installed and its function is set to be enabled
When operation is being performed in the self-diagnosis mode (Disabled until the main switch is
turned OFF)
Sleep mode
Since +24VD DC voltages are not supplied but +12VA and +5VS DC voltages only, the
equipment does not enter into the ready state.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 89
3.17.4
Output Channel
The following are output channels for the main power switch line.
main power switch line
Connector
CN511
CN512
CN514
Pin No.
5
6
9
10
11
5
6
7
2
Voltage
Destination
+5VS
SYS board
RADF (via SYS board)
+12VA
+12VA
LGC board
+12VA
PFC board
The following are output channels for the cover switch line.
Cover switch line
Connector
CN512
CN513
CN514
Pin No.
17
18
19
20
1
5
6
Voltage
Destination
+24VD1
LGC board
HVT (via LGC board)
CFD board (via LGC board)
ADU board (via LGC board)
+24VD2
+24VD3
+24VD4
+24VD5
SYS board
PFC board
Finisher
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 90
3.17.5
Fuse
When the power supply secondary fuse is blown out, confirm that there is no abnormality with each part
using the following table.
Voltage
+24VD1
Board/Unit
Part
+24VD3
LGC board
+24VD4
SYS board
Auto-toner sensor-K
Auto-toner sensor-C
Auto-toner sensor-M
Auto-toner sensor-Y
SYS board cooling fan
Ozone exhaust fan
Ozone suctioning fan
Registration clutch
Feed clutch
Mono/color switching motor
Toner motor-Y
Toner motor-M
Toner motor-C
Toner motor-K
Sensor shutter solenoid
High-voltage transformer
Paper feeding/developer unit
drive motor
Fuser motor
Exit motor
Discharge LED-K
Discharge LED-C
Discharge LED-M
Discharge LED-Y
Bridge unit, JSP
Key copy counter, copy key
card, coin controller
Drum/TBU motor
ADU motor
1st drawer feed clutch
Bypass feed clutch
CFD board
Scan motor
+24VD5
PFC board
+24VD2
LGC board
LGC board
Fuse type
S1
S2
S3
S4
F1
F2
F3
CLT1
CLT2
M3
M8
M9
M10
M11
SOL1
HVT
M2
F201:
4 A (Semi time-lag)
F202:
4 A (Semi time-lag)
M4
M5
ERS-K
ERS-C
ERS-M
ERS-Y
M6
M12
CLT3
CLT4
CFD
M1
-
F203:
4 A (Semi time-lag)
F204:
4 A (Semi time-lag)
F205:
4 A (Semi time-lag)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 91
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
OUTLINE OF THE MACHINE
3 - 92
4.
4.1
Covers
4.1.1
(1)
(2)
Front cover
Fig. 4-1
4.1.2
(1)
(2)
Left cover
[2]
Fig. 4-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-1
4.1.3
(1)
(2)
Receiving tray
Fig. 4-3
4.1.4
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-4
4.1.5
(1)
Fig. 4-5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-2
4.1.6
(1)
(2)
(3)
[1]
Fig. 4-6
4.1.7
(1)
Fig. 4-7
4.1.8
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-8
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-3
4.1.9
(1)
(2)
[1]
Fig. 4-9
4.1.10
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-10
4.1.11
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-4
4.1.12
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-12
4.1.13
(1)
Rear cover
Fig. 4-13
4.1.14
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-14
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-5
(3)
Fig. 4-15
4.1.15
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-16
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-6
4.2
Control Panel
4.2.1
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-17
(5)
(6)
(7)
Fig. 4-18
Notes:
When installing, pass the harness through
the harness clamp of the frame.
Fig. 4-19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-7
4.2.2
(1)
(2)
KEY board
Fig. 4-20
(3)
Fig. 4-21
4.2.3
(1)
(2)
DSP board
Fig. 4-22
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-8
(3)
Fig. 4-23
(4)
(5)
Fig. 4-24
4.2.4
(1)
(2)
Touch panel
Fig. 4-25
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4-9
(3)
Fig. 4-26
(4)
Fig. 4-27
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 10
4.3
Scanner Unit
Notes:
Since the scanner section is assembled with high precision, be sure not to perform any
disassembling other than that instructed in the Service Manual.
4.3.1
(1)
(2)
Original glass
Notes:
Make sure that the original glass [2] is
securely inserted into the groove of the
fixing part of the original glass [1].
Securely insert 2 pins of the original glass
[1] into the holes in the frame.
Fig. 4-28
4.3.2
(1)
(2)
Lens cover
Fig. 4-29
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 11
4.3.3
(1)
(2)
Notes:
Only the 20ppm/25ppm are equipped with
automatic original detection sensors 1
and 2.
A4 models are equipped only with
automatic original detection sensor 1 and
LT models are equipped with automatic
original detection sensors 1 and 2.
Fig. 4-30
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 12
4.3.4
(1)
(2)
Notes:
1. The CCD lens unit is adjusted finely, so
the re-adjustment or replacement of some
parts are impossible in the field. The lens unit
must be replaced on a unit basis.
2. Handle the lens unit with care. Do not hold
the adjustment unit or lens.
3. When replacing the lens unit, do not touch
the screws (7 places).
Fig. 4-31
Fig. 4-32
Fig. 4-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 13
4.3.5
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-34
(3)
Fig. 4-35
(4)
Fig. 4-36
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 14
4.3.6
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-37
Notes:
To move the carriage, manually rotate the
drive pulley.
Fig. 4-38
(3)
Fig. 4-39
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 15
(4)
Fig. 4-40
(5)
Fig. 4-41
4.3.7
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-42
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 16
(3)
Notes:
When installing the scan motor, use the belt
tension jig.
P. 6-79 "6.6.3 Belt tension adjustment of
the Scan motor"
Fig. 4-43
(4)
Fig. 4-44
4.3.8
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-45
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 17
(3)
Fig. 4-46
4.3.9
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Carriage-1
Fig. 4-47
Notes:
To move the carriage, manually rotate the
drive pulley.
Fig. 4-48
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 18
(5)
Remove 2 screws.
Fig. 4-49
(6)
Fig. 4-50
Notes:
Follow the procedure below to connect the
exposure lamp harness.
1. Push carriage-1 and -2 to the leftmost
side and fix carriage-1.
2. Securely install the exposure lamp
harness on the cable guide and SYS
board.
3. After connecting the exposure lamp
harness, move carriage-1 to the leftmost
side and check the lamp harness for any
twists.
Fig. 4-51
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 19
4.3.10
Remove carriage-1.
P. 4-18 "4.3.9 Carriage-1"
Move carriage-2 to the center.
Attach the wire holder jig to the pulley to
prevent the wire from coming loose.
Fig. 4-52
Notes:
1. When attaching the wire holder jig [1],
make sure that the wire has not shifted or
become loose.
2. The wire should come out of the slot of
the wire holder jig [1] and be passed
under the jig arm [2].
3. When installing the wire holder jig, be
careful of the orientation.
[2]
[1]
[1]
Fig. 4-53
(4)
(5)
Fig. 4-54
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 20
(6)
Notes:
Replace mirror-2 and -3 together with
carriage-2 [1]. Do not remove mirror-2 and 3.
Fig. 4-55
[7]
[3]
[2]
[4]
[5]
[1]
Notes:
It is not necessary to adjust the carriage wire
tension since a certain tension is applied to
the carriage wires through the tension
springs. Make sure the tension applied to the
wire is normal.
[6]
Fig. 4-56
[8]
[3]
[2]
[4]
[5]
[1]
[6]
Fig. 4-57
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 21
(2)
Notes:
When winding the wire onto the pulley, be
sure to note the following.
Do not twist the wire.
Wind the wires tightly so that they are in
complete contact with the surface of the
pulleys.
Each turn should be pushed against the
previously wound turn so that there is no
space between them.
[6]
[3]
[5]
[1]
[2]
[7]
Fig. 4-58
[5]
[4]
[6]
[1]
[2]
[8]
Fig. 4-59
(3)
Notes:
1. When attaching the wire holder jig [1],
make sure that the wire has not shifted or
become loose.
2. The wire should come out of the slot of
the wire holder jig [1] and be passed
under the jig arm [2].
3. When installing the wire holder jig, be
careful of the orientation.
[2]
[1]
[1]
Fig. 4-60
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 22
4.3.11
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-61
(3)
Fig. 4-62
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 23
4.4
LED Unit
4.4.1
(1)
(2)
(3)
LED Tray
Fig. 4-63
(4)
Fig. 4-64
Notes:
When installing the flat cable, be careful
not to insert it at an angle.
Do not apply pressure to or damage the
edge of the flat cable.
When installing the flat cable, do not push
it in strongly.
Fig. 4-65
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 24
(5)
Fig. 4-66
(6)
Fig. 4-67
Notes:
Store the connector inside the jig.
Fig. 4-68
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 25
(7)
(8)
Fig. 4-69
Notes:
Always hold both sides of the LED tray,
and be careful not to touch the LED.
Be careful not to leave any fingerprints on
the lens of the LED printer head.
The LED tray is a precision unit, so be
careful when handling it so that it is not
subjected to impact or vibration.
The LED print head is an electrical part,
so be careful of static electricity when
handling it. In particular, exercise great
care when handling the LED print head
connector part.
When installing the LED tray, attach the
harness holding the jig and pass the
harness through the hole in the frame.
When installing the LED tray, mount the
attachment screw from the left side.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
Fig. 4-70
4 - 26
4.4.2
(1)
(2)
Discharge LED
Fig. 4-71
(3)
Fig. 4-72
(4)
Fig. 4-73
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 27
4.4.3
Notes:
The LED printer head is an electrical part, so be careful of static electricity when handling it. In
particular, exercise great care when handling the LED head connector part.
If you accidentally touch the LED print head, clean it using a dry cloth to remove stains. If
grease adhered to the LED head, clean it with alcohol.
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-74
(3)
Fig. 4-75
(4)
Fig. 4-76
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 28
(5)
Tilt the LED print head [1] toward the left side
to release the latch in order to remove it.
Fig. 4-77
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 29
Notes:
Make sure that the plate spring [1] on the
front of the LED print head is placed in the
groove [2].
Fig. 4-78
Fig. 4-79
Fig. 4-80
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 30
Notes:
When installing the LED print head, push
both sides [3] and then the center part [4]
of the head inside. Then, make sure that
the head is securely installed.
After the link has been installed, check
the contact/release operations.
4
Fig. 4-81
(6)
Fig. 4-82
(7)
Fig. 4-83
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 31
Notes:
When installing the flat cable, do not push
it in strongly.
When installing the flat cable, be careful
not to insert it at an angle.
Do not apply pressure to or damage the
edge of the flat cable.
Fig. 4-84
(8)
Fig. 4-85
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 32
Notes:
When installing the LED printer head, make
sure that the flanges [1] in the front and rear
sides of the LED printer head are inside the
flat spring [2].
Fig. 4-86
Fig. 4-87
(9)
Fig. 4-88
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 33
4.4.4
(1)
(2)
LED spacer
Notes:
When attaching the LED spacer, make sure
that it is placed in the correct orientation.
Fig. 4-89
Fig. 4-90
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 34
4.5
4.5.1
(1)
(2)
Bypass unit
Fig. 4-91
(3)
Notes:
When removing the paper width detection
PC board cover, be careful not to drop the
gear web washers or washers.
Fig. 4-92
(4)
Notes:
When removing the hinge stoppers, move
the projection portion to the wider part of the
groove.
Fig. 4-93
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 35
(5)
Fig. 4-94
(6)
Fig. 4-95
(7)
Fig. 4-96
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 36
4.5.2
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-97
(3)
Fig. 4-98
4.5.3
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-99
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 37
4.5.4
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-100
(3)
Notes:
When removing the paper width detection
PC board cover, be careful not to drop the
gear web washers or washers.
Fig. 4-101
4.5.5
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-102
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 38
(3)
Fig. 4-103
(4)
Fig. 4-104
4.5.6
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-105
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 39
(3)
Fig. 4-106
4.5.7
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-107
4.5.8
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-108
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 40
(3)
Fig. 4-109
4.5.9
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-110
(3)
Fig. 4-111
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 41
4.5.10
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-112
4.5.11
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-113
4.5.12
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-114
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 42
4.5.13
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-115
(3)
Fig. 4-116
(4)
Fig. 4-117
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 43
(5)
Fig. 4-118
(6)
Fig. 4-119
(7)
Fig. 4-120
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 44
4.5.14
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-121
Notes:
When installing the registration clutch, align
the clutch stopper with the frame projection.
Fig. 4-122
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 45
4.5.15
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Registration roller
Fig. 4-123
Fig. 4-124
(5)
Fig. 4-125
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 46
4.5.16
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-126
(3)
Fig. 4-127
(4)
Fig. 4-128
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 47
(5)
Fig. 4-129
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 48
4.6
4.6.1
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-130
4.6.2
(1)
(2)
Developer unit
Fig. 4-131
Notes:
When inserting the developer unit, align the
corner [1] of the developer unit guide with the
R part [2], and the corner [3] of the developer
unit with the R part [4].
Fig. 4-132
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 49
Notes:
Do not peel off the film [1] on the upper part
of the developer unit.
Fig. 4-133
4.6.3
Developer material
Fig. 4-134
(3)
(4)
Remove 1 screw.
Release the hook and remove the mixer
shaft cover [1].
Fig. 4-135
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 50
(5)
Fig. 4-136
(6)
Fig. 4-137
(7)
Fig. 4-138
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 51
(8)
Notes:
Do not remove the developer material
adhering to the magnetic rubber in the upper
cover.
Fig. 4-139
Notes:
Do not remove the developer material
adhering to the magnetic rubber in the upper
cover.
Fig. 4-140
(9)
Notes:
Make sure not to have developer material
adhering to the drive gears or bushings.
If the developer material on the developer
sleeve is hard to come off, use a brush
(jig) to clean it off.
4407915710 BRUSH-33
Fig. 4-141
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 52
Fig. 4-142
(3)
Fig. 4-143
(4)
Fig. 4-144
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 53
(5)
Fig. 4-145
(6)
Notes:
Fill the developer material in the mixer
section under the developer sleeve as
much as possible.
Check if the developer does not adhered
to the joint of the upper cover.
Fig. 4-146
(7)
Notes:
After the installation, check that all the
protrusions and latches are fitted and locked
securely.
Fig. 4-147
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 54
Notes:
Do not install the upper cover from the rear
side by tilting it as shown in the figure.
4
Fig. 4-148
Notes:
Hook the latches, and then install the cover
while holding it from above.
Fig. 4-149
Notes:
Check that the seal material is not folded
down. The folding allowance shall be 0.7 mm
or less.
MAX 0.7
Fig. 4-150
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 55
4.6.4
(1)
(2)
Doctor blade
Fig. 4-151
4.6.5
(2)
Fig. 4-152
(3)
(4)
Disconnect 1 connector.
Lift the rib up and remove the auto-toner
sensor by turning it clockwise.
Fig. 4-153
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 56
4.6.6
(1)
(2)
(3)
Development sleeve
Fig. 4-154
(4)
Notes:
When installing, align the idler gear shaft to
the hole of the gear holder.
(5) Disconnect the connector from the gear
cover.
Fig. 4-155
(6)
Fig. 4-156
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 57
(7)
(8)
Remove 1 screw.
Release the hook and remove the mixer
shaft cover [1].
Fig. 4-157
(9)
Fig. 4-158
4.6.7
(1)
(2)
Mixer
Fig. 4-159
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 58
(3)
Fig. 4-160
Notes:
When installing a separator, turn the short
collar [1] side to the left.
Fig. 4-161
4.6.8
(1)
(2)
Cleaner unit
Notes:
Before removing the cleaner unit, be sure
to take off the developer unit for the
corresponding color.
When installing the cleaner, make sure to
correspond to the color.
Fig. 4-162
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 59
Notes:
To remove the cleaner unit for black (K), pull
the TBU release lever, turn it clockwise to
release the lock, and then pull out the
cleaner unit.
Fig. 4-163
4.6.9
(1)
(2)
Main charger
Fig. 4-164
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 60
(3)
Fig. 4-165
Fig. 4-166
(4)
Fig. 4-167
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 61
(5)
Fig. 4-168
4.6.10
(1)
(2)
(3)
Drum
Fig. 4-169
(4)
Fig. 4-170
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 62
(5)
Notes:
Be sure not to touch, spit or scratch on
the drum surface.
Avoid a direct sunlight onto the drum.
Move it to a dark place as soon as it is
taken off.
Be sure not to touch or scratch the edge
of the drum cleaning blade.
Fig. 4-171
4.6.11
(1)
(2)
Notes:
Be sure not to touch or scratch the edge of
the cleaning blade.
Fig. 4-172
4.6.12
(1)
(2)
Notes:
To remove the gear, and release the lock by
raising the latch.
Fig. 4-173
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 63
4.6.13
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-174
(3)
Notes:
Do not touch the mesh area of the grid.
When installing the grid, be careful not to
let the urethane sheet adhered to the
charge case get caught in it.
Fig. 4-175
Notes:
There are 2 holes on the rear side of the
main charger grid for determining which is
the front or back surface. Be sure to place
the grid so that the 2 holes come as shown in
the figure.
Fig. 4-176
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 64
4.6.14
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-177
4.6.15
(1)
(2)
Needle electrode
Notes:
When installing the needle electrode, be sure
of the following:
Be sure that its needle comes at its top
side.
Hook the needle electrode and the spring
on both front and rear terminals securely.
Do not twist the needle electrode.
Do not touch the needle electrode directly
with bare hands.
4.6.16
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-178
Fig. 4-179
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 65
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-180
(7)
Fig. 4-181
(8)
Fig. 4-182
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 66
(9)
Fig. 4-183
Fig. 4-184
Fig. 4-185
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 67
Fig. 4-186
Fig. 4-187
Fig. 4-188
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 68
4.6.17
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-189
4.6.18
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-190
(7)
Fig. 4-191
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 69
4.6.19
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-192
4.6.20
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-193
(7)
Fig. 4-194
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 70
(8)
Fig. 4-195
(9)
Fig. 4-196
4.6.21
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-197
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 71
(4)
Fig. 4-198
4.6.22
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-199
(4)
Notes:
When installing the drum switching motor
bracket, put the gear projection into the arm
hole.
Fig. 4-200
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 72
(5)
Notes:
Before removing the gear, place a marking
so that it can be re-assembled at the same
position.
Fig. 4-201
(6)
Notes:
Pay attention to the size (length) of the
screws. If incorrect ones are used, the motor
could be damaged.
Fig. 4-202
4.6.23
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-203
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 73
4.6.24
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Fig. 4-204
Notes:
If an optional PFU is installed, press the drive
gear [2] down and install the drive unit.
Fig. 4-205
4.6.25
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-206
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 74
(3)
Fig. 4-207
4.6.26
Fig. 4-208
Notes:
When installing the toner cartridge rail,
securely align at the position at which the
frame matches the rail groove.
Fig. 4-209
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 75
(4)
Fig. 4-210
Fig. 4-211
4.6.27
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-212
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 76
(3)
Fig. 4-213
(4)
Notes:
Pay attention to the size (length) of the
screws. If incorrect ones are used, the motor
could be damaged.
Fig. 4-214
4.6.28
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-215
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 77
4.6.29
(1)
(2)
Ozone filter
Fig. 4-216
4.6.30
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-217
(3)
Fig. 4-218
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 78
4.6.31
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-219
(4)
Fig. 4-220
4.6.32
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-221
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 79
(7)
Fig. 4-222
4.6.33
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-223
(3)
Fig. 4-224
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 80
Notes:
When installing the drum drive gear cover,
make sure that the spring is engaged with
the concave portion of the gear.
Fig. 4-225
(4)
Fig. 4-226
4.6.34
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-227
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 81
(3)
Fig. 4-228
4.6.35
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-229
(7)
Fig. 4-230
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 82
4.7
4.7.1
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-231
4.7.2
(1)
(2)
(3)
Notes:
After the blade seals have been attached, be
sure that no gap is left between the blade
seals and the edge of the transfer belt
cleaning blade.
Fig. 4-232
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 83
4.7.3
Notes:
You are recommended to wear gloves so that you do not touch the surface of the transfer belt
with bare hands.
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-233
(3)
Fig. 4-234
(4)
Fig. 4-235
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 84
Notes:
Be careful not to generate any friction
between the transfer belt and the 2nd
transfer roller unit when pulling out the
transfer belt unit.
When installing the transfer belt unit,
make sure that the lever [1] is pulled out.
When installing the transfer belt unit,
push the handle unit [3] inside while the
screw [2] is lowered.
Fig. 4-236
4.7.4
Transfer belt
Notes:
You are recommended to wear gloves so that you do not touch the surface of the transfer belt
with bare hands.
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-237
(3)
Fig. 4-238
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 85
(4)
Fig. 4-239
(5)
Notes:
Use 1 piece of white urethane foam (138 x
138 x 25 mm) with a 30 mm diameter hole.
Fig. 4-240
Notes:
When installing, make sure that the
mark
[1] of the transfer belt unit is aligned with the
mark [2] of the waste toner box.
Fig. 4-241
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 86
(6)
Fig. 4-242
Notes:
When installing the transfer belt, place
the side with the serial number facing
upward (front side).
Install the transfer belt in the middle so
that it does not move to one side.
Do not touch the belt surface directly with
bare hands.
Be sure not to scratch the belt surface.
Check if the rib on both ends of the
transfer belt does not run on the rollers.
Fig. 4-243
4.7.5
(1)
(2)
Drive roller
Fig. 4-244
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 87
Notes:
When installing the driver roller, correctly
attach the spring [1] on the rear drive roller
shaft.
Fig. 4-245
4.7.6
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-246
(4)
Fig. 4-247
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 88
4.7.7
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-248
(3)
Fig. 4-249
4.7.8
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-250
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 89
(3)
Fig. 4-251
4.7.9
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-252
4.7.10
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-253
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 90
(3)
Fig. 4-254
4.7.11
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-255
Notes:
When installing the 1st transfer contact/
release sensor, pass the harness through the
harness guide.
Fig. 4-256
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 91
(3)
Fig. 4-257
4.7.12
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-258
4.7.13
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-259
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 92
(3)
Fig. 4-260
(4)
Fig. 4-261
(5)
(6)
Fig. 4-262
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 93
(7)
Notes:
The number of the springs for the left side
power supply terminal differs from the one for
the right side power supply terminal.
Left side (see from rear side): 3 springs
Right side (see from rear side): 2 springs
Fig. 4-263
(8)
Fig. 4-264
Fig. 4-265
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 94
Notes:
When installing the drum TBU drive unit,
insert the protrusion of the transfer belt drive
shaft release arm into the hole in the lever.
Fig. 4-266
(9)
Fig. 4-267
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 95
4.8
4.8.1
(1)
(2)
(3)
Notes:
The attachment screw on the rear side is a
shoulder screw, so exercise care when
handling it during installation.
Fig. 4-268
Fig. 4-269
Notes:
Be sure to pass the harness of the image
quality control unit through the harness
clamp.
Fig. 4-270
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 96
4.8.2
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-271
4.8.3
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-272
4.8.4
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-273
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 97
4.9
Fuser Unit
4.9.1
Fuser unit
Notes:
Be sure that the temperature of the fuser unit has lowered enough before removing it. If the
unit still heated should be removed, wear a pair of gloves before working.
When a new fuser unit is installed, be sure to check whether the fuser-related life counter
values have been cleared in the list printing mode or the setting mode (08).
Notes:
If the equipment and the fuser unit are left
unused for a long time, install the pressure
release plate (SPACER-PRS-INI) to release
the pressure of the fuser unit.
Fig. 4-274
(1)
(2)
Notes:
The fuser unit is extremely hot. When
removing the fuser unit, hold the handles
of the unit to avoid a direct touch on the
unit.
When installing the fuser unit, be sure to
press it in until the lever goes up.
Fig. 4-275
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 98
4.9.2
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-276
4.9.3
(1)
(2)
Notes:
When installing the cover, put the harness
into the harness guide so that it will not be
pinched by the cover.
Fig. 4-277
4.9.4
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-278
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 99
4.9.5
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-279
4.9.6
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-280
4.9.7
(1)
(2)
Notes:
When installing, be sure that the gap
between the thermostat and fuser roller is
1.2 to 1.8 mm.
After replacing the center and side
thermostats, adjust the gap between the
thermostats and the fuser roller.
See the external document.: P. 6-**
"6.12.2 Adjusting the gap of the
thermostat"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
Fig. 4-281
4 - 100
4.9.8
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-282
(5)
Fig. 4-283
(6)
Notes:
Before installing the fuser roller edge
thermistor, assemble the fuser roller.
When installing, be careful not to deform
the thermistor. Also, make sure that the
thermistor is in touch with the fuser roller.
After replacing the edge thermistor, be
sure to calibrate the fuser thermistor.
Fig. 4-284
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 101
(7)
Notes:
When installing, be careful not to cause
any deformation to occur to the
thermistor.
After replacing the center and side
thermistors, adjust the gap between the
thermistor and the fuser roller. And, be
sure that the gap between the thermister
and fuser roller is 0.5 to 1.0 mm.
See the external document.: 6.12.1
Adjustment of the non-contact thermistor
Gap
After adjusting the gap, be sure to
calibrate the fuser thermistor.
4.9.9
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-285
Fig. 4-286
(5)
Fig. 4-287
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 102
(6)
(7)
Fig. 4-288
(8)
Fig. 4-289
4.9.10
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-290
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 103
(4)
Fig. 4-291
4.9.11
(1)
(2)
(3)
Pressure roller
Fig. 4-292
(4)
Fig. 4-293
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 104
(5)
Remove 2 springs.
Notes:
After replacing the springs, adjust the gap
between the thermistor and the fuse
roller. And, be sure that the gap between
the thermister and fuser roller is 0.5 to 1.0
mm.
See the external document.: 6.12.1
Adjustment of the non-contact thermistor
Gap
After adjusting the gap, be sure to
calibrate the fuser thermistor.
Fig. 4-294
(6)
Notes:
After replacing the pressure roller, adjust
the gap between thermistor and the fuser
roller. And, be sure that the gap between
the thermistor and fuser roller is 0.5 to 1.0
mm.
See the external document.: 6.12.1
Adjustment of the non-contact thermistor
Gap
After adjusting the gap, be sure to
calibrate the fuser thermistor.
Fig. 4-295
4.9.12
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fuser roller
Fig. 4-296
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 105
(5)
Fig. 4-297
Notes:
Be careful not to damage the fuser roller.
When removing or installing the C-ring,
be careful not change its shape by
forcefully opening it excessively.
Be sure to fit the C-ring to the groove on
the fuser roller. (Make sure that the 2
opening ends and the center part of the
C-ring are firmly positioned in the
groove.)
After replacing the fuser roller, adjust the
gap between the thermistors and fuser
roller.
And, be sure that the gap between the
thermister and fuser roller is 0.5 to 1.0
mm.
P. 6-85 "6.12.1 Adjustment of the noncontact thermistor Gap"
After adjusting the gap, be sure to
calibrate the fuser thermistor.
4.9.13
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-298
Fig. 4-299
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 106
(4)
Fig. 4-300
(5)
Fig. 4-301
4.9.14
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-302
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 107
Notes:
When installing the paper exit guide, align
the protrusion on the rear of the bottom of
the screw hole with the frame hole, and fit
the drive gear shaft into the bearing.
Fig. 4-303
4.9.15
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-304
(3)
Fig. 4-305
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 108
4.9.16
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-306
(4)
Fig. 4-307
Fig. 4-308
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 109
(5)
Fig. 4-309
(6)
Fig. 4-310
4.9.17
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-311
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 110
(5)
Fig. 4-312
(6)
Fig. 4-313
4.9.18
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-314
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 111
Notes:
Exercise care to ensure the inside gear [1]
does not drop.
Fig. 4-315
(4)
Fig. 4-316
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 112
Fig. 4-317
(5)
Fig. 4-318
(6)
Notes:
During installation, turn the rear hinge
downward, and then install the right rear
cover.
Fig. 4-319
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 113
(7)
(8)
Fig. 4-320
Notes:
When installing the automatic duplexing unit,
fit the boss to the hole in the front hinge.
Fig. 4-321
4.10.2
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-322
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 114
(3)
Notes:
When installing the feed clutch, attach a
rotation stopper.
Fig. 4-323
4.10.3
(1)
(2)
Transport roller
Fig. 4-324
(3)
Fig. 4-325
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 115
Notes:
Install the gear, bushing, and spring in the
orientation shown in the figure.
Fig. 4-326
4.10.4
(1)
(2)
(3)
Transport unit
Fig. 4-327
(4)
(5)
Fig. 4-328
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 116
(6)
Fig. 4-329
(7)
Fig. 4-330
4.10.5
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-331
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 117
4.10.6
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-332
(4)
Fig. 4-333
4.10.7
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-334
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 118
4.10.8
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 4-335
(4)
(5)
Fig. 4-336
(6)
Fig. 4-337
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 119
Notes:
When taking off the transport roller, bend
the rib [1] to remove the collar [2], slide
the shaft [3] onto the rib, and then take off
the collar [4] on the opposite side to pull
out the shaft.
Be sure to attach the belt when carrying
out installation.
Fig. 4-338
4.10.9
(1)
(2)
Fig. 4-339
(3)
Fig. 4-340
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 120
4.11.1
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-341
(5)
Disconnect 1 connector.
Fig. 4-342
(6)
Fig. 4-343
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 121
(7)
Fig. 4-344
(8)
Remove 1 screw.
Fig. 4-345
(9)
Remove 2 screws.
Fig. 4-346
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 122
Fig. 4-347
4.11.2
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-348
(5)
[1]
[2]
Fig. 4-349
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 123
(6)
Fig. 4-350
(7)
Fig. 4-351
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 124
(8)
Fig. 4-352
(9)
Fig. 4-353
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 125
Fig. 4-354
4.11.3
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-355
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 126
(5)
[1]
[2]
Fig. 4-356
(6)
Fig. 4-357
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 127
(7)
Fig. 4-358
(8)
Fig. 4-359
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 128
(9)
Fig. 4-360
Fig. 4-361
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 129
Fig. 4-362
4.11.4
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-363
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 130
(5)
Fig. 4-364
(6)
Fig. 4-365
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 131
(7)
Fig. 4-366
(8)
Fig. 4-367
(9)
Fig. 4-368
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 132
Fig. 4-369
Fig. 4-370
Fig. 4-371
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 133
Fig. 4-372
Fig. 4-373
Fig. 4-374
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 134
Fig. 4-375
4.11.5
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-376
(5)
Disconnect 1 connector.
Fig. 4-377
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 135
(6)
Fig. 4-378
(7)
Remove 1 screw.
Fig. 4-379
(8)
Fig. 4-380
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 136
(9)
Fig. 4-381
4.11.6
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-382
(5)
Fig. 4-383
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 137
(6)
Fig. 4-384
(7)
Fig. 4-385
(8)
Fig. 4-386
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 138
(9)
Fig. 4-387
Fig. 4-388
Fig. 4-389
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 139
Fig. 4-390
4.11.7
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-391
(5)
Fig. 4-392
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 140
(6)
Fig. 4-393
(7)
Fig. 4-394
(8)
Fig. 4-395
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 141
4.11.8
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig. 4-396
(5)
Fig. 4-397
(6)
Fig. 4-398
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 142
(7)
Disconnect 2 connectors.
Fig. 4-399
(8)
Fig. 4-400
(9)
Fig. 4-401
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 143
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
DISASSEMBLY AND REPLACEMENT
4 - 144
5.
5.1
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Overview
For start
[0] + [1] +
[POWER]
[0] + [3] +
[POWER]
[0] + [4] +
[POWER]
[0] + [5] +
[POWER]
[0] + [8] +
[POWER]
[3]+[C]+
[POWER]
HDD assist
mode
[4]+[CLEAR]+
[POWER]
File system
recovery mode
SRAM clear
mode
List print mode
[5] + [C] +
[POWER]
[6]+[CLEAR]+
[POWER]
[9] + [START] +
[POWER]
[6] + [START] +
[POWER]
[4] + [9] +
[POWER]
[8] + [9] +
[POWER]
PM support
mode
Firmware
update mode
Password reset
mode
SRAM data
cloning mode
Contents
All LEDs on the control panel are lit, and all
the LCD pixels blink.
Checks the status of input/output signals.
Outputs the test patterns.
Adjusts various items.
Sets various items.
Clears error flags or SRAM, or safely deletes
data in the HDD or SRAM to support the
replacement of the SYS board, SRAM or
HDD.
Assists the ADI-HDD by checking the type of
the mounted HDD, reverting the HDD to a
factory default or removing keys.
Checks, recovers or initializes the file system
(HDD).
Recovers the equipment from particular
errors such as F800 or F900.
Prints various lists or outputs them in a CSV
format.
Clears each counter.
Performs firmware update with USB device.
Performs firmware update with download jig.
Resets the administrator password and
service password.
Backs up the SRAM data to USB device.
For exit
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
Display
100% C
TEST MODE
100% P A4
TEST PRINT
100% A A4
TEST MODE
100% D
TEST MODE
-
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
[POWER]
OFF/ON
100% L A4
LIST PRINT
100% 2
TEST MODE
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-1
Note:
Do not enter any of the modes shown below since they are provided only for production. If
you do so, the equipment may not be restarted.
[2]+[CLEAR]+[POWER]
[7]+[CLEAR]+[POWER]
[8]+[CLEAR]+[POWER]
[9]+[CLEAR]+[POWER]
[D] State transition diagram of self-diagnosis modes
[POWER]
ON
Normal
Warming up
Self-diagnosis
mode
Authentication
screen
Each mode
Ready
*2
[POWER]
OFF
*1
To user
Fig.5-1
*1 If you have used a self-diagnostic mode, turn the power OFF before the customer starts using the
equipment
*2 Mode shown in the table "[C] List of modes"
[E] About each mode
Control panel check mode (01)
Operation procedure
[0][1]
[POWER]
LED lit/
LCD blinking
[START]
(Button check)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[START]
Notes:
A mode can be cancelled by [POWER] OFF/ON when the LED is lit and the LCD is blinking.
Button Check
Buttons with LED: Press to turn OFF the LED.
Buttons without LED: Press to display the message on the control panel.
Button on touch panel: Press to display the initial screen displayed at power-ON. Press
[execution] on the touch panel and then the [CLEAR] button on the control panel. The screen
then returns to the Button Check menu.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-2
(Operation started)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-3
Operation procedure
[4][8][9]
[POWER]
(Operation started)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-4
5.2
Service UI
5.2.1
Overview
The following self-diagnostic modes can be used with Service UI on the touch panel of the control
panel.
5.2.2
Login procedure
(2)
(3)
With the [USER FUNCTIONS] menu displayed, enter the Service Mode password provided
during product training.
Fig.5-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-5
(4)
Enter the user name and password on the SERVICE TECHNICIAN PASSWORD screen, then
press [OK]. They are set by default as follows:
User Name
Password
Service
None
Fig.5-3
(2)
Enter the user name and password on the USER AUTHENTICATION screen. The password
needs to be changed to log in for the first time.
Notes:
In case the password is forgotten, ask the administrator to reset the service password. In case
both the service password and administrator password are forgotten, the passwords can be reset
in the password reset mode. Note that the user data are deleted at that time.
(3)
(4)
Enter the password for Service UI on the USER FUNCTIONS screen. The SERVICE MODE
screen is displayed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-6
5.2.3
After selecting the mode and pressing the [NEXT] button, the screen is switched to the selected mode.
5.2.4
(1)
Setting/Changing password
Press the [SETTINGS] button on the SERVICE MODE screen to display the SETTINGS screen.
Fig.5-4
(2)
Press the [SERVICE PASSWORD] button to change the service password, or [RESET ADMIN
PASSWORD] to reset the administrator password.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-7
5.3
The status of each input signal can be checked by pressing the [FAX] button, [COPY] button,
[SCAN] button and the digital keys in the test mode (03).
<Operation procedure>
[0][3]
[POWER]
[START]
[CLEAR]
[FAX]
[COPY]
or
[SCAN]
[Digital keys]
(LCD ON)
[CLEAR]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Notes:
Initialization is performed before the equipment enters the test mode.
The PRINT DATA lamp blinks when the input check is running.
Refer to "Appendix" in this manual for the items to be checked and the condition of the equipment when
the buttons [A] to [H] are highlighted.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-8
5.4
Status of the output signals can be checked in the test mode 03.
<Operation procedure>
Procedure 1
[0][3]
[POWER]
(Code)
Operation
ON
[START]
Stop
code
[START]
Operation
OFF
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 2
[0][3]
[POWER]
5
[START]
(Code)
Operation
One direction
[CLEAR]
Test mode
standby
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 3
[0][3]
[POWER]
(Code)
[START]
Operation
ON
[START]
Operation
OFF
Test mode
standby
[CLEAR]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 4
[0][3]
[POWER]
(Code)
[START]
[POWER] OFF
Refer to "Appendix" in this manual for the codes available in the test mode 03.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5-9
5.5
The embedded test pattern can be printed out in the test print mode (04).
<Procedure 1>
[0][4]
[POWER]
(Code)
(Media selection)
[START]
Operation
Continuous
Test Printing
[CLEAR]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
<Procedure 2>
[0][4]
[POWER]
(Code)
Media
[START]
selection
[CLEAR]
Color
selection
[START]
Operation [CLEAR]
Continuous
Test Printing
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Notes:
When an error occurs, it is indicated on the panel, but the recovery operation is not performed.
Turn OFF the power and then back ON to clear the error.
During test printing, the [CLEAR] button is disabled when Wait adding toner is displayed.
Remarks:
In the (Color selection) of <Procedure 2>, the printing method is different between [K(1)] and
[K(4)] as follows.
[K(1)]: Printing by bringing one K color developer unit into contact with the transfer belt
[K(4)]: The developer units of four (YMCK) colors are brought into contact with the transfer
belt, but the test pattern is printed in K color only.
* The number in parentheses indicates the contact of the developer unit and the transfer belt.
Refer to "Appendix" in this manual for the codes available in the test print mode.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 10
5.6
Procedure 1
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
*[FUNCTION CLEAR]
(Key in a value)
[START]
[CANCEL]
[FAX]
[OK]
or
[START]
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM) (Test copy)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 2
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
Value
displayed
[OK]
([FAX] [START])
or
(Test copy)
[INTERRUPT]
(Value unchangeable)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 3
[0][5]
[POWER]
[UP]
or
[DOWN]
(Adjust a value)
[OK]
([FAX] [START])
or
(Test copy)
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[CANCEL]
[FUNCTION CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
Procedure 4
[CANCEL]
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[START]
([FAX]
[OK]
or
[Digital key] [START] [Digital key]
[POWER]
[INTERRUPT]
(Sub code)
OFF/ON
[START])
*[FUNCTION CLEAR]
Stores value
(Exit)
(Key in a value)
in RAM (Test copy)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
*Press [FUNCTION CLEAR] to enter minus (-).
Procedure 5
[CANCEL]
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[OK]
or
[INTERRUPT]
Stores value
in RAM
Automatic
adjustment
[FAX]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[START]
(Test copy)
Procedure 6
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
Automatic
adjustment
[FAX] [COPY])
(Test copy)
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
*[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
*
*
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 11
Procedure 7
[CANCEL]
[Digital key]
[Digital key]
[0][5]
[START]
(Code)
(Sub code)
[POWER]
Automatic
adjustment
[START]
[OK]
Stores value
in RAM
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[FAX]
[START]
(Test copy)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
*[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
*
*
Procedure 10
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Sub code)
[START]
Value
displayed
[START]
[OK] or [INTERRUPT]
(Value unchangeable)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 12
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Key in a value)
[FAX]
[OK]
or
[START]
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM) (Test copy)
Manual
adjustment
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[CANCEL]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 12
Procedure 14
[0][5]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Sub code)
[START]
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[OK]
or
[INTERRUPT]
Stores value
in RAM
[FUNCTION CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
(Input value)
[FAX]
[START]
(Test copy)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Notes:
The fuser roller temperature control at the adjustment mode is different from that at the normal
state. Therefore, the problem of fusing efficiency may be occurred in the test copy at the
adjustment mode. In that case, turn ON the power normally, leave the equipment for approx. 3
minutes after it has become ready state and then start up the adjustment mode again.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 13
5.7
Operation:
One test print is printed out when the [FAX] button is pressed after the code is keyed in at Standby
Screen.
Code
Remarks
55
57
58
60
70
7
8
12
13
14
15
71
74
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 14
Code
Remarks
75
76
77
78
79
84
85
86
87
98
99
100
101
104
200
201
204
205
206
207
208
209
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 15
Code
Remarks
214
215
216
217
230
231
234
235
236
237
238
239
244
245
246
247
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 16
5.8
Procedure 1
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
*[FUNCTION CLEAR]
Sets or
changes value
[START]
[OK]
[POWER] OFF/ON
or
(Exit)
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
Procedure 2
[0][8]
[POWER]
5
[Digital key]
(Code)
[OK]
or
[INTERRUPT]
Adjustment value
cannot be changed
[START]
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 3
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
[INITIALIZE]
or
(Automatic setting)
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 4
[CANCEL]
[START]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Sub-code)
[START]
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[OK]
or
[Digital key]
[INTERRUPT]
* [FUNCTION CLEAR]
(Stores value
Sets or
in RAM)
changes value
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 5
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
Sets or
changes value
[OK]
[POWER] OFF/ON
or
(Exit)
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 17
Procedure 9
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[OK]
[POWER] OFF/ON
or
(Exit)
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[Select button]
Procedure 10
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(1st setting)
[START]
[OK]
[POWER]
or
OFF/ON
[INTERRUPT]
(Exit)
(Stores value in RAM)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[Digital key]
(2nd setting)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
Procedure 11 and 12
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
*
*
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
or
[OK]
[START]
[Software keyboard] *2(Stores value in RAM)
*1 [MONITOR/PAUSE]
Sets or
changes value [CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Procedure 14
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Code)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Sub-code)
[START]
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
[OK]
or
[INTERRUPT]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Adjustment value
cannot be changed
5 - 18
5.9
5.9.1
General description
This is a mode to operate the partitions of HDD, initialize the SRAM data, erase the HDD/SRAM data,
back up/restore the encryption key and licences.
Functions:
Clearing update error flag (Clear Error Flag in Software Installation)
Formatting data storage partition (Format Root Partition)
Creating HDD partition (Format HDD)
Formatting SRAM data (Clear SRAM)
Backing up/restoring encryption key and license (Key Backup Restore)
Erasing HDD securely (Erase HDD Securely)
Erasing SRAM securely (Erase SRAM Securely)
Clearing service tech password (Clear Service Tech)
5.9.2
(1)
Operating Procedure
Turn ON the power while [3] button and [CLEAR] button are pressed simultaneously.
The following screen is displayed.
(2)
Select the item with the digital keys and press the [START] button.
5.9.3
Functions
[A] Clearing update error flag (Clear Error Flag in Software Installation)
Even if the firmware downloading has been completed normally, the Recovery Mode may accidentally
start up and an F600 error occurs when the power is turned ON again. In this case, clear the Update
Error flags used in the download process with this function. (Normally, the flags are automatically
cleared in the download process.)
Also in the case the Recovery Mode accidentally starts up after the replacement of SRAM on the SYS
board, the flags are cleared with this function.
[B] Formatting data storage partition (Format Root Partition)
When a defect occurs on the UI data, etc. which are stored in the HDD, the partition with the stored UI
data, etc. is formatted with this function.
Do not use this function since it is not normally necessary. HDD data must be installed after performing
this function.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 19
5 - 20
4: SIMPLE
This is the simple overwriting method. It takes the shortest time to erase data.
Key in the level number to display "<" next to it.
(At this time, if "0" is entered, the screen returns to the initial one of the Assist Mode.)
Press the [START] button to display the reconfirmation screen, and then press the [START] button
again to start overwriting.
[G] Erasing SRAM securely (Erase SRAM Securely)
This function is used before discarding the SRAM board (for the SYS board).
It overwrites all the used areas on the SRAM board with the selected data, and makes it unusable.
Immediately after selecting this function, the processing starts and is completed.
[H] Clearing service tech password (Clear Service Tech)
This function is needed after the HDD/SSD is replaced.
When the HDD/SSD is replaced, the service tech password stored in the new one is set as a blank.
Therefore, its password is copied to the SRAM board so that both passwords become the same with
this function. The setting is enabled when the equipment is started up in the normal mode after
performing this function.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 21
General description
This mode is available only when the security HDD (ADI-HDD) is mounted in the equipment. It enables
you to check the type of the mounted HDD/SSD, revert the ADI-HDD to the factory default or remove
keys.
Functions
Checks the type (ADI, SATA, or SSD) of the mounted HDD/SSD.
Disposes of ADI-HDD data safely without any of leakage.
Deletes user data when reusing a used ADI-HDD.
5.10.2
Operation procedure
[4][C]
[Power]
[Digital Key]
(Select)
[START]
[STOP]
for SATA-HDD
HDD data
clear
[Power] OFF
Operation
Failed
Cancel
Turn the power ON while pressing the [4] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously. Then the type of the
mounted HDD is checked and either of the following screens is displayed.
Fig.5-7
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 22
Fig.5-8
Remarks:
If the HDD/SSD type cannot be identified, "Unknown HDD" may appear on the screen.
Refer to P. 8-159 " [F106_1] ADI-HDD error: HDD type detection error"
Note:
When "SATA HDD" (normal HDD) is displayed, items 1 and 2 are not selectable.
If you select any of 1 and 2 and press the [START] button, the error message below appears.
Operation Failed.
Press SoftPower Key to Switch Off
Fig.5-9
5.10.3
Functions
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 23
This operation requires only a few seconds; however, you must create the partition in the HDD in the
3C mode (Format HDD) and reinstall the HDD data in the 49 mode to make the HDD reusable.
When "1" is selected and then [START] button is pressed, the menu below appears.
To start, press the [START] button.
Confirmation Screen
Are you sure ???
Press START to continue
Press STOP to cancel
Fig.5-10
Fig.5-11
Note:
If the equipment is started in the normal mode with this condition, an HDD mounting error occurs.
[B] 2. Remove Key
Select this to reuse the ADI-HDD as well as the equipment.
When this item is selected, all data in the HDD except program data are deleted.
This operation requires approx. 20 minutes since the partition must be rebuilt.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 24
When "2" is selected and then [START] button is pressed, the menu below appears.
To start, press the [START] button.
Confirmation Screen
Are you sure ???
Fig.5-12
Fig.5-13
Note:
After this operation, the equipment becomes reusable without reinstalling the firmware.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 25
Overview
This is a mode to check if there is any damage to the file system (HDD) and recover it if necessary. Use
this mode only in the following cases:.
There is an apparent damage to the file system (HDD), requiring recovery or initialization.
5.11.2
Operation procedure
[5][C]
[POWER]
[Digital key]
(Selection)
[START]
[Digital key]
(Selection)
[START]
(HDD formatting)
(DB formatting
such as log data)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Notes:
Do not turn the main power switch OFF after you select a menu and processing has
started (during processing).
After the processing is completed, a beep sounds 4 times and either "Completed" or
"Failed" appears on the screen.
Turn ON the power while pressing the [5] and [CLEAR] button simultaneously. The following screen is
displayed.
Fig.5-14
Remark:
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 26
5.11.3
Functions
0: Main menu
1. ALL
2. /
3. /work
4. /registration
5. /backup
6. /imagedata
7. /storage
Fig.5-15
More than one partition can be selected. (">" is displayed on the left of the selected number.)
0: Main menu
1. ALL
2. /
3. /work
4. /registration
5. /backup
6. /imagedata
7. /storage
Fig.5-16
More than one partition can be selected. (">" is displayed on the left of the selected number.)
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 27
Remark:
More than one partition can be selected. (">" is displayed on the left of the selected number.)
Notes:
If [1. ALL] is selected, applications and OS data in the equipment are also initialized. In
this case, the applications and the file system must be reinstalled.
If [2. Except /] or [3. User Data] is selected, minimal data necessary for normal startup are
automatically recovered.
If [2. Except /] is selected, databases such as logs and address book are also initialized.
Back up such data before initializing if necessary.
If [3. User Data] is selected, all documents stored by users (e.g. scan data) are deleted.
Back up such data before initializing if necessary.
[D] Initialize the DB (Initialize DB)
In case that particular service calls occur or there is a possibility of damage to the databases, each
one can be initialized.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 28
0: Main menu
1. LDAP DB
2. Log DB(Job,Msg)
3. Language DB
5
Fig.5-18
The selected databases are initialized and recreated in the next normal startup.
[E] Displaying various data in the HDD/SSD (SMART Info)
Various data in the HDD/SSD can be displayed. (Data equivalent to the setting contents of 089065 are displayed.)
When this item is selected, data in the HDD/SSD embedded in the equipment are displayed. "---" is
displayed for the items not supported.
1: PrevPage
2:NextPage
VALUE
0
0
15
.
.
.
0: Main menu
Serial : xxxxxxxxx
NAV Worst
100
100
100
100
253
253
.
.
.
.
.
.
Fig.5-19
Remark:
Notes:
The values of NAV and Worst should be treated as a rough reference since their basis may differ
depending on the specification of HDD manufacturers.
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 29
ALL(Mbyte) FREE(Mbyte)
8737
5401
10326
9563
2861
3099
949
1036
23343
24778
25332
26873
--- encrypted partition ---
USE(%)
33.1%
2.3%
2.6%
3.3%
0.7%
0.7%
Fig.5-20
Remark:
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 30
General description
This is a mode in which you can clear particular errors such as F800 or F900 without entering a Service
Technician password.
For example, when SYS-SRAM is in an abnormal status or needs replacement but service technicians
cannot log into the 3C mode, SRAM can be initialized by entering the SRAM clear mode (6C) and
selecting item 1 below.
The content of item 1 in this mode is the same as that of item 4 in the 3C mode (Clear SRAM).
Use this mode to clear the SRAM data when a particular error occurs or service technicians cannot log
in with their password and therefore cannot use the 3C mode.
Functions
Sets the serial number of this equipment.
Clears SRAM data when the 3C mode cannot be used.
Clears F800 error.
Clears F900 error.
5.12.2
Operation procedure
[6][C]
[Power]
[Digital Key]
(Select)
[START]
[STOP]
[START]
SRAM data
clear
or
S/N Input
[Power] OFF
Cancel
Turn the power ON while pressing the [6] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously. Then the following
screen is displayed.
Key in the desired item number and then press the [START] button.
Fig.5-21
Notes:
When "0" is keyed in and the [START] button is pressed, the menu to key in the serial number
appears. Key in the serial number of this equipment and then press [OK] to determine the
setting.
Items 1 and 2 can be canceled while 0 and 3 cannot.
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 31
5.12.3
When "3" is keyed in and the [START] button is pressed, the operation starts.
Functions
Fig.5-22
After updating with a download jig and performing Clear SRAM, select this item.
After selecting this, initialize SRAM following its replacement procedure.
Refer to P. 9-26 "9.2.5 Precautions and procedure when replacing the SRAM board (for the SYS
board)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 32
Operation procedure
[ 1 ] Print out
[9][START]
[POWER]
[START]
(Code)
[Digital keys]
101: Adjustment mode (05)
Key in the first
102: Setting mode (08)
code to be printed
[START]
[Digital keys]
Key in the last
code to be printed
[START]
List starts to
be printed
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
(Code)
103: PM support mode
104: Stored information of pixel counter (toner cartridge reference)
105: Stored information of pixel counter (service technician reference)
106: Error history (Maximum 1000 items)
107: Error history (Latest 80 items)
108: Firmware update log (Maximum 200 items)
110: Power-ON/OFF log (Maximum 100 items)
111: Version list
114: Total counter list
Connect
USB
[START]
(Code)
[Digital keys] [START] [Digital keys]
201: Adjustment mode (05) Key in the first
Key in the last
202: Setting mode (08)
code to be printed
code to be printed
[START] Disconnect
List starts to
USB
be printed
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
(Code)
203: PM support mode
204: Stored information of pixel counter (toner cartridge reference)
205: Stored information of pixel counter (service technician reference)
206: Error history (Maximum 1000 items)
208: Firmware update log (Maximum 200 items)
210: Power-ON/OFF log (Maximum 100 items)
211: Version list
212: Engine firmware log * Manufacture Purpose Only
214: Total counter list
300: ALL CSV files
Notes:
Precautions when storing information into USB device
When storing the setting information of the equipment into a USB device, be sure to obtain
permission from a user in advance.
When storing the setting information of the equipment into a USB device, the information is
printed out in a CSV format. Handle and manage the information with extra care.
Do not lose or leak the setting information of the equipment.
Do not use the setting information of the equipment for purposes other than maintenance or
product services.
Provide the information promptly if a user requires so.
The buttons on the control panel keep blinking while data are being stored in the USB device.
Do not disconnect the USB device while data are being stored.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 33
Remarks:
In the USB storage procedure above, lists are stored in a CSV format. The names of the CSV
files are shown below.
201: ADJUSTMENT_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
202: SETTING_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
203: PM_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
204: PIXEL_TONER_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
205: PIXEL_SERVICE_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
206: ERROR_LOG_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
208: FW_UPGRADE_LOG_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
210: POWER_ONOFF_LOG_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
211: VERSION_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
212: ENG_FW_LOG_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
214: TOTAL_COUNTER_LIST_serial_date and time(YYYYMMDDHHMMSS).csv
5.13.2
List Printing
List code
Printout
101
102
103
104
204
105
205
106
(Maximum 1000 items)
107
(Latest 80 items)
108
(Maximum 200 items)
110
(Maximum 100 items)
111
114
-
206
(Maximum 1000 items)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
208
(Maximum 200 items)
210
(Maximum 100 items)
211
212
214
300
5 - 34
05 ADJUSTMENT MODE
DATA LIST
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
2000
128
3860
88
4830
128
5920
128
Fig.5-23
The selected adjustment codes and the current adjustment value for each code are output in a list.
See the following page for the adjustment code (05):
Refer to "Appendix" - "Adjustment Code (05)."
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 35
08 SETTING MODE
DATA LIST
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
CODE
DATA
2010
2880
12
3040
3070
Fig.5-24
The selected setting codes and the current setting value for each code are output in a list. See the
following page for the setting code (08):
Refer to "Appendix" - "Setting Code (08)"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 36
PM support mode
PM SUPPORT CODE LIST
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
UNIT
OUTPUT PAGES/
DEVELOP COUNTS
DRUM (K)
DRUM BLADE (K)
GRID (K)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (K)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (K)
DRUM (Y)
DRUM BLADE (Y)
GRID (Y)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (Y)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (Y)
DRUM (M)
DRUM BLADE (M)
GRID (M)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (M)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (M)
2516
2516
2516
2516
2516
411
411
411
411
411
411
411
411
411
411
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
PM OUTPUT PAGE/
DEVELOP COUNTS
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
70000
DRIVE COUNTS
11735
11735
11735
11735
11735
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
8625
PM DRIVE COUNTS
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
Fig.5-25
The number of pages currently output (OUTPUT PAGES/DEVELOP COUNTS), the recommended
number of output pages for PM (PM OUTPUT PAGES/DEVELOP COUNTS), the current drive count
(DRIVE COUNTS) and the recommended drive count for PM (PM DRIVE COUNTS) are output
together with PM units. Use this list for confirming the PM units to be replaced at each PM. See the
following page for PM:
P. 7-1 "7. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 37
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
TONERCARTRIDGE
No DATE
COLOR
PPC
PRN
FAX
TOTAL
0 20xx-xx-xx
1 20xx-xx-xx
2 20xx-xx-xx
3 20xx-xx-xx
4 20xx-xx-xx
5 20xx-xx-xx
6 20xx-xx-xx
7 20xx-xx-xx
8 20xx-xx-xx
9 20xx-xx-xx
10 20xx-xx-xx
11 20xx-xx-xx
Y
Y
Y
M
M
M
C
C
C
K
K
K
181
2.70
6.15
181
6.11
6.82
181
5.46
6.42
278
6.15
7.32
45
1.74
0.39
45
2
2.15
45
2
2.73
145
3.86
2.19
------------------9
23.25
6.25
226
2.51
0.39
226
5.29
2.15
226
4.81
2.73
432
5.74
2.19
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Fig.5-26
Pixel counter data (toner cartridge reference) are output in a list. See the following page for the pixel
counter:
P. 5-46 "5.14 Pixel counter"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 38
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
SERVICEMAN
No DATE
COLOR
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
F
F
F
Y
Y
Y
M
M
M
C
C
C
K
K
K
K
K
K
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
PPC
PRN
FAX
TOTAL
181
4.95
8.36
181
2.7
6.15
181
6.11
6.82
181
5.46
6.42
181
5.51
14.05
97
7.36
7.32
45
2.34
2.34
45
1.74
0.39
45
2
2.15
45
2.18
2.73
45
3.43
4.10
100
4.06
2.19
------------------------------9
23.25
6.25
226
4.43
2.34
226
2.51
0.39
226
5.29
2.15
226
4.81
2.73
226
5.10
4.10
206
6.45
2.19
Fig.5-27
Pixel counter data (service call reference) are output in a list. See the following page for the pixel
counter:
P. 5-46 "5.14 Pixel counter"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 39
Error history
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
CODE
F110
F110
F110
F110
F110
EAD0
E860
E731
E090
E870
E724
COUNTER
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
DATE
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
TIME
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
ZOOM_XY
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
000 000
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
Fig.5-28
The error history is output. See the following page for the parameters for each error:
P. 8-25 "8.2.4 Printer function error"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 40
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
MANUFACTURE DATE
UNPACKING DATE
20xx-xx-xx
20xx-xx-xx
TOTAL
FAX
STATUS
Service Txxxxxxx-xxxx 20xx-xx-xx 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 OK
Service Txxxxxxx-xxxx 20xx-xx-xx 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 OK
Service Txxxxxxx-xxxx 20xx-xx-xx 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 99999999 OK
Fig.5-29
Content
User who updated firmware
Version of firmware
Date that firmware was updated
Total counter data when firmware was updated
Copier counter data (black) when firmware was updated
Copier counter data (twin color) when firmware was updated
Copier counter data (full color) when firmware was updated
Printer counter data (black) when firmware was updated
Printer counter data (twin color) when firmware was updated
Printer counter data (full color) when firmware was updated
List print counter data when firmware was updated
Fax print counter data when firmware was updated
Result of update
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 41
Power-ON/OFF log
POWER ON_OFF LOG
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
DATE
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
TIME
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
FUNCTION
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
RMT_OFF
OFF
TOTAL
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
DATE
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
xxxx-xx-xx
TIME
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
xx:xx:xx
FUNCTION
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
RMT_OFF
TOTAL
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
99999999
Fig.5-30
Content
DATE
TIME
FUNCTION
TOTAL
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 42
Version list
VERSION LIST
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
20xx-xx-xx xx:xx
SYSTEM FIRMWARE ROM VERSION
: Txxxxxxxxxxx
SYSTEM FIRMWARE INTERNAL ROM VERSION: Vx.x.x.xx.xx
PRINTER ROM VERSION
: xxxM-xxx
SCANNER ROM VERSION
: xxxS-xxx
PFC ROM VERSION
: xxxF-xxx
RADF ROM VERSION
: DF-xxx
FINISHER STACKER ROM VERSION
: FINFINISHER SADDLE ROM VERSION
: SDLFINISHER PUNCH ROM VERSION
: PUNCONVERTER ROM VERSION
: CNV-xxx
FAX BOARD FIRMWARE ROM VERSION
: Fxx-xxx
SYSTEM FIRMWARE OS VERSION
: Vx.xxx.x.x
HDD DATA VERSION
: Txxxxxxxxxxx
LANGUAGE VERSION
English(US)
: xxx.xxx xxx xxx xx xx:xx:xx xxxx
CAPACITY OF HDD
DEVICE INFORMATION OF HDD
SERIAL NUMBER OF HDD
MEMORY SIZE
INSTALLED ELK NAME
: xx.x GB
: xxx xxxxxxx-xxxxxx
: xx-xxxxxxxxxxxx
: xxxx MB / xxxx MB
: Data overwrite enabler
IPSec enabler
Meta scan enabler
External interface enabler
Fig.5-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 43
ENGINE FW LOG
20xx/xx/xx xx:xx
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
Cxxxxxxxx
FIN S/N-xxxxxxxx
TOTAL, 9999999, DF TOTAL, 9999999
CODE
SUB
DATA
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
0
0
58
3
58
3
0
56
3
0
41
1
29
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
4624
Fig.5-32
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 44
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF TOTAL:
9999999
PRINT COUNTER
TOTAL
FULL COLOR TWIN/MONO COLOR BLACK TOTAL
COPY
37
0
1
38
FAX
0
0
0
0
PRINTER
122
0
60
182
LIST
0
0
0
0
TOTAL
159
0
61
220
COPY
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
FAX
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
PRINTER
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
LIST
CALIBRATION COUNTER : 0
SCAN COUNTER
TOTAL
FULL COLOR TWIN/MONO COLOR BLACK TOTAL
COPY
7
0
1
FAX
0
0
0
NETWOR
0
0
0
TOTAL
7
0
1
8
0
0
8
COPY
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
FAX
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
NETWORK
SMALL
LARGE
TOTAL
Fig.5-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 45
Outline
[ 1 ] Outline
Pixel counter is a function that counts the number of dots emitted by the LED heads and converts it into
the print ratio (%) per standard paper size. This Print ratio (%) per standard paper size is called Pixel
count (%).
This function enables you to know how each user uses the equipment and to grasp the tendency of
toner consumption (number of output pages per cartridge).
[ 2 ] Factors affecting toner consumption
Standard number of output pages per cartridge shows the average number of output pages under the
condition that the data of print ratio 6% is printed on the standard paper size (A4/LT) at a normal
temperature and humidity.
However, users do not always print under the above condition. As for the type of original, copy/print
mode and environment, each user has different tendency, and as a result, the number of output pages
per cartridge becomes different depending on the user.
The major factors affecting toner consumption are as follows:
Original/Data coverage
Original/Data density
Original/Print mode
Density setting
Also there are other factors in addition to the above, such as environment, individual difference of
equipment, difference in lot quality of materials, toner density and drum surface potential.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 46
Toner consumption
Toner consumption
The general relations between the above 4 factors and toner consumption per output page in the copy
function are as follows:
Toner consumption
Original density
Toner consumption
Original coverage
TEXT
/PHOTO
TEXT
PHOTO
PRINTED
IMAGE
MAP
Density setting
Original mode
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 47
Clearing of the counter of the service technician reference is performed in the setting mode (086502).
Print count (number of output pages)
The number of output pages shown at the pixel counter is counted after converting all paper sizes to
the standard paper size (A4/LT). Printing on other than the standard size is converted by paper area
ratio. The standard paper size is set in the setting mode (08-6500).
The examples of conversion are as follows:
Ex.)
1 is added to the print count when printing on A4/LT size.
2 is added to the print count when printing on A3/LD size. (area ratio to A4/LT: 200%)
1.49 is added to the print count when printing on B4 size. (area ratio to A4: 149%)
1.27 is added to the print count when printing on LG size. (area ratio to LT: 127%)
Pixel count (%)
Pixel count (%) shows the ratio of the emitting pixels of the LED heads to all pixels on standard
paper.
The examples of pixel count are as follows:
Notes:
In the following examples, solid copy is considered to be 100%. But since the image has 4
margins, it never becomes 100% actually.
Ex.)
Printing 5 pages on A4/LT size with solid copy (LED heads emit to all pixels.)
Pixel count: 100%, Print count: 5
Printing 5 pages on A4/LT size with blank copy (LED heads never emit.)
Pixel count: 0%, Print count: 5
Printing 2 pages on A4/LT size with solid copy (LED heads emit to all pixels.)
Printing 2 pages on A4/LT size with blank copy (LED heads never emit.)
Pixel count: 50%, Print count: 4
Printing 3 pages on A4/LT size with 6% of LED heads emission
Printing 1 page on A4/LT size with 2% of LED heads emission
Pixel count: 5%, Print count: 4
Printing 2 pages on A3/LD size with solid copy (LED heads emit to all pixels.)
Pixel count: 100%, Print count: 4
Printing 2 pages on A3/LD size with 6% of LED heads emission
Pixel count: 6%, Print count: 4
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 48
The following list is the information that can be confirmed by LCD screen. But actually, more
information can be confirmed by the setting mode (08).
See after-mentioned 5)-Display in the setting mode (08) for details.
Table 2-201 Type of calculated data
Toner cartridge reference
Copier
function
Printer
function
FAX function
Total
Yellow
Magen
ta
Cyan
Black
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Black
Black
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 49
Y/2
X/2
Y/10
X/10
60%
6% 12%
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 50
Fig.5-3
When selecting and pressing the button in the above screen, each pixel counter screen is displayed.
[TONER CARTRIDGE] button: Information screen of toner cartridge reference is displayed.
[SERVICE (COLOR)] button: Information screen of service technician reference (full color) is
displayed.
[SERVICE (BLACK)] button: Information screen of service technician reference (black) is displayed.
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [TONER CARTRIDGE] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 51
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [SERVICE (COLOR)] button.
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [SERVICE (BLACK)] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 52
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 53
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF COUNTER:
9999999
'08-02-08 20:13
TONERCARTRIDGE
No DATE
COL.
--------------------------0 20080208 Y
1 20080208 Y
2 20080208 Y
3 20080208 M
4 20080208 M
5 20080208 M
6 20080208 C
7 20080208 C
8 20080208 C
9 20080208 K
10 20080208 K
11 20080208 K
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
Print Count[LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count[%]
Latest Pixel Count[%]
PPC
PRN
FAX
TOTAL
181
2.70
6.15
181
6.11
6.82
181
5.46
6.42
278
6.15
7.32
45
1.74
0.39
45
2
2.15
45
2
2.73
145
3.86
2.19
------------------9
23.25
6.25
226
2.51
0.39
226
5.29
2.15
226
4.81
2.73
432
5.74
2.19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 54
'08-02-08 20:13
S/N: xxxxxxxxx
TOTAL:
9999999
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx
DF COUNTER:
9999999
SERVICEMAN
No DATE
COL.
--------------------------0 20080208 F
Print Count[LT/A4]
1 20080208 F
Average Pixel Count[%]
2 20080208 F
Latest Pixel Count[%]
3 20080208 Y
Print Count[LT/A4]
4 20080208 Y
Average Pixel Count[%]
5 20080208 Y
Latest Pixel Count[%]
6 20080208 M
Print Count[LT/A4]
7 20080208 M
Average Pixel Count[%
8 20080208 M
Latest Pixel Count[%]
9 20080208 C
Print Count[LT/A4]
10 20080208 C
Average Pixel Count[%]
11 20080208 C
Latest Pixel Count[%]
12 20080208 K
Print Count[LT/A4]
13 20080208 K
Average Pixel Count[%]
14 20080208 K
Latest Pixel Count[%]
15 20080208 K
Print Count[LT/A4]
16 20080208 K
Average Pixel Count[%]
17 20080208 K
Latest Pixel Count[%]
PPC
PRN
FAX
TOTAL
181
4.95
8.36
181
2.7
6.15
181
6.11
6.82
181
5.46
6.42
181
5.51
14.05
97
7.36
7.32
45
2.34
2.34
45
1.74
0.39
45
2
2.15
45
2.18
2.73
45
3.43
4.10
100
4.06
2.19
------------------------------9
23.25
6.25
226
4.43
2.34
226
2.51
0.39
226
5.29
2.15
226
4.81
2.73
226
5.10
4.10
206
6.45
2.19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 55
Copier
function
Printer
function
FAX
function
Total
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
Average pixel count
(%)
Black
Black
(at color)
+
Black
6562
6563
6621
6622
6623
6624
6637
6638
6639
6724
6568
6570
6572
6564
6565
6625
6626
6627
6628
6629
6630
6640
6641
6642
6643
6725
6566
6635
6644
6631
6632
6633
6634
Cyan
Black
6557
6558
6587
6588
6589
6590
6591
6602
6606
6607
6608
6609
6610
6616
6559
6560
6592
6593
6594
6595
6596
6603
6611
6612
6613
6614
6615
6617
6561
6604
6618
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
Black
6567
6569
6571
6619
6620
6636
Copier
function
Printer
function
FAX
function
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
Print count
(page)
Average pixel count
(%)
Latest pixel count
(%)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Black
5 - 56
Total
Cyan
Black
6597
6600
6601
6598
6599
Black
6605
Copier
function
Printer
function
FAX function
Black
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
Black
6713
6714
6715
6716
6721
6717
6718
6719
6720
6722
6723
Notes:
By entering the sub code at the above code, the pixel count distribution can be displayed dividing
into 10 ranges. The sub codes are as follows.
0: 0 - 5%
1: 5.1 - 10%
2: 10.1 - 15% 3: 15.1 - 20% 4: 20.1 - 25%
5: 25.1 - 30% 6: 30.1 - 40% 7: 40.1 - 60% 8: 60.1- 80% 9: 80.1 - 100%
Other information
Toner cartridge replacement counter.
The toner cartridge replacement count is displayed.
08-6573: Toner cartridge Y
08-6574: Toner cartridge M
08-6575: Toner cartridge C
08-6576: Toner cartridge K
Toner cartridge reference count started date
The toner cartridge reference count started date is displayed.
08-6519: Toner cartridge Y
08-6520: Toner cartridge M
08-6521: Toner cartridge C
08-6522: Toner cartridge K
Service technician reference cleared date
The service technician reference cleared date (08-6510) is displayed.
The date (08-6502 was performed) is stored.
Toner cartridge reference cleared date
The toner cartridge reference cleared date is displayed.
The date (08-6503 was performed) is stored.
08-6511: Toner cartridge Y
08-6512: Toner cartridge M
08-6513: Toner cartridge C
08-6514: Toner cartridge K
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 57
Code
Subcode
08-8914 1
Description
0: Disable the
function
1: Enable the function
0: Disable the
function
1: Enable the function
0: Disable the
function
1: Enable the function
0: Disable the
function
1: Enable the function
1: Enable Samba
2: Disable Samba
3: Disable Print Share
4: Disable File Share
08-9599
08-8900 0
2
08-9121
Item
0: Printed forcibly
1: Not printed
2: Deleted forcibly
0: Forcible execution
1: Execution
impossible (pooled in
the invalid queue)
2: Forcible deletion
0-14
08-9397
Execution of user
authentication when the
user ID is not entered
08-9946
Number of Email
transmission retries
Scan preview default
0: OFF
setting
1: ON
Fax preview default setting 0: OFF
1: ON
Job skip setting
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08-8526
08-8901
08-8904
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Default value
when 08-8759
is performed
Default value
when 08-8760
is performed
2000
1000
100
50
1000
500
No change
No change
No change
5 - 58
Code
Subcode
Item
Description
08-9344
08-9264
User department
management
Security mode (level)
setting
0: Normal mode
1: Private Print limited
mode
2: Hold Print limited
mode
3: Private/Hold Print
limited mode
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Security function level
setting
1: Low security
2: 3: High security
4: -
08-8911
Default value
when 08-8759
is performed
Default value
when 08-8760
is performed
No change
No change
No change
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 59
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
5 - 60
6.
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6.1
6.1.1
This chapter mainly explains the procedures for image related adjustment. When replacing
components which have other specified instructions for adjustment, those specified instructions are to
be obeyed in priority.
In the following diagram, the solid lines with arrow lead to essential adjustments, while the dotted lines
lead to adjustments to be performed if necessary.
Developer material
Photoconductive drum
1st transfer roller(*1)
Main charger grid
Item to be adjusted
6.1.2 Adjustment of the autotoner sensor(*2)
Parts to be replaced
Drum cleaning blade
Transfer belt(*1)
Image position aligning
Needle electrode
sensor(*1)
Image quality sensor(*1)
Code in mode 05
2400 (Y,M,C,K), 2401 (Yellow)
2402 (Magenta), 2403 (Cyan)
2404 (Black), 2406 (Y,M,C)
Item to be adjusted
Code in mode 05
Item to be adjusted
6.1.4 Adjustment of color registration control
2742(*3)
Code in mode 05
4719
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
6.1.7
Image
dimensional
adjustment
at the
printing
section
6.1.8
Image
dimensional
adjustment
at the
scanning
section
Code in mode 05
4100, 4101, 4103, 4104, 4105,
4106, 4107, 4108, 4109, 4110,
4111, 4115, 4116, 4117, 4118,
4120, 4128, 4129
4006
4526
4402, 4058, 4059, 4060,
4061, 4062, 4560
4019
3030
3032
3031
4050
4052
4053
6.1.9 Image
(h) Reproduction ratio adjustment of primary
dimensional
scanning direction (PPC)
adjustment
in the copy/ (i) Reproduction ratio adjustment of primary
printer/fax
scanning direction (PRT/FAX)
function
Item to be adjusted
6.2.1 Automatic gamma adjustment (PPC)
6.3.1 Automatic gamma adjustment (PRT)
7000
7001
Code in mode 05
7869 (*4), (7871)
8008 (*5), 8004-0, 2 to 4, 7, 8, 8009 (*6), 8005-0, 2 to 4, 7, 8 (*6)
END
Order
LED head
Fig.6-1
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-1
6.1.2
When the developer material is replaced, adjust the auto-toner sensor in the following procedure.
If the value of 08-2707 (toner density ratio manual offset control) of the replacing developer material
has been changed from "0" (default), return the sub code value of the corresponding color to "0".
(1) Install the cleaner unit and developer unit.
Notes:
Do not install the toner cartridge.
(2)
While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. The following message will be
displayed.
100%
[0] [5]
[POWER]
A3
TEST MODE
Fig.6-2
(3)
Code
(Code)
100%
2400
[START]
A3
TEST MODE
Fig.6-3
(4)
The message below will be displayed approx. 2 minutes later and the adjustment starts:
During the adjustment, Current sensor voltage (V) shown in (B) automatically changes and
gradually approaches to Target value (V) for adjustment reference voltage shown in (A).
(B)
(C)
(A)
ww%
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-2
(5)
When the Current sensor voltage (V) in (B) is converged and the Sensor output control value
(bit value) corresponding to the value for initial developer material is displayed in (C), the
adjustment is completed.
When the adjustment is completed, the [OK] button is displayed on the screen.
(B)
(C)
(A)
Notes:
The values in (A), (B) and (C) vary with humidity.
(6)
Press the [OK] button to store the adjustment result in the memory.
(7)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-3
6.1.3
(1)
(2)
When unpacking
Prior to image dimensional adjustment, perform the Forced performing of image quality closedloop control (05-2742) procedure.
When any of the following parts is replaced, be sure to perform the Forced performing of image
quality closed-loop control (05-2742) procedure.
Photoconductive drum
Developer material
LED head
Needle electrode
Main charger grid
Notes:
When performing Automatic gamma adjustment in addition, Forced performing of image
quality closed-loop control (05-2742) should be done first.
(3)
When performing Automatic gamma adjustment in cases no parts written above are replaced,
do the Forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-2742) procedure before
Automatic gamma adjustment.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-4
Code
2742
Item to be adjusted
Forced performing of
image quality closedloop control
Contents
<Procedure>
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
Adjustment Mode
2. Key in [2742] and press the [START] button.
3. WAIT is displayed.
4. When the adjustment finishes normally, the equipment returns
to the initial state of Adjustment Mode.
When an error occurs
<When Waste toner box replacement is displayed>
Basic Manual "[E] Waste toner box replacement"
1. Replace the waste toner box with a new one and close the
waste toner cover.
2. Press and hold the [MAIN POWER] button for a few seconds
to shut down the equipment.
3. Turn the power ON.
4. Release the waste toner box full status by the warming-up
operation.
5. Check that WAIT is displayed.
<When an adjustment error is displayed>
Basic Manual "[C] No toner in the cartridge"
1. Press and hold the [ON/OFF] button for a few seconds to shut
down the equipment in order to check the toner empty status.
2. Turn the power ON.
3. Check the toner supply operation in warming-up.
When a message prompts you to replace the toner cartridge,
open the front cover and replace the cartridge with a new one.
4. Check that WAIT is displayed.
<Other abnormalities>
Take the appropriate action described in Troubleshooting.
P. 8-1 "8. ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-5
6.1.4
After having finished the Forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-2742) procedure,
perform the Forced performing of color registration control adjustment (05-4719) procedure.
Code
Item to be adjusted
Contents
4719
Forced performing of
color registration
control
<Procedure>
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power
ON.
Adjustment mode
2. Key in [4719] and press the [START] button.
3. When the adjustment finishes normally, the equipment
returns to the initial state of Adjustment Mode.
If the following errors are displayed after performing 05-4719,
clear the error by following the steps below, and then perform
05-4719 again.
<When Waste toner box replacement is displayed>
Basic Manual "[E] Waste toner box replacement"
1. Replace the waste toner box with a new one and close the
waste toner cover.
2. Press and hold the [MAIN POWER] button for a few
seconds to shut down the equipment.
3. Turn the power ON.
4. Release the waste toner box full status by the warming-up
operation.
5. Check that WAIT is displayed.
<When an adjustment error is displayed>
Basic Manual "[C] No toner in the cartridge"
1. Press and hold the [ON/OFF] button for a few seconds to
shut down the equipment in order to check the toner empty
status.
2. Turn the power ON.
3. Check the toner supply operation in warming-up.
When a message prompts you to replace the toner
cartridge, open the front cover and replace the cartridge with
a new one.
4. Check that WAIT is displayed.
<Other abnormalities>
Take the appropriate action described in Troubleshooting.
P. 8-1 "8. ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-6
6.1.5
There are several adjustment items in the image dimensional adjustment, as listed below. Prior to this
image dimensional adjustment, perform "Forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (052742)" and "Forced performing of color registration control (05-4719)".
When adjusting these items, the following adjustment order should strictly be observed.
Item to be adjusted
Code in mode 05
2. Printerrelated
image
dimensional
adjustment
3. Scannerrelated
image
dimensional
adjustment
4. Image
dimensional
adjustment
in the copy/
printer/fax
function
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-7
<Operation keys>
<Display>
100%
0
A3
TEST MODE
POWER
1
Digital keys : Key in codes.
Code No.
100%
START
XXX
A3
TEST MODE
YYY
ZZZ
100%
A3
A3
A3
TEST MODE
100%
Wait Warming Up
100%
COPYING
Fig.6-6
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-8
6.1.6
Fig.6-7
2. Select the paper size.
Fig.6-8
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6-9
Fig.6-9
4. Key in the adjustment value.
Fig.6-10
5. Press the [OK] button to finish the adjustment.
* Press the [FUNCTION CLEAR] or [CANCEL] button to return to the previous menu.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 10
Drawer
Code
Sub code
1st drawer
(CST1)
4100
4115
4101
4116
4108
4117
4109
4118
4103
4104
4105
4107
4128
4129
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
2nd drawer
(CST2)
3rd drawer
(CST3)
4th drawer
(CST4)
Bypass feed
LCF
ADU
4111
4110
4120
0,1,2,3,4
0,1,2,3,4
Paper size
(Select the paper size with the
sub code.)
0: 330 mm or longer
(13.0 inches or longer)
1: 220329 mm
(8.712.9 inches)
2: 205219 mm
(8.18.6 inches)
3: 160-204 mm
(6.38.0 inches)
4: 159 mm or shorter
(6.26 inches or shorter)
0: 330 mm or longer
(13.0 inches or longer)
1: 220329 mm
(8.712.9 inches)
2: 205219 mm
(8.18.6 inches)
3: 160-204 mm
(6.38.0 inches)
4: 159 mm or shorter
(6.26 inches or shorter)
Paper type*
Plain paper
Thick paper 1
Plain paper
Thick paper 1
Plain paper
Thick paper 1
Plain paper
Thick paper 1
Plain paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
OHP
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
Plain paper
Plain paper
Thick paper 1/Special
paper 1/Special paper 2
*Weight:
Plain paper: 60 to 105 g/m2 (16 lb. Bond to 28 lb. Bond)
Thick paper 1: 106 to 163 g/m2 (28 lb. Bond to 60 lb. Cover (90 lb. Index))
Thick paper 2: 164 to 209 g/m2 (61 lb. Cover to 77.3 lb. Cover (115.7 lb. Index))
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 11
<Procedure>
(Not necessary for LCF)
[0][5]
[Power]
(Code)
[START]
[OK] or
[INTERRUPT]
Stores in memory
(Sub-code)
[START]
Current value
displayed
[ ]*1 +[FAX]
[Drawer
selection]
(Test print)
Enter new
value
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
Fig.6-11
(*1)
3:
55:
57:
58:
60:
98:
K(4)*: System in which the test pattern is printed only in the black mode, though the four color
developers (Y, M, C, K) are contacted to the transfer belt.
Notes:
If the aligning amount is too large, abnormal noise (paper-folding noise) or actual paper folding
may occur during paper feeding. If the aligning amount is too small, on the other hand, a skew,
an image dislocation in feeding direction or a paper exit jam (E010) may occur. Pay attention to
the above and select the appropriate value.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 12
6.1.7
The printer related adjustment is performed by using the printed out grid pattern.
6
B
22
Feeding direction
A, D
Fig.6-12
Adjustment
Tolerance
A
B
52 0.5mm
200 0.5mm
C
D
52 0.5mm
52 0.5mm
Detail of adjustment
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 13
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 14
[B] Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of transfer belt motor
rotation speed)
Code
Sub code
Function
Remarks
4526
0
1
2
4
5
6
If the sub code 0 of 05-4526 is adjusted, the adjustment values of sub codes 1 to 6 are also changed
automatically, being operated with the adjusted value, according to the proper parameter. Basically,
adjusting only the sub code 0 completes all the adjustment of PRT, PPC and FAX.
[B-1]
Confirmation of 05-4526-0
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Adjustment Mode)
2. Press [98] [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm pitch is printed out. Use A3/LD from the 1st
drawer.)
3. Measure the distance B from the 2nd line at the leading edge of the paper to the 22nd line of
the grid pattern.
* Normally, the 1st line of the grid pattern is not printed.
4. Check if the distance B is within 2000.5 mm.
5. If not, perform the procedure in [B-2] Adjustment of 05-4526-0 to change the values and
measure the distance B again.
6. Perform the color registration (4719) after the adjustment.
[B-2]
Adjustment of 05-4526-0
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code [4526]) [START] (Key in the sub-code [0])
[START] (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
* When the value is not within the recommended values, the trailing edge area of the image
may be out of position for the paper length or the density at the trailing edge area of the image
may become lower. Perform the adjustment confirming the image.
100% A is displayed
Press [98] [FAX] (A grid pattern is printed out.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance B becomes (approx. 0.1 mm/
step).
(Key in the code [4719]) [START] (Enforced color registration)
Notes:
The grid pattern output by pressing [0][5] [98] [FAX] is the one of PRT (05-4526-0). Even
though the sub codes 1 to 6 are adjusted, the result cannot be confirmed in the grid pattern
output by pressing [0][5] [98] [FAX].
When 05-4526-0 is performed, a proper value is automatically calculated for the size of an
image in each function mode (copy/printer/Fax) or at each speed (normal speed/reduced speed/
high speed). The speed of the transfer belt motor is also adjusted. Therefore, use the above
default value other than the sub code 0, unless otherwise required.
Remarks:
For long paper (length: 484 mm to 1,200 mm) and A3/LD, it is recommended to adjust the
distance B above within the range of 199.5 mm and 200 mm otherwise the margin of the trailing
edge may be deleted.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 15
Paper size
Acceptable value
Remarks
4402
A3/LD
0 to 200
1
2
3
4
5
6
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Paper source
Code
Paper size
Acceptabl
e value
1st drawer
2nd drawer
3rd drawer
4th drawer
Bypass feed
4058
4059
4060
4560
4061
A4/LT
A3/LD
A4/LT
A4/LT
A4/LT
0 to 100
0 to 100
0 to 100
0 to 100
0 to 100
Duplexing
4062
A3/LD
0 to 100
Remarks
While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Adjustment Mode)
Press [98] ([3] for duplexing) [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm pitch is printed out.)
Measure the distance C from the leading edge of the paper to the 6th line of the grid pattern.
* Normally, the 1st line of the grid pattern is not printed.
* At the duplexing, measure it on the top side of the grid pattern.
Check if the distance C is within 520.5 mm.
If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance C again.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code shown above) [START]
(Key in an acceptable value shown above)
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
100% A is displayed
Press [98] ([3] for duplexing)
[FAX] (A grid pattern is printed out.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance C becomes (approx. 0.10 mm/
step).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 16
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 17
Notes:
When the writing start position (05-4019-0) for long-sized paper is changed, the one for mediumsized paper is also altered. (However, the value of 05-4019-2 is not changed.)
If 05-4019-0 is changed, check it with A4-R/LT-R paper and adjust the value of 05-4019-2 again
as required.
<Adjustment procedure summarization for A to D>
A:
B:
C:
D:
[0] [5] [Power ON] [98] ([3](05-4062, 4019) for duplexing) [FAX]
05-4006 (1st drawer, A3/LD)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 18
6.1.8
Feeding direction
Step 1
Feeding direction
Step 2
Fig.6-13
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
Press [FAX] to make a copy of any image on a sheet of A3/LD paper.
Key in [3033] and press the [START] button to move the carriage to the adjustment position.
Make an adjustment in the order of step 1 and 2.
Step 1
In case of A:
Tighten the mirror-3 adjustment screw (Rear) [1]
(CW).
In case of B:
Loosen the mirror-3 adjustment screw (Rear) [1]
(CCW).
Fig.6-14
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 19
Step 2
In case of C:
Tighten the mirror-1 adjustment screw (Rear) [1]
(CW).
In case of D:
Loosen the mirror-1 adjustment screw (Rear) [1]
(CCW).
(5)
Fig.6-15
The following adjustments (b) to (e) should be performed with Test Chart No. TCC-1.
P. 6-25 " Adjustments and Checks using Test Chart No. TCC-1"
[B] Image location of primary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Adjustment Mode)
(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).
(3) Press [FAX] [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Full color and Text/Photo.
(4) Measure the distance B from the left paper edge to the 5 mm line of left grid pattern on the copy
with a ruler.
(5) Check if the distance B is within 50.5 mm.
(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in code [3030]) [START]
(Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance B becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
[C] Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Adjustment Mode)
(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).
(3) Press [FAX] [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Full color and Text/Photo.
(4) Measure the distance C between M3 and M4 on the copy with a ruler.
(5) Check if the distance C is within 1500.5 mm.
(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code [3032]) [START]
(Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance C becomes (approx. 0.03 mm/
step).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 20
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 21
Copy
(6)
Black
Color
If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code [4050]) [START]
(Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
(100% A is displayed.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
Feeding direction
Fig.6-16
Notes:
Paper jams tend to occur in equipment in which thin paper such as 64g/m2 (17lb. Bond) paper is
used or a large amount of high density images such as pictures are output. For this equipment,
we recommend that you adjust the top margin in the plus direction in order to prevent paper
jamming.
Range of top margin adjustment (e.g.)
Function
Copy
Black
4.2 - 7.0 mm
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
Color
5.0 - 7.0 mm
6 - 22
(6)
Function
Black
Color
Copy
22.0 mm
22.0 mm
If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code [4052]) [START]
(Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory).
(100% A is displayed.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area at the right side becomes
(approx. 0.04 mm/step).
Feeding direction
Fig.6-17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 23
(6)
Function
Black
Color
Copy
32.0 mm
32.0 mm
If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>
(Adjustment Mode) (Key in the code [4053]) [START]
(Key in value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))
[OK] or [INTERRUPT] (stored in memory)
(100% A is displayed.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area at the trailing edge becomes
(approx. 0.04 mm/step).
Feeding direction
Fig.6-18
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 24
Feeding direction
Fig.6-19
<Adjustment order>
[0] [5] [Power ON] (Chart TCC-1) [FAX] [START] (A3/LD, 100%, Full color and Text/
Photo)
B: 05-3030 50.5 mm (0.04 mm/step)
C: 05-3032 1500.5 mm (0.03 mm/step)
D: 05-3031 100.5 mm (0.08 mm/step)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 25
[1]
[3]
[8]
[10]
[5]
[2]
[2]
[7]
[3]
[2]
[1]
[1]
[6]
[6]
[4]
[3]
[11]
[14]
[7]
[7]
[2]
[12]
[7]
[13]
[8]
[1]
Fig.6-20
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Grid patterns
YMCK patches
Resolution patterns
Gradation pattern
:
:
:
:
[5]
[6]
[7]
:
:
:
[8]
[9]
Center lines
Arrow
:
:
[10]
[11]
Halftone band
White text on the black
solid
Text
Thin lines
Note area
:
:
[12]
[13]
[14]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 26
6.1.9
Function
7000
PPC
7001
PRT(*1)/FAX
Remarks
The larger the value is, the larger the reproduction ratio in the primary
scanning direction becomes.
(0.1%/step)
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
The larger the value is, the larger the reproduction ratio in the primary
scanning direction becomes.
(0.1%/step)
Acceptable values: 128 to 255 (Default: 128)
*1: This adjustment is not available for the printer function when the resolution of the image is 600 x
1200 dpi.
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure:
Notes:
Since the reproduction ratio may vary due to expansion and contraction of the paper immediately
after the image is printed out, it is recommended to measure its dimension after at least 3
minutes have passed.
This adjustment may cause image troubles such as moire, disappearance or breaking of thin
lines on the printed image. Therefore check if there is no such image trouble while you are
performing the adjustment.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct a value, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. -> The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Make a test copy and check the image copied. To check the printed image, turn off the power
and then back on, and then print the image. If the image is not in the desired reproduction ratio,
repeat steps (2) to (4).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 27
6.2
6.2.1
When the reproduction of gradation is not appropriate, the gradation reproducibility of all colors Y, M, C
and K can be corrected by performing this automatic gamma adjustment. In case the gradation
reproduction of the image checked is not satisfactory, make this adjustment as described below at parts
replacement.
(1) When unpacking or any of the following parts has been replaced, be sure to make this
adjustment:
Photoconductive drum
(2)
Developer material
LED head
Needle electrode
Main charger grid
When any of the following parts are replaced or adjusted, make a copy and check the image to
determine if adjustment is necessary:
2nd transfer roller
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing the image adjustment in P. 6-4 "6.1.3
Performing Image Quality Control" and P. 6-7 "6.1.5 Image Dimensional Adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. Adjustment Mode
(2) Select the A4/LT/A3/LD drawer. Key in the pattern number and press the [FAX] button to output a
Patch chart for gamma adjustment.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Pattern No.
Pattern No.
Remark
Paper type
4
200
204
206
208
214
216
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
Color/black integrated
(3)
Place the patch chart for adjustment printed in step (2) face down on the original glass.
Place the chart aligning its side with 2 black squares against the original scale.
(4)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 28
The scanner reads the chart automatically and performs automatic gamma adjustment
calculation (approx.30 sec.).
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7869
(7871)
(5)
Item to be adjusted
Contents
Automatic gamma When the reproduction of gradation is not appropriate, the gradation
adjustment
reproducibility of all colors Y, M, C and K can be corrected by
performing this automatic gamma adjustment. The result of 7869 is
applied to all paper types. The result of 7871 is applied to the
specified paper type.
When the adjustment has finished normally, press the [OK] button to have the adjustment results
reflected.
(To cancel the reflection of adjustment results, press the [CANCEL] button.)
In the case of an abnormal ending, ADJUSTMENT ERROR is shown.
Press the [CANCEL] button to clear the error display. When it is cleared, the control panel display
will return to the ready state. Then, check if the patch chart on the original glass is placed in the
wrong direction or if it is placed inclined on the original glass, and then repeat step (3) and
afterward.
Remarks:
To select the paper type for the automatic gamma adjustment in user calibration, change the
code below to "1". (copy/print)
Code
08-9059
Remarks
0: No paper selecting buttons displayed
1: Paper selecting buttons displayed. (For both Copy and Printer)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 29
6.2.2
Density adjustment
The center density and the density variation controlled by density adjustment keys can be adjusted as
follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color
mode
Full color
Twin
color
Mono
color
Text/
Photo
(*1)
Text
7713
7714
7720
7721
Original mode
Printe
d
Photo
Map
Image
(*2)
7715
7716
7717
7722
7723
7724
Custo
m
Mode
Red
Seal
Color
Mode
Item to be
adjusted
7718
7719
7725
7726
Manual density
mode center
value
Automatic
density
Manual density
mode center
value
Automatic
density
Manual density
mode center
value
Automatic
density
7733
7734
7735
7736
7737
7738
7727
7728
7729
7730
7731
7732
Remarks
Original mode
Text/
Text
Photo
Black
7114
7123
Photo
Gray
scale
Custom
Mode
7115
7116
7138
7134
7124
7125
7141
7137
Item to be
adjusted
Manual
density mode
center value
Automatic
density mode
Remarks
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure.
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.
(6) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (5).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 30
6.2.3
The color balance is adjusted by adjusting the density of each color at the Full Color Mode. The
adjustment is performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density
and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Original mode
Color
Map
Custom
mode
Red
Seal
Color
7963-0
7964-0
7980-0
7984-0
7962-1
7963-1
7964-1
7980-1
7984-1
7961-2
7962-2
7963-2
7964-2
7980-2
7984-2
7965-0
7966-0
7967-0
7968-0
7969-0
7981-0
7985-0
7965-1
7966-1
7967-1
7968-1
7969-1
7981-1
7985-1
7965-2
7966-2
7967-2
7968-2
7969-2
7981-2
7985-2
7970-0
7971-0
7972-0
7973-0
7974-0
7982-0
7986-0
7970-1
7971-1
7972-1
7973-1
7974-1
7982-1
7986-1
7970-2
7971-2
7972-2
7973-2
7974-2
7982-2
7986-2
7975-0
7976-0
7977-0
7978-0
7979-0
7983-0
7987-0
7975-1
7976-1
7977-1
7978-1
7979-1
7983-1
7987-1
7975-2
7976-2
7977-2
7978-2
7979-2
7983-2
7987-2
Text
Printed
Image
Photo
Yellow 7960-0
7961-0
7962-0
7960-1
7961-1
7960-2
Mage
nta
Cyan
Black
Text/
Photo
Item to
be
Remarks
adjusted
Low
density
Medium
density
High
density
Low
density
Medium
density
High
density
Low
density
Medium
density
High
density
Low
density
Medium
density
High
density
The larger
the value
is, the
darker the
color to
be
adjusted
becomes.
Acceptabl
e values:
0 to 255
(Default:
128)
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure.
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
Changing the adjustment setting influences the adjacent density area slightly.
E.g.: When the value of the medium density is larger, the adjacent areas in the low density
and high density range will become slightly darker.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the code of the mode to be adjusted (color and original mode) and press the [START]
button.
(3) Select the density area to be adjusted with digital keys (0, 1 or 2), and press the [START] button.
0: Low density
1: Medium density
2: High density
(4) Key in an adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory.
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 31
(6)
(7)
(8)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 32
<Range of the density area (low density, medium density, high density)>
The color from 10 to 30 (low density), from 40 to 70 (medium density) and from 80 to 100 (high density)
in No. TCC-1 chart can be used as a guide for the range of the density area influenced by the change of
the adjustment value (low density, medium density, high density).
Low density
Medium density
High density
Fig.6-21
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 33
6.2.4
The density adjustment at the Black Mode is performed by selecting its density area from the following:
low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color
mode
Black
Original mode
Text/
Photo
Text
Photo
Gray
scale
Custom
mode
Item to be
adjusted
Low density
Medium density
High density
Remarks
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure.
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-31 "6.2.3 Color balance adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 34
6.2.5
Background adjustment
Full
color
Mono
color
Twin
color
Black
Text/
Photo
Map
Custom Gray
mode
scale
Red
Seal
Color
Mode
7659
7660
7661
---
7662
7709
---
---
---
---
---
7711
7712
---
---
---
---
---
7101
---
7102
---
7106
7105
---
Text
Printed
Image
Photo
7656
7657
7658
7707
7708
7710
7100
Remarks
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustment using the following procedure.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
6.2.6
Judgment levels for automatically identifying whether an original is color or black are adjusted. This
adjustment is for judgment levels when Auto Color is selected as a color mode. The same adjustment
value is simultaneously applied to all cases of originals on the original glass for copier functions and
network scanning functions, and those placed on the RADF.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7630
Item to be
Contents
adjusted
Judgment threshold The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be judged as black even at
for ACS
the Auto Color Mode. The smaller value is, the more it tends to be judged as
color.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 70)
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary and make
adjustment.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 35
6.2.7
Sharpness adjustment
If you want to make copy images look softer or sharper, perform the following adjustment.
The adjustment can be made for each of the color modes and original modes independently.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7796
7797
7798
7799
7800
7795
7794
Color mode
Full Color
7801
7802
7803
7804
7805
Mono color
7806
7056
7057
7058
7249
7061
Twin color
Black
Original mode
Text/Photo
Text
Printed Image
Photo
Map
Custom mode
Red Seal Color
Mode
Text/Photo
Text
Printed Image
Text/Photo
Text
Contents
The larger the value is, the sharper the image becomes;
while the smaller the value is, the softer the image
becomes.
The smaller the value is, the less moire tends to appear.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
Printed Image
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
Gray scale
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustment.
Notes:
You have to make adjustment by balancing between moire and sharpness.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 36
6.2.8
The values of the background peak/text peak in the range correction at the Black Mode can be
switched to varied or fixed in the following codes.
If they are fixed, the range correction is performed with standard values.
The values of the background peak affects the reproduction of the background density, and the values
of the text peak affects that of the text density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Original mode
Original mode
Text/Photo
Text
User Custom
Black
7286
7237
7287
Item to be
adjusted
Remarks
Manual
density mode
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustment.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
6.2.9
The smudge/faint text at a Black Mode can be set at the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color mode
Original mode
Text/
Text
Photo
Custom
mode
Black
7097
7252
7098
Item to be
adjusted
Adjustment of
smudged/ faint
text
Remarks
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustment.
Notes:
Remember the image specifications and life span of the replacing parts may not meet the
standard when the setting value is changed from the default value.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 37
6.2.10
The color of the one touch adjustment MARKER can be adjusted so that any marker colors already on
the original can be distinguished.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Item to be
adjusted
7850-0
Yellow
7850-1
Magenta
7850-2
Cyan
7850-3
Red
7850-4
Green
7850-5
Blue
3 (Default)
4 to 6
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
Red
Green
Blue
Notes:
The color may not always be reproduced precisely due to the characteristics of the fluorescent
ink.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in a sub-code and press the [START] button.
(4) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(6) Turn the power OFF and back ON in the normal mode. Then make a copy in the one touch
adjustment MARKER mode.
(7) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (6).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 38
6.2.11
The LED emission level in the black mode can be adjusted as follows. This adjustment adjusts the dot
size.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7212-0
7212-1
7212-2
7212-3
7212-4
Item to be adjusted
LED emission level 0/4
LED emission level 1/4
LED emission level 2/4
LED emission level 3/4
LED emission level 4/4
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the smaller the LED
emission level becomes. Therefore, the smaller dot is
reproduced accordingly. Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: Level 0/4: 0, Level 1/4: 63, Level 2/4: 127,
Level 3/4: 191, Level 4/4: 240)
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in a sub-code and press the [START] button.
(4) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(6) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.
(7) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (6).
Notes:
The setting value must increase as the LED emission level number (0 to 4) becomes higher. Do
not increase this order when setting the values.
Usually, LED emission level 4 / 4 is most effective in the black mode.
6.2.12
The maximum toner adhesion amount can be adjusted for each paper type.
It is used when offsetting occurs.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7913-0
7913-2
7913-3
7913-4
7913-7
7913-8
7913-11
7913-12
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the toner amount adhered
decreases of the high density area (ex. prevention of
fusing offsetting, etc.).
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
Envelop
OHP film
Notes:
Even if a large value is set, the image does not drastically appear dark (the amount of toner
adhering is not increased).
<Procedure>
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 39
6.2.13
The maximum text density in each color in the full color mode (Text/Photo, Text, Map mode) can be
adjusted.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
Black
Code
7889
7890
7891
7892
Item to be adjusted
Maximum text density
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the maximum
text density of each color to be adjusted
becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 10 (Default: 5)
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustments according to the following procedure.
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
6.2.14
Text/Photo reproduction level at the Full color mode and Auto color mode can be adjusted.
Text/Photo reproduction level adjustment can be switched to Photo oriented 1, Photo oriented 2,
Text oriented 1 or Text oriented 2 in the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Text/
Photo
7840
Mode
Custom
mode
(Text/Photo
base)
7841
Red Seal
Color
Mode
Item to be
adjusted
7842
Text/Photo
reproduction level
adjustment
Contents
0, 5: Default
The smaller the value, the higher the
printed image reproduction level becomes
(Photo oriented). The larger the value, the
higher the text reproduction level becomes
(Text oriented).
Notes:
The text reproduction level is lower when the mode is switched from the default value to the
Photo oriented.
When you change the setting from the default value to Text oriented, noise occurs in a printed
photo with a few lines.
The codes for the user custom setting are enabled only when the base original mode of the
user custom mode is Text/Photo.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 40
6.2.15
Code
7811
7812
7816
7817
Original mode
Text/Photo
Text
Custom mode
Red Seal Color
Mode
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the headers
become. However, the density level differs depending
on the modes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 8 (Default: 0)
If the value is set to "0", the table specified by default
is used. The default tables are as follows:
Text/Photo mode: 4
Text mode: 4
User custom setting
(in the Text/Photo, Map, or Text mode base): 4
User custom setting
(in the Photo or Printed image mode base): 3
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make
adjustment.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
6.2.16
Code
7641-0
7641-1
7641-2
Item to be
adjusted
High density
Medium density
Low density
7642-0
7642-1
7642-2
High density
Medium density
Low density
Remarks
The larger the value is, the larger the area
recognized as black in the original becomes. The
smaller the value is, the larger the area recognized
as the color other than black becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
The larger the value is, the larger the black area
becomes. The smaller the value is, the larger the
red area becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-31 "6.2.3 Color balance adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 41
6.2.17
The judgment level is adjusted for automatic identification of whether the original set is blank or not.
This adjustment is made when OMIT BLANK PAGE is selected on the control panel.
The adjustment value is simultaneously applied to all modes at PPC and scanning.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7618
Item to be adjusted
Judgment threshold
adjustment for blank
original
Remarks
The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be
judged as a bank sheet.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
6.2.18
The background level for scanning originals with the RADF is adjusted when the background fogging at
the scanning of a manually-set original and an original used with the RADF is different. This is to adjust
the level of the background image removed when the scanning of the originals with the RADF is
performed.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color mode
Color
Black
Code
7026
7025
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the background density
becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 42
6.2.19
The density of the color specified on the touch panel is adjusted in the monocolor copy or twin color
copy mode. This adjustment is reflected to both monocolor and twin color copying.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Magenta
Yellow
YellowGreen
Cyan
Pink
Red
Orange
Green
Blue
Purple
Subcode
Y
M
C
7644-0 7644-1 7644-2
7645-0 7645-1 7645-2
7646-0 7646-1 7646-2
7647-0 7647-1 7647-2
7648-0 7648-1 7648-2
7649-0 7649-1 7649-2
7650-0 7650-1 7650-2
7651-0 7651-1 7651-2
7652-0 7652-1 7652-2
7653-0 7653-1 7653-2
K
7644-3
7645-3
7646-3
7647-3
7648-3
7649-3
7650-3
7651-3
7652-3
7653-3
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the density
becomes, and the smaller the value is, the
lighter the density becomes. When "255" is
set, the specified solid color is used for
printing. When "0" is set, nothing is printed.
For example, in case of "Red", the color when
"Red" is specified becomes blue if you set as
follows:
(Y) 7649-0=0
(M) 7649-1=128
(C) 7649-2=255
Acceptable value: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
Notes:
If a large value is set for all of YMCK,
offsetting may occur. Make an
adjustment while checking the
image.
If "0" is set for all four colors of
YMCK, when a color is specified for
the adjustment item, nothing is
printed.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the code of the mode to be adjusted (color and original mode) and press the [START]
button.
(3) Select the density area to be adjusted with digital keys (0, 1, 2 or 3), and press the [START]
button.
0: Y
1: M
2: C
3: K
(4) Key in an adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory.
The equipment goes back to the ready state.
(6) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).
(7) Turn ON the power of the equipment and make a copy.
(8) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (7).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 43
6.2.20
The maximum density for each paper type can be adjusted collectively.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7902
7904
7905
7906
7909
7910
7901
7911
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the lower the density of the
whole image becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: Plain paper: 255, Recycled paper: 255,
Thick paper 1: 255, Thick paper 2: 255, Special paper
1: 255, Special paper 2: 255, Envelope: 255, OHP
film: 240)
Envelope
OHP film
Notes:
Be aware that if too small a value is set, a faint image occurs.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 44
6.2.21
When the custom mode or red seal color mode is selected, the color reproduction can be adjusted as
follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7690
7691
Original mode
Custom mode
Red seal color mode
Item to be adjusted
Color reproduction
adjustment
Remarks
0: Text/Photo, printed image, text, map
1: Photo
2: Red seal color mode
3: Text/Photo, printed image, text, map
4: Text/Photo, printed image, text, map
<Default value>
Custom mode: 0
Red seal color mode: 2
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.
(6) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (5).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 45
6.2.22
Hue adjustment
Code
Original mode
7665-0
Text/Photo
Red
7665-1
Text/Photo
Yellow
7665-2
Text/Photo
Green
7665-3
Text/Photo
Cyan
7665-4
Text/Photo
Blue
7665-5
Text/Photo
Magenta
7666-0
Text
Red
7666-1
Text
Yellow
7666-2
Text
Green
7666-3
Text
Cyan
7666-4
Text
Blue
7666-5
Text
Magenta
7667-0
Printed image
Red
7667-1
Printed image
Yellow
7667-2
Printed image
Green
7667-3
Printed image
Cyan
7667-4
Printed image
Blue
7667-5
Printed image
Magenta
Description
Remarks
Acceptable value: 0 to
255
Default value: 128
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 46
Item to be
adjusted
Code
Original mode
7668-0
Photo
Red
7668-1
Photo
Yellow
7668-2
Photo
Green
7668-3
Photo
Cyan
7668-4
Photo
Blue
7668-5
Photo
Magenta
7669-0
Map
Red
7669-1
Map
Yellow
7669-2
Map
Green
7669-3
Map
Cyan
7669-4
Map
Blue
7669-5
Map
Magenta
7670-0
Custom
Red
7670-1
Custom
Yellow
7670-2
Custom
Green
7670-3
Custom
Cyan
7670-4
Custom
Blue
7670-5
Custom
Magenta
7671-0
Red
7671-1
Yellow
Description
Remarks
Acceptable value: 0 to
255
Default value: 128
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 47
Item to be
adjusted
Code
Original mode
7671-2
Green
7671-3
Cyan
7671-4
Blue
7671-5
Magenta
Description
Remarks
Acceptable value: 0 to
255
Default value: 128
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button. (e.g. 7665)
(3) Key in a value to adjust the color.
0: Red
1: Yellow
2: Green
3: Cyan
4: Blue
5: Magenta
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Repeat step (2) to (4) to make the setting again.
(6) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.
(7) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (6).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 48
6.2.23
Saturation adjustment
The saturation of the copied image in the color copying function can be adjusted as follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Item to be
adjusted
Code
Original mode
7675-0
7675-1
7675-2
7675-3
Text/Photo
Text/Photo
Text/Photo
Text/Photo
Red
Yellow
Green
Cyan
7675-4
Text/Photo
Blue
7675-5
Text/Photo
Magenta
7676-0
7676-1
Text
Text
Red
Yellow
7676-2
Text
Green
7676-3
7676-4
7676-5
Text
Text
Cyan
Blue
Magenta
Text
7677-0
7677-1
Printed image
Printed image
Red
Yellow
7677-2
Printed image
Green
7677-3
Printed image
Cyan
7677-4
Printed image
Blue
7677-5
Printed image
Magenta
7678-0
7678-1
Photo
Photo
Red
Yellow
7678-2
Photo
Green
7678-3
Photo
Cyan
7678-4
Photo
Blue
7678-5
Photo
Magenta
7679-0
7679-1
Map
Map
Red
Yellow
7679-2
Map
Green
7679-3
Map
Cyan
7679-4
Map
Blue
7679-5
Map
Magenta
7680-0
7680-1
Custom
Custom
Red
Yellow
7680-2
Custom
Green
7680-3
Custom
Cyan
7680-4
Custom
Blue
7680-5
Custom
Magenta
7681-0
7681-1
Red
Yellow
7681-2
Green
7681-3
Cyan
7681-4
Blue
7681-5
Magenta
Description
Remarks
Acceptable value: 0 to
255
Default value: 128
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 49
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment is made after performing P. 6-28 "6.2.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button. (e.g. 7675)
(3) Key in a value to adjust the color.
0: Red
1: Yellow
2: Green
3: Cyan
4: Blue
5: Magenta
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Repeat step (2) to (4) to make the setting again.
(6) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.
(7) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (6).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 50
6.3
6.3.1
When the reproduction of gradation is not appropriate, the gradation reproducibility of all colors Y, M, C
and K can be corrected by performing this automatic gamma adjustment. In case the gradation
reproduction of the image checked is not satisfactory, make this adjustment as described below at parts
replacement.
1. When unpacking or any of the following parts has been replaced, be sure to make this adjustment:
- Photoconductive drum
- Developer material
- LED head
- LED gap spacer
- Transfer belt
- 1st transfer roller
- Drum cleaning blade
- Needle electrode
- Main charger grid
- Image position aligning sensor
- Image quality sensor
- SRAM board (SYS board)
- EEPROM (LGC board)
2. When any of the following parts are replaced or adjusted, make a print and check the image to
determine if adjustment is necessary:
2nd transfer roller
Screen switchover (for color: 05-8176, for black: 05-8187)
P. 6-62 "6.3.13 Screen switchover"
Notes:
Be sure to perform this adjustment after performing P. 6-4 "6.1.3 Performing Image Quality
Control".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 51
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. Adjustment Mode
(2) Select the A4/LT/A3/LD drawer. Key in the pattern number and press the [FAX] button to output a
Patch chart for adjustment.
600dpi
Pattern No.
70
74
76
78
84
86
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
Remarks
Notes:
However, this is applied to all paper types when 05-8008 is performed.
1200dpi
Pattern No.
230
234
236
238
244
246
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
Remarks
Notes:
However, this is applied to all paper types when 05-8009 is performed.
(3)
Place the patch chart for adjustment printed in step (2) face down on the original glass, with its
side, on which two black squares are present, aligned against the original scale.
(4) Key in a code and press the [START] button. The scanner reads the chart automatically and
performs automatic gamma adjustment calculation (approx. 30 sec.).
600dpi
Code
8004-0
8004-2
8004-3
8004-4
8004-7
8004-8
8008
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
All paper types
Remarks
* If the code 8008 is performed, the adjustment will be applied to all paper types.
1200dpi
Code
8005-0
8005-2
8005-3
8005-4
8005-7
8005-8
8009
*
Paper type
Plain paper
Recycled paper
Thick paper 1
Thick paper 2
Special paper 1
Special paper 2
All paper types
Remarks
If the code 8009 is performed, the adjustment will be applied to all paper types.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 52
(5)
When the adjustment has finished normally, press the [OK] button to have the adjustment results
reflected.
(To cancel the reflection of adjustment results, press the [CANCEL] button.)
In the case of an abnormal ending, ADJUSTMENT ERROR is shown. Press the [CANCEL]
button to clear the error display.
When it is cleared, the control panel display will return to the ready state. Then, check if the patch
chart on the original glass is placed in the wrong direction or if it is placed inclined on the original
glass, and then repeat step (3) and afterward.
To select the paper type for the automatic gamma adjustment in user calibration, change the code
below to "1". (copy/print)
Code
08-9059
Remarks
0: No paper selecting buttons displayed
1: Paper selecting buttons displayed. (For both Copy and Printer)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 53
6.3.2
The gamma balance is adjusted by adjusting the density at the Black Mode. The adjustment is
performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density, and high
density.
When "Black" (600 dpi) is set for the color mode and "Auto" is selected for the halftone setting, the
gamma balance can be adjusted in each area of Text, Graphics and Image.
Notes:
PS, XPS, and 1200dpi are not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Smooth Detail
(PS)
(PS)
7315-0 7316-0
Black
(600dpi) 7315-1
(PCL)
7317-0
Detail
(PCL)
7318-0
(XPS)
7319-0
7316-1
7317-1
7318-1
7319-1
7315-2
7316-2
7317-2
7318-2
7319-2
Black
7309-0
(1200dp 7309-1
i)
7309-2
7310-0
7310-1
7310-2
Color
mode
Smooth
Smooth
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Black
(600dpi) 7360-1
Smoot
h
(PCL)
7362-0
7363-0
Smoot
h
(XPS)
7364-0
7361-1
7362-1
7363-1
7364-1
7360-2
7361-2
7362-2
7363-2
7364-2
Remarks
---
Auto (PS)
Smoot
Detail
h
(PS)
(PS)
7360-0 7361-0
Color
mode
Detail
(XPS)
Auto (PCL)
Detail
(PCL)
Detail
(XPS)
Remarks
Auto (XPS)
Color
mode
Smooth Detail
(PS)
(PS)
Black
7366-0
(600dpi) 7366-1
7366-2
7367-0
7367-1
7367-2
Smoot
h
(PCL)
7368-0
7368-1
7368-2
Remarks
The larger the value is, the density of the item to be
adjusted becomes darker.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing P. 6-51 "6.3.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
Changing the adjustment setting influences the adjacent density area slightly.
E.g.: When the value of the medium density is larger, the adjacent areas in the low density and
high density range will become slightly darker.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes to be adjusted (language and screen) and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the value corresponding to the density area to be adjusted (0, 1 or 2) and press the
[START] button.
0: Low density 1: Medium density 2: High density/Highest density
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 54
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).
Let the equipment restart and perform the printing job.
If the image density has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (7)
<Range of the density area (low density, medium density, high density)>
The color from the 1st to the 7th stage (low density), from the 8th to the 11th stage (medium density)
and from the 12th to the 13th stage (high density) in "Patch chart for gamma adjustment ([71] [FAX])"
output as a confirmation in P. 6-51 "6.3.1 Automatic gamma adjustment" can be used as a guide for
the range of the density area (low density, medium density, high density) influenced by the change of
the adjustment value.
6
1
2
3
Low
density
4
5
6
7
8
Medium
density
9
10
11
12
High density
13
Fig.6-22
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 55
6.3.3
The color balance is adjusted by adjusting the density of each color. The adjustment is performed by
selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density, and high density.
Notes:
PS, XPS, and 1200dpi are not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
For color printing
Color
Yellow
(600dpi)
Magenta
(600dpi)
Cyan
(600dpi)
Black
(600dpi)
Yellow
(1200dpi)
Magenta
(1200dpi)
Cyan
(1200dpi)
Black
(1200dpi)
PS
Smooth
8050-0
8050-1
8050-2
8051-0
8051-1
8051-2
8052-0
8052-1
8052-2
8053-0
8053-1
8053-2
8268-0
8268-1
8268-2
8269-0
8269-1
8269-2
8270-0
8270-1
8270-2
8271-0
8271-1
8271-2
PCL
Detail
8054-0
8054-1
8054-2
8055-0
8055-1
8055-2
8056-0
8056-1
8056-2
8057-0
8057-1
8057-2
8272-0
8272-1
8272-2
8273-0
8273-1
8273-2
8274-0
8274-1
8274-2
8275-0
8275-1
8275-2
Smooth
8058-0
8058-1
8058-2
8059-0
8059-1
8059-2
8060-0
8060-1
8060-2
8061-0
8061-1
8061-2
-------------------------
XPS
Detail
8062-0
8062-1
8062-2
8063-0
8063-1
8063-2
8064-0
8064-1
8064-2
8065-0
8065-1
8065-2
-------------------------
Smooth
8042-0
8042-1
8042-2
8043-0
8043-1
8043-2
8044-0
8044-1
8044-2
8045-0
8045-1
8045-2
-------------------------
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
Detail
8046-0
8046-1
8046-2
8047-0
8047-1
8047-2
8048-0
8048-1
8048-2
8049-0
8049-1
8049-2
-------------------------
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker
the color to be adjusted becomes.
Acceptable
values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
6 - 56
Color specified
for twin color
print
Item to be adjusted
Black
8023-0
8023-1
8023-2
Cyan
Black
Magenta
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
Yellow
Magenta
Cyan
8024-0
8024-1
8024-2
8027-0
8027-1
8027-2
8030-0
8030-1
8030-2
8033-0
8033-1
8033-2
8036-0
8036-1
8036-2
8039-0
8039-1
8039-2
8025-0
8025-1
8025-2
8028-0
8028-1
8028-2
8031-0
8031-1
8031-2
8034-0
8034-1
8034-2
8037-0
8037-1
8037-2
8040-0
8040-1
8040-2
8026-0
8026-1
8026-2
8029-0
8029-1
8029-2
8032-0
8032-1
8032-2
8035-0
8035-1
8035-2
8038-0
8038-1
8038-2
8041-0
8041-1
8041-2
Remarks
The larger the value is, the
darker the color to be adjusted
becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
Notes:
Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing P. 6-51 "6.3.1 Automatic gamma
adjustment".
Changing the adjustment setting influences the adjacent density area slightly.
E.g.: When the value of the medium density is larger, the adjacent areas in the low density and
high density range will become slightly darker.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
<Range of the density area (low density, medium density, high density)>
The color from the 1st to the 7th stage (low density), from the 8th to the 11th stage (medium density),
from the 12th to the 13th stage (high density) in Patch chart for gamma adjustment ([71] [FAX]) output
in P. 6-51 "6.3.1 Automatic gamma adjustment" can be used as a guide for the range of the density
area influenced by the adjustment with the printer driver and the change of the adjustment value (low
density, medium density, and high density (Refer to P. 6-55 "Fig.6-22 ").
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 57
6.3.4
Color mode
PS
PCL
XPS
8130
8131
8132
Remarks
When the small characters or fine lines in a
halftone image are faint, they can be improved
by increasing the value to raise the density level.
Acceptable values: 0 to 8 (Default: 0)
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes to be adjusted and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (4).
(6) Let the equipment restart and perform the printing job.
(7) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (6).
6.3.5
The upper limit value of the density when "Toner save" is selected in the Custom tab of the printer driver
can be adjusted.
Notes:
PS, XPS, and 1200dpi are not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color
Black mode
Color mode
PS
7307-0
8160-0
PCL
7307-1
81601-
XPS
7307-2
8160-2
1200dpi
7302
8161
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the lighter
the density of image becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 176)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 58
6.3.6
Code
8145
8149
Paper type
OHP film
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the toner amount adhered
decreases of the high density area (ex. prevention of
fusing offsetting, etc.).
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 200)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-58 "6.3.4 Adjustment of faint text".
Notes:
The larger the value is, the more frequently fusing offsetting occurs.
6.3.7
XPS
Color mode
PS
PCL
7322-0
7322-2
8102-0
7322-1
8102-1
Remarks
8102-2
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
6.3.8
Photographi
c
Item to be
adjusted
8210-0
8211-0
8212-0
8210-1
8211-1
8212-1
8210-2
8211-2
8212-2
Text
Graphics
Image
8210-3
8211-3
8212-3
Remarks
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 59
6.3.9
Item to be
adjusted
Remarks
8213
8214
8215
Text
Graphics
Image
The larger the value is, the wider the color range to be printed only
with the black toner becomes. The smaller the value is, the narrower
this color range becomes.
Acceptable values: 1 to 255
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-58 "6.3.4 Adjustment of faint text".
6.3.10
Notes:
This adjustment is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Original mode
General
Photogra
phic
Presentat
ion
Line art
Color
profile
8252-0
8253-0
8254-0
8252-1
8253-1
8254-1
8252-2
8253-2
8254-2
8252-3
8253-3
8254-3
8252-4
8253-4
8254-4
Item to be
adjusted
Text
Graphics
Image
Remarks
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
6.3.11
Notes:
This adjustment is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Original mode
General
Photogra
phic
Presentat
ion
Line art
Color
profile
8249-0
8250-0
8251-0
8249-1
8250-1
8251-1
8249-2
8250-2
8251-2
8249-3
8250-3
8251-3
8249-4
8250-4
8251-4
Item to be
adjusted
Text
Graphics
Image
Remarks
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 60
6.3.12
Notes:
PS and XPS are not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Smooth/
Auto
(PS/PCL/
XPS)
8071-0
8071-2
8071-3
8071-4
8071-7
8071-8
8071-11
8071-12
Detail
(PS/PCL/
XPS)
Smooth
(1200dpi)
Detail
(1200dpi)
8070-0
8090-0
8089-0
8070-2
8090-2
8089-2
8070-3
8090-3
8089-3
8070-4
8090-4
8089-4
8070-7
8090-7
8089-7
8070-8
8090-8
8089-8
8070-11
8090-11
8089-11
8070-12
8090-12
8089-12
Paper type
Remarks
Plain paper
When you set a larger value,
Recycled paper the density becomes high in
some parts of the high
Thick paper 1 density area since the
Thick paper 2 maximum amount of toner
adhering increases.
Special paper 1
When you set a smaller
Special paper 2 value, the reproduction of the
gradation tends to be
Envelope
reduced since the maximum
OHP film
amount of toner adhering
decreases and the maximum
density becomes low.
Be aware that if too large a
value is set, offsetting
occurs.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 61
6.3.13
Screen switchover
Code
8176
8187
Remarks
The level of the screen ruling when "Smooth" is selected for the "Halftone" in
the "Detailed setting" in the Image quality tab of the printer driver can be
switched.
0: High screen ruling value (smoother image)
1: Low screen ruling value (rougher image)
Notes:
When the screen is switched, perform P. 6-51 "6.3.1 Automatic gamma adjustment".
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-58 "6.3.4 Adjustment of faint text".
6.3.14
Sharpness adjustment
General
Photo
Present
ation
Line art
Red
Seal
Color
Twin
color
Black
Remarks
Text
Graphics
Image
8110-0
8110-1
8110-2
8111-0
8111-1
8111-2
8112-0
8112-1
8112-2
8113-0
8113-1
8113-2
8109-0
8109-1
8109-2
8108-0
8108-1
8108-2
8118-0
8118-1
8118-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 62
Text/
Others
Thin text
Image
General
Photo
Present
ation
Line art
Red
Seal
Color
Twin
color
Black
Remarks
8110-0
8111-0
8112-0
8113-0
8109-0
8108-0
8118-0
8110-1
8110-2
8111-1
8111-2
8112-1
8112-2
8113-1
8113-2
8109-1
8109-2
8108-1
8108-2
8118-1
8118-2
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
6.3.15
Remarks
8240
(600dpi)
8241
(1200dpi)
Sets the lower limit value of the thin line width when Distinguish Thin Lines is
selected in the screen selecting menu of the printer driver.
The larger the value is, the thicker (darker) the thin line becomes.
Acceptable values: 1 to 9
(Default: 2)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-58 "6.3.4 Adjustment of faint text".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 63
6.3.16
Color
Twin
Color
Black
PS
Smooth
Detail
PCL
Smooth
Detail
XPS
Smooth
8010-0
8011-0
8013-0
8014-0
8012-0
8015-0
1200dpi
Smooth
Detail
Detail
8010-1
8011-1
8013-1
8014-1
8010-2
8011-2
8013-2
8014-2
8016
8017
8012-1
8015-1
8012-2
8015-2
8018
8019
Remarks
The larger
the value is,
the darker
the
background
becomes.
The smaller
the value is,
the lighter
the
background
becomes.
Acceptable
values: 0 to
255
(default:
128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
6.3.17
The color reproduction of the image object is specified in the twin color mode.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
8218
Remarks
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-58 "6.3.4 Adjustment of faint text".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 64
6.3.18
The LED emission level in the BOX printing (black/binary), network FAX and e-mail FAX can be set.
The size of the dots can be adjusted.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7330-0
7330-1
7330-2
7330-3
7330-4
Item to be adjusted
LED emission level 0/4
LED emission level 1/4
LED emission level 2/4
LED emission level 3/4
LED emission level 4/4
Remarks
The smaller the value is, the smaller the LED
emission level of the primary scanning direction
becomes. Therefore, the smaller dots are reproduced
accordingly.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: Level 0/4: 0, Level 1/4: 63, Level 2/4: 127,
Level 3/4: 191, Level 4/4: 255)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 65
6.3.19
This adjustment is available regardless of whether "Distinguish Thin Lines" of the printer driver is
selected or not.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color mode
Code
Remarks
Color/Black
8242-0
The density of the line in Black in the line density range specified
by "05-8243-0" or "05-8243-1" can be adjusted.
The larger the value is, the darker the line density becomes.
Acceptable value: 0 to 5 (Default: 3)
8242-1
Color mode
Code
Color/Black
8243-0
Remarks
The effective range (lower limit) of the
density adjustment for the line in Black can
be set.
Acceptable value: 0 to 255 (Default: 1)
8243-1
8243-2
8243-3
Notes:
Be sure to set the values of the upper and lower limit properly so that they are not set in reverse.
The line density adjustment codes with black (8242-0, 8243-0 and 8243-1) are in common for
both the color and black modes.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-54 "6.3.2 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 66
6.4
6.4.1
The gamma balance at the Black Mode is adjusted by adjusting the density. The adjustment is
performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high
density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Black
Original mode
Text/
Photo
Text
Photo
7485-0
7485-1
74850-2
7486-0
7486-1
7486-2
7487-0
7487-1
7487-2
Custom
mode
7480-0
7480-1
7480-2
Gray
Scale
7488-0
7488-1
7488-2
Item to be
adjusted
Remarks
Low density
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the code corresponding to the desired original mode and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the value corresponding to the density area to be adjusted (0, 1 or 2) and press the
[START] button.
0: Low density (L), 1: Medium density (M), 2: High density (H)
(4) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory.
The equipment goes back to the ready state.
(6) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).
(7) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning job.
(8) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (7).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 67
6.4.2
Density adjustment
Original mode
Text/
Text
Photo
Color
8339
8340
Photo
Custom
mode
8341
8380
Item to be
adjusted
Remarks
Manual
The larger the value is, the
density center darker the image becomes.
value
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
Gray
Scale
Item to be
adjusted
7475
7447
7478
7459
Manual
density center
value
Automatic
density
Mode
Text/
Photo
Text
Photo
Custom
mode
Black
7444
7445
7446
7456
7457
7458
Remarks
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in an adjustment value (acceptable values: 0 to 255).
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory.
The equipment goes back to the ready state.
(5) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning.
(6) If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 68
6.4.3
The adjustment level of background center value is adjusted. The control value of background
adjustment button is automatically adjusted to the same level as the adjusted center value.
For example, when the control value of background adjustment key ranges from 0 to 6, the background
center value (-2 to +2) is used to be the range from 6 to 14 accordingly.
Before adjustment
+2
+1
-1
-2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
+2
After adjustment
+1
-1
-2
Fig.6-23
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Original mode
Remarks
8309
8310
8311
8370
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values: 0 to 50. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning job.
(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 69
6.4.4
Color mode
Black
7437
7438
7441
7439
Grayscale
Original mode
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
Remarks
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
6.4.5
The judgment level is adjusted for the automatic identification of whether the original set on the glass is
black or color. Namely, this is to adjust the judgment level used when Auto Color is selected at color
modes. The same adjustment value is simultaneously applied to all cases of originals on the original
glass for copier functions and network scanning functions, and those placed on the RADF.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Item to be adjusted
Contents
7630
Judgment threshold
for ACS
The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be judged as
black even at the Auto Color Mode. The smaller the value is, the
more it tends to be judged as color.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 70)
<Procedure>:
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 70
6.4.6
Sharpness adjustment
If you want to make scan images look softer or sharper, perform the following adjustment. The
adjustment can be made for each of the color modes and original modes independently.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Color mode
Original mode
Contents
8354
8335
8336
8375
7430
7431
7432
7470
7433
Full Color
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
-
Black
Gray Scale
Notes:
You have to make adjustment by balancing between moire and sharpness.
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 71
6.4.7
Original mode
Remarks
8314
Text/Photo
8315
8316
8371
Text
Photo
Custom mode
The larger the value is, the black side of the image becomes darker.
Acceptable values: 0 to 4 (Default: 1)
The larger the value is, the black side of the image becomes darker.
Acceptable values: 0 to 4 (Default: 0)
Notes:
Be careful for the value not to be too large since the gradation is reproduced worse in darker
side.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values: 0 to 4. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning job.
(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
6.4.8
Original mode
Remarks
8319
8320
8321
8372
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values: 0 to 3. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning job.
(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 72
6.4.9
Adjustment of saturation
Original mode
Remarks
8324
8325
8326
8373
Text/Photo
Text
Photo
Custom mode
The larger the value is, the brighter the image becomes.
The smaller the value is, the duller the image becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values: 0 to 255.
(To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in the memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5) Let the equipment restart and perform the scanning job.
(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
6.4.10
The background level for scanning originals with the RADF is adjusted when the background fogging at
the scanning of a manually-set original and an original used with the RADF is different. This is to adjust
the level of the background image removed when the scanning of the originals with the RADF is
performed.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color mode
Color
Black
Code
7026
7025
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the background density
becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 73
6.4.11
The compression quality or the resolution is adjusted to reduce the file capacity of a SlimPDF or
improve its quality.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
9104
9107
Item to be
adjusted
Compression
quality of
SlimPDF
background
processing
Resolution of
SlimPDF
background
processing
Remarks
The smaller the value, the less the file capacity and the lower the
image quality becomes. The larger the value, the greater the file
capacity and the higher the image quality becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 10 (Default: 5)
The smaller the value, the less the file capacity and the lower the
image quality becomes. The larger the value, the greater the file
capacity and the higher the image quality becomes.
0: 75dpi
1: 100dpi
2: 150dpi
3: 200dpi
Acceptable values: 0 to 3 (Default: 1)
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2)
(3)
Key in the adjustment value. (To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4)
Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. -> The equipment goes
back to the ready state.
(5)
Let the equipment restart. Acquire the SlimPDF file and check it.
(6)
If the desired image quality has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
6.4.12
Item to be adjusted
Remarks
7489
Surrounding void
amount adjustment
When the value increases, the blank area around the scanned
image becomes wider, and the data on the image decrease.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 0)
The setting value "1" is equal to 1 dot with 600 dpi. (The value
"24" is equal to approx. 1 mm.)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 74
6.4.13
The judgment level is adjusted for automatic identification of whether the original set is blank or not.
This adjustment is made when OMIT BLANK PAGE is selected on the control panel.
The adjustment value is simultaneously applied to all modes at PPC and scanning.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
7618
Item to be adjusted
Judgment threshold
adjustment for blank
original
Remarks
The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be
judged as a bank sheet.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
6.4.14
The compression level for saving the scanned data in the JPEG format can be adjusted as follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
8304-0
8304-1
8304-2
Item to be adjusted
High quality
Standard
Low quality
Remarks
The larger the value is, the better the quality becomes, and
the larger the size of file becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-68 "6.4.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 75
6.5
6.5.1
The center density and the density variation controlled by density adjustment keys can be adjusted as
follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color
mode
Original mode
Text/
Text *
Photo
Black
7533
7534
7535
Manual density
center value
7542
7543
Automatic
density mode
Photo
Item to be
adjusted
Remarks
Since the gradation in this mode is reproduced in a binary image (black and white), this adjustment
should be a simple binary threshold adjustment.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(4) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(5) Turn the power OFF.
<Confirmation>
If possible, perform a Fax transmission and check the adjusted density with the image on the recipient's
side.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 76
6.5.2
The LED emission level in the fax function can be set. In this setting the size of dots is adjusted.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Code
Item to be adjusted
Remarks
7594-0
7594-1
7594-2
7594-3
7594-4
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(3) Key in a sub-code and press the [START] button.
(4) Key in an adjustment value.
(To correct a value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)
(5) Press the [OK] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. The equipment goes back to the
ready state.
(6) Take the POWER OFF.
<Confirmation>
Check the LED emission level setting with the actual fax data received, if possible.
Notes:
The setting value must increase as the LED emission level number (0 to 4) becomes higher. Do
not increase this order when setting the values.
Usually, LED emission level 4 / 4 is the most effective in the black mode.
6.5.3
The background level for scanning originals with the RADF is adjusted when the background fogging at
the scanning of a manually-set original and an original used with the RADF is different. This is to adjust
the level of the background image removed when the scanning of the originals with the RADF is
performed.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Color mode
Black
Code
7025
Remarks
The larger the value is, the darker the background density
becomes.
Acceptable values: 0 to 255
(Default: 128)
<Procedure>
The procedure is the same as that of P. 6-30 "6.2.2 Density adjustment".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 77
6.6
Scanner
6.6.1
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Notes:
Rotate the drive pulley to move the carriage.
(6)
Fig.6-24
Notes:
Confirm that they are aligned properly
through the windows [5] and [6] of the exit
side frame [2].
Fig.6-25
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 78
6.6.2
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
6.6.3
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Fig.6-26
[1]
[6]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[2]
Fig.6-27
Fig.6-28
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 79
6.7
6.7.1
Writing Section
Image Adjustment in the Writing Section
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 80
6.8
6.8.1
If the clearance between the paper and the side guides is too wide, it can be adjusted to between 0 and
1 mm using the following procedure (the clearance between the paper and the guides is 1 to 2 mm
including both front and rear sides).
<Procedure>
(1)
(2)
Fig.6-29
Fig.6-30
(3)
Fig.6-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 81
6.9
6.9.1
The high-voltage transformers (PS-HVT-210) supply high-voltage to the parts related to charging,
development, transfer and Discharging blade.
The high-voltage transformer has the following high-voltage outputs.
CH1
CH2
CH3
CH4
CH5
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
-
Notes:
Never move the variable resistance on the board since the output adjustment has been
performed at the shipment for the high-voltage transformer supplied as a service part. Also do
not perform the setting change when the high-voltage power supply is replaced.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 82
6.10.2
For the adjustment of the doctor-to-sleeve gap, perform the same procedure for the Y, M, C and K
developer units.
Adjustment tool to use: Doctor-sleeve gap jig
<Adjustment procedure>
(1)
(2)
Fig.6-32
(3)
Fig.6-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 83
Notes:
1. Flip up protection sheet[1] for the doctor
blade from the sleeve before inserting the
gauge. Also, be sure not to damage the
protection sheet[1].
Fig.6-34
Fig.6-35
(4)
Fig.6-36
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 84
When the image quality sensor is replaced, perform the automatic initialization of the image quality
control.
P. 6-4 "6.1.3 Performing Image Quality Control"
Perform this adjustment when the following parts are replaced or disassembled.
- Fuser roller
- Pressure roller
- Center thermistor(Non-contact thermistor)
- Side thermistor(Non-contact thermistor)
- Front thermistor
- Pressure spring
Adjustment tool to use: Non-contact thermistor/thermostat gap jig (Thin side)
Notes:
Perform gap adjustment when the fuser unit is at a normal temperature.
Make sure that the pressure roller is pressed.
Be careful not to damage the fuser roller and jig.
Perform non-contact thermistor correction after the adjustment.
<Adjustment procedure>
(1)
(2)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 85
(3)
(4)
Fig.6-37
Fig.6-38
(5)
Notes:
The jig should be inserted under its own
weight.
Fig.6-39
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 86
(6)
Fig.6-40
(7)
(8)
Fig.6-41
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 87
6.12.2
Since the center thermistor and the side thermistor are non-contact thermistors, the temperature
detected or controlled by these thermistors may differ depending on the gap between the fuser roller
and these thermistors. Therefore they must be corrected.
(1)
(2)
(3)
When unpacking
Perform the Forced performing of non-contact thermistor correction (05-5990) procedure
before you start printing (or gamma adjustment).
When any of the following parts is replaced, be sure to perform the Forced performing of noncontact thermistor correction (05-5990) procedure.
Fuser unit
Heater lamp
Fuser roller
Pressure roller
Center thermistor(Non-contact thermistor)
Side thermistor(Non-contact thermistor)
Front thermistor
Pressure spring
EEPROM
Procedure
Code
5990
Item to be adjusted
Contents
Forced performing of
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
non-contact thermistor
Adjustment Mode
correction
2. Key in [5990] and press the [START] button.
3. WAIT is displayed.
4. When the adjustment finishes normally, the equipment returns
to the initial state of Adjustment Mode.
When an error occurs
Refer to the C4F0 and C4F1.
P. 8-91 " [C4F0] Center thermistor error correction"
P. 8-91 " [C4F1] Side thermistor error correction"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 88
6.12.3
Perform this adjustment when the following parts are replaced or disassembled.
- Fuser roller
- Center thermostat
- Side thermostat
Adjustment tool to use: Non-contact thermistor/thermostat gap jig (Thick side)
Notes:
Perform gap adjustment when the fuser unit is at a normal temperature.
Make sure that the pressure roller is pressed.
Be careful not to damage the fuser roller and jig.
<Adjustment procedure>
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Fig.6-42
Fig.6-43
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 89
(5)
Notes:
The jig should be inserted under its own
weight.
Fig.6-44
(6)
(7)
Fig.6-45
Fig.6-46
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
SETTING / ADJUSTMENT
6 - 90
7.
7.1
General Description
The purpose of preventive maintenance (PM) is to maintain the quality level of this equipment by
periodically inspecting and cleaning this equipment and also replacing the parts whose replacement
timing has come according to the maintenance contract. There are PM kits packaged for each unit or a
group of parts with the same replacement number of output pages, allowing you to carry out efficient
parts replacement.
7.2
PM Display
7.2.1
General Description
The maintenance timing for the PM parts of the process unit, such as the drum and developer material,
and the PM parts of the units other than the process unit, such as the 2nd transfer roller varies
depending on the conditions of the use, such as the ratio of color/black printing. Therefore, this
equipment shows the appropriate maintenance timing of each part on the control panel LCD.
7.2.2
PM Display Conditions
The conditions of the PM display consist of the codes of the setting mode (08) for the setting value
treated as a threshold of the PM display, the counter indicating the current number of prints and
driving time and the setting value which determines the display conditions.
The PM timing is displayed when the counter exceeds the setting value according to the display
condition based on the setting value which determines the display conditions.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-1
08-6196
08-6197
08-5564
08-5565
08-5566
08-5567
08-5568
08-5569
08-5570
08-5571
08-5572
08-5573
08-5574
08-5575
08-5576
08-5577
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-2
7.2.3
PM Display Contents
When the counter value exceeds the setting value, the equipment notifies you of when the
maintenance time has come by displaying the message Time for periodic maintenance **** on the
control panel LCD. **** in the message is a 4-digit hexadecimal number code. This number is
allocated in the following manner, therefore the parts needing maintenance can be identified.
PM parts of the process unit (K)
PM parts of the process unit (Y)
PM parts of the process unit (M)
PM parts of the process unit (C)
Developer material (K)
Developer material (Y)
Developer material (M)
Developer material (C)
Parts other than the PM parts of the process unit
: 0008
: 0001
: 0002
: 0004
: 0080
: 0010
: 0020
: 0040
: 0100
If multiple parts have reached the maintenance time, the sum of the corresponding code values listed
above is displayed in hexadecimal numbers.
For example, if the PM parts of the process units (K) and (C) and the developer materials (K) and (C)
reach the maintenance time, the 4-digit hexadecimal number code will be 00CC in hexadecimal
numbers: 0008+0004+0080+0040=00CC.
4th digit
None
Always 0
3rd digit
Part (2nd transfer roller)
Hexadecimal
number
Explanation
code
2nd digit
Developer material
Hexadecimal
number
Explanation
code
No
maintenanc
e required
Maintenanc
e required
1st digit
Photoconductive drum
Hexadecimal
number code
No
maintenanc
e required
Y
No
maintenanc
e required
Y
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
M
M+Y
C
Y+C
C+M
Y+M+C
K
K+Y
K+M
K+M+Y
K+C
K+Y+C
K+C+M
K+Y+M+C
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
M
M+Y
C
Y+C
C+M
Y+M+C
K
K+Y
K+M
K+M+Y
K+C
K+Y+C
K+C+M
K+Y+M+C
Explanation
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-3
7.2.4
Counter Clearing
The counter indicating current number of prints and driving time used for the PM display function is
reset by entering 0 in it or clearing it in the PM support mode.
Notes:
Even if 0 is entered in the PM management setting value of the setting mode (08), the
corresponding counter for the PM display is not reset. Be sure to clear the counter in the PM
support mode when the maintenance is finished.
The reset condition of each counter is as follows:
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-4
In addition, when the developer unit is recognized as a new one by the M developer unit old/new
detection switch, or the auto-toner sensor adjustment is performed, the counter is also reset.
08-5576: Current value of PM counter [parts other than the PM parts of the process unit]
08-5577: Current value of PM time counter [parts other than the PM parts of the process unit]
When the current value of 2nd TRANSFER on the main screen or 2nd TRANSFER ROLLER on
the sub screen in the PM support mode is cleared, the counter is reset.
7.3
(1)
S/N : CYL000001
TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
UNIT
TOTAL
: 2146
DF TOTAL : 1213
OUTPUT PAGES
PM OUTPUT PAGES DRIVE COUNTS
DEVELOP COUNTS DEVELOP COUNTS
DRUM(K)
DRUM BLADE(K)
GRID(K)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE(K)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD(K)
DRUM(Y)
DRUM BLADE(Y)
GRID(Y)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE(Y)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD(Y)
DRUM(M)
DRUM BLADE(M)
GRID(M)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE(M)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD(M)
DRUM(C)
DRUM BLADE(C)
GRID(C)
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE(C)
CHARGER CLEANING PAD(C)
1957
1957
1957
1957
1957
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1957
1957
1957
1957
1957
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
1077
3940
10870
10870
10870
10870
3766
3766
3766
3766
3766
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
9547
PM DRIVE COUNTS
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
170000
Fig. 7-1
(2)
(3)
Turn OFF the power and make sure to unplug the equipment.
Perform a preventive maintenance using the following checklist and illustrations. Refer to the
Service Manual if necessary.
Plug in the equipment after the maintenance has been finished. Then turn ON the power and
make some copies to confirm that the equipment is working properly.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-5
7.4
7.4.1
PM Support Mode
General Description
This equipment has a PM support mode which enables you to confirm the use status of each part (the
number of output pages or developed pages, and drive counts) requiring periodic replacement and also
the replacement record, as well as resetting counter values efficiently. This record can be printed out in
the list print mode.
7.4.2
Operational flow
Authentication screen
Main screen
[CANCEL] pressed
[RETURN]
pressed
Sub screen
Sub unit list displayed
Clear finished
Clear screen
Counter clear
confirmation displayed
[CANCEL]
pressed
Sub unit chosen
[RESET] pressed
[INITIALIZE]
pressed
Clear finished
Counter clear performed
Fig. 7-2
*
*
*
When the authentication screen appears, press [OK]. (Enter the password, if one has been set.)
To finish the PM support mode, shut down the equipment by pressing and holding [ON/OFF] on the
main screen for a few seconds.
The screen goes back to the main screen when the counter clear is performed or the [CANCEL]
button is pressed after moving from the main screen, while it goes back to the sub screen after
moving from the sub screen.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-6
7.4.3
Operational screen
The description of the display (including the function of each button) on the LCD screen is shown
below.
1. Main screen
1
Fig. 7-3
Displaying of the number of print / develop pages (Page/D. cnt), drive counts (Cnt.) and
previous replacement date (Chg.) for a chosen unit
When the replacement date for the sub unit is different, press the [SUB UNIT] button to
move to the sub screen and see each information, otherwise information is not displayed
Displaying of the standard number of drive counts to replace the unit parts
Displaying of the standard number of print / develop pages to replace the unit parts
Moving to the clear screen to clear the selected unit counters 4 and 6 , including all sub
unit (parts) counters belonging to that unit When the unit is not selected, all counters are
cleared.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-7
Notes:
is always displayed at the drive counts section for the reversing automatic document feeder
(RADF) and feed unit.
is displayed at the numeric section for the paper source which is not installed since the paper
source is different depending on the structure of options.
2. Sub screen
1
Fig. 7-4
Displaying of the number of print / develop pages and drive counts and previous
replacement date for a chosen sub unit
Displaying of the standard number of drive counts to replace the sub unit (parts)
5
6
Moving to the clear screen to clear the selected unit (parts) counters
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-8
3. Clear screen
7
2
Fig. 7-5
When the [INITIALIZE] button is pressed, Present number of print / develop pages and
Present driving counts are cleared and Previous replacement date is updated.
When the [CANCEL] button is pressed, the counter is not cleared and the display returns to
the main or sub screen.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7-9
7.4.4
Access tree
The relation between the main unit and the sub unit is shown below.
Notes:
Some parts in this manual are described with different names on the LCD screen. In this case,
the name in this manual is indicated in square brackets [ ].
Main screen
CLEANER/DRUM/CHARGER (K)
[Process unit (K)]
CLEANER/DRUM/CHARGER (Y)
[Process unit (Y)]
CLEANER/DRUM/CHARGER (M)
[Process unit (M)]
CLEANER/DRUM/CHARGER (C)
[Process unit (C)]
OZONE FILTER
[Ozone filter-1]
DEVELOPMENT UNIT
2nd TRANSFER
1st CST.
[1st drawer]
2nd CST.
[2nd drawer]
SFB
[Bypass unit]
RADF
LCF
3rd CST.
[PFP upper drawer]
Sub-screen
DRUM (K)
DRUM BLADE (K) [Drum cleaning blade]
GRID (K) [Main charger grid]
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (K) [Needle electrode]
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (K) [Main charger cleaner]
LED GAP SPACER (K)
DRUM (Y)
DRUM BLADE (Y) [Drum cleaning blade]
GRID (Y) [Main charger grid]
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (Y) [Needle electrode]
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (Y) [Main charger cleaner]
LED GAP SPACER (Y)
DRUM (M)
DRUM BLADE (M) [Drum cleaning blade]
GRID (M) [Main charger grid]
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (M) [Needle electrode]
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (M) [Main charger cleaner]
LED GAP SPACER (M)
DRUM (C)
DRUM BLADE (C) [Drum cleaning blade]
GRID (C) [Main charger grid]
MAIN CHARGER NEEDLE (C) [Needle electrode]
CHARGER CLEANING PAD (C) [Main charger cleaner]
LED GAP SPACER (C)
----BLACK DEVELOPER [Developer material K]
YELLOW DEVELOPER [Developer material Y]
MAGENTA DEVELOPER [Developer material M]
CYAN DEVELOPER [Developer material C]
2nd TRANSFER ROLLER
FEED ROLLER
SEP PAD (1st CST.) [Separation pad]
PICK UP ROLLER (2nd CST.)
FEED ROLLER (2nd CST.)
SEP ROLLER (2nd CST.) [Separation roller]
FEED ROLLER (SFB)
SEP PAD (SFB) [Separation pad]
PICK UP ROLLER (RADF)
FEED ROLLER (RADF)
SEP ROLLER (RADF) [Separation roller]
PICK UP ROLLER (LCF)
FEED ROLLER (LCF)
SEP ROLLER (LCF) [Separation roller]
PICK UP ROLLER (3rd CST.)
FEED ROLLER (3rd CST.)
SEP ROLLER (3rd CST.) [Separation roller]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 10
Main screen
4th CST.
[PFP lower drawer]
Sub-screen
Notes:
When the counter value of any of the pickup roller, feed roller and separation roller in each unit is
reset, the value of the feeding retry counter is also reset simultaneously. When the [RESET]
button is pressed after selecting the feed unit in the Main Screen, the value of the feeding retry
counter is also reset simultaneously.
The feeding retry counter:
1st drawer
Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6230)
2nd drawer
Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6231)
PFP upper drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6232)
PFP lower drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6233)
Bypass unit
Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6234)
LCF
Reset the feeding retry counter (08-6235)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 11
7.5
The life span of the parts changes depending on their general use, such as the ratio of the color/black
printing or the adjustment for keeping the printing quality. Therefore, it is necessary to consider not only
the number of printed/developed pages but also the drive counts when deciding the timing for parts
replacement. Even if the number of print / develop pages has reached the level of replacement, for
instance, the part may still be usable with its drive counts not reaching the specified drive counts. On
the other hand, the part may need replacement even if the number of print / develop pages has not
reached the level of replacement with its driving time exceeding the specified drive counts. The life
span of some parts such as feed roller is heavily dependent on the number of output pages rather than
the drive counts.
The following work flow diagram shows how to judge the timing of replacement with the number of print
/ develop pages.
Example 1:
When the number of print / develop pages has reached the specified level
Yes
No
The part is still usable.
Example 2:
When the image failure occurred before the number of print / develop pages has reached the
specified level
Check the drive counts of all parts at PM support mode.
Yes
No
Check the part and equipment according to the TROUBLESHOOTING.
Fig. 7-7
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 12
7.6
Lubrication/Coating
A: Clean with
alcohol
B: Clean with soft
pad, cloth or vacuum
cleaner
L:
SI:
W1:
Launa 40
Silicon oil
White grease
(Molykote EM-
Replacement
Value:
Replacement cycle
R: Replace if deformed
or damaged
Operation check
O: After cleaning or
replacement, confirm
there is no problem.
30L)
W2: White grease
(Molykote HP300)
AV: Alvania No.2
FL: Floil (GE-334C)
20ppm, LL20ppm
25ppm, LL25ppm
Black
Full color
The value in the Replacement field of the table below indicates the replacement number of
output pages in either the black or the full color mode. If they differ according to the model, they
are indicated in the order of the 20ppm, LL20ppm, 25ppm, LL25ppm.
The replacement cycle of the parts in the feeding section equals to the number of sheets fed from
each paper source.
Be careful not to put oil on the rollers, belts and belt pulleys when lubricating.
Parts list <P-I> represents the page item in e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C Service
Parts List.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 13
7.6.1
Scanner
A2
A5
A1
A4
A6
A8
A10
A9
A7
A3
Fig. 7-8
Replacement
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
*
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
Items to check
Cleaning
Original glass
ADF original glass
Mirror-1
Mirror-2
Mirror-3
Reflector
Lens
Exposure lamp
Automatic original
detection sensor
Slide sheet
(front and rear)
B or A
25-2
25-3
(x 1,000
sheets)
10-9
R
B
B or A
11-3
1--12
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 14
7.6.2
LED unit
B1
Fig. 7-9
Replacement
Items to check
B1
Discharge LED
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
31-15
B or A
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 15
7.6.3
Feed unit
C3
C1
C2
Fig. 7-10
Replacement
Items to check
C1
C2
C3
7.6.4
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
80
AV, W2
A
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
(x 1,000
sheets)
80
R
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
43-12
43-7
13-3
D3
D1
D2
D1
D2
Fig. 7-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 16
Replacement
Items to check
D1
D2
D3
Transport roller
One side of the plastic
bushing to which the
shaft is inserted
Paper guide
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
R
W1
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
R
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
41-10
41-18
41-20
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 17
7.6.5
E1
E2
E3
Fig. 7-12
Replacement
Items to check
E1
E2
E3
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
Pickup roller
Separation pad (Tray)
Separation pad (Guide)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
(x 1,000
sheets)
80
80
80
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
21-19
21-20
21-7
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 18
7.6.6
Main charger
F4
F3
F5
F6
F1
F2
7
Fig. 7-13
Replacement
Items to check
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
35-12
56/70
255
35-8
35-2
35-4
56/70
B
255
56/70
255
56/70
255
35-6
35-7
O
35-15
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 19
7.6.7
G5
G4
G2
G3
G6
Fig. 7-14
Replacement
Items to check
G1
G2
G3
G4
G5
G6
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
56/70
255
56/70
255
34-35
34-8
56/70
255
34-10
B
B
34-9
G2: Drum
Handling precautions
If fingerprints or oil adhere to the surface of the drum, its properties may degrade, affecting
the quality of the copy image. So, wear gloves to avoid touching the drum surface with your
bare hands. Be sure to handle the drum carefully when installing and removing it so as not to
damage its surface.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 20
Cleaning procedure
Clean the blade edge with a cloth moistened with water and squeezed lightly.
Replace the cleaning blade with new ones if poor images are copied due to the damaged
blade regardless of the number of output pages which have been made
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 21
G4: Felt
When replacing the drum cleaning unit, check that there is no gap between the blade and felt on
both ends. If there is, or when the felts put pressure to the cleaning blade, reattach the felts on
the position shown in the figure (by slightly pushing them to the direction of the arrows).
Fig. 7-15
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 22
7.6.8
H9
H2
H5
H6
H3
H8
H1
H4
H7
H5
Fig. 7-16
Replacement
Items to check
H1
H2
H3
H4
H5
H6
H7
H8
H9
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
B
W1
56/70
145
33-8
33-6
33-7
33-25
33-25
33-4
32-9
H1: Developer unit, H4: Front shield (unified with the doctor blade)
1. Cleaning
Clean the doctor blade so as to prevent developer material from adhering to it when the
drum is being replaced.
Space the front shield from the developer sleeve and then insert a doctor blade
cleaning jig into the doctor sleeve gap. Then clean the doctor blade by running the jig
for 3 times to and fro along with the edge of the blade.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 23
Fig. 7-17
30mm
1
Fig. 7-18
(4) Slide the cleaning jig to where the white streak appears.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 24
(5) Pull out the cleaning jig while manually turning the gear to rotate the developer
sleeve.
Knob
Fig. 7-19
Tip:
If foreign matter is not removed by the above procedure, take off the developer unit,
discharge the developer material on to a sheet of clean paper and then remove any
foreign matter found. If you cannot find any foreign matter, exchange the developer
material.
3. Removal of foreign matter on the developer sleeve
(1) Apply a sheet of paper to the developer sleeve.
(2) Scrape off foreign matter and developer material on the developer sleeve using the
jig.
Foreign matter
Fig. 7-20
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 25
Clean the surface of the auto-toner sensor with a cotton swab or soft cloth with sufficient alcohol
filled in.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 26
7.6.9
J8
J9
J3
J7
J2(Y)
J2(M)
J6
J2(C)
J2(K)
J1
J6
J4
J5
Fig. 7-21
Replacement
Items to check
Cleaning
Transfer belt
1st transfer roller
Tension roller
TBU drive roller
Front 2nd transfer roller
Lift roller
Winding roller (K)
Transfer belt cleaning
blade
J9
Recovery blade
J10 Blade seal
J1
J2
J3
J4
J5
J6
J7
J8
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
R
(x 1,000
sheets)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
26-14
27-9
26-10
26-27
27-2
26-8
27-4
30-19
30-22
30-20
30-21
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 27
Cleaning procedure
Fully clean up the toner and such adhering to the roller with alcohol, and then wipe it with a
dry cloth until no trace remains. Take care not to have the transfer belt surface being
damaged or dented. Replace the transfer belt with a new one regardless of the number of
output pages, if any crack or major scar is found.
J3:Tension roller, J4: TBU drive roller, J5: Front 2nd transfer roller, J6: Lift roller
Fully clean up the toner and such adhering to the roller with alcohol when the transfer belt
cleaning blade is replaced, since an image failure may occur if there is any dirt remaining on the
roller. Also, remove dust and toner scattering adhering to the inside of the transfer belt unit in
order to keep rollers clean.
Cleaning procedure
Clean the blade edge with a cloth moistened with water and squeezed lightly.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 28
7.6.10
Fig. 7-22
7
Replacement
Items to check
K1
K2
K3
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
R
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
R
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
14-6
14-9
14-6
K2: Actuator
If toner adheres to the actuator (paper contact section), clean it with a soft pad, cloth or electric
vacuum cleaner.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 29
7.6.11
L4
L3
L1
L2
Fig. 7-23
Replacement
Items to check
L1
L2
L3
L4
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
R
(x 1,000
sheets)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
14-28
22-11
14-19
14-22
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 30
7.6.12
Fuser unit
M3
M8
M6
M1
M7
M2
M5
M4
Fig. 7-24
Replacement
Items to check
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
M8
Heat roller
Pressure roller
Separation finger for
Heat roller
Fuser unit entrance
guide
Thermistor
Drive gear (tooth face
and shaft)
Heat roller gear
Exit sensor actuator
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
R
38-20
38-26
(x 1,000
sheets)
38-15
38-11
38-16
38-17
40-10
39-24
M5: Thermistor
Clean the thermistor with alcohol if the toner or dirt is sticking to it when the Heat roller is
replaced.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 31
Do not deform or damage the thermistor during the cleaning. Replace the thermistor with a new
one if it is damaged or deformed regardless of degree.
Be sure to perform the fuser thermistor correction when it is removed or replaced.
*
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 32
7.6.13
Exit unit
N1
N3
N2
Fig. 7-25
Replacement
Items to check
N1
N2
N3
*
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
40-17
W2
A
40-5
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 33
7.6.14
RADF (MR-3024)
5
10
Fig. 7-26
Replacement
Items to check
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Pickup roller
Separation roller
Feed roller
Registration roller
Intermediate transfer
roller
Front read roller
Rear read roller
Reverse registration
roller
Exit/reverse roller
Platen sheet
Lubrication/
Coating
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
120
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
-
120
4-10
120
5-27
Cleaning
(x 1,000
sheets)
5-27
4-30
3-13
3-14
3-1
3-10
4-25
B or A
1-25
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 34
7.6.15
PFP (KD-1032)
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[4]
[2]
[3]
7
Fig. 7-27
Replacement
Items to check
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
Pickup roller
(upper/lower)
80
or every
2.5 years,
whichever
comes first
5-26
Feed roller
(upper/lower)
5-26
Separation roller
(upper/lower)
80
or every
2.5 years,
whichever
comes first
80
or every
2.5 years,
whichever
comes first
Transport roller
(tooth face)
Paper guide
2-35
2-40
5-30
4-1
4-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 35
7.6.16
LCF (KD-1031)
4
Fig. 7-28
Replacement
Items to check
1
2
3
4
Pickup roller
Feed roller
Separation roller
Drive gear
(tooth face)
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
160
4-4
160
4-3
160
5-8
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 36
7.6.17
PFU (MY-1040)
1
2 3 4 5 5
6
4
4
Fig. 7-29
Replacement
Items to check
1
2
3
4
5
6
Pickup roller
Feed roller
Separation roller
Guide
Transport roller
Paper feed roller
7.6.18
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
80
5-26
80
5-26
80
5-30
4-3
4-23
4-1
4-11
JSP (MJ-5004)
2
5
6
3
1
2
4
Fig. 7-30
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 37
Replacement
Items to check
Cleaning
Lubrication/
Coating
(x 1,000
sheets)
(x 1,000
drive
counts)
Operation
check
Parts
list
<P-I>
Idling roller
O or A
80
1-25
1-26
1-27
1-28
1-30
Other rollers
O orA
80
Paper guide
O orA
80
1-40
1-42
1-14
1-5
1-7
4
5
6
1-11
1-11
1-16
1: Idling roller
Apply each one-rice-grain amount of the white grease (Molykote EM-30L) at the point A (2
points) in Figure 7-36
Fig. 7-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 38
7.7
Precautions for storing supplies and replacement parts are shown below.
1. Toner/Developer
Toner and developer should be stored in a place where the ambient temperature is between 10C to
35C (no condensation), and should also be protected against direct sunlight during transportation.
2. Photoconductive drum
Like the toner and developer, photoconductive drum should be stored in a dark place where the
ambient temperature is between 10C to 35C (no condensation). Be sure to avoid places where
drums may be subjected to high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
3. Drum cleaning blade / Transfer belt cleaning blade
This item should be stored in a flat place where the ambient temperature is between 10C to 35C,
and should also be protected against high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
4. Transfer belt / Transfer roller / Fuser roller / Pressure roller
Avoid places where the rollers may be subjected to high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
5. Paper
Avoid storing copy paper in places where it may be subjected to high humidity.
After a package is opened, be sure to place and store it in a storage bag.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 39
7.8
PM KIT
DEV-KIT-FC30K
Component
DEV-KIT-FC30CLR
ROL-KIT-1026 (LCF)
DF-KIT-3018 (RADF)
Separation roller
Pick up roller
Feed roller
Separation roller
Pick up roller
Feed roller
Separation roller
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
Part name
BL-FC30D
GRID-CHARGR-MAINH21X
PIN-ARRAY-CHARGRH21X
FILM-CLNR-CHARGRH21X
D-FC30-K
SPACER-LED-FRT-H21XN1
SPACER-LED-RER-H21XN1
BL-FC30D
GRID-CHARGR-MAINH21X
PIN-ARRAY-CHARGRH21X
FILM-CLNR-CHARGRH21X
D-FC30-Y
D-FC30-M
D-FC30-C
SPACER-LED-FRT-H21XN1
SPACER-LED-RER-H21XN1
ASYS-ROLL-FEEDH21X_H
ASYS-ROLL-FEEDH21X_H
ASYS-ROLL-SPT-H21X_H
ASYS-ROL-PICK-KD1026
ASYS-ROL-FEED-KD1026
ASYS-ROL-RET-KD1026
ASYS-ROL-FEED
ASYS-ROL-FEED
ASYS-ROL-RET
Qty.
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
3
3
3
6
1
1
1
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
7 - 40
7.9
The parts used for the maintenance of this equipment are as follows.
No.
1
3
Cleaning brush
Doctor blade cleaning jig
Wire pulley holder jig
15
Drum bag
Download jig (DLM board)
ROM
Download jig-2 (6 Flash
ROMs)
ROM writer adapter (For 1881)
ROM writer adapter (For 1931)
Patting pawder
Door-switch jig
Color test chart
16
17
18
19
20
21
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Item
Purpose
P-I*
101-2
101-3
101-4
101-5
101-6
101-7
101-9
102-1
102-10
102-2
102-4
102-5
101-25
101-1
101-10
101-11
101-8
101-8
102-8
102-7
101-12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 41
13
17,18
14
11,12
10
15
19
16
20
21
Fig. 7-32
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 42
Grease name
Volume
Launa 40
White grease (Molykote EM-30L)
White grease (Molykote HP-300)
Alvania No.2
FLOIL (GE-334C)
Silicon oil
Container
Parts list
<P-I>*
100 cc
Oiler
101-21
100 g
Bottle
101-24
10 g
Bottle
101-22
100 g
Tube
101-23
20 g
Bottle
101-26
100 cc
Bottle
* : Part list <P-I> represents the page item in e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C Service Parts
List.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 43
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
7 - 44
8.
8.1
General Descriptions
This chapter explains the procedures for solving troubles occurring in the equipment.
When a trouble occurs, check if an error code is displayed on the LCD screen of the control panel first.
If displayed, refer to P. 8-3 "8.2 Error Code List" to figure out the classification and contents of the
error, and then refer to P. 8-35 "8.3 Diagnosis and Prescription for Each Error Code" to remove its
cause.
If not displayed and the equipment does not operate properly or images are not printed properly, refer
to P. 8-208 "8.4 Other errors" or P. 8-211 "8.5 Troubleshooting for the Image" to remove its
cause.
Note:
If unusual odor is detected or if smoke or fire comes out of the equipment, immediately turn the power
OFF.
Even in the cases other than the above, fully observe safety precautions.
If any PC board or HDD shall be replaced, refer to9.3Precautions for Installation of GP-1070 and
Disposal of HDD/SSD/Board.
8.1.1
If a problem continues even after performing all troubleshooting and technical tips, report the problem
to the appropriate Toshiba service center along with the following information. This information will help
the service center understand your problem and take quick action to find the solution.
1. Serial Number
2. List Print
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual / Service Handbook for the detailed procedure to obtain
a List Print.
A. Enter the value given below to obtain a List Print by CSV file.
9S-300: All CSV files
B. Enter the value given below to obtain a List Print by printing it out.
9S-101: 05 code
9S-102: 08 code
9S-104: Pixel counter data (Toner cartridge standard)
9S-106: Error history (1000 cases max)
9S-108: Firmware update log (200 cases max)
9S-110: Power on/off log (100 cases max)
3. For image-related problems, collect image samples with the problem areas and the feeding direction
marked first. Then provide information about the media type and weight, and the print data / spool
files for duplicating the problem.
4. For abnormal acoustic noise, describe the situation in as much detail as possible.
5. For hardware-related problems, provide photos of any broken parts, paper jams, etc.
In case of paper jams, include the type of paper and its manufacturer.
6. For software-related problems, provide list prints, TopAccess Logs and the detailed procedure
needed to duplicate the problem.
* This is the minimum information required to report a complaint. It would be appreciated if you could
obtain additional information.
* Follow the directions of the service center if they request additional information as each issue is
unique to some degree.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-1
8.1.2
[ 1 ] General description
The purpose of collecting the debug logs is to acquire the information for analyzing problems which
occurred during the MFP's operation. In such a case, you can collect the debug logs by inserting a USB
device into the MFP. Even if the power has to be turned OFF with the main power switch after a
problem occurs, the debug logs will be saved in the MFP (up to 3 logs). If the debug logs have already
been saved in the MFP, they also can be collected.
The following information is included in the USB debug logs.
Internal operation, Job history, HDD/memory usage status, etc. (Personal/Corporate information
(address book) not included)
When the debug logs are collected, also do so for the following information.
List print mode ([9] + [START]) [300: All CSV files]
Job logs below in TopAccess -> [Logs] -> [Export Logs]
- Print Job Log Export
- Fax Transmission Journal Export
- Fax Reception Journal Export
- Scan Log Export
- Messages Log Export
[ 2 ] Collection procedure
1. Note
When collecting a log, be sure to obtain consent from the user in advance and get the dedicated
script file from the service center.
2. About USB devices
Be sure to format the USB device with FAT16/32 beforehand. (Recommend size: 2GB or more)
3. Advance preparation of collection
Store the dedicated script file to the root directory of the USB device.
4. Procedure for collecting debug logs
1. Insert USB device, in which the dedicated script file is stored, into the MFP while the
power is ON.
2. The LED in the MFP starts blinking after the USB device has been inserted.
3. When the collection of the debug logs is finished, beeping is heard.
4. After the beeping has stopped, remove the USB device.
Notes:
Do not remove the USB device while the LED in the MFP is blinking.
If the LED does not start blinking after the USB device is inserted and a few minutes have
passed, try the procedure from step 1 again.
If there is no beeping after the LED starts blinking (about 20 minutes), try procedure from step
1 again.
If the USB device is inserted when the MFP is not ready, the debug logs cannot be collected.
5. Collected debug logs
- When the collection of the debug logs is completed, the compressed file of the collected logs is
stored in the root directory of the USB device.
File name: XXXX.YYYYMMDDHHmmSS
(XXXX= Serial number of the equipment, YYYY= year, MM= month, DD= day, HH= hour, mm=
minute, SS= second)
- After the debug logs have been collected, be sure to send them to the service center together
with a report.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-2
8.2.1
Error code
Jam
Classification
E010
E011
E013
E020
E030
E061
E062
E063
E064
E065
E090
E091
E0A0
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-35
P. 8-50
P. 8-51
P. 8-37
P. 8-53
8
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-54
P. 8-55
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-3
Error code
E110
Classification
Paper misfeeding
E120
E130
E140
E150
E160
E190
E200
E210
E220
E300
E310
E320
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-38
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-38
P. 8-39
P. 8-39
P. 8-40
P. 8-40
P. 8-41
P. 8-42
P. 8-42
P. 8-42
P. 8-42
P. 8-42
P. 8-43
8-4
Error code
Classification
Contents
Troubleshooting
E330
P. 8-42
E340
E350
E360
E3C0
E3D0
E3E0
E400
E410
E420
E430
E440
E450
E480
E490
P. 8-42
P. 8-43
P. 8-44
P. 8-42
8
P. 8-42
P. 8-43
P. 8-58
P. 8-58
P. 8-59
P. 8-59
P. 8-60
P. 8-60
P. 8-61
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-5
Error code
Classification
E510
Paper transport jam
(ADU section)
E520
E550
E551
E552
E712
RADF jam
E714
E721
E722
E724
E725
E726
E731
E860
E870
E871
Contents
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
P. 8-45
P. 8-47
P. 8-55
P. 8-56
P. 8-56
P. 8-62
P. 8-62
P. 8-63
P. 8-63
P. 8-64
P. 8-64
P. 8-65
P. 8-65
P. 8-66
P. 8-66
P. 8-66
8-6
Error code
Classification
E9F0
Finisher jam
(Puncher unit)
EA10
EA20
Finisher jam
(Finisher section)
EA10
EA20
EA25
EA2E
EA31
EA32
EA40
EA50
Finisher jam
(Finisher section)
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-75
P. 8-68
P. 8-68
P. 8-69
P. 8-69
P. 8-69
P. 8-70
P. 8-70
P. 8-71
P. 8-71
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-7
Error code
EAB0
Classification
Finisher jam
(Saddle Stitcher
section)
EAF3
ED15
EF14
EF1B
EF1C
EAD0
EAE0
EB30
EB50
EB60
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-72
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-72
P. 8-73
P. 8-73
P. 8-74
P. 8-73
P. 8-76
P. 8-76
P. 8-77
P. 8-47
P. 8-49
8-8
8.2.2
Service call
Error code
C020
C040
Classification
Contents
C150
C160
C180
C1A0
C1B0
C260
C270
C280
C290
Scanning system
related service call
Troubleshooting
P. 8-80
P. 8-80
P. 8-81
P. 8-81
P. 8-82
8
P. 8-83
P. 8-84
P. 8-85
P. 8-85
P. 8-86
P. 8-86
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8-9
Error code
C370
C380
Classification
Copy process
related service call
C381
C390
C391
C3A0
C3A1
C3B0
C3B1
C3E0
C3E1
C411
C412
C445
C446
C447
C449
C450
C451
C452
C4B0
C4C0
C4D0
C4F0
C4F1
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-142
P. 8-91
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-142
P. 8-143
P. 8-144
P. 8-145
P. 8-146
P. 8-147
P. 8-148
P. 8-149
P. 8-150
P. 8-152
P. 8-88
P. 8-88
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-89
P. 8-90
P. 8-90
P. 8-91
8 - 10
Error code
C550
Classification
Optional
communication
related service call
C560
C551
C580
CE00
C5A0
C5A1
C8E0
C900
Circuit related
service call
Optional
communication
related service call
Circuit related
service call
C911
C940
C962
C970
C9E0
CB01
CB30
CB31
CB40
CB50
CB51
Process related
service call
Circuit related
service call
Finisher related
service call
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-93
P. 8-93
P. 8-96
P. 8-93
P. 8-94
P. 8-97
P. 8-97
P. 8-96
P. 8-97
P. 8-99
P. 8-100
P. 8-100
P. 8-153
P. 8-100
P. 8-104
P. 8-105
P. 8-106
P. 8-107
P. 8-108
P. 8-109
P. 8-111
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 11
Error code
CB80
Classification
Finisher related
service call
CB84
CB90
CBC0
CBF0
CC02
CC21
CC22
CC23
CC51
CC53
CC54
CC60
CC61
CC71
CC80
CC91
CC92
CC93
CC94
Finisher related
service call
Contents
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
P. 8-112
P. 8-113
P. 8-114
P. 8-114
P. 8-115
P. 8-115
P. 8-116
P. 8-116
P. 8-117
P. 8-117
P. 8-118
P. 8-119
P. 8-119
P. 8-120
P. 8-120
P. 8-121
P. 8-122
P. 8-121
P. 8-121
P. 8-123
P. 8-123
P. 8-124
P. 8-124
P. 8-124
P. 8-121
8 - 12
Error code
CA00
CE10
Classification
Image control
related service call
LED head related
service call
CE20
CE40
CE41
CE50
CE70
CE80
CE90
Image control
related service call
F070
Communication
related service call
Circuit related
service call
F090
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-126
P. 8-133
P. 8-133
P. 8-136
P. 8-138
P. 8-140
P. 8-140
8
P. 8-102
P. 8-141
P. 8-94
P. 8-101
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 13
Error code
F100_0
Classification
F100_1
F100_2
F101_0
F101_1
F101_2
F101_3
F101
F102
F103
F104
F105
F106_0
F106_1
F106_2
F106_3
F106_4
F106_5
F109_0
F109_1
F109_2
Contents
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
P. 8-154
P. 8-154
P. 8-155
P. 8-156
P. 8-156
P. 8-156
P. 8-156
P. 8-156
P. 8-158
P. 8-158
P. 8-158
P. 8-158
P. 8-158
P. 8-159
P. 8-159
P. 8-160
P. 8-160
P. 8-160
P. 8-161
P. 8-161
P. 8-161
8 - 14
Error code
F109_3
Classification
F109_4
F109_5
F109_6
F120
F121
F122
F124
F130
F140
F200
F400
Circuit related
service call
F500
F350
F510
F520
F521
F550
F600
F700
F800
F900
F902_1
F902_3
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-162
P. 8-163
P. 8-164
P. 8-165
P. 8-167
P. 8-167
P. 8-168
P. 8-168
P. 8-169
P. 8-169
P. 8-169
P. 8-101
P. 8-170
P. 8-170
P. 8-170
P. 8-171
P. 8-171
P. 8-171
P. 8-171
P. 8-172
P. 8-172
P. 8-172
P. 8-173
P. 8-174
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 15
8.2.3
Classification
Troubleshooting
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-175
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 16
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
2500
2501
2503
2504
2550
2551
2552
2553
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-176
P. 8-177
P. 8-176
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 17
2B50
2B51
2B71
2B80
2B90
2BA0
2BA1
2BB0
2BB1
2BC0
2BD0
2BE0
2BF0
2BF1
2BF2
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-177
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
8 - 18
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
P. 8-178
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 19
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
2C20
2C21
2C22
2C30
2C10
2C11
2C12
2C13
2C14
2C15
2C31
2C32
2C33
2C40
2C43
2C44
2C45
2C60
2C61
2C62
2C63
2C64
2C65
2C66
2C69
2C6A
2C6B
2C6C
2C70
2C71
2C72
2CC0
2CC1
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
Encryption error
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-179
P. 8-180
P. 8-179
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
P. 8-180
8 - 20
2D63
2D64
2D65
2D66
2D67
2D68
2D69
2DA0
2DA1
2DA2
2DA3
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-180
Encryption error
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-180
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-181
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 21
Error code
2DA4
2DA5
2DA6
2DA7
2DC0
2DC1
2E10
2E11
2E12
2E13
2E14
2E15
2E30
2E31
2E32
2E33
2E40
2E43
2E44
2E45
2E65
2E66
2EC0
2EC1
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-180
P. 8-182
P. 8-183
P. 8-183
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-181
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-182
P. 8-183
P. 8-183
P. 8-183
P. 8-183
P. 8-183
8 - 22
3A80
3B10
3B20
3B40
3C10
3C13
3C20
3C30
3C40
3C50
3C60
3C70
3C90
3D10
3D20
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
Content-Type error
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-184
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 23
Error code
3D30
3E10
3E20
3E30
3E40
3F10
3F20
Message displayed in
the TopAccess screen
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
P. 8-185
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 24
8.2.4
Following codes are displayed at the end of the user name on the print job log screen.
Error code
4011
4021
4031
4041
4042
4045
4111
4112
4113
4121
4211
4212
4213
4214
4221
4231
4311
4312
4313
4314
4321
Contents
Print job cancellation - Print job (copy, list print, network print) is
deleted from the print job screen.
Print job power failure - The power of the equipment is turned OFF
during print job (copy, list print, network print).
HDD full during print - Large quantity image data by private print or
invalid network print are saved in HDD.
User authentication error: The user who intended to print a document
is not registered as a user.
Department authentication error? A department whose code is
specified for a print job is not registered.
Problem in LDAP server connection or LDAP server authorization
settings
Quota over error (The number of the assigned pages set by
department and user management has reached 0.): The numbers of
output pages have exceeded those specified with both of the
department code and the user code at the same time.
Quota over error (The number of the assigned pages set by user
management has reached 0.): The number of output pages has
exceeded the one specified with the user code.
Quota over error (The number of the assigned pages set by
department management has reached 0.): The number of output
pages has exceeded the one specified with the department code.
Job canceling due to external counter error
Printing data storing limitation error: Printing with its data being
stored to the HDD temporarily (Proof print, Private print, Scheduled
print, etc.) cannot be performed.
e-Filing storing limitation error: Printing with its data being stored to
the HDD (print and e-Filing, print to e-Filing, etc.) cannot be
performed.
File storing limitation error: The file storing function is set to
"disabled".
Fax/Internet Fax transmission limitation error: Fax / Internet Fax
transmission function or Network Fax/Internet Fax function is
disabled.
Private-print-only error: Jobs other than Private print jobs cannot be
performed.
Hardcopy security printing error: hardcopy security printing job is
performed when the function is restricted.
Not being authorized to perform JOB
Not authorized to store a file
No privilege for e-Filing storage: No privilege to store e-Filing data is
given. (e-Filing storage permission)
No privilege for Fax / Internet Fax transmission: No privilege to send
Fax or Internet Fax jobs is given. (Fax / Internet Fax transmission
permission)
No privilege for print settings: No privilege to print with the specified
settings is given. (Print setting permission)
Troubleshooting
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-186
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 25
Error code
4411
4412
4611
4612
4613
4621
4F10
Contents
Image data creation failure: Data that you tried to print may be
corrupted.
Network print: Data are corrupted or invalid.
Direct print: A file is corrupted or not in a supported format.
Printing was attempted in which print data have not been
supported by PCL6 printer driver. [LL20ppm/LL25ppm]
Double-sign encoding error: A double-sign encoding error occurred
because the PDF file is encrypted in a forbidden language or in a
language not supported.
Font download failure (exceeding maximum number of registrations):
A new font cannot be registered because the number of fonts
registered in this equipment has reached the limit.
Font download failure (HDD full): A new font cannot be registered
because there is not sufficient space in the font storage area of this
equipment.
Font download failure (others): A new font cannot be registered due
to other abnormality.
Font deletion failure: A font cannot be deleted because the specified
font does not exist, the specified font is undeletable or any other
abnormality occurred.
Printing was not performed successfully due to other abnormalities.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
P. 8-187
8 - 26
8.2.5
Error code
5010
5012
5013
5014
5015
5016
5017
5018
5019
501A
501B
5110
5212
5BD0
5C10
5C11
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-188
P. 8-188
P. 8-188
8
P. 8-188
P. 8-189
P. 8-189
P. 8-189
P. 8-189
P. 8-189
P. 8-189
P. 8-190
P. 8-190
P. 8-190
P. 8-191
P. 8-191
P. 8-191
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 27
8.2.6
Error code
6007
6008
6032
Illegal period.
6033
No entering record.
6034
6041
6042
6121
6131
SecureErase fails
SNTP server synchronization
failure
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-192
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-192
P. 8-192
P. 8-192
P. 8-192
P. 8-193
P. 8-193
P. 8-193
P. 8-193
8 - 28
8.2.7
Maintenance error
Error code
7101
7103
7105
7109
710B
710F
7111
7113
7115
7117
711D
711F
71A4
71AA
71AB
71AC
71B0
71B5
71B7
71B9
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-195
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-194
P. 8-195
P. 8-195
P. 8-195
P. 8-196
P. 8-196
P. 8-196
P. 8-196
P. 8-197
P. 8-197
P. 8-197
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 29
8.2.8
Network error
Error code
8000
8011
8012
8013
8014
8022
8023
8024
8031
8032
8034
8035
8036
8037
Certificate unavailable
8038
8039
No ISAKMP SA established
Invalid Signature
803A
803B
803D
803E
803F
8040
8041
CA not trusted
8033
803C
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-198
P. 8-198
P. 8-198
P. 8-198
P. 8-198
P. 8-198
P. 8-199
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-199
P. 8-199
P. 8-199
P. 8-199
P. 8-200
P. 8-200
P. 8-200
P. 8-200
P. 8-200
P. 8-201
P. 8-201
P. 8-201
P. 8-201
P. 8-201
P. 8-202
P. 8-202
P. 8-202
P. 8-202
8 - 30
Error code
8042
8043
8044
8045
8046
8047
8048
8049
804A
804B
8061
8062
8063
8064
8065
8066
8067
8068
8069
8101
8102
8103
8121
8122
8123
8124
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-202
P. 8-203
P. 8-203
P. 8-203
P. 8-203
P. 8-203
P. 8-203
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-204
P. 8-205
P. 8-205
P. 8-205
P. 8-205
P. 8-205
P. 8-206
P. 8-206
P. 8-206
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 31
Error code
8125
8126
8127
8128
8129
812A
812B
Contents
Troubleshooting
P. 8-206
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
P. 8-206
P. 8-207
P. 8-207
P. 8-207
P. 8-207
P. 8-207
8 - 32
8.2.9
Error history
In the setting mode (08-9703), the latest twenty groups of error data will be displayed.
Display example
EA10
99999999
Error code Total counter
4 digits
8 digits
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
MMM
NNN
O
06 04 14 17 57 32
YY MM DD HH MM SS
12 digits (Year is indicated
with its last two digits.)
064
MMM
3 digits
064
NNN
3 digits
Paper source
0: Not selected 1: Bypass feed 2: LCF 3: 1st drawer 4: 2nd drawer 5: PFP upper drawer
6: PFP lower drawer 7: Unused 8: Unused
Paper size code
0: A5/ST 1: A5-R 2: ST-R 3: LT, 4: A4 5: B5-R 6: LT-R 7: A4-R 8: OTHER/UNIV 9: B5,
A: FOLIO/COMP B: LG C: B4 D: LD E: A3 F: 13"LG G: Unused H: A6-R I: Post card J:
8.5"SQ
K: A3-wide L: LD wide M: 8K N: 16K-R O: 16K P: Unused Q: Unused R: Unused S: Unused
T: Unused U: SRA3(320x450) V: SRA3(320x460) Z: Not selected
Sort mode/staple mode
0: Non-sort/Non-staple 1: Group 2: Sort 7: Front staple
8: Double staple 9: Rear staple A: Saddle stitch
ADF mode
0: Unused 1: AUTO FEED (SADF) 2: STACK FEED
APS/AMS mode
0: Not selected 1: APS 2: AMS
Duplex mode
0: Not selected 1: Book 2: Double-sided/Single-sided 4: Double-sided/Duplex copying
8: Single-sided/Duplex copying
Unused
Image shift
0: Unused 1: Book 2: Left 3: Right 4: Top 5: Bottom 6: Book+Top 7: Book+Bottom 8:
Left+Top
9: Left+Bottom A: Right+Top B: Right+Bottom
Editing
0: Unused 1: Masking 2: Trimming 3: Mirror image 4: Unused 5: NEG/POS
Edge erase/Dual-page
0: Unused 1: Edge erase 2: Dual-page 3: Edge erase & Dual-page
Unused
Function
0: Unused 1: Copying 2: FAX/Internet FAX transmission 3: FAX/Internet FAX/E-mail
reception printing
4: Unused 5: Printing/List print 6: Scan/E-mail transmission
Primary scanning reproduction ratio (Display in hexadecimal)
(Mx256)+(Mx16)+M
Secondary scanning reproduction ratio (Display in hexadecimal)
(Nx256)+(Nx16)+N
Color mode
0: Auto color 1: Full color 2: Black 3: Unused 4: Twin color copy 5: Gray scale
6: Unused 7: Image smoothing
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 33
Media type
0: Plain paper 1: Thick 1 2: Thick 2 3: Thick 3 4: Thick 4 5: Special paper 1 6: Special
paper 2
7: Recycled paper 8: Plain paper 1 9: Plain paper 2 A: Thin paper B: OHP film C: Thick 1/
reverse D: Thick 2/ reverse E: Thick 3/ reverse F: Thick 4/ reverse G: Special paper 1/
reverse
H: Special paper 2/ reverse I: Envelope J: Tab paper Z: Unused
RADF size mixed
0: Unused 1: Single-size document 2: Size mixed
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 34
8.3
8.3.1
Sensor check
Connector check
Harness check
Motor check
Board check
8.3.2
Contents
Error content
Transfer belt
unit
Fuser unit
Fuser unit
Drawer
Leading edge
margin
Measures
Fuser unit
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 35
Check item
Fuser unit
Transfer belt
Paper folded in one side and
fused during duplex printing
All
Exit sensor
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 36
Error content
Measures
Fuser unit
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 37
8.3.3
Paper misfeeding
Error content
Check item
Registration
guide
Registration
sensor
CFD board
LGC board
ADU
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Registration sensor
CFD board
LGC board
Rollers in the ADU
Remark
[E120] Bypass misfeeding (paper not reaching the bypass feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
Check item
Feed sensor
CFD board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
8 - 38
Parts to be replaced
LGC board
Bypass feed roller
Bypass separation pad
Remark
[E130] 1st drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the 1st drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
Check item
CFD board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Feed sensor
CFD board
LGC board
1st drawer feed roller
1st drawer separation pad
1st drawer pickup roller
Remark
[E140] 2nd drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the 2nd drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
2nd drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the 2nd drawer feed
sensor)
Check item
PFC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 39
Parts to be replaced
Remark
[E150] PFP upper drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP upper drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
PFP upper drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP upper
drawer feed sensor)
Check item
Measures
PFC board
PFP board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
[E160] PFP lower drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP lower drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
PFP lower drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP lower
drawer feed sensor)
Check item
PFC board
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 40
Check item
PFP board
Measures
Board check
Connector check (J959, CN241, CN246, CN247)
Harness check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
[E190] LCF misfeeding (paper not reaching the LCF feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
Check item
PFC board
LGC board
PFP board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 41
8.3.4
[E200] 1st drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
[E210] 2nd drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
[E300] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
[E330] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
[E3C0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
Classification
Error content
Check item
Registration sensor
CFD board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Registration sensor
Lower transport clutch
CFD board
LGC board
Feed roller
Separation roller, Separation
pad
Pickup roller
Transport roller
Remark
[E220] 2nd drawer transport jam (not reaching the feed sensor)
[E310] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the feed sensor)
[E340] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the feed sensor)
[E3D0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 42
Check item
Measures
Feed sensor
speed)
CFD board
LGC board
PFC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
[E320] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed sensor)
[E350] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed sensor)
[E3E0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed
sensor)
PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed
sensor)
LCF transport jam (not reaching the 2nd drawer feed sensor)
Check item
PFC board
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 43
Check item
LGC board
Measures
Board check
Connector check (CN312)
Harness check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
[E360] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the PFP upper drawer feed sensor)
Classification
Error content
PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the PFP upper
drawer feed sensor)
Check item
Measures
PFC board
LGC board
PFP board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 44
Error content
[20ppm/25ppm]
Phenomenon of paper jamming
Check item
ADU
Drawer
Fuser Unit
Exit unit
Stop in the fuser unit /
scratches on the leading edge
of paper
All
Fuser Unit
Measures
ADU entrance
sensor
Exit motor
ADU motor
LGC board
ADU board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 45
[LL20ppm/LL25ppm]
Phenomenon of paper jamming
Check item
ADU
Drawer
Fuser Unit
Stop in the fuser unit /
scratches on the leading edge
of paper
All
Fuser Unit
Measures
ADU entrance
sensor
Exit motor
ADU motor
EXT board
LGC board
ADU board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 46
Error content
Check item
LGC board
ADU board
ADU motor
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Error content
When the paper is fed from any of the 1st drawer, bypass feed unit or ADU:
(When the paper is fed from the 1st drawer:)
Check item
Feed sensor
CFD board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Feed sensor
CFD board
LGC board
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 47
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Feed sensor
CFD board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
ADU board
Registration sensor
CFD board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 48
When the paper is fed from any of the PFU, PFP or LCF:
Check item
PFC board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Error content
Registration sensor
CFD board
PFC board
Drive unit, Rollers
Measures
Sensor check
(Perform the input check: 03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[A])
Connector check (CN404)
Harness check
Board check
Connector check (CN404, CN408)
Harness check
Connector check (CN334)
Board check
Gear check
Roller check
Parts to be replaced
Registration sensor
CFD board
PFC board
Rollers
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 49
8.3.5
[E011] Paper jam caused by clinging to the transfer belt (Paper not reached the paper clinging
detection sensor)
Classification
Error content
Check item
Transfer belt
unit
Drawer
Drawer
Process unit
Paper
clinging
detection
sensor
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 50
All
Check item
CFD board
Measures
Board check
Connector check (CN406, CN408)
Harness check
LGC board
Board check
Connector check (CN334)
Harness check
Sensor check (Perform the input check: 03Paper
[ALL]OFF/[9]/[E])
clinging
Connector check (J746, J645, CN405)
detection
Harness check
sensor
Check of the Check that the 2nd transfer roller shaft is securely
grounded via the frame.
2nd transfer
Check if the leaf spring is deformed.
roller
Check if the shaft tip and the leaf spring contact
connection
properly.
Change of the If the leading edge of paper clings to the 2nd
2nd transfer
transfer roller and causes paper jamming, change
bias
the 2nd transfer roller bias correction factor of the
leading/trailing edge of the paper. (The larger the
value, the smaller the transfer voltage of the
leading/trailing edge of the paper.)
Codes to be changed (Initial value of the
transfer bias of the leading edge of the paper: 0)
Color mode print (top side): 05-2938-*
Color mode print (back side): 05-2939-*
Black mode print (top side): 05-2940-*
Black mode print (back side): 05-2941-*
Sub codes:* -> Plain paper: 0, Recycled
paper: 7
Notes:
After these codes are changed, perform
solid duplex-printing and check that there is
no faint or void image on the leading/trailing
edge of the paper.
Parts to be replaced
Process unit
Registration motor
CFD board
LGC board
Paper clinging detection
sensor
Registration roller
Remark
[E013] Jam not reaching transport sensor after paper alignment at the registration roller
Classification
Error content
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 51
Check item
Drawer
Drive unit,
Rollers
Developer
unit
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Rollers
Developer unit
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 52
Error content
Power-ON jam
Check item
Measures
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Cover
Exit area
ADU
Fuser cover
ADU
PFU
LCF
PFP
Side cover
LCF side cover
PFP side cover
Bridge unit
Bridge unit
Finisher
Finisher door
Sensor
Registration sensor
Paper clinging detection
sensor
Registration pass sensor
Feed sensor
Exit sensor
ADU entrance sensor
ADU exit sensor
2nd drawer feed sensor
LCF feed sensor
PFP upper drawer feed sensor
PFP lower drawer feed sensor
Bridge unit transport sensor-1
(Entrance sensor)
Bridge unit transport sensor-2
(Exit sensor)
Sensors in the finisher
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[E]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[F]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[B]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[C]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[G]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[H]
03-[FAX]ON/[1]/[F]
03-[COPY]ON/[9]/[F]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[D]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[B]
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 53
Error item
Check item
Other
Measures
SYS board
LGC board
HDD
Page memory
Replace parts
Remarks
SYS board
LGC board
HDD
Page memory
Error item
Check item
Other
Power
SYS board
LGC board
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 54
Check item
HDD
Measures
Connector check
HDD check
Replace parts
Remarks
SYS board
LGC board
HDD
[E0A0]Image transport ready time-out jam
Classification
Error content
Check item
LGC board
Measures
Connector check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
8
[E550] Paper remaining jam on the transport path
Classification
Step
Error content
Check Item
Result
LGC board
4
Next
Step
Measure
Notes:
If the jam is occurring in the ADU, PFC, PFU, CFD, LCF or PFP, check the
board in each unit.
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 55
Cover
Sensor
Exit area
ADU
Fuser cover
ADU
PFU
LCF
PFP
Side cover
LCF side cover
PFP side cover
Bridge unit
Bridge unit
Finisher
Finisher door
Registration sensor
Paper clinging detection
sensor
Registration pass sensor
Feed sensor
Exit sensor
ADU entrance sensor
ADU exit sensor
2nd drawer feed sensor
LCF feed sensor
PFP upper drawer feed sensor
PFP lower drawer feed sensor
Bridge unit transport sensor-1
(Entrance sensor)
Bridge unit transport sensor-2
(Exit sensor)
Sensors in the finisher
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[E]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[F]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[B]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[C]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[G]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[H]
03-[FAX]ON/[1]/[F]
03-[COPY]ON/[9]/[F]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[D]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[B]
-
[E551] Paper remaining jam on the transport path (when a service call occurs)
[E552] Paper remaining jam on the transport path (when the cover is closed)
Classification
Step
Error content
Check Item
Result
Next
Step
LGC board
3
Measure
Notes:
If the jam is occurring in the ADU, PFC, PFU, CFD, LCF or PFP, check the
board in each unit.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 56
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Cover
Exit area
ADU
Fuser cover
ADU
PFU
LCF
PFP
Side cover
LCF side cover
PFP side cover
Bridge unit
Bridge unit
Finisher
Finisher door
Sensor
Registration sensor
Paper clinging detection
sensor
Registration pass sensor
Feed sensor
Exit sensor
ADU entrance sensor
ADU exit sensor
2nd drawer feed sensor
LCF feed sensor
PFP upper drawer feed sensor
PFP lower drawer feed sensor
Bridge unit transport sensor-1
(Entrance sensor)
Bridge unit transport sensor-2
(Exit sensor)
Sensors in the finisher
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[E]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[F]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[B]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[C]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[G]
03-[ALL]OFF/[9]/[H]
03-[FAX]ON/[1]/[F]
03-[COPY]ON/[9]/[F]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C]
03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[D]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[A]
03-[ALL]OFF/[0]/[B]
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 57
8.3.6
Error content
Check item
Switching regulator
LGC board
Measures
Is the voltage of 24V being supplied from the power supply unit?
(Perform the input check: 03-[ALL]OFF[7]/[D])
Connector check (CN512, CN530, CN531)
Fuse check (F201, F202, F203)
Board check
Connector check (CN321, CN322, CN323)
Harness check
Switch check (Perform the input check: 03-[ALL]OFF/[7]/[A])
Connector check (CN338)
Harness check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Switching regulator
LGC board
Transfer cover switch
Error content
Check item
Measures
Switching regulator
LGC board
Is the voltage of 24V being supplied from the power supply unit?
(Perform the input check: 03-[ALL]OFF[7]/[D])
Connector check (CN323)
Fuse check (F201, F202, F203)
Board check
Connector check (CN319, CN323)
Harness check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Switching regulator
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 58
Error content
Check item
PFP board
PFC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Error content
Check item
Measures
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 59
Error content
Check item
Measures
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Error content
Check item
LCF board
PFC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 60
Error content
Check item
Measures
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 61
8.3.7
RADF jam
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Pickup roller
Feed roller
Separation roller
Original registration sensor
RADF board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Empty sensor
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Empty sensor
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 62
RADF jam
Phenomenon of paper jamming
All
Error content
Registration
sensor
Read roller
Read sensor
RADF board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
8
Replace it if it is worn out.
Replace it if it is worn out.
[E722] Jam not reaching the original exit/reverse sensor (during scanning)
Classification
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Read roller
Original exit/reverse sensor
RADF board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 63
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Registration roller
Registration sensor
RADF board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Registration sensor
RADF board
Registration roller
Remark
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Read roller
Read sensor
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Read sensor
RADF board
Read roller
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 64
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
RADF board
SLG board
Measures
Board check
Connector check
Harness check
Board check
Connector check
Harness check
Check if the 24V and 5V outputs of the switching power supply
are normal.
Board check
Connector check
Harness check
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF board
SLG board
Switching power supply
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Exit roller
Stop jam at the original exit/
reverse sensor
RADF board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Exit sensor
RADF board
Exit roller
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 65
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF jam
Error content
Check item
Measures
RADF board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF jam
Error item
RADF
Original jam access cover opening/
closing sensor
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 66
Check item
RADF board
Measures
Replace parts
Remarks
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 67
8.3.8
[EA10, EA20] 1st transport motor (M8) fault/ 2nd transport motor (M4) fault
Classification
Finisher jam
(Finisher section)
Error content
MJ-1036
Probable cause
[EA10, EA20] Transport motor-1 (M1) fault/ Transport motor-2 (M2) fault
Classification
Finisher jam
(Finisher section)
Error content
MJ-1037
Probable cause
Measure the voltage of the TP30 on the finisher control PC board (FIN),
and check that the measured voltage is 1V or lower when not shielded and
within the range of 3.3V 5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall
within the above range, replace the sensor.
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor and the connector,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 68
Error content
Paper transport jam in the Finisher
MJ-1036
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensor and connectors,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Error content
Paper transport remaining jam in the Finisher
MJ-1036
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Measure the voltage on TP85 on the finisher control PC board
(FIN). Then check that the measured voltage is 1V or lower when
not shielded and within the range of 3.3V
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Check if the electrical continuity between the connector terminals is
normal. If electricity is not conducted, replace the connector.
(Finisher control PC board (FIN): CN6, CN22)
If the error still occurs after replacing the sensor and the connector,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 69
Error content
Paper transport remaining jam in the Finisher:
MJ-1037
Probable cause
Measure the voltage on TP1 on the finisher control PC board (FIN). Then
check that the measured voltage is 1V or lower when not shielded and
within the range of 3.3V5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall
within the range mentioned, replace the sensor.
If the error still occurs after replacing the sensor and the connector,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Error content
MJ-1036
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the sensor and the
connector, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
MJ-1037
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the sensor and the connector,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 70
Error content
MJ-1036
Probable cause
Sub-path opening/closing
sensor (S12) abnormality
If the error still occurs after replacing the switches, sensor and connector,
exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Error content
Stapling jam
MJ-1036
Probable cause
Staple unit stapling start position
sensor (S17) abnormality
5% when OFF. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the staple unit.
Staple unit staple empty sensor
(S18) abnormality
5% when OFF. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the staple unit.
Faulty cables and connectors
Finisher control PC board (FIN)
abnormality
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 71
8.3.9
Finisher jam
(Saddle stitcher section)
Error item
MJ-1037
Probable cause
Error content
Gripper arm motor home position detection error
MJ-1037
Error
Gripper motor
Gripper arm home position sensor
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the gripper arm home position sensor (S13) is not
detected in the specified time when the gripper arm is exited.
The turning ON of the gripper arm home position sensor (S13) is not
detected in the specified time when the gripper arm is returned to its
home position.
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 72
Error content
Finisher jam
MJ-1037
Error
Transport motor-2
Paddle home position sensor
Timing of detection
The paddle home position sensor (S34) does not change from "ON"
to "OFF" within the pre-specified time during paddle rotation.
The paddle home position sensor (S34) does not change from
"OFF" to "ON" within the pre-specified time during paddle rotation.
Error content
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 73
Finisher jam
(Finisher section)
Error content
MJ-1037
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 74
8.3.10
Finisher jam
(Puncher unit)
Error content
Punching jam
Timing of detection
Punch motor
Punch shaft home position sensor
Punch shaft rotational direction
sensor
The turning OFF of the punch shaft home position sensor (S35)
is not detected in the specified time when the punch motor
(M15) is rotated.
The turning ON of the punch shaft home position sensor (S35)
is not detected in the specified time when the punch motor
(M15) is rotated.
The punch shaft home position sensor (S35) and the punch
shaft rotational direction sensor (S34) do not specify the home
position or the rotational direction correspondingly during
initialization, or initialization is not finished at a turning-ON point
for the punch shaft home position sensor (S35).
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 75
8.3.11
Error content
Check item
Power
SYS board
LGC board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
SYS board
LGC board
Error content
MJ-1031
Check item
Finisher
PFC board
Measures
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
PFC board
Harness
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 76
Error content
Check item
Finisher
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
PFC board
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 77
8.3.12
Error content
Check item
Developer unit
Measures
LGC board
Registration roller
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Developer unit
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 78
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 79
8.3.13
Error content
Check item
Result
Yes
No
Measure
Yes
No
PFP board
Next
Step
Parts to be replaced
Remark
PFP motor
PFP board
PFC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 80
Error content
Proce
dure
Result
Check item
Yes
No
Measure
Yes
No
PFC board
8
3
Next
Step
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Tray-up motor
PFP board
PFC board
Tray-up sensor
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 81
Check item
Error content
Result
Yes
No
Measure
Yes
No
PFC board
Next
Step
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 82
Error content
Check item
Result
Yes
No
Measure
Yes
No
PFC board
Next
Step
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 83
Check item
Error content
The LCF transport motor is not rotating normally (when paper can
be fed from any drawer except the LCF).
Result
Measure
Next
Step
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 84
8.3.14
Check item
Exposure lamp
Error content
Result
Measure
Yes
No
Next
Step
2
3
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Lens unit
Exposure lamp
[C270] Carriage home position sensor not going OFF within a specified time / Downloading
firmware with an incorrect model
Classification
Error content
Remove the original glass and move the carriages to the exit side. Turn ON the power and check the
following items.
Proce
dure
1
Check item
Result
Yes
Measure
Next
Step
No
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 85
Parts to be replaced
Remark
CCD board
[C280] Carriage home position sensor not going ON within a specified time
Classification
Error content
Remove the original glass and move the carriages to the exit side. Turn ON the power and check the
following items.
Proce
dure
1
Check item
Result
Measure
Yes
No
Next
Step
2
3
The carriage home position sensor is not
turned ON.
Check if the connector of the sensor is
disconnected.
Check if the circuits of the CCD board are
abnormal.
The carriages are stopped at the home position
and do not move.
Check if the connector pins are
disconnected or the harnesses are short
circuited or open circuited.
Check if the conductor pattern on the CCD
board is short circuited or open circuited.
CCD board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Check item
CCD board
Error content
The scanning system does not operate due to a blowout of the fuse
in the scanning system.
Result
Measure
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 86
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 87
8.3.15
Notes:
Be sure to turn OFF the power and unplug the power cable beforehand when checking the
power supply unit and fuser unit.
The fuser unit itself or the part of the unit remains heated and the capacitors are still charged
after a while the power cable is unplugged. So make sure the unit is cooled down enough
before checking.
[C411/C412] Thermistor / heater lamp abnormality at power-ON
Classification
Error content
Check item
Power voltage
Thermistor
LGC board
Status counter
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 88
Error content
Check item
Measures
Error content
Check item
Measure
LGC board
Status counter
1.
2.
3.
4.
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 89
Error content
Check item
Measure
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Fuser unit.
PC board
Error content
Check item
Thermistor
LGC board
Measure
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Thermistor
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 90
Error content
Check item
Thermistor
Measure
LGC board
Check the gap between the center thermistor and the fuser
roller.
P. 6-85 "6.12.1 Adjustment of the non-contact thermistor
Gap"
Check that the front thermistor is installed properly.
Connector check (J627)
Check if the harnesses of the center, side and front
thermistor are open circuited.
Connector check (CN301, CN323)
Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is open
circuited or short circuited.
Is the fuser unit installed correctly?
Check if the heater lamp is broken.
Check if the terminal of the heater lamp is attached securely.
Check if the center and side thermostat are blown
Check if the drawer connector is damaged or its connection
is detected.
Check if the connectors of the power supply unit are
disconnected (CN504m, CN506).
Check if the power supply unit is abnormal.
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Center thermistor
front thermistor
LGC board
Heater lamp
Power supply unit
Error content
Check item
Thermistor
Measure
LGC board
Check the gap between the side thermistor and the fuser
roller.
P. 6-85 "6.12.1 Adjustment of the non-contact thermistor
Gap"
Check that the front thermistor is installed properly.
Connector check
Check if the harnesses of the center, side and front
thermistor are open circuited.
Connector check (CN301)
Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is open
circuited or short circuited.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 91
Check item
Measure
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Side thermistor
front thermistor
LGC board
Heater lamp
Power supply unit
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 92
8.3.16
Error content
RADF board
Measure
SYS board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF board
SYS board
[C560] Communication error between Engine-CPU and PFC board
Classification
Error item
Harness
Measures
LGC board
PFC board
Connector check
Harness check
Connector check (CN312)
Board check
Connector check (CN910, CN911)
Board check
Replace parts
Remarks
LGC board
PFC board
[C580] Communication error between PFC board and finisher
Classification
Error content
Communication related service call Communication error between PFC board and finisher
Check item
Finisher
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 93
Timing of detection
No response is received in a control line from the Hole Punch
Unit in the specified time during communication determination
using control lines at power-ON.
Three consecutive transmission retries failed after a data
reception error was detected.
No response is received in a control line in the specified time
after data transmission from the Finisher.
No response is returned to a command from the Finisher after
the specified time has passed.
Probable cause
Error content
Communication related service call Communication error between System-CPU and Engine-CPU
Check item
Measure
HRNS-LGC-DRM-210
HRNS-CFD-TRU-210
HRNS-LGC-ADUCFD-210
HRNS-LGC-DEV-210
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
SYS board
LED head
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 94
Parts to be replaced
Remark
HRNS-LGC-DRM-210
HRNS-CFD-TRU-210
HRNS-LGC-ADUCFD-210
HRNS-LGC-DEV-210
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 95
8.3.17
Error content
Check item
RADF
Measure
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF
Error content
Check item
Power
RADF board
Measure
Parts to be replaced
Remark
RADF board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 96
8.3.18
Contents
Check item
EEPROM
LGC board
Measure
EEPROM check
IC socket check (IC45)
Board check
Replacement part
Measure
EEPROM
LGC board
Contents
Check item
EEPROM
LGC board
Measure
EEPROM check
IC socket check (IC45)
Board check
Replacement part
Measure
EEPROM
LGC board
[C900] Connection error between the SYS board and the LGC board
Classification
Contents
Check item
LGC board
SYS board
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
LGC board
SYS board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 97
Contents
Proce
dure
Result
3
4
5
6
7
Check item
Yes
No
Measure
Next
Step
2
2
Yes
No
Notes:
The spring of the contact point may be released if you push the toner
cartridge all the way in when an abnormality occurs.
LGC board
Connector check (CN324)
Board check
HRNS-LGC-TNRIC-210
Connector check (CN324, CN440)
Harness check
CTIF board for each color
Check that the board is installed properly.
(Y, M, C and K)
Board check
Replacement part
Measure
Toner cartridge
LGC board
HRNS-LGC-TNRIC-210
CTIF board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 98
Proce
dure
3
4
5
6
7
Check item
Contents
Result
Yes
No
Measure
Next
Step
2
2
Yes
No
Notes:
The spring of the contact point may be released if you push the toner
cartridge all the way in when an abnormality occurs.
LGC board
Connector check (CN324)
Board check
HRNS-LGC-TNRIC-210
Connector check (CN324, CN440)
Harness check
CTIF board for each color
Check that the board is installed properly.
(Y, M, C and K)
Board check
Replacement part
Measure
Toner cartridge
LGC board
HRNS-LGC-TNRIC-210
CTIF board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 99
Contents
Engine-CPU abnormality
Check item
LGC board
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
LGC board
[C962] LGC board ID abnormality
Classification
Contents
Check item
LGC board
Measure
SYS board
Replacement part
Measure
LGC board
SYS board
[C9E0] Connection error between the CCD board and the SYS board
Classification
Contents
Check item
CCD board
SYS board
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
CCD board
SYS board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 100
Contents
Check item
SRAM
Measure
SYS board
Replacement part
Measure
Contents
Check item
CCD board
Combination of the firmware
version
Measure
Board check
Check the combination of the firmware version of the system
firmware, engine firmware, and scanner firmware.
Reinstall the scanner firmware.
Replacement part
Measure
CCD board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 101
8.3.19
Step
Contents
Check Item
Result
Measure
Yes
No
Next
Step
2
4
2
3
5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 102
Step
Check Item
Result
Yes
No
Measure
Next
Step
4
5
Repair it.
Repair it.
Replacement part
Measure
LGC board
Harness (FFC)
Harness (power supply)
LED head
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 103
8.3.20
Error content
Check item
Measure
Finisher
PFC board
LGC board
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Timing of detection
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 104
[CB30] Movable tray shift motor (M1) abnormality, Movable tray paper top detection error
MJ-1036
Classification
Contents
Error
Movable tray shift motor (M1)
Stack top detection solenoid (SOL1)
Stack top detection sensor-1 (S1)
Stack top detection sensor-2 (S2
Movable tray lower limit sensor (S14)
Timing of detection
A locking signal is detected after the specified time *while the movable
tray is moving.
* A locking signal is not monitored from the start driving the motor until
the specified time has passed.
The stack top position of paper is not detected after the movable tray
shift motor (M1) is driven in the specified time when the movable tray is
moved up.
The lower limit position of the stack top of paper is not detected after
the movable tray shift motor (M1) has been driven in the specified time
during the initial movement of the movable tray.
The turning OFF of the movable tray lower limit sensor (S14) is not
detected when the movable tray is moved from a point where this
sensor is turned ON to one point where this sensor is turned OFF after
the movable tray shift motor (M1) has been driven in the specified time.
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Stack top detection sensor-2 (S2)
abnormality
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 105
Probable cause
Finisher control PC board (FIN)
abnormality
Contents
Error
Movable tray shift motor
Movable tray shift motor clock sensor
Timing of detection
The status of the movable tray shift motor clock sensor (S15) is not
changed for the specified time when the movable tray shift motor (M5)
is driven.
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 106
Contents
Error
Movable tray shift motor
Stack top holding/detecting sensor
Paper holding home position sensor
Timing of detection
The stack top holding/detecting sensor (S11) and the paper holding
home position sensor (S12) do not detect the position of the top of the
stack of paper in the specified time when the paper holding lever is
moved to the paper detection position.
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Stack top holding/detecting sensor
(S11) abnormality
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
If the error still occurs after replacing the solenoid, sensors and
connector, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 107
Contents
Error
Rear alignment motor (M3)
Rear alignment plate home position
sensor (S6)
Timing of detection
Probable cause
Contents
Error
Rear alignment motor
Rear aligning plate home position
sensor
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the rear alignment plate home position sensor
(S10) is not detected in the specified time when the rear alignment
plate is moved from a point where this sensor is turned ON to one point
where this sensor is turned OFF.
The turning ON of the rear alignment plate home position sensor (S10)
is not detected in the specified time when the rear alignment plate is
moved from a point where this sensor is turned OFF to one point
where this sensor is turned ON.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 108
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensor and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN)
Contents
Timing of detection
The staple unit clinching home position sensor (S16) does not
detect the opening of the staple unit after the stapler motor (M9)
has been driven reversely in the specified time from the closing
during the initial movement of the staple unit.
The staple unit clinching home position sensor (S16) does not
detect the opening of the staple unit in the specified time from
the closing during the clinching movement of the staple unit,
and also this sensor does not detect the opening by the reverse
rotation of the motor after the stapler is stopped.
The staple unit clinching home position sensor (S16) does not
detect the closing of the staple unit after the specified time
during the clinching movement of the staple unit.
The staple unit clinching home position sensor (S16) does not
detect the opening of the staple unit at the start of the clinching.
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 109
Probable cause
Timing of detection
Probable cause
5% when OFF. If the voltage does not fall within the range mentioned,
replace the staple unit.
Edge staple unit improper clinching
prevention sensor (S25) abnormality
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 110
Probable cause
10% when OFF. If the voltage does not fall within the range mentioned,
replace the switch. (Be sure that all covers and doors are closed
before starting measurement.)
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensors, switch and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Contents
Stapler shift home position error: The stapler is not at the home
position.
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the staple unit sliding home position sensor (S3) is
not detected when the staple unit is moved from a point where this
sensor is turned ON to one point where this sensor is turned OFF after
the staple unit sliding motor (M7) has been driven at the specified
number of pulse.
The turning ON of the staple unit sliding home position sensor (S3) is
not detected when the staple unit is moved from a point where this
sensor is turned OFF to one point where this sensor is turned ON after
the staple unit sliding motor (M7) has been driven at the specified
number of pulse.
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the staple unit, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 111
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the edge staple unit sliding home position sensor
(S14) is not detected in the specified time when the edge staple unit is
moved from a point where this sensor is turned ON to one point where
this sensor is turned OFF.
The turning ON of the edge staple unit sliding home position sensor
(S14) is not detected in the specified time when the edge staple unit is
moved from a point where this sensor is turned OFF to one point
where this sensor is turned ON.
Probable cause
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Saddle stitch staple unit sliding home
position sensor (S22) abnormality
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the staple unit, sensors and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Contents
MJ-1036
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 112
Error
Timing of detection
EEPROM
Probable cause
Finisher control PC board (FIN)
abnormalit
MJ-1037
Error
Back-up memory
Timing of detection
Probable cause
Contents
MJ-6008
Error
Back-up memory
Timing of detection
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 113
Error item
Hole Punch Unit - Main CPU program error
Check item
Measures
Replace parts
Remarks
Timing of detection
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 114
Timing of detection
Probable cause
Timing of detection
Stacker motor
Stacker home position sensor
Probable cause
Stacker motor (M9) abnormality
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 115
Probable cause
Faulty cables and connectors
Measure
The stack exit roller home position sensor (S13) does not detect
that the exit roller is not at the upper position after the stack exit
roller motor (M6) has been driven in the specified time when the
exit roller is moved down.
The stack exit roller home position sensor (S13) does not detect
that the exit roller is at the upper position after the stack exit
roller shift motor (M6) has been driven in the specified time
when the exit roller is moved up.
Timing of detection
The exit roller nip home position sensor (S8) does not become OFF
from ON in the specified time when the status in which the exit roller
nip is large or small is changed to one in which the exit roller or the
middle transport roller is released.
The exit roller nip home position sensor (S8) does not become ON
from OFF in the specified time when the status in which the exit roller
or the middle transport roller is released is changed to one in which the
exit roller nip is large or small.
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensor and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 116
[CC21] Saddle stitch 3rd transport roller drive motor (M10) abnormality
MJ-1037
Error
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the saddle stitch 3rd transport roller home
position sensor (S23) is not detected in the specified time when
the saddle stitch 3rd transport roller is nipped or performing
paper transport.
The turning ON of the saddle stitch 3rd transport roller home
position sensor (S23) is not detected in the specified time when
the saddle stitch 3rd transport roller is released.
Probable cause
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the saddle stitch staple unit clinching home
position sensor (S32) is not detected in the specified time when
saddle stitch stapling is performed.
The turning ON of the saddle stitch staple unit clinching home
position sensor (S32) is not detected in the specified time after
the turning OFF of this sensor had been detected when saddle
stitch stapling is performed, and also the turning ON of this
sensor is not detected in a reverse rotation after the saddle
stitch stapler is stopped.
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 117
Probable cause
If the error still occurs after replacing the saddle stitch staple
unit and the connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board
(FIN).
Measure the voltage on pin CN17.7 on the finisher control PC
board (FIN). Then check that the measured voltage is 1V or
lower when the sensor is ON and within the range of 5V5%
when OFF. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the saddle stitch staple unit.
Check if the electrical continuity between the connector
terminals is normal. If electricity is not conducted, replace the
saddle stitch staple unit.
If the error still occurs after replacing the saddle stitch staple
unit and the connector, exchange the finisher control PC board
(FIN).
Probable cause
Timing of detection
The punch sliding unit is not slid after sliding request is sent.
The punch sliding unit home position sensor (S23) does not detect that
the unit is at its home position after the specified time when the unit is
returned to the home position, or this sensor does not detect that the
unit is out of its home position after the specified time when the unit is
released.
The punch sliding unit home position sensor (S23) does not detect that
the unit is at its home position after the specified time when the unit is
moved, or this sensor does not detect that the unit is at its home
position when the unit is released.
Checking and measures
Check if the electrical continuity of the coil is normal. If electricity is not
conducted, replace the motor.
Measure the voltage on TP26 on the hole punch control PC board
(HP). Then check that the measured voltage is 1V or lower when not
shielded and within the range of 5V
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensor and
connectors, exchange the hole punch control PC board (HP).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 118
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the punch sliding unit home position sensor
(S37) is not detected when the punch unit sliding motor (M16) is
driven for the specified distance while this sensor is ON.
The turning ON of the punch sliding unit home position sensor
(S37) is not detected when the punch unit sliding motor (M16) is
driven for the specified distance in the same direction as the
ON direction of this sensor while returning to its home position
Probable cause
Timing of detection
After the sensor output adjustment, the input value is lower than
1.2V against the output value of 2.8V, or the input value is
higher than 1.5V against the output value of 0.1V.
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 119
Timing of detection
The adjustment of the paper detection sensors (S24 and S25) has
been failed.
Probable cause
Measure the voltage on pin CN6.8 on the hole punch control PC board
(HP). Then check that the measured voltage is 3.0V or higher when
not shielded and 1.2V or lower when shielded. If the voltage does not
fall within the range mentioned, replace a couple of PC boards on
either the light-receiving side or the light-emitting side.
If the error still occurs after replacing the sensors and the connectors,
exchange the hole punch control PC board (HP).
[CC54] Abnormality of trailing edge detection sensors (S39 and S40) and horizontal registration
detection sensors (S39 and S40)
MJ-1037
Error
Timing of detection
After the sensor output adjustment, the input value is lower than
3.2V against the output value of 2.8V, or the input value is
higher than 3.5V against the output value of 0.1V.
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 120
Probable cause
Timing of detection
The paper detection sensors (S24 and S25) do not emit light after
specified time when they are selected
The level of the light-receiving amount is not lowered after the lightemitting amount of the paper detection sensors (S24 and S25) is
adjusted to the lower limit.
Punching is not performed after punching request is sent, or the
punching request is sent during the punching.
The status of the punch shaft home position sensor (S26) or the rear
punch shaft home position sensor (S22) is not changed after punching
request is sent.
A punching locking signal is detected consistently over the specified
time.
The punch shaft home position sensor (S26) or the rear punch
shaft home position sensor (S22) does not detect that the shaft
is not at its home position at the start of punching or punch
waste full detection.
Probable cause
Punch motor (M11) abnormality
Rear punch shaft home position sensor
(S22) abnormality
voltage does not fall within the range mentioned, replace the
sensor.
Punch shaft home position sensor
(S26) abnormality
voltage does not fall within the range mentioned, replace the
sensor.
Punch motor clock sensor (S20)
abnormality
voltage does not fall within the range mentioned, replace the
sensor.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 121
Probable cause
Faulty cables and connectors
Punch motor
Punch shaft home position sensor
Punch motor clock sensor
Timing of detection
Probable cause
Flash ROM
Timing of detection
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 122
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the front alignment plate home position sensor (S5)
is not detected when the front alignment plate is moved from a point
where this sensor is turned ON to one point where this sensor is turned
OFF after the front alignment motor (M2) has been driven at the
specified number of pulse.
5% when shielded. If the voltage does not fall within the range
mentioned, replace the sensor.
Faulty cables and connectors
If the error still occurs after replacing the motor, sensor and
connectors, exchange the finisher control PC board (FIN).
Timing of detection
The turning OFF of the front alignment plate home position sensor (S9)
is not detected in the specified time when the front alignment plate is
moved from a point where this sensor is turned ON to one point where
this sensor is turned OFF.
The turning ON of the front alignment plate home position sensor (S9)
is not detected in the specified time when the front alignment plate is
moved from a point where this sensor is turned OFF to one point
where this sensor is turned ON
Probable cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 123
Probable cause
Finisher control PC board (FIN)
abnormality
Timing of detection
The turning ON of the movable tray upper limit sensor (S16) is
detected.
Probable cause
Timing of detection
The knurled roller home position sensor (S10) does not detect that the
knurled roller is at the upper position after the 2nd transport motor (M4)
has been driven at the specified number of pulses during the initial
rising movement of the knurled roller.
The knurled roller home position sensor (S10) does not detect that the
knurled roller is not at the upper position after the 2nd transport motor
(M4) has been driven at the specified number of pulses during the
initial lowering movement of the knurled roller.
The knurled roller home position sensor (S10) does not detect that the
knurled roller is at the upper position when the pressurization of stack
exit movement is finished.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 124
Timing of detection
The turning ON of the fan locking signal is detected consistently after
the specified time*.
* A locking signal is not monitored from the start driving the motor until
the specified time has passed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 125
8.3.21
(1)
Based on the procedure of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40] described below, check the status and
take appropriate actions. And then perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop
control according to the following procedure.
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn ON the power.
2. Key in [2742], and then press the [START] button. Confirm that the image quality control has
finished normally.
(2) After confirming the items in (1), clear the abnormal detection counter of image quality control.
1. While pressing [0] and [8] simultaneously, turn ON the power.
2. Key in [2528], and then press the [START] button.
3. Rewrite the displayed status counter from 1 - 16 to 0, and then press the [OK] or
[INTERRUPT] button.
4. Key in [2529], and then press the [START] button.
5. Rewrite the displayed status counter from 1 - 16 to 0, and then press the [OK] or
[INTERRUPT] button.
6. Key in [2530], and then press the [START] button.
7. Rewrite the displayed status counter from 1 - 16 to 0, and then press the [OK] or
[INTERRUPT] button.
8. Key in [2531], and then press the [START] button.
9. Rewrite the displayed status counter from 1 - 16 to 0, and then press the [OK] or
[INTERRUPT] button.
10.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Make sure that the equipment enters the normal ready
state.
[CA00] Color registration abnormality
Classification
Step
2
3
Check Item
Contents
Result
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Measure
Next
Step
7
4
8 - 126
Step
Check Item
LED head
Result
Measure
7
8
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 127
Step
Check Item
11
Result
Measure
Next
Step
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
12
17
12
17
12
17
Remarks:
The adjustment value is the sum
of (*1), which, as in the example
below, specifies the cause of the
detection abnormality.
(E.g. 1) 05-4720 --- in case of 72
72 = 64 + 8
K on the rear side / M on the
front side detection abnormality
(E.g. 2) 05-4720 --- in case of
146
146 = 128 + 18 = 128 + 16 + 2
K on the front side / C on the
rear side / Y on the front side
detection abnormality
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 128
Step
Check Item
12
Result
Measure
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 129
Step
Check Item
Result
Measure
13
14
15
15
16
Yes
No
17
16
Yes
No
16
Next
Step
17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
12
8 - 130
Step
18
19
Check Item
Result
Yes
No
20
21
22
23
24
25
Yes
No
21
23
Yes
No
25
24
Yes
No
26
27
27
26
27
20
23
22
Next
Step
21
19
Check the contacting status of the
transfer belt and the photoconductive
drum.
Check the amount of the developer
material. (Check if the developer
material is supplied on the developer
sleeve.)
Developer material
Measure
Yes
No
29
28
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 131
Step
Check Item
Result
Measure
28
29
30
31
Yes
No
Next
Step
17
10
30
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 132
Step
Check Item
Result
Measure
Next
Step
32
Contents
Check Item
Measure
Connector check
Connector check (CN318)
Check the harnesses between the LGC board and the
image quality sensor.
Check the harnesses between the LGC board and the
switching power supply.
Check if the +12V voltage is normally output by the CN3457pin on the LGC board.
Replacement part
Measure
Step
Check Item
Contents
Result
Measure
Next
Step
Yes
No
2
3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 133
Step
Check Item
Result
Transfer belt
Yes
No
18*
8
6
Sensor shutter
Next
Step
Measure
Yes
No
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
18*
12
10
8 - 134
Step
Check Item
Result
10
LGC board
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Measure
Next
Step
18*
16
15
8
Blank print, Solid print, White banding,
Color banding, White spots, Poor
transfer, Uneven image density, Faded
image (low density), Uneven light
distribution, Blotched image.
* Blank print: including when one of
the YMCK colors is not printed.
17
20
19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 135
Step
Contents
Check Item
Result
Measure
4
5
Yes
No
Yes
No
Next
Step
9
8
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 136
Step
10
11
12
13
Check Item
Result
Yes
No
16
17
18
19
20
21
Next
Step
17*
15
14
14
15
Measure
Yes
No
16
19
18
If you have already performed this checking cycle once, proceed to step (12).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 137
Step
Check item
Error item
Result
Under
628 (Y,
M, C
and K)
Measures
Next
step
628 or
above
(Y, M, C
and K)
180 or
above
(Y, M, C
,K all)
Under
180 (Y,
M, C, K
each)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 138
Step
Check item
Result
Measures
Next
step
Replace parts
Remarks
LGC board
SYS board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 139
Contents
Check Item
Temperature/humidity sensor
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
Temperature/humidity sensor
LGC board
Step
1
2
3
4
Contents
Check Item
Result
Yes
No
5
2
Yes
Is the drum switching detection
sensor (S11) working? (Perform
No
the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/
[E] (Highlighted in the color mode))
Drum switching detection sensor
(S11)
LGC board
Next
Step
Measure
Yes
No
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 140
Step
Check Item
Result
10
11
12
LGC board
Next
Step
Measure
Yes
No
12
11
Check if the slide area (guide, plate) of
the drum switching guide is deformed
or any foreign matter is attached to it.
(Replace it if there is.)
Board check
Replacement part
Measure
Contents
Check Item
Drum thermistor
LGC board
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
Drum thermistor
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 141
8.3.22
Contents
Check Item
Measure
Replacement part
Measure
Step
Contents
Check Item
Developer unit
Result
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Next
Step
8 - 142
Replacement part
Measure
Step
Contents
Check Item
Developer unit
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 143
Step
Check Item
Developer unit
Contents
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 144
Step
Contents
Check Item
Developer unit
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 145
Step
Check Item
Developer unit
Contents
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 146
Step
Contents
Check Item
Developer unit
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 147
Step
Check Item
Developer unit
Contents
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 148
Step
Contents
Check Item
Developer unit
Result
Measure
Replacement part
Next
Step
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 149
Step
1
10
11
12
Contents
Check Item
Result
Measure
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
Next
Step
4
2
3
Replace the harness.
4
Replace the old/new detection switch.
3
Correct the old/new detection pusher
so that it is moved to the escape
position.
No
Yes
No
6
9
7
Yes
No
9
8
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
9
Replace the paper feeding/developer
unit drive motor.
Correct the engagement of the
couplings in the drum TBU drive unit
and the developer unit.
10
11
Reconnect the connector.
12
Replace the harness.
Replace the LGC board.
Replacement part
Measure
8 - 150
Replacement part
Measure
Harness
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 151
Step
1
10
11
Contents
Check Item
Result
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
Measure
Next
Step
4
2
3
Replace the harness.
4
Replace the drum old/new detection
switch.
3
Correct the drum old/new detection
pusher so that it is moved to the
escape position.
No
Yes
No
6
9
7
Yes
No
9
8
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
9
Replace the drum TBU drive motor.
11
Reconnect the connector.
12
Replace the harness.
Replace the LGC board.
Replacement part
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 152
Contents
Check Item
Main charger
Spring of high-voltage supply
contact point
Needle electrode
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 153
8.3.23
Contents
Check item
Setting
Measures
[F100_1] HDD format error (HDD encryption key data damaged - one board)
Classification
Contents
HDD format error: Encryption key data of either the SYS board
or the SRAM board for the SYS board are damaged.
Check item
Measures
Take appropriate countermeasures shown in the table below according to the messages displayed in
"SRAM Key Status" and "FROM Key Status".
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware, system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
P. 11-5 "11.1 Firmware Updating with USB Device"
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
OK
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull
KeyBroken
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull
KeyBroken
OK
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 154
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
Keymismatch
Keymismatch
Measure
[F100_2] HDD format error (HDD encryption key data damaged - both boards)
Classification
Contents
HDD format error: Encryption key data of both the SYS board
and the SRAM board for the SYS board are damaged.
Check item
Measures
Take appropriate countermeasures shown in the table below according to the messages displayed in
"SRAM Key Status" and "FROM Key Status".
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware / system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
AccessFailed
AccessFailed
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 155
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
Measure
Contents
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 156
Replacement part
Measure
HDD
SYS board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 157
Contents
Check item
HDD
Measures
Replacement part
Measure
HDD
SYS board
[F106_0] ADI-HDD error: Illegal disk replacement detected (ADI-HDD Exchange to SATA-HDD)
Classification
Error item
Check item
Setting
HDD
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 158
Error item
Check item
Measures
Setting
HDD
Error item
ADI-HDD error: Downloading of or consistency check for ADIHDD encryption key fails.
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 159
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 160
Contents
Check item
Measures
Setting
[F109_1] Key consistency error (SRAM encryption AES key data damage)
Classification
Contents
Check item
Measures
Setting
Contents
Key consistency error - Public key data used for Integrity Check
are damaged.
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 161
Contents
Check item
Measures
Take measures given in the following table according to the messages displayed in the SRAM Key
Status and FROM Key Status fields.
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware, system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
AccessFailed
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
OK
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 162
SRAM Key
Status
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
FROM Key
Status
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
Measure
Classification
Contents
Check item
Measures
Take measures given in the following table according to the messages displayed in the SRAM Licence
Status and FROM Licence Status fields.
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware, system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
SRAM Licence
Status
FROM Licence
Status
AccessFailed
AccessFailed
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 163
SRAM Licence
Status
KeyMismatch
FROM Licence
Status
KeyMismatch
Measure
* AccessFailed or KeyMismatch
[F109_5] Key consistency error (encryption key for ADI-HDD is damaged)
Classification
Contents
Check item
Measures
Take measures given in the following table according to the messages displayed in the SRAM Key
Status and FROM Key Status fields.
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware, system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
AccessFailed
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 164
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyMismatch
KeyMismatch
Measure
* AccessFailed or KeyMismatch
[F109_6] Key consistency error (administrator password error for ADI-HDD authentication)
Classification
Contents
Check item
Measures
Take measures given in the following table according to the messages displayed in the SRAM Key
Status and FROM Key Status fields.
Remarks:
If the error is not cleared, reinstallation of the system firmware, system software and application
is needed. ([4]+[9] Power-ON)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 165
SRAM Key
Status
FROM Key
Status
AccessFailed
AccessFailed
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
OK
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyNull/
KeyBroken
KeyMismatch
KeyMismatch
Measure
* AccessFailed or KeyMismatch
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 166
Error item
Database abnormality: Database is not operating normally.
Check item
Setting
Measures
8
[F121] Database abnormality (user information management database)
Classification
Error item
Login after the startup fails in any starting mode because user
management database is corrupted.
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 167
Error item
Login after the startup fails in any starting mode because log
management database is corrupted.
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 168
Contents
Check item
Measures
Setting
Contents
Check item
Measures
SYS board
Main memory
Connector check
Board check
Check the installation
Main memory check
Replace parts
Remarks
Main memory
SYS board
[F200] Data Overwrite option (GP-1070) disabled
Classification
Contents
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 169
Contents
Check item
Measures
Replacement part
Measure
SYS board
SYS board cooling fan
[F500] HD partition damage
Classification
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Replace parts
Remarks
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
1. Reboot.
2. If it has still not recovered, reinstall the system software.
3. If it still persists after step 2, perform [3] + [C] + [POWER]
3, and then reinstall the system software.
Notes:
User data will be deleted when [3] + [C] + [POWER]
3 is performed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 170
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
1. Reboot.
2. If it has still not recovered, reinstall the system software.
3. If it still persists after step 2, perform [3] + [C] + [POWER]
3, and then reinstall the system software.
Notes:
User data will be deleted when [3] + [C] + [POWER]
3 is performed.
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 171
Error item
Overwriting fails.
Check item
Setting
Measures
If a service call occurs again after the reboot, replace the HDD.
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Reset the date, and request the administrator to set the date
and time.
1. Turn the power on while pressing the [6] and [CLEAR]
button.
2. Select [2] key, and then press the [START] button.
3. Press the [START] button on the confirmation screen
displayed. (The date is set to January 1st, 2011.)
4. Request the administrator to set the date and time.
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 172
Error item
Check item
LGC board
Measures
Label
8
Fig.8-1
Setting
1.
2.
3.
4.
Notes:
When the SSD is replaced with the HDD in the 20/25
ppm model, perform the following procedures after the
HDD is installed.
Confirm the model of the equipment.
For the 20/25 ppm model, install the SSD or HDD. For, the
LL20/LL25pm model, install the SSD.
Install the system firmware corresponding to the model.
([8]+[9] mode)
P. 11-33 "11.3.2 System firmware"
Install the system software corresponding to the model.
([4]+[9] mode [4])
P. 11-9 "11.1.1 System firmware / Engine firmware /
Scanner firmware / System software / RADF firmware /
PFC firmware / Punch firmware / Finisher firmware"
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 173
Error item
Check item
LGC board
Measures
Label
Fig.8-2
Setting
1.
2.
3.
4.
Notes:
When the SSD is replaced with the HDD in the 20/25
ppm model, perform the following procedures after the
HDD is installed.
Confirm the model of the equipment.
For the 20/25 ppm model, install the SSD or HDD. For, the
LL20/LL25pm model, install the SSD.
Install the system firmware corresponding to the model.
([8]+[9] mode)
P. 11-33 "11.3.2 System firmware"
Install the system software corresponding to the model.
([4]+[9] mode [4])
P. 11-9 "11.1.1 System firmware / Engine firmware /
Scanner firmware / System software / RADF firmware /
PFC firmware / Punch firmware / Finisher firmware"
Parts to be replaced
Remark
LGC board
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 174
8.3.24
Notes:
When formatting the HDD ([5] + [C] + [POWER] ON -> [3] -> [1]), all data in the shared folder,
Electronic Filing, Address Book, template, etc. are erased. Back up these data before the
initialization. Note that some of data cannot be backed up
P. 9-16 "9.2.3 Precautions and procedures when replacing the HDD/SSD"
[ 1 ] Internet FAX related error
[1C10] System access abnormality
[1C32] File deletion failure
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
If the error still occurs, first, check if there are no jobs existing and then perform the HDD formatting
([5] + [C] + [POWER] ON -> [3] -> [1]).
[1C11] Insufficient memory
When there are running jobs, perform the job in error again after the completion of the running jobs.
If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[1C12] Message reception error
[1C13] Message transmission error
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C14] Invalid parameter
When a template is used, form the template again.
If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[1C15] Exceeding file capacity
Reset and extend the Maximum send to E-mail/iFAX size or reduce the number of pages and
perform the job again.
[1C30] Directory creation failure
[1C31] File creation failure
[1C33] File access failure
Check if the access privilege to the storage directory is writable.
Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[1C40] Image conversion abnormality
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
Replace the main memory and perform the job again.
[1C60] HDD full failure during processing
Delete the job in progress or being set or in the HOLD/PRIVATE/PROOF/INVALID, and perform it
again.
Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[1C61] Address Book reading failure
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
Reset the data in the Address Book and perform the job again.
[1C63] Terminal IP address unset
Reset the Terminal IP address.
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C64] Terminal mail address unset
Reset the Terminal mail address.
Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 175
8 - 176
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 177
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 178
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 179
8 - 180
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 181
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 182
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 183
8 - 184
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 185
8.3.25
8 - 186
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 187
8.3.26
Error item
There is a print job, a proof print job, a private print job, a print
job without a set department code, a scan job or a fax job
remaining in this equipment.
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 188
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 189
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Setting
Measures
[5212] Time for cleaning of the slit glass and main charger
Classification
Error item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 190
Error item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 191
8.3.27
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[6008] Failed to connect on External Role Base Access Control (LDAP) Server
Classification
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[6033] Card related error: Invalid flag data (no room-entry data)
Classification
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Use a correct card that has been used for entering the room.
[6034] Card related error: Invalid flag data (invalid card data)
Classification
Error item
The card cannot be used because the data required for the
use of the card are not correctly set.
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 192
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Classification
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 193
8.3.28
Maintenance error
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Remarks
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 194
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Return the license to the USB device used for installing the
license.
Check that the USB device is correctly installed.
Notes:
The GP-1080 IPSec Enabler cannot return to the USB
device due to license problem.
The GP-1070 Overwrite Enabler cannot return to the
USB device in the high security (08-8911: 3).
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 195
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[71AC] File save error during certificate acquisition from SCEP server
Classification
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
File saving failed for some reason. If the error still occurs after
rebooting the equipment, start up using the following
procedure:[3] + [C] + [POWER] 3. HDD formatting
Reinstallation of software or HDD replacement
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 196
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Maintenance error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 197
8.3.29
Network error
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 198
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Check
1. CA and user certificate in both MFP and remote peer certificate timestamp and IPsec Certificate template
should be valid.
2. CRL DP server name is mapped in MFPs host table or
DNS entry.
3. Certificate against CRL.
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 199
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 200
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Classification
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Check
1. CA and user certificate in both MFP and remote peer certificate timestamp and IPsec Certificate template
should be valid.
2. CRL DP server name is mapped in MFPs host table or
DNS entry.
3. Certificate against CRL.
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 201
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 202
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 203
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 204
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[8102] MFP not able to contact the Access point with the specified SSID
Classification
Network error
Error item
MFP not able to contact the Access point with the specified
SSID
Check item
Setting
Measures
Verify the access point name setting and mechanism used for
association same as Access Point setting.
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 205
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[8125] Domain - User account has expired and cannot be used for logon
Classification
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[8126] Domain - User account is locked and cannot be used for logon
Classification
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 206
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[8128] Active Directory Domain - Clock Skew error due to difference in Time between Server and
MFP
Classification
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
[8129] Active Directory Domain - Kerberos Ticket has expired and cannot be used for Authentication
Classification
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
Network error
Error item
Check item
Setting
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 207
8.4
8.4.1
Other errors
Equipment operation disabled after the installation of option(s)
8.4.2
The connection state and settings of the Wireless LAN can be checked with [USER FUNCTIONS]
[ADMIN] [WIRELESS LAN] [SETTING CHECK].
Confirm the settings with the administrator.
NIC INITIALIZING does not disappear at the time of the power being turned ON and it disappears
after 6 minutes with the NIC initializing time-out. In this case, the connection to the Wireless LAN did
not succeed even though NIC INITIALIZING disappears.
The connection to the Wireless LAN cannot be made if the Access Point to be connected is not
found or security settings are not correct.
8.4.3
Log in to TopAccess as an administrator, select [Authentication] on the [User Management] tab, and
then check whether Department Setting is enabled or disabled.
Department Setting is enabled:
Log in to TopAccess as an administrator, select [Authentication] on the [User Management] tab, and
then check User Management Setting.
Confirm the settings of 08-3805 in the setting mode.
Department Setting is disabled:
Log in to TopAccess as an administrator, select [Authentication] on the [User Management] tab, and
then check User Management Setting.
8.4.4
If the leading edge of B4, B5 or B5-R paper is folded when it exits, check the following items.
Check if the rear and side guides of the drawer or the side guide of the bypass tray correspond to
the paper size.
8.4.5
8.4.6
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 208
8.4.7
The equipment does not start after the power has been turned
ON.
LVPS
[3]
F2
F203
F202
F201
F204
F205
[1]
[2]
N
G
L
CN511
F1
FG
[5]
[4]
Fig.8-3
Check item
Power voltage
Power cable
Switching power supply
(LVPS) [3]
LGC board
SYS board
Measures
Parts to be replaced
Remark
Fuse
Harness (for the inlet)
Harness (for the main power
switch)
Main power switch
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 209
Parts to be replaced
Remark
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 210
8.5
8.5.1
Color deviation
1) Color deviation
<Symptoms>
Original mode
Location
Phenomena
All modes
Color
deviation
Text Mode
Text/Photo
Mode
White
void
Photo Mode
Map Mode
Color
deviation
Fig.8-4
Fig.8-5
Fig.8-6
8
Cause/Section
Ste
p
Drum rotation
abnormality
Check Item
Measure
5
Inadequate
drum TBU
motor rotation
speed
Drum coupling 6
and coupling
on the
equipment
side
Remark
For the
following
checks
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 211
Cause/Section
Ste
p
Transfer belt
9
10
11
12
13
High-voltage
transformer
14
Check Item
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Remark
8 - 212
8.5.2
<Symptoms>
Original mode
All modes
Location
Phenomena
Uneven
pitch
Feeding
direction
Fig.8-7
Cause/Section
Drum
Step
Drum drive
Drum rotation
abnormality
Developer
6
sleeve
7
Inadequate
drum TBU
motor rotation
speed
Drum coupling 8
Transfer belt
drive
Measure
Transfer belt
Check Item
Reconnect the
connectors.
Replace the harnesses.
Replace the LGC board.
Replace the drum TBU
motor.
Replace the developer
sleeve.
Reset drum TBU motor
speed to 128.
11
10
12
Remark
Check the
halftone pattern.
(Uneven pitch:
approx. 56 mm)
Check the
halftone pattern.
(Uneven pitch:
approx. 56 mm)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 213
Cause/Section
Feeding drive
Step
13
14
Fusing drive
15
16
17
EPU drive
18
19
2nd transfer
roller
20
Check Item
Measure
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Remark
Perform Fine
adjustment of fuser
roller rotational speed
(05-4529).
Check if the fuser unit is
installed correctly.
Replace the drive gear
of the pressure roller.
Replace the developer
drive unit, developer
sleeve and drive gears
of the mixer.
This problem
may occur on
thick paper or
the image on
the back side of
the paper in
duplex printing.
8 - 214
8.5.3
Cause/Section
Step
Density / Color 1
reproduction /
Gray balance
Printer density 2
Scanner
Parameter
adjustment
value
Check item
Measures
Remarks
See step
5 if defect
occurs.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 215
Cause/Section
Printer output
image
abnormal
Step
Check item
Measures
Remarks
If the trouble is not solved at the step 1 and the step 2 or followings (excluding the parameter
adjustment) are performed, make sure to perform Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop
control and then Automatic gamma adjustment after taking a measure.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 216
8.5.4
Background fogging
8
Fig.8-9
Cause/Section
Density
reproduction
Step
Check item
Measures
Printer section 2
Scanner
Parameter
adjustment
value
Cover
Auto-toner
Remark
s
See
step 6 if
defects
occur.
Clean it.
Check the value of offsetting
adjustment for background
adjustment.
While checking the above
encircled image, adjust the
reproduction level by the
offsetting adjustment for
background adjustment.
Correct it.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 217
Cause/Section
Step
Main charger 9
output
Developer
10
bias
Developer unit 11
Developer
material/
Toner/Drum
12
13
14
Drum cleaning 15
blade
Transfer belt
16
cleaning blade
Toner dusting
17
Check item
Measures
Remark
s
If the trouble is not solved at the step 1 and the step 2 or followings (excluding the parameter
adjustment) are performed, make sure to perform Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop
control and then Automatic gamma adjustment after taking a measure.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 218
8.5.5
8
A
Fig.8-10
Moire
Cause/Section
Step
Check item
Density
reproduction
Parameter
adjustment
value
Printer section 4
Measures
Remarks
When defects
occur, perform the
corresponding
troubleshooting
procedures.
Lack of sharpness
Cause/Section
Density
reproduction
Step
Check item
Measures
Remarks
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 219
Cause/Section
Parameter
adjustment
value
Step
Check item
Measures
Remarks
If the trouble is not solved at the step 1 and the step 2 or followings (excluding the parameter
adjustment) are performed, make sure to perform Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop
control and then Automatic gamma adjustment after taking a measure.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 220
8.5.6
Toner offset
Feeding direction
Black solid
Approx.
173 mm
Shadow image
Fig.8-11
Toner offset (Shadow image appears approx. 173 mm behind the high density image.)
Cause/Section
Fuser unit
Step
4
5
Check item
Measures
Remarks
8 - 221
Cause/Section
Paper
Developer
material
Scanner
Image quality
control
Density
Step
Check item
Measures
12
13
8
9
10
11
Printer density 11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Remarks
When
defects
occur,
perform the
correspondi
ng
troubleshoot
ing
procedures.
8 - 222
Blurred image
Feeding direction
8.5.7
Fig.8-12
Cause/Section
Step
Check item
Scanner
Drum
1
2
Ozone
exhaust
4
LED head
Main charger
Main charger
6
7
Measures
Clean it.
Wipe the drum with dry cloth.
* Be sure never use alcohol or
other organic solvents because
they have bad effect on the drum.
Check the connection of the
connector.
Replace it.
Clean the LED head.
Clean or replace the charger grid.
Remove foreign matter.
Clean or replace the charger grid.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 223
Poor fusing
Feeding direction
8.5.8
Fig.8-13
Cause/Section
Electric
power/control
abnormal
Step
1
2
4
5
Check item
Pressure
between fuser
roller and
pressure roller
improper
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Measures
Correct it.
Replace the switching power supply.
Reconnect them.
8 - 224
Cause/Section
Step
Check item
Measures
Fuser roller
temperature
Developer
material and
toner
Paper
10
11
12
13
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 225
Blank print
Feeding direction
8.5.9
Fig.8-14
Cause/Section
Step
1
High-voltage
transformer
(1st/2nd
2
transfer roller
and developer
bias)
Developer unit 3
4
5
Measures
10
Drum
Check item
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 226
Cause/Section
Transfer unit
Harnesses for
CCD, SYS
and LGC
boards
Step
Check item
11
12
13
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 227
Solid print
Feeding direction
8.5.10
Fig.8-15
Step
Check item
Measures
Exposure
lamp
Harnesses for
CCD, SYS
and LGC
boards
Scanner
Bedewing of
scanner
Remove it.
Clean the mirrors and lens.
Keep the power cord plugged so that
the damp heater can work.
Main charger
Step
1
2
High-voltage
transformer
(main charger
needle
electrode/grid
bias)
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Reinstall it securely.
Reinstall it securely.
Adjust the output and correct the
circuit, or replace the high-voltage
transformer.
Reconnect the harness securely.
Replace the high-voltage harness.
8 - 228
Cause/Section
Bedewing of
drum
Step
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 229
Feeding direction
8.5.11
Fig.8-16
Cause/Section
LED head
Step
Main charger 2
grid
Developer unit 3
4
5
Drum
Transfer unit
7
8
9
Transfer unit
10
Transport path 11
Discharge
LED
12
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 230
Cause/Section
Scanner
Step
13
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 231
Feeding direction
8.5.12
Fig.8-17
Cause/Section
Main charger
Drum
Step
1
2
3
Discharge
4
LED
Developer unit 5
6
Drive systems
8
High-voltage
transformer
(main charger
needle
electrode/grid,
1st/2nd
transfer roller
and developer
bias)
Main charger 9
Main charger 10
Check item
Measures
Correct it.
Check each drive system.
Check/correct any electric leakage
and related circuits.
If the high-voltage transformer does
not work, replace it.
Is the charger grid dirty or deformed? Clean or replace the charger grid.
Is there foreign matter on the
Remove foreign matter.
charger grid?
Clean or replace the charger grid.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 232
Feeding direction
8.5.13
Fig.8-18
Cause/Section
Drawer/LCF
Step
1
2
Check item
Paper feed
roller
Rollers
2nd transfer
roller
Aligning
amount
Registration
roller
Registration
guide
2nd transfer
front guide
8
9
10
11
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 233
Cause/Section
Step
RADF
12
Transfer unit
13
Check item
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Measures
8 - 234
Feeding direction
8.5.14
Fig.8-19
Cause/Section
Scanner
Step
1
2
Main charger
3
4
5
6
7
8
Drum cleaner
9
10
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 235
Cause/Section
Transfer unit
Step
11
12
13
Fuser unit
14
Drum
15
LED head
16
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 236
Feeding direction
8.5.15
Fig.8-20
Cause/Section
Step
Main charger
Fuser unit
High-voltage
transformer
(main charger
needle
electrode/grid
and transfer
roller bias)
Drum
Check item
7
2nd transfer
roller
Scanner
Main charger
Main charger
10
11
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 237
White spots
Feeding direction
8.5.16
Fig.8-21
Cause/Section
Developer
unit/Toner
cartridge
Developer
material/
Toner/Drum
Step
2
3
6
7
8
9
10
Main charger
Measures
Transfer unit
Check item
11
12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Remove it.
Clean or replace the needle
electrode.
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
8 - 238
Cause/Section
Step
13
High-voltage
transformer
(main charger
needle
electrode/grid,
developer 1st/
2nd transfer
roller bias)
Paper
14
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 239
Poor transfer
Feeding direction
8.5.17
Fig.8-22
Cause/Section
Transfer unit
Step
1
2
3
4
5
Paper
7
8
Registration
roller
Aligning
amount
10
Check item
Measures
Clean it.
Correct it.
Correct it.
Replace the belt.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 240
Cause/Section
High-voltage
transformer
(1st/2nd
transfer roller
bias)
Step
11
12
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 241
Feeding direction
8.5.18
Fig.8-23
Cause/Section
Step
Check item
Measures
Main charger
Transfer unit
3
4
5
LED head
Discharge
LED
7
8
Developer unit 9
10
11
Scanner
section
12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 242
Cause/Section
Dram cleaner
unit
Step
13
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 243
8.5.19
Fig.8-24
Cause/Section
Step
Developer unit 1
Check item
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Measures
8 - 244
8.5.20
Feeding direction
Fig.8-25
Feeding direction
Fig.8-26
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 245
Cause/Section
Developer unit
Step
Check item
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Measures
8 - 246
Feeding direction
8.5.21
Fig.8-27
Cause/Section
Toner empty
Auto-toner
circuit
Step
1
2
3
Toner motor
Toner
cartridge
Developer
material
Developer unit
Main charger
Drum
Transfer unit
10
11
High-voltage
transformer
(developer
bias)
4
5
Check item
12
13
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 247
Feeding direction
8.5.22
Fig.8-28
Cause/Section
Adjustment
error of
scanner or
printer section
Registration
roller
Step
5
6
7
8
9
Registration
guide
Measures
Paper feed
clutch
Aligning
amount
Paper pushing
amount
Each roller
Check item
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 248
Image jittering
Feeding direction
8.5.23
Fig.8-29
Cause/Section
Step
Registration
roller
Transfer unit
Fuser unit
Drum
Scanner
5
6
7
8
9
Drum drive
system
10
11
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 249
8.5.24
Poor cleaning
Feeding direction
Notes:
Poor cleaning may occur in feeding direction.
Fig.8-30
Cause/Section
Developer
material
Drum cleaner
Transfer belt
cleaner
Step
1
2
3
4
5
6
Toner
recovery
auger
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 250
Cause/Section
Fuser unit
Step
Check item
10
11
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 251
Feeding direction
8.5.25
Fig.8-31
Cause/Section
Step
Original glass
Main charger
1
2
Discharge
LED
Scanner
exposure
lamp
3
4
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Clean them.
Adjust the installed position of the
lamp.
Replace it.
8 - 252
Blotched image
Feeding direction
8.5.26
Fig.8-32
Cause/Section
Step
Paper
Transfer unit
2
3
High-voltage
transformer
(1st/2nd
transfer roller
bias)
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 253
Feeding direction
8.5.27
Feeding direction
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 254
Cause/Section
Image
adjustment/
setting
Step
1
2
3
4
Paper feeding
/Transport
area
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Transfer unit
13
14
15
16
17
18
Fuser unit
19
20
21
Check item
Measures
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 255
8.5.28
Feeding direction
Fig.8-34
Cause/Section
Fuser unit
Step
Check item
Measures
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Fig.8-35
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 256
8.5.29
Paper wrinkle
There are 2 locations where the paper wrinkle occurs: before the fusing stage and in the fuser unit
See below to determine the case.
Smooth out the wrinkled paper. When there is no image in the wrinkled area
See (1) Paper wrinkle before fusing.
Smooth out the wrinkled paper. When there is a copied image in the wrinkled area
See (2) Paper wrinkle in the fuser unit.
(1) Paper wrinkle before fusing
Is paper properly set?
|
NO Set paper properly.
YES
Is there any abnormality such as scratch or wear on the transport roller?
|
YES
Replace the transport roller.
NO
Is flexible paper such as recycled paper used?
|
YES
Switch to the recycled paper mode.
|
YES
Has the paper absorbed moisture?
|
YES Use paper that has not absorbed moisture.
NO
Is flexible paper such as recycled paper used?
|
YES Switch to the recycled paper mode.
|
(Select RECYCLED PAPER in MEDIA TYPE.)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 257
Fig.8-36
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 258
8.5.30
Streaks
Feeding direction
Fig.8-37
Cause/Section
2nd transfer
unit
Step
Check item
Measures
Fig.8-38
Notes:
Clean them with a soft pad, cloth or electric vacuum cleaner.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 259
Faint image
Feeding direction
8.5.31
Fig.8-39
*
Step
Check item
Measures
Transfer belt
unit (TBU)
Process unit
(EPU)
LED head
4
5
Transfer unit
(TRU)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 260
Toner scattering
Feeding direction
8.5.32
8
Fig.8-40
Cause/Section
2nd transfer
output
Step
Check Item
Measure
<Thick paper>
Is toner scattered on the
image on the back side of the
paper in duplex printing when
it is fed from the bypass tray?
<Plain paper>
Is toner scattered on the
image on the back side of the
paper in duplex printing when
it is fed from the bypass tray?
Remark
This problem
may occur when
the paper is dry
under a low
humidity
environment.If
plain paper is
used, [BACK]
and bypass
feeding cannot
be selected
together. In this
case, use the
ADU or select
[RECYCLED
PAPER].
Remarks:
To select a paper type, refer to the Copying Guide.
To set 2nd transfer output, refer to the Imaging Manual [1.3].
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 261
The larger the setting value is, the higher the transfer voltage becomes and the less toner
scattering occurs.
Paper type
Full color
Front side
Full color
Front side
[05] code
Recycled
paper
Recycled
paper
Sub code
Recommen
Acceptable
ded setting
values
value
Default
05-2934
6~8
0~10
05-2934
6~8
0~10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 262
8.5.33
Feathered image
Feeding direction
Fig.8-41
Cause/Section
Step
Developer unit 1
Check Item
Measure
[4]
[3]
[1]
[2]
[1]
Fig.8-42
2012 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 263
Notes:
Check the image after the pole position is adjusted.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
ERROR CODE AND TROUBLESHOOTING
8 - 264
9.
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9.1
Notes:
When the PC board/HDD is replaced, refer to the respective Notes and Cautions of
Replacement of PC boards and HDD in P. 9-12 "9.2 Precautions, Procedures and Settings
for Replacing PC Boards and HDD/SSD".
9.1.1
(1)
(2)
Fig. 9-1
(3)
Fig. 9-2
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-1
9.1.2
(1)
(2)
(3)
SYS board
Fig. 9-3
(4)
Notes:
When removing the SYS board, hold the
LAN connector and the lower right connector
on the board.
Do not hold the heat sink, memory or SRAM
board, as doing so causes load on the SYS
board.
Fig. 9-4
9.1.3
(1)
(2)
Fig. 9-5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-2
(3)
Fig. 9-6
9.1.4
(1)
(2)
(3)
Fig. 9-7
(4)
Fig. 9-8
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-3
(5)
Fig. 9-9
9.1.5
(1)
FAX cover
Fig. 9-10
9.1.6
(1)
(2)
LGC board
Fig. 9-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-4
(3)
Fig. 9-12
9.1.7
(1)
(2)
Switching regulator
Fig. 9-13
(3)
Fig. 9-14
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-5
(4)
Fig. 9-15
9.1.8
(1)
(2)
Fig. 9-16
(3)
(4)
Remove 5 screws.
Release 4 locking supports[1] and take off
the high-voltage transformer.
Fig. 9-17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-6
Notes:
When installing the HVT Board, fit the lower
part first.
Make sure the feed springs contact the
plastic (locator) pins as shown in the figure.
9.1.9
(1)
(2)
(3)
CFD board
Fig. 9-18
(4)
Fig. 9-19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-7
9.1.10
(1)
(2)
Fig. 9-20
(3)
Fig. 9-21
9.1.11
(1)
(2)
Notes:
Be careful not to damage the EEPROM
when replacing the EEPROM.
Fig. 9-22
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-8
9.1.12
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
CTIF board
Fig. 9-23
Fig. 9-24
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9-9
(5)
Fig. 9-25
Fig. 9-26
(6)
Fig. 9-27
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 10
9.1.13
(1)
(2)
(3)
Lens unit
Fig. 9-28
(4)
Fig. 9-29
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 11
9.2
9.2.1
The ID for each equipment is registered on the LGC board, the SYS board and Lens unit. So, if their
replacement is required, be sure to replace only one board at a time. Do not replace the SYS board
and the SRAM board (for the SYS board) together.
If both the LGC board and SYS board require replacement, replace them in the following procedure.
1. First, replace one of the board to be replaced.
2. Turn the power ON and confirm that READY is displayed.
3. Turn the power OFF.
4. Replace another board that requires replacement.
When replacing the LGC board, remove the EEPROM on the old board, and then attach it to the
new board.
When the HDD/SSD requires replacement, see P. 9-16 "9.2.3 Precautions and procedures
when replacing the HDD/SSD".
When the SYS board requires replacement, see P. 9-22 "9.2.4 Precautions and Procedures
when replacing the SYS board" .
When the Lens unit requires replacement, see P. 9-39 "9.2.7 Procedures and settings when
replacing the Lens unit".
When SRAM board requires replacement, see P. 9-26 "9.2.5 Precautions and procedure when
replacing the SRAM board (for the SYS board)".
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 12
9.2.2
This code displays the HDD/SSD operation history, which is recorded in the HDD/SSD, on the control
panel. HDD/SSD failure can be diagnosed or predicted with the information displayed.
1. Display
The following screen is displayed with setting code 08-9065. You can also refer to the same
information by pressing the [ON/OFF] button while pressing [5] and [C] simultaneously and then
selecting "5. SMART Info".
HDD manufacturer
Model name
Fig. 9-30
-
2. Usage
The combination of the values of ID=05 and c5 is used to diagnose whether or not the HDD/SSD
has a physical failure when HDD/SSD failure is suspected (service call F100 - F108 or F121 or F122
occurred).
ID
05
c5
Result
VALUE
0
0
05
c5
From 1 to 999
0
05
c5
Any value
1 or more
05
c5
Description
Diagnosis
HDD/SSD
replacement is
not required.
HDD/SSD
replacement is
not required.
HDD/SSD
replacement is
recommended.
HDD/SSD
replacement is
recommended.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 13
ID
05
c5
Result
VALUE
All values are
displayed as -------.
Description
Diagnosis
HDD/SSD
replacement is
recommended.
3. ID=05 and c5
ID
Name
05
Description
Remarks
Re-allocated Sector
Count
c5
Current Pending
Sector Count
4. Description of each ID
ID
01
Name
02
03
Spin Up Time
04
05
07
08
09
Power-On Hours
0a
0c
c0
c1
c2
Temperature
c3
c4
c5
c6
Meaning
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 14
ID
c7
c8
Name
Meaning
Notes:
"Over-range" is displayed if the number of digits acquired from the HDD/SSD exceeds the
maximum digits which can be displayed on the control panel; however, this does not indicate an
error.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 15
9.2.3
Notes:
Replacing ADI-HDD with SATA-HDD/SSD is not possible. When replacing ADI-HDD, replace it
with another ADI-HDD.
When the HDD/SSD is replaced, it is necessary to back up the data in the HDD/SSD before
replacing and to recover them after replacing.
To maintain the security, ask users to perform the backup/restore for users data/information in
the HDD/SSD. The service technician can perform them only when users permit it.
Some data in the HDD cannot be backed up and can be kept only on the paper.
Do not replace the HDD/SSD and the SRAM board (for the SYS board) together.
A procedure for replacing the HDD/SSD is shown below.
Start
[A] Back up data in HDD/SSD
[B] Print out "FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE"
[C] Print out "FUNCTION" list
[D] Return License
[E] Erase HDD/SSD
[F] Replace/Format HDD/SSD
[G] Reset user's setting item and restore data/information
[H] Reset "FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE"
[I] Reset "FUNCTION" list
[J] Batch setting for disconnecting HDD
[K] Adjust image quality
Setting completed
Fig. 9-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 16
Availability
Backup method
HDD: Available
SSD: Not available
Available
Available
Available
HDD: Available
SSD: Not avalable
Not available
Not available
Not available
Not available
(3)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 17
Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.
Notes:
Explain the procedure to the user (machine administrator) and ask him/her to enter his/her
password.
(3)
(4)
Press the [FUNCTION] button. The FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE is printed out.
(2)
(3)
(4)
Select the license to be returned, and then press the [REMOVE] button.
(5)
Install the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, in the equipment,
and then press the [OK] button.
(6)
The Remove screen is displayed, then press the [YES] button. If this screen is not displayed,
check whether the one-time dongle is installed in the equipment properly.
(7)
After 10 to 40 seconds passes, the screen for notifying the success of performance is displayed.
Then press the [OK] button. If this screen is not displayed or the screen for notifying the failure of
performance is displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO]/[CLOSE] button. Then, check
whether the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, is installed in
the equipment.
(8)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be returned, repeat from step (4).
If there is no more licenses to be returned, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power
OFF.
[E] Erase HDD/SSD
In case of the ADI-HDD:
(1)
Turn the power ON while pressing [4] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
Key in [1] to select "1: Revert factory install status HDD." and then press the [START] button.
(3)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 18
Incase of SATA-HDD/SSD:
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
Key in [6] to select "6: Erase HDD Security." and then press the [START] button.
(3)
Select "1. LOW", "2. MEDIUM", "3. HIGH" and "4. SIMPLE.
(4)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
When the Fax Unit (GD-1320) is installed, perform Fax Set Up (1*-100) and Clearing the
image data (1*-102). Then turn the power OFF.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 19
Printer driver
F-code information, Template
registering information, Address
book data
Department management data
Image data in the Electronic Filing
Method
When the SSL is enabled, perform the setting of the following items again with Self-signed
certificate of TopAccess.
- Country Name
- State or Province Name
- Locality Name
- Organization Name
- Organizational Unit Name
- Common Name
- Email Address
When wireless LAN is used, perform the setting again on the LCD panel. (only when security
with a certificate is used) Also, upload the following certificate file with Install Certificate for
Wireless LAN of TopAccess.
- CA certificate
- User certificate
While pressing [1] and [3] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Fax Function Mode)
(3)
Compare the lists which were printed before and after the formatting to check the setting items
having the different setting values. Set the value which was set before the formatting.
(4)
Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.
Notes:
Explain the user (machine administrator) about the next operation and ask him/her to enter his/
her password.
(3)
Press the [FAX] button and then the [TERMINAL ID] button to set each item.
(4)
9 - 20
(1)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 21
9.2.4
Start
Setting completed
Fig. 9-32
(2)
(3)
(4)
Select the license to be returned, and then press the [REMOVE] button.
(5)
Install the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, in the equipment,
and then press the [OK] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 22
(6)
The Remove screen is displayed, then press the [YES] button. If this screen is not displayed,
check whether the one-time dongle is installed in the equipment properly.
(7)
After 10 to 40 seconds passes, the screen for notifying the success of performance is displayed.
Then press the [OK] button. If this screen is not displayed or the screen for notifying the failure of
performance is displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO]/[CLOSE] button. Then, check
whether the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, is installed in
the equipment.
(8)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be returned, repeat from step (4).
If there is no more licenses to be returned, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power
OFF.
[B] Replace the SYS board
Notes:
Before replacing the SYS board, perform the following procedure.
P. 9-12 "9.2.1 Precautions when replacing PC boards"
(1)
(2)
(3)
Install DIMM (main memory, page memory) to the new SYS board (from the old SYS board).
(4)
Install SRAM board to the new SYS board (from the old SYS board).
(5)
Install HDD/SSD to the new SYS board (from the old SYS board).
Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [5] to select "5.ADI Key SRAM to FROM", and then press the [START] button.
(5)
Wait until the restoring of the encryption key is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 23
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [1] to select "1. Key SRAM to FROM", and then press the [START] button.
(5)
Wait until the restoring of the encryption key is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6)
Restart the equipment after the restoring is completed. If you want to perform the restoring of the
license, do not restart the equipment but perform from (4) in "[H] Restore license".
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [3] to select "3. License SRAM to FROM", and then press the [START] button.
(5)
Wait until the restoring of the license is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6)
After the restoring is completed, check that "OK" is indicated in "SRAM License STATUS" and
"FROM License Status". Then, restart the equipment.
(7)
If "4. License FROM to SRAM" is performed by mistake, carry out the following procedure.
P. 9-40 "[ 1 ] Re-registration when the board is replaced"
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3)
(4)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Install the one-time dongle in the equipment (the one which you used for returning the selected
license before replacing the equipment). Then press the [OK] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 24
(6)
Select the license to be installed, and then press the [INSTALL] button.
(7)
The screen for notifying that the installation will be started is displayed. Then press the [YES]
button.
(8)
After 10 to 40 seconds have passed, the screen for notifying the success of the performance is
displayed. Then press the [OK] button. If the screen for notifying a failure of the performance is
displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO] button. Then check that the one-time dongle is
installed properly in the equipment.
(9)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be installed, repeat from step (4). If there are no other licenses
to be installed, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power OFF.
[I] Check firmware versions
System firmware version (08-9930)
Scanner firmware version (08-9902)
Notes:
If the security mode is changed from High Security to Low Security in the step "[A] Return
License", set the value of 08-8911 to "3" (High Security).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 25
9.2.5
Notes:
Do not replace the HDD and the SRAM board (for the SYS board) together.
Be careful not to damage the board when replacing the SRAM board.
A procedure for replacing the SRAM board is shown below.
When disposing of the SRAM board, perform the items in P. 9-42 "9.3.4 Precautions when disposing
of the SRAM board (for SYS board)".
Start
Backup SRAM
possible?
No
Yes
With backup
data SRAM?
No
Yes
[A] Backup SRAM
No
Yes
[B] Return License
Setting completed
Fig. 9-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 26
Notes:
"[G] Backup ADI key" is required only for the equipment in which the ADI-HDD has been
installed. Other procedures are the same as those for installing the SATA-HDD.
[A] Backup SRAM
Notes:
If "[A] Backup SRAM" fails, proceed to [B]Return License.
If "[A] Backup SRAM" succeeds, proceed to [C]Replace SRAM board.
(1)
Turn the power ON while pressing [6] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
When "SRAM Clear Mode" appears on the LCD, key in [0] to select "0. Set Serial Number" and
then press the [START] button.
(3)
Key in the serial number on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, and then press
the [OK] button.
(4)
(5)
(6)
Install the USB media in the equipment, and then turn the power ON while pressing [5] and [9]
buttons simultaneously.
(7)
Key in [1] to select "1. Backup SRAM Data to USB", and then press the [START] button.
(8)
(9)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Select the license to be returned, and then press the [REMOVE] button.
(5)
Install the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, in the equipment,
and then press the [OK] button.
(6)
The Remove screen is displayed, then press the [YES] button. If this screen is not displayed,
check whether the one-time dongle is installed in the equipment properly.
(7)
After 10 to 40 seconds passes, the screen for notifying the success of performance is displayed.
Then press the [OK] button. If this screen is not displayed or the screen for notifying the failure of
performance is displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO]/[CLOSE] button. Then, check
whether the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, is installed in
the equipment.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 27
(8)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be returned, repeat from step (4).
If there is no more licenses to be returned, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power
OFF.
[C] Replace SRAM board
(1) Confirm that the power is turned OFF.
(2)
(3)
When "SRAM Clear Mode" appears on the LCD, key in [1] to select "1. Clear SRAM" and then
press the [START] button.
(3)
(4)
When "SRAM Clear Mode" appears on the LCD, key in [0] to select "0. Set Serial Number" and
then press the [START] button.
(3)
Key in the serial number on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, and then press
the [OK] button.
(4)
(5)
(6)
Install the USB media in the equipment, and then turn the power ON while pressing [5] and [9]
simultaneously.
(7)
Key in [2] to select "2. Restore SRAM Data from USB" and then press the [START] button.
(8)
(9)
(10) Turn the power OFF after the restoring of SRAM is completed.
Remarks:
When the restoration is completed successfully, do not perform "[F] Clear SRAM update error
flags" or later procedures.
End this procedure here and finish replacing the SRAM board (for SYS board).
(11) Reinstall the GD-1320 Fax Unit if used.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 28
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [ENTER] button without entering anything.)
(3)
After Firmware Assist Mode is displayed on the LCD, check that 1: Clear Error Flag in Software
Installation. is marked and press the [START] button.
If not, key in [1] and then press the [START] button.
(4)
When Operation Complete is displayed on the LCD, clearing the flag is completed.
(5)
Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [6] to select "6. ADIKey FROM to SRAM", and then press the [START] button.
(5) Wait until the backup of the ADI key is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6) Restart the equipment after the backup is completed.
If you want to perform the backup of the license, do not restart the equipment but perform from
(4) in "[H] Backup encryption key".
[H] Backup encryption key
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2)
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [ENTER] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [2] to select "2. Key FROM to SRAM", and then press the [START] button.
(5) Wait until the backup of the encryption key is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6) Restart the equipment after the backup is completed. If you want to perform the backup of the
license, do not restart the equipment but perform from (4) in "[I] Backup license".
(7)
[I]
Notes:
If "3. License SRAM to FROM" is performed by mistake, carry out the following procedure.
P. 9-40 "[ 1 ] Re-registration when the board is replaced"
(1)
Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 29
(2)
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [ENTER] button without entering anything.)
(3)
Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4)
Key in [4] to select "4. License FROM to SRAM", and then press the [START] button.
(5) Wait until the backup of the license is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6) Restart the equipment after the backup is completed.
(7) Turn the power OFF.
[J] Initialize SRAM board
(1) Start up with the Setting Mode (08).
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Install the one-time dongle in the equipment (the one which you used for returning the selected
license before replacing the equipment). Then press the [OK] button.
(6)
Select the license to be installed, and then press the [INSTALL] button.
(7)
The screen for notifying that the installation will be started is displayed. Then press the [YES]
button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 30
(8)
After 10 to 40 seconds have passed, the screen for notifying the success of the performance is
displayed. Then press the [OK] button. If the screen for notifying a failure of the performance is
displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO] button. Then check that the one-time dongle is
installed properly in the equipment.
(9)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be installed, repeat from step (4).
If there are no other licenses to be installed, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the
power OFF.
[L] Enable HDD/SSD encryption
If the HDD/SSD encryption function is used, follow the procedure below.
(1)
(2)
(3)
Notes:
If the SSD is installed, this setting cannot be used.
(4)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(3)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 31
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Set the dial type according to these buttons: [USER FUNCTIONS] -> [ADMIN] -> [FAX] ->
[INITIAL SETUP]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 32
9.2.6
Notes:
Be careful not to damage the EEPROM when replacing the EEPROM.
A procedure for replacing the SRAM board is shown below.
Start
Setting completed
Fig. 9-34
9
[A] Replace SRAM board
(1) Confirm that the power is turned OFF.
(2)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 33
(3)
(4)
(5)
Check whether the displayed destination (see the below figure) of the SRAM board (for the SYS
board) is the same as the one in step (1).
Fig. 9-35
Remarks:
If the destinations are different, initialize the SRAM board (for the SYS board) with reference to
the following procedure.
P. 9-26 "9.2.5 Precautions and procedure when replacing the SRAM board (for the SYS
board)"
(6)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 34
(7)
Press the [INITIALIZE] button to perform the initialization of the SRAM board (for the LGC
board).
Fig. 9-36
9
(8)
Perform "Destination display at SRAM initialization" (08-9060), and check whether the same
destinations are displayed for the SYS board and the LGC board.
Fig. 9-37
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 35
Remarks:
If an error occurs during the initialization of the LGC board and the initialization fails, error
messages are displayed on the touch panel. The error messages and the corresponding
troubleshooting methods are shown below.
Error message
R/W FAILURE
UNDEFINED MODEL
UNDEFINED VERSION
VERIFY ERROR
Troubleshooting
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 36
H (0)
05/2622
05/2623
05/2624
05/2625
05/2627
05/2628
05/2629
05/2630
05/2984
05/2983
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
1.
2.
3.
Notes:
You can reset the auto-toner sensor by directly entering the adjustment values for (05) 24050 to 3 and (05) 2409-0 to 3 with the Adjustment mode data list, which has been printed during
normal operation of equipment such as when it is setup, when preventive maintenance (PM)
is performed or when developer material is replaced, etc.
If you perform automatic adjustment (05-2400) of the auto-toner sensor without replacing the
developer materials for four colors (YMCK), image quality is not guaranteed.
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 37
(2)
(3)
(4)
Notes:
Be sure to change the setting of Line adjustment mode (08-9010) to 0: For factory shipment.
Since 1: For line is set for Line adjustment mode in SRAM supplied as a service part, number
of prints is not counted unless it is changed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 38
9.2.7
(2)
(3)
(4)
Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button. (If the password is not set for Service, press
the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(5)
Perform Data transfer of characteristic value of scanner / SYS board -> Lens unit (05-3209).
(6)
(7)
9.2.8
After replacing the PC board/HDD, check the firmware version in the setting mode (08) and confirm if
the firmware combination is correct.
Firmware
Code
Remarks
08-8952
08-9900
08-9930
08-9901
08-9902
08-9903
08-9904
08-9944
08-9905
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 39
9.2.9
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Install the one-time dongle in the equipment (the one which you used for registering the selected
license), and then press the [OK] button.
(6)
Select the license to be installed, and then press the [INSTALL] button.
(7)
The screen for notifying that the installation will be started is displayed. Then press the [YES]
button.
(8)
After 10 to 40 seconds have passed, the screen for notifying the success of the performance is
displayed. Then press the [OK] button. If the screen for notifying a failure of the performance is
displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [CLOSE] button. Then check that the one-time
dongle, which you used for uploading the selected license, is installed in the equipment.
(9)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be returned, repeat from step (4). If there are no other licenses
to be returned, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power OFF.
Notes:
This procedure is available only with the one-time dongle used for the previous registration, since
the model information registered in it is utilized. Use the same one-time dongle and the
equipment when registering the license.
[ 2 ] Re-registration when the equipment is replaced due to malfunction
When the equipment has to be replaced due to a malfunction, return the license registered in the
equipment to the one-time dongle and register it to the new equipment following the procedure below.
Notes:
The license of the IPSec Enabler (GP-1080) cannot be reinstalled. The one-time dongle to be
used is the one for the previous registration of the license. The license is deleted from the
equipment and is stored in the one-time dongle.
Do not perform the deletion of PDFA Converter since it is deleted without any return to the onetime dongle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Select the license to be returned, and then press the [REMOVE] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 40
(5)
Install the one-time dongle in the equipment (the one which you used for uploading the selected
license), and then press the [OK] button.
(6)
(7)
After 10 to 40 seconds have passed, the screen for notifying the success of the performance is
displayed. Then press the [OK] button.
If the screen for notifying a failure of the performance is displayed, quit this operation by pressing
the [CLOSE] button. Then check that the one-time dongle, which you used for uploading the
selected license, is installed in the equipment.
(8)
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be returned, repeat from step (4).
If there are no other licenses to be returned, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power
OFF.
(9)
(10) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [8] simultaneously.
(11) Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button.
(If the password is not set for Service, press the [ENTER] button without entering anything.)
(12) Key in [3840], and then press the [START] button.
(13) Press the [INSTALL] button.
(14) Install the one-time dongle in the equipment (the one which you used for returning the selected
license before replacing the equipment). Then press the [OK] button.
(15) Select the license to be installed, and then press the [INSTALL] button.
(16) The screen for notifying that the installation will be started is displayed. Then press the [YES]
button.
(17) After 10 to 40 seconds have passed, the screen for notifying the success of the performance is
displayed. Then press the [OK] button. If the screen for notifying a failure of the performance is
displayed, quit this operation by pressing the [NO] button. Then check that the one-time dongle is
installed properly in the equipment.
(18) Check that the installed license is displayed on the license list.
Remarks:
If there are any other licenses to be installed, repeat from step (13). If there are no other licenses
to be installed, press the [CLOSE] button, and then turn the power OFF.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 41
9.3
9.3.1
When installing the Data Overwrite Enabler (GP-1070), perform the following setting:
3C->6. Erase HDD Securely : HDD securely erasing
This setting is the overwriting method complying with DoD 5220.22-M.
1 : LOW: This is the normal overwriting method. (This setting is used normally.)
2 : MEDIUM: This overwriting method is more secure than LOW. The erasing time is between LOW
and HIGH.
3 : HIGH:This is the most secure overwriting method. It takes the longest time to erase data
4 :SIMPLE : This is the simple overwriting method. It takes the shortest time to erase data.
9.3.2
9.3.3
When disposing of the SYS board, data clearing is not required since important data, such as user
information, etc. are stored in the SRAM board.
9.3.4
When disposing of the SRAM board (for SYS board), perform 3C ->7:Erase SRAM Securely (SRAM
securely erasing) for security reasons.
Notes:
If this is performed, the equipment cannot be started up.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REPLACEMENT OF PC BOARDS/HDD
9 - 42
Outline
FAX
Installation of the FAX board is required.
If the FAX board has not been installed, it is regarded as OFF setting.
E-mail (E-mail body + TIFF image)
(2)
Order Intervals
When the toner empty occurs, the number of occurrences is counted. And when it reaches the
specified number for CONDITION, the order is placed automatically.
With regard to the used waste toner box, it is done according to the number of the used waste
toner box full detection.
The number of the CONDITION can be set respectively for the toner and used waste toner box.
(3)
10.1.2
Setting Item
(2)
Basic setting
[ADMIN] > [SERVICE] > [SUPPLY ORDER SETUP] > [ORDER INFORMATION]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 1
10
AUTO SUPPLY
ORDER
FAX NUMBER
E-MAIL
CUSTOMER
NAME
TEL NUMBER
E-MAIL
ADDRESS
SUPPLIER
NAME
ADDRESS
SERVICE TECNICIAN
NUMBER
NAME
TEL NUMBER
E-MAIL
Supplier information
The order is placed when the number of replacement reaches the number specified for the
CONDITION.
FAX number of this equipment (common information)
[ADMIN] > [FAX] > [TERMINAL ID]
ID NAME
FAX NUMBER
When sending an E-mail, validity of the address is checked. If the address is invalid, it is
not sent.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 2
(3)
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 3
10.1.3
Setting procedure
(1)
Start up the self-diagnosis setting mode 08-9783, and then change the setting value to 0.
(2)
(3)
Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button to enter the user function screen.
(4)
Fig.10-1
(5)
Press the [PASSWORD] button and the screen is switched to a full keyboard. Then key in the
Administrator Password and press the [OK] button.
* Confirm the password to the administrator.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 4
Fig.10-2
(6)
(7)
10
Fig.10-3
(8)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 5
Fig.10-4
(9)
Fig.10-5
(11) Press the buttons on the screen of ORDER INFORMATION to set the required item.
[FAX]/[MAIL]/
[OFF]
Select the [FAX] or the [MAIL] button for the transmitting way of order.
(HTTP has not been supported yet.)
[OFF]: Turn off the AUTO SUPPLY ORDER function.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 6
[FAX NUMBER]
[E-MAIL]
10
Fig.10-6
(14) Press the buttons of the screen of SUPPLIER to set the required item.
[NAME]
Input the name of supplier.
[ADDRESS] Input the address of supplier.
(15) Press the [OK] button.
(16) The SERVICE screen is displayed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 7
Fig.10-7
(17) Press the [SERVICE INFORMATION] button.
(18) The CUSTOMER/SERVICE TECHNICIAN screen is displayed.
Fig.10-8
(19) Press the buttons of the screen of CUSTOMER/SERVICE TECHNICIAN to set the required item.
CUSTOMER
[NAME]
[TEL NUMBER]
[E-MAIL]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 8
[ADDRESS]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
[NUMBER]
[NAME]
[TEL NUMBER]
[E-MAIL]
(20) Press the [OK] button to register and complete the order information setting.
(21) The SERVICE screen is returned.
10
Fig.10-9
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 9
Fig.10-10
(23) Press the [TONER ORDERING] button.
(24) The TONER ORDERING screen is displayed.
Fig.10-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 10
Fig.10-12
(26) Input the order information of TONER.
[PART NUMBER]
[CONDITION]
[QUANTITY]
Toner number
The order is placed when the number of toner empty reaches the number
specified for the CONDITION.
Quantity to be ordered
AUTO ORDER
[ON]/[OFF]
(27) Press the [OK] button to register the setting of toner order.
(28) The TONER ORDERING screen is displayed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 11
10
Fig.10-13
(29) Press the [MAGENTA(M)] / [CYAN(C)] / [BLACK(K)] / [USED TONER CONTAINER] button, and
then input the order information in the same way.
Fig.10-14
(30) Press the [OK] button to register the order information.
Notes:
Auto Supply Order setting is also available from the following setting mode (08).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 12
Items
08 code
Contents
9750
SUPPLIER
[FAX NUMBER]
SUPPLIER
[E-MAIL]
CUSTOMER
[NAME]
CUSTOMER
[TEL NUMBER]
CUSTOMER
[E-MAIL]
CUSTOMER
[ADDRESS]
SUPPLIER
[NAME]
SUPPLIER
[ADDRESS]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
[NUMBER]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
[NAME]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
[TEL NUMBER]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
[E-MAIL]
Remarks
[DESCRIPTION]
RESULT PRINTING
[OFF] / [ALWAYS] / [ON
ERROR]
YELLOW(Y) TONER
[PART NUMBER]
YELLOW(Y) TONER
[CONDITION]
YELLOW(Y) TONER
[QUANTITY]
MAGENTA(M) TONER
[PART NUMBER]
MAGENTA(M) TONER
[CONDITION]
MAGENTA(M) TONER
[QUANTITY]
CYAN(C) TONER
[PART NUMBER]
CYAN(C) TONER
[CONDITION]
CYAN(C) TONER
[QUANTITY]
9751
0: Ordered by FAX
1: Ordered by E-mail
2: Ordered by HTTP
3: OFF
Maximum 32 digits
9752
9756
Maximum 50 letters
9757
Maximum 32 digits
9758
9759
9764
Maximum 50 letters
9765
9760
Maximum 5 digits
9761
Maximum 50 letters
9762
Maximum 32 digits
9763
9766
9782
9773
0: OFF
1: Always
2: ON Error
Maximum 20 digits
9775
1-99
9774
1-99
9770
Maximum 20 digits
9772
1-99
9771
1-99
9767
Maximum 20 digits
9769
1-99
9768
1-99
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 13
Items
08 code
Contents
BLACK(K) TONER
[PART NUMBER]
BLACK(K) TONER
[CONDITION]
BLACK(K) TONER
[QUANTITY]
USED TONER CONTAINER
[PART NUMBER]
USED TONER CONTAINER
[CONDITION]
USED TONER CONTAINER
[QUANTITY]
9776
Maximum 20 digits
9778
1-99
9777
1-99
9779
Maximum 20 digits
9781
1-99
9780
1-99
Fig.10-15
(33) When Service Notification (Device Info) is set to ON, the screen to set the notification date is
displayed.
Then set the notification date with the following procedure.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 14
Fig.10-16
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 15
10
Fig.10-17
Key in the date (acceptable values: 0-31) in Notify Date 1 or Notify Date 2 and press the [OK]
button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 16
Fig.10-18
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 17
10
10.1.4
:99-99-'99 99:99
:XXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
PART NUMBER
TONER CARTRIDGE
CYAN
MAGENTA
YELLOW
BLACK
USED TONER CONTAINER
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
QUANTITY
99
99
99
99
99
(*1)
PRINT COUNTER
SCAN COUNTER
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
TOTAL
999999999
999999999
BLACK
999999999
999999999
TONER INFORMATION
YELLOW REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
MAGENTA REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
CYAN REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
BLACK REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
:
:
:
:
TWIN COLOR
999999999
999999999
FULL COLOR
999999999
999999999
0000059
0000060
0000061
0000062
Fig.10-19
DESCRIPTION AREA:
DEVICE DESCRIPTION:
SERIAL NUMBER:
DEVICE FAX NUMBER:
DEVICE E-MAIL ADDRESS:
Remarks
Model name
Serial number
Fax number
E-mail address
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 18
(2)
E-MAIL (TIFF image attached with the E-mail is the same format with that of the FAX order
sheet.)
SUBJECT: SUPPLY ORDER REQUEST
*1 Part not to be ordered is not output. (Less space between the lines)
Date&Time: '12-04-14 00:17
Customer Number: a1 MachineName: TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
SerialNumber: 1234567890
Device FAX Number: 456
Device Email: aaa@linux.nam1.local
OrderInformation:
CYAN PartNumber: CYAN-01 Quantity: 15
MAGENTA PartNumber: MAGENTA-02 Quantity: 16 (*1)
BLACK PartNumber: BLACK-04 Quantity: 18
CounterInformation:
PrintCounter(Small) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 150
PrintCounter(Large) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 0
ScanCounter FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 7
Fig.10-20
Date&Time:
Order date and time
Customer Number:
Customer number
MachineName:
Model name (MFP model name)
SerialNumber:
Serial number
Device FAX Number:
Fax number
Device Email:
E-mail address
OrderInformation:
Order information
CYAN PartNumber:
Cyan toner cartridge part number
MAGENTA PartNumber:
Magenta toner cartridge part number
BLACK PartNumber:
Black toner cartridge part number
Quantity:
Order quantity
CounterInformation:
Counter information
PrintCounter (Small) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black:
Print count (Small size) for Full color, Twin color and Black
PrintCounter (Large) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black:
Print count (Large size) for Full color, Twin color and Black
ScanCounter FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: Scan count
Scan count for Full color, Twin color and Black
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 19
10
(3)
Result list
*1 Part not to be ordered is not output. (Less space between the lines)
ORDER XXXXXXXXX
:99-99-'99 99:99
:XXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
PART NUMBER
TONER CARTRIDGE
CYAN
MAGENTA
YELLOW
BLACK
USED TONER CONTAINER
QUANTITY
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
: XXXXXXXXXXXX
99
99
99 (*1)
99
99
PRINT COUNTER
SCAN COUNTER
TOTAL
999999999
999999999
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
BLACK
999999999
999999999
TWIN COLOR
999999999
999999999
FULL COLOR
999999999
999999999
TONER INFORMATION
YELLOW REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
MAGENTA REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
CYAN REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
BLACK REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
:
:
:
:
00000059
00000059
00000059
00000059
Fig.10-21
ORDER SUCCESSFUL/FAILURE:
DATE & TIME:
CUSTOMER NUMBER:
CUSTOMER NAME:
CUSTOMER ADDRESS:
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER:
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS:
SERVICE TECHNICIAN TEL NUMBER:
SERVICE TECHNICIAN E-MAIL:
SUPPLIER NAME:
SUPPLIER ADDRESS:
PART NUMBER:
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 20
QUANTITY:
TONER CARTRIDGE:
Order quantity
Toner cartridge
CYAN: Cyan
MAGENTA: Magenta
YELLOW: Yellow
BLACK: Black
USED TONER CONTAINER:
Used toner container (waste toner box)
DESCRIPTION AREA:
Remarks
DEVICE DESCRIPTION:
Model name (MFP model name)
SERIAL NUMBER:
Serial number
DEVICE FAX NUMBER:
Fax number
DEVICE E-MAIL ADDRESS:
E-mail address
PRINT COUNTER:
Print count
SCAN COUNTER:
Scan count
TOTAL:
Total
BLACK:
Black
TWIN COLOR:
Twin color
FULL COLOPY:
Full color
YELLOW REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
Toner remaining quantity (Yellow)
MAGENTA REMAINING QUANTITY (%) Toner remaining quantity (Magenta)
CYAN REMAINING QUANTITY (%)
Toner remaining quantity (Cyan)
BKACKREMAINING QUANTITY (%)
Toner remaining quantity (Black)
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 21
Outline
This function automatically notifies the status of the equipment to the service technician by E-mail or
FAX. The following three are the items to be notified.
PM counter notification
When this function is effective, it notifies that the PM timing has come when the present PM count
has reached to its setting value, or the present PM driving count has reached to its setting value.
10.2.2
Setting
Notes:
When using this function, it is required that sending and receiving E-mails or FAXes are
available. Confirm the details to the administrator.
[ 1 ] Preparation
The screen to set this function is not displayed at the default setting.
Set this screen to be displayed with the following code (08).
08-9604 Setting of notification display
0: Invalid (Default)
1: Valid
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 22
[ 2 ] Setting procedure
(1)
Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button and select the [ADMIN] button. Then enter the password
and press the [OK] button.
Confirm the password to the administrator.
Fig.10-22
(2)
10
Fig.10-23
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 23
(3)
Fig.10-24
(4)
Fig.10-25
(5)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 24
Fig.10-26
Press the [FAX NUMBER] button, key in the FAX number and then press the [OK] button.
10
Fig.10-27
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 25
(6)
Press the [ON] button to notify or the [OFF] button not to notify each item for E-mail and FAX.
When Total Count Transmit is set to ON, the screen to set the notification date is displayed.
Then set the notification date with the following procedure.
Fig.10-28
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 26
Fig.10-29
Key in the date (acceptable values: 0-31) in Notify Date 1 or Notify Date 2 and press the [OK]
button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 27
10
Fig.10-30
Notes:
Service Notification setting is also available from the following setting mode (08).
Items
08 code
Contents
9793
9794
9607
9608
9784
9795
9796
9880
0 to 31
9881
9606
1 byte
00000000(0)-01111111(127)
From the 2nd bit - Sunday, Monday,
Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday,
Saturday
00:00-23:59
9605
9797
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 28
10.2.3
Items to be notified
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Date
: 04/26/2012 12:34
Machine Model : TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
SerialNumber : 1234567890
Total Counter : 00004787
Supplier:
Name
: SUPPLIER_NAME
Tel Number : 1122334455
E-Mail
: Supplier_emailaddress@cccc.xxx
Address
: SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
Customer:
Name
: CUSTOMER_NAME
Tel Number : 1234567890
E-Mail
: customer_emailaddress@dddd.xxx
Address
: CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
Service Technician:
Number
: svc12
Name
: SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
Tel Number : 0987654321
E-Mail
: svc@toshibatec.co.jp
ChargeCounterFormat:
LargeSizeChargeCount
1
LargeSizeChargePaperDefinition
1
PMCounterFormat:
LargeSizePMCount
1
LargeSizePMPaperDefinition 0
Charge Counter:
Large
Small
<Print Counter>
Full Color ------------------------------------Copy
00000000 00000000
Print
00000000 00000000
Twin Color -----------------------------------Copy
00000000 00000000
Black -----------------------------------------Copy
00000000 00000000
Print
00000000 00000000
List
00000000 00000000
FAX
00000000 00000000
<Scan Counter>
Full Color ------------------------------------Copy Scan
00000000 00000000
Net Scan
00000000 00000000
Twin Color -----------------------------------Copy Scan
00000000 00000000
Black -----------------------------------------Copy Scan
00000000 00000000
FAX Scan
00000000 00000000
Net Scan
00000000 00000000
<FAX Counter>
Transmit
00000000 00000000
Receive
00000000 00000000
10
Fig.10-31
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 29
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
Pages
Drive Counts
-----------------------------------------------------------------K-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
Y-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
M-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
C-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
-----------------------------------------------------------------K-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
Y-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
M-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
C-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
-----------------------------------------------------------------Others
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
(*1)
Toner Information
46
47
48
49
Toner
Remaining Quantity (%)
-----------------------------------------------------------------Yellow
00000000
Magenta
00000000
Cyam
00000000
Black
00000000
Fig.10-32
Date
Serial number
Supplier information
Customer information
10
11
12
13
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 30
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
PM count setting value / PM driving count setting value [Developer material (K)]
36
PM count present value / PM driving count present value [Developer material (K)]
37
PM count setting value / PM driving count setting value [Developer material (Y)]
38
PM count present value / PM driving count present value [Developer material (Y)]
39
PM count setting value / PM driving count setting value [Developer material (M)]
40
PM count present value / PM driving count present value [Developer material (M)]
41
PM count setting value / PM driving count setting value [Developer material (C)]
42
PM count present value / PM driving count present value [Developer material (C)]
43
44
45
History error
*1 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 31
10
46
47
48
49
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 32
DATE
MACHINE MODEL
SERIAL NUMBER
TOTAL COUNTER
: 12/04/14 13:47
: TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
: 1234567890
: 00004787
CUSTOMER NAME
CUSTOMER ADDRESS
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS
: CUSTOMER_NAME
: CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
: 1234567890
: customer_emailaddress@dddd.xxx
: svc12
: SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
: 0987654321
: svc@toshibatec.co.jp
SUPPLIER NAME
SUPPLIER ADDRESS
SUPPLIER FAX NUMBER
SUPPLIER E-MAIL
: SUPPLIER_NAME
: SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
: 5544332211
: supplier_emailaddress@ccccc.xxx
Fig.10-33
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 33
Sheet 2
COUNTER NOTIFICATION (*1)
CHARGE COUNTER FORMAT
8
9
PM COUNTER FORMAT
:1
:1
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
:1
:0
10 11
CHARGE COUNTER
PRINT COUNTER
FULL COLOR
COPY
PRINT
TWIN COLOR
COPY
PRINT
BLACK
COPY
PRINT
LIST
FAX
LARGE
00000000
00000000
LARGE
00000000
00000000
LARGE
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
LARGE
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
22
SCAN COUNTER
FULL COLOR
COPY SCAN
NET SCAN
TWIN COLOR
COPY SCAN
LARGE
00000000
00000000
LARGE
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
23
24
25
BLACK
COPY SCAN
FAX SCAN
NET SCAN
LARGE
00000000
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
00000000
20
21
FAX COUNTER
26
27
TRANSMIT
RECEIVE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
(K-EPU PAGES)
(K-EPU PAGES)
(K-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(K-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(Y-EPU PAGES)
(Y-EPU PAGES)
(Y-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(Y-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(M-EPU PAGES)
(M-EPU PAGES)
(M-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(M-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(C-EPU PAGES)
(C-EPU PAGES)
(C-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(C-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(K-DEV PAGES)
(K-DEV PAGES)
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
Fig.10-34
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 34
Sheet 3
COUNTER NOTIFICATION (*1)
64
TIME
16:44
22:28
22:23
22:23
11:12
ERROR CODE
F110
F110
F110
F110
F110
COUNTER
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
DATE
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
TIME
16:44
16:44
16:44
16:44
16:44
ERROR CODE
F110
F110
F110
F110
F110
COUNTER
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
(*2)
TONER INFORMATION
65
66
67
68
:
:
:
:
00000059
00000059
00000059
00000059
Fig.10-35
Date
Serial number
Customer information
Supplier information
10
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 35
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 36
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
History of error
*2 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
65
66
67
68
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 37
1
2
3
4
5
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
Date
: 04/26/2012 12:34
Machine Model : TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
SerialNumber : 1234567890
Total Counter : 00004787
Supplier:
Name
: SUPPLIER_NAME
Fax Number : 1122334455
E-Mail
: Supplier_emailaddress@cccc.xxx
Address
: SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
Customer:
Name
: CUSTOMER_NAME
Tel Number : 1234567890
E-Mail
: customer_emailaddress@dddd.xxx
Address
: CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
Service Technician:
Number
: svc12
Name
: SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
Tel Number : 0987654321
E-Mail
: svc@toshibatec.co.jp
ChargeCounterFormat:
LargeSizeChargeCount
1
LargeSizeChargePaperDefinition
1
PMCounterFormat:
LargeSizePMCount
1
LargeSizePMPaperDefinition 0
Charge Counter:
Large
Small
<Print Counter>
Black -----------------------------------------Copy
00000000 00000000
Print
00000000 00000000
List
00000000 00000000
FAX
00000000 00000000
<Scan Counter>
Full Color ------------------------------------Net Scan
00000000 00000000
Black -----------------------------------------Copy Scan
00000000 00000000
FAX Scan
00000000 00000000
Net Scan
00000000 00000000
<FAX Counter>
Transmit
00000000 00000000
Receive
00000000 00000000
Fig.10-36
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 38
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
Pages
Drive Counts
-----------------------------------------------------------------K-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
-----------------------------------------------------------------K-EPU
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
-----------------------------------------------------------------Others
Setting
00000000 00000000
Current
00000000 00000000
(*1)
Toner Information:
29
30
31
32
Toner
------------------------------------------------------------------Yellow
00000000
Magenta
00000000
Cyan
00000000
Black
00000000
10
Fig.10-37
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Date
Machine model name
Serial number
Total counter value
Supplier information
Customer information
Service technician information
Count setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Count setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages at the List Print Mode (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (Full color)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (BLACK)
Number of transmitted pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 39
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 40
1
2
3
4
DATE
MACHINE MODEL
SERIAL NUMBER
TOTAL COUNTER
: 12/04/14 13:47
: TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxxx
: 1234567890
: 00004787
CUSTOMER NAME
CUSTOMER ADDRESS
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS
: CUSTOMER_NAME
: CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
: 1234567890
: customer_emailaddress@dddd.xxx
: svc12
: SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
: 0987654321
: svc@toshibatec.co.jp
SUPPLIER NAME
SUPPLIER ADDRESS
SUPPLIER FAX NUMBER
SUPPLIER E-MAIL
: SUPPLIER_NAME
: SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
: 5544332211
: supplier_emailaddress@ccccc.xxx
Fig.10-38
10
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 41
Sheet 2
8
9
PM COUNTER FORMAT
:1
:1
CHARGE COUNTER
12
13
14
15
PRINT COUNTER
BLACK
COPY
PRINT
LIST
FAX
:1
:0
10 11
LARGE
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
LARGE
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
16
17
18
19
SCAN COUNTER
FULL COLOR
NET SCAN
BLACK
COPY SCAN
FAX SCAN
NET SCAN
LARGE
00000000
LARGE
00000000
00000000
00000000
SMALL
00000000
SMALL
00000000
00000000
00000000
FAX COUNTER
20
21
TRANSMIT
RECEIVE
22
23
24
25
26
27
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
34
TIME
16:44
22:28
22:23
22:23
11:12
(K-EPU PAGES)
(K-EPU PAGES)
(K-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(K-EPU DRIVE COUNTS)
(K-DEV PAGES)
(K-DEV PAGES)
ERROR CODE
F110
F110
F110
F110
F110
:
:
:
:
:
:
COUNTER
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
SETTING VALUE
CURRENT VALUE
DATE
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
08/04/13
TIME
16:44
16:44
16:44
16:44
16:44
ERROR CODE
F110
F110
F110
F110
F110
COUNTER
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
:
:
:
:
:
:
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
28
29
30
31
32
33
(*2)
Fig.10-39
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 42
Sheet 3
35
36
37
38
39
40
Point Of Destination
0
Used History
Developer Counter
Developer Driving Time
Drum Driving Time
00000000
00000000
1
00000056
00000057
00000058
Toner Information
41
42
43
44
:
:
:
:
00000059
00000060
00000061
00000062
Fig.10-40
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
Date
Machine model name
Serial number
Total counter value
Customer information
Service technician information
Supplier information
Count setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Count setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages at the List Print Mode (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (Full color)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (BLACK)
Number of transmitted pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of received pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
PM count setting value [EPU (K)]
PM count present value [EPU (K)]
PM driving count setting value [EPU (K)]
PM driving count present value [EPU (K)]
PM count setting value [Developer material (K)]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 43
10
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 44
4
5
6
7
10
11
SerialNumber:1234567890
3
Function: Printer
Severity: Error
ErrorCode: XXXX
Message:
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
Supplier:
Name
Tel Number
E-Mail
Address
: SUPPLIER_NAME
: 1122334455
: supplier_emailaddress@cccc.xxx
: SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
Customer:
Name
Tel Number
E-Mail
Address
: CUSTOMER_NAME
: 1234567890
: customer_emailaddress@dddd.xxx
: CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
Service Technician:
Number
: svc12
Name
: SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
Tel Number : 0987654321
E-Mail
: svc@toshibatec.co.jp
10
(*1)
Toner Information
12
13
14
15
Toner
Remaining Quantity(%)
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Yellow
00000000
Magenta
00000000
Cyan
00000000
Black
00000000
Fig.10-41
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 45
Serial number
Error code
Supplier information
Customer information
10
11
History of error
*1 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
12
46
13
14
15
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
REMOTE SERVICE
10 - 46
Updating method
USB device
Download jig
(PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F)
System firmware
Engine firmware
Scanner firmware
System software
USB device
Options
Model name
Firmware
Updating method
PFC firmware
Finisher
(MJ-1036)
Finisher
(MJ-1037)
Hole Punch Unit
(MJ-6008)
FAX Unit
(GD-1320)
Finisher firmware
USB device
Download jig
(K-PWA-DLM-320F)
USB device
Finisher firmware
USB device
USB device
FAX firmware
Download jig
(K-PWA-DLM-320F)
RADF firmware
USB device
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 1
11
A. System firmware/
Engine firmware/
Scanner firmware /
System software/
RADF firmware /
PFC firmware /
Punch firmware /
Finisher firmware
USB media
Fig.11-1
P. 11-9
B. System firmware
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2
ROM1
ROM2
Fig.11-2
System firmware
P. 11-33
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 2
Fig.11-3
C
D
P. 11-35
P. 11-37
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 3
Notes:
Written firmware varies depending on the kinds of the boards provided as service parts. For
updating, only the minimum firmware is installed on the system control PC board, logic PC board,
and scanning section control PC board. No firmware is installed on the FAX board. The latest
version of the firmware at the time of delivery is written on the RADF control PC board and
finisher control PC board.
When any of above boards is replaced with a new one in the field, check the other firmware
version used and then update with a corresponding suitable version.
The system firmware is not installed on the SSD provided as a service part. When the hard disk
is replaced with a new one, check the other firmware version used and then write a
corresponding suitable version.
"Can't fetch Ver." is displayed in the Installed Version field when the version of the installed
firmware cannot be acquired properly. If a normal power on is not performed after the firmware is
updated and the [ON/OFF] button is pressed while simultaneously holding down the [4] and [9]
buttons, "Can't fetch Ver." may be displayed on the control panel for some firmwares. A normal
power on must be performed.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 4
Stored
System firmware
System control PC
board
(SYS board)
Engine firmware
Logic PC board
(LGC board)
System control PC
board
(SYS board)
SSD / HDD
Scanner firmware
System software
Display
SYSTEM FIRMWARE
(OS Data)
SYSTEM SOFTWARE
(HD Data)
ENGINE FIRMWARE
SCANNER FIRMWARE
11
Option
Firmware
RADF firmware
PFC firmware
Punch firmware
(MJ-6008)
Finisher firmware
(MJ-1036)
Finisher firmware
(MJ-1037)
Stored
DLG board
(MR-3024)
PFC board
(GH-1080)
Punch control PC
board (HP)
Finisher control PC
board
Finisher control PC
board
H546DFWW.0xxx
* xxx is version.
T210FWW.xxx
* xxx is version.
PUN6008T.xxx
* xxx is version.
FIN1036T.xxx
* xxx is version.
FIN1037T.xxx
* xxx is version.
Display
RADF FIRMWARE
PFC FIRMWARE
PUNCH FIRMWARE
FINISHER FIRMWARE
FINISHER FIRMWARE
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 5
Store the data file for updating in the model specific folder. This configuration is an example. The
number of files differs depending on the installed option.
20ppm/25ppm, SSD only
Model specific folder name
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T210SF0Wxxxx.tar
T210MWW.xxx
T210SLGWW.xxx
T210HD0Wxxxx.tar
H546DFWW.0xxx
T210FWW.xxx
PUN6008T.xxx
FIN1036T.xxx (When MJ-1036 is connected.)
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-4
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T210SF0Wxxxx.tar
T210MWW.xxx
T210SLGWW.xxx
T569HD0Wxxxx.tar
H546DFWW.0xxx
T210FWW.xxx
PUN6008T.xxx
FIN1036.xxx (When MJ-1036 is connected.)
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 6
LL20ppm/LL25ppm
Model specific folder name
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T230SF0Wxxxx.tar
T210MWW.xxx
T210SLGWW.xxx
T230HD0Wxxxx.tar
H546DFWW.0xxx
T210FWW.xxx
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-6
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 7
Notes:
Since the date and time set in the equipment are recorded in the firmware update log, make sure
that they are correct before updating the firmware.
Never change the model specific folder name, since it is used for identifying the data file when
the data files used for updating multiple models are stored in the USB device.
Important:
Only the USB devices which meet the following conditions should be used for updating. Be
careful since updating with any device other than the above is never guaranteed.
- A combination USB device with a flash memory (to be connected directly to the
USB port) and its capacity is 1GB or more.
- Operation of the USB device used for updating has been confirmed at the input
check of this equipment (Test mode 03). ( P. 5-8 "5.3 Input check (Test mode
03)")
- USB devices which comply with the following standards regulated by USB-IF (USB
Implementers Forum)
Class number:
8 (=08h) (Mass-storage class)
Sub-class number:
6 (=06h) (SCSI transfer command set)
Protocol number:
80 (=50h) (Bulk-Only)
* Most common USB devices comply with the specification above and can be used for
updating. However, the operation in all the Multi Functional Digital Color Systems and
Multi Functional Digital Systems is not necessarily guaranteed since the most of these
devices are developed based on use in a PC environment (Windows or Macintosh).
Therefore, check thoroughly that the device is operational in the equipment for which
the updating will be performed when purchasing it.
The USB devices complying with USB2.0 can be used for updating.
Do not update the firmware by any storage device other than a flash memory (such as a USB
connection type memory card reader, CD/DVD drive or hard disk), since it is never guaranteed.
It is possible to store the model specific update program and the data file for updating directly in
the root directory when you store the updating data file for one specific model in the USB device.
However, if the model specific folder for the same model as that of the data file stored in the root
directory already exists, this will have priority.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 8
11.1.1
Important:
The file system of USB device should be formatted in the FAT or FAT32 format. Be careful since
the devices formatted in NTFS or other format will not be able to be operated. The file system
can be confirmed on the device properties in applications such as Explorer of Windows.
Never shut down the equipment during the update. Firmware data and the following option data
(if installed) could be damaged and may not be able to be operated properly.
- Data Overwrite Enabler (GP-1070)
- Meta Scan Enabler (GS-1010)
- External Interface Enabler (GS-1020)
- IPSec Enabler (GP-1080)
- Hardcopy Security kit (GP-1190A)
[A] Update procedure
(1) Connect the USB device to the PC and write the model specific folder in which the data file is
stored.
Store the data file for updating in the model specific folder.
(2)
(3)
Connect the USB device [1] to the USB port [2] on the right upper cover.
[2]
11
[1]
Fig.11-7
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 9
(4)
Press the [ON/OFF] button while simultaneously holding down the [4] and [9] buttons.
Data in the USB device are checked and the checking status is displayed on the screen.
(5)
#
<
$
>
%
?
&
_
(
^
)
@
=
+
~
[
{
:
}
/
Caps
Space
Ok
Backspace
Reset
Fig.11-8
The screen for selecting items to be updated is displayed after approx. 3 minutes.
On this screen, the current firmware version of this equipment and the firmware version of data to
be updated are displayed.
Fig.11-9
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 10
Notes:
The display of items on this screen varies depending on the types of data written on the USB device.
Each item is displayed only when each data file is written on the USB device in the following
conditions.
Item
1. SYSTEM FIRMWARE (OS Data)
2. ENGINE FIRMWARE
3. SCANNER FIRMWARE
4. SYSTEM SOFTWARE (HD Data)
5. RADF FIRMWARE
6. PFC FIRMWARE
7. PUNCH FIRMWARE
8. SADDLE FIRMWARE
9. FINISHER FIRMWARE
Condition
<20ppm/25ppm: When only SSD is mounted.>
T210SF0Wxxxx.tar is written.
<20ppm/25ppm: When HDD is mounted.>
T210SF0Wxxxx.tar is written.
<LL20ppm/LL25ppm>
T230SF0Wxxxx.tar is written.
(xxxx is version.)
T210MWW.xxx is written. (xxx is version.)
T210SLGWW.xxx is written. (xxx is version.)
<20ppm/25ppm: When only SSD is mounted.>
T210HD0Wxxxx.tar is written.
<20ppm/25ppm: When HDD is mounted.>
T569HD0Wxxxx.tar is written.
<LL20ppm/LL25ppm>
T230HD0Wxxxx.tar is written.
(xxxx is version.)
H546DFWW.0xxx is written.
(When MR-3024 is connected)
* xxx is version.
T210FWW.xxx is written.
(When GH-1080 is connected)
* xxx is version.
PUN6008T.xxx is written.
(When MJ-6008 is connected.)
* xxx is version.
This item is unused.
FIN1036T.xxx is written. (When MJ-1036 is connected.)
FIN1037T.xxx is written. (When MJ-1037 is connected.)
* xxx is version.
If the USB device is not recognized properly, USB device Not detected message is displayed. In
this case, disconnect the USB device and connect again within 3 minutes, or shut down the
equipment and connect the device properly. Then repeat the procedure from (4).
If any of the error messages below is displayed, confirm if the data file in the USB device is correct.
Then repeat the procedure from (4).
Error
number
01
02
03
04
Error message
Error Loadmodule
Machine Model Get Error
05
Cause
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 11
11
Error
number
06
(6)
Error message
Remarks
Updating System firmware
Updating Engine firmware
Updating Scanner firmware
Updating System software
Updating RADF firmware
Updating PFC firmware
Updating Punch firmware
Updating Saddle firmware (Not used)
Updating Finisher firmware
(8)
Item
1. SYSTEM FIRMWARE(OS Data)
2. ENGINE FIRMWARE
3. SCANNER FIRMWARE
4. SYSTEM SOFTWARE (HD Data)
5. RADF FIRMWARE
6. PFC FIRMWARE
7. PUNCH FIRMWARE
8. SADDLE FIRMWARE
9. FINISHER FIRMWARE
(7)
Cause
Update successfully completed Restart the MFP is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen
after the updating is completed properly.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 12
Fig.11-10
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 13
Notes:
Update Failed. is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not
completed properly. Failed appears next to the failed item on the status display. Even
though an update fails, do not turn the power OFF until other updates are finished. If "Update
Failed" appears at the bottom of the screen, turn OFF the power and then check the following
items. After confirming and clearing the problems, restart updating from the beginning.
- Does the USB device meet the conditions to be used for updating?
- Is the data file written properly on the USB device?
- Is the USB device installed properly?
- Do the USB device and equipment operate properly?
When an system firmware (OS Data) update error or system software (HD Data) update error
occurs, "Update Failed" or "Failed" appears on the screen and the error number appears next
to the message.
For details of each error, refer to the following tables.
Error number
O01
O02
O03
O04
O05
O06
Error number
H01
H02
H03
H00
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 14
When an Engine firmware update error, Scanner firmware update error, RADF firmware
update error, Punch firmware update error, Finisher firmware update error or PFC firmware
update error occurs, "Update Failed" or "Failed" appears on the screen and the error number
and error message appear next to the message. For details of each error, refer to the
following tables.
Error number
M01
M02
M03
M04
M05
M06
M07
M08
M09
M10
M00
Error number
S01
S02
S03
S05
S06
S08
S09
S10
S00
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Checksum error
(When the download is finished)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
Other error
Time out
(When the download is requested)
Time out
(When the download is written)
Time out
(When the download is finished)
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
Other error
11
Error content
Communication timeout
(When the download is requested)
Communication timeout
(When the download is written)
Communication timeout
(When the download is finished)
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
Other error
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 15
Error number
R01
R02
R03
R05
R06
R08
R09
R10
R21
R23
R00
Error number
F01
F02
F03
F04
F05
F06
F07
F08
F09
F10
F00
Error number
U01
Time out
(When the download is requested)
Time out
(When the download is written)
Time out
(When the download is finished)
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
RADF Uninstallation
RADF Firmware model mismatch
Other error
Error content
Communication timeout
(When the download is requested)
Communication timeout
(When the download is written)
Communication timeout
(When the download is finished)
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
RADF not installed
RADF ROM for different model
data connected
Other error
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 16
Error number
U02
U03
U04
U05
U06
U07
U08
U09
U10
U00
Error number
F01
F02
F03
F04
F05
F06
F07
F08
F09
F10
F00
(9)
Error content
Time out
(When the download is written)
Time out
(When the download is finished)
Reception failed
(When the download is requested)
Communication timeout
(When the download is written)
Communication timeout
(When the download is finished)
Downloading request was denied.
(When the download is requested)
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Checksum error
(When the download is finished)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
Other error
Deletion error
(When the download is written)
Writing error
(When the download is written)
Checksum error
(When the download is finished)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is requested)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is written)
Reception status code abnormality
(When the download is finished)
Other error
Press the [ON/OFF] button to shut down the equipment, and then remove the USB device.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 17
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 18
[System firmware]
[Engine firmware]
[Scanner firmware]
[System software]
1. SYSTEM
FIRMWARE
(OS Data)
2. ENGINE
FIRMWARE
3.SCANNER
FIRMWARE
4. SYSTEM
SOFTWARE
(HD Data)
[RADF firmware]
5. RADF
FIRMWARE
[Punch firmware]
[PFC firmware]
7. PUNCH
FIRMWARE
6. PFC
FIRMWARE
[Saddle firmware]
8. SADDLE
FIRMWARE
[Finisher firmware]
9. FINISHER
FIRMWARE
Update Completed
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 19
During the update, "Update in progress" is displayed on the right of each item. After it is completed,
"Completed" is displayed there. Example screens of the system firmware update are as follows, and
these are the same for other firmware.
Fig.11-11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 20
Stored
System firmware
System control
PC board
(SYS board)
System software
SSD / HDD
Display
SYSTEM
FIRMWARE(OS Data)
SYSTEM SOFTWARE
(HD Data)
Store the data file for patch updating in the model specific folder.
20ppm/25ppm, SSD only
Model specific folder name
11
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T210SFPWxxxx.tar
T210HDPWxxxx.tar
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 21
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T210SFPWxxxx.tar
T569HDPWxxxx.tar
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-13
LL20ppm/LL25ppm
Model specific folder name
2050C_5050C
USB media
2050C_5050C
T230SFPWxxxx.tar
T230HDPWxxxx.tar
signartures.sig
pubkey.key
plt_integrity.cfg
Fig.11-14
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 22
Notes:
Since the date and time set in the equipment are recorded in the firmware update log, make sure
that they are correct before updating the firmware.
Never change the model specific folder name, since it is used for identifying the data file when
the data files used for updating multiple models are stored in the USB device.
Important:
Only the USB devices which meet the following conditions should be used for updating. Be
careful since updating with any device other than the above is never guaranteed.
- A combination USB device with a flash memory (to be connected directly to the
USB port) and its capacity is 1GB or more.
- Operation of the USB device used for updating has been confirmed at the input
check of this equipment (Test mode 03). ( P. 5-8 "5.3 Input check (Test mode
03)")
- USB devices which comply with the following standards regulated by USB-IF (USB
Implementers Forum)
Class number:
8 (=08h) (Mass-storage class)
Sub-class number:
6 (=06h) (SCSI transfer command set)
Protocol number:
80 (=50h) (Bulk-Only)
* Most common USB devices comply with the specification above and can be used for
updating. However, the operation in all the Multi Functional Digital Color Systems and
Multi Functional Digital Systems is not necessarily guaranteed since the most of these
devices are developed based on use in a PC environment (Windows or Macintosh).
Therefore, check thoroughly that the device is operational in the equipment for which
the updating will be performed when purchasing it.
The USB devices complying with USB2.0 can be used for updating.
Do not update the firmware by any storage device other than a flash memory (such as a USB
connection type memory card reader, CD/DVD drive or hard disk), since it is never guaranteed.
It is possible to store the model specific update program and the data file for updating directly in
the root directory when you store the updating data file for one specific model in the USB device.
However, if the model specific folder for the same model as that of the data file stored in the root
directory already exists, this will have priority.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 23
11
11.2.1
Important:
The file system of USB device should be formatted in the FAT or FAT32 format. Be careful since
the devices formatted in NTFS or other format will not be able to be operated. The file system
can be confirmed on the device properties in applications such as Explorer of Windows.
Never shut down the equipment during the update. Firmware data and the following option data
(if installed) could be damaged and may not be able to be operated properly.
- Data Overwrite Enabler (GP-1070)
- Meta Scan Enabler (GS-1010)
- External Interface Enabler (GS-1020)
- IPSec Enabler (GP-1080)
- Hardcopy Security kit (GP-1190A)
[A] Update procedure
(1) Connect the USB device to the PC and write the model specific folder in which the data file is
stored.
Store the data file for updating in the model specific folder.
(2)
Press the [ON/OFF] button on the control panel to shut down the equipment.
(3)
Connect the USB device [1] to the USB port [2] on the right upper cover.
[2]
[1]
Fig.11-15
(4)
Press the [ON/OFF] button while simultaneously holding down the [4] and [9] buttons.
Data in the USB device are checked and the checking status is displayed on the screen.
(5)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 24
Enter Password
#
<
$
>
%
?
&
_
(
^
)
@
=
+
~
[
{
:
}
/
Caps
Space
Ok
Backspace
Reset
Fig.11-16
The screen for selecting items to be updated is displayed after approx. 3 minutes.
On this screen, the current firmware version of this equipment and the firmware version of data to
be updated are displayed.
11
Fig.11-17
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 25
Notes:
The display of items on this screen varies depending on the types of data written on the USB device.
Each item is displayed only when each data file is written on the USB device in the following
conditions.
Item
1. SYSTEM FIRMWARE(OS Data)
Condition
<20ppm/25ppm: When only SSD is mounted.>
T210SFPWxxxx.tar is written.
<20ppm/25ppm: When HDD is mounted.>
T569SFPWxxxx.tar is written.
<LL20ppm/LL25ppm>
T230SFPWxxxx.tar is written.
(xxxx is version.)
<20ppm/25ppm: When only SSD is mounted.>
T210HDPWxxxx.tar is written.
<20ppm/25ppm: When HDD is mounted.>
T569HDPWxxxx.tar is written.
<LL20ppm/LL25ppm>
T230HDPWxxxx.tar is written.
(xxxx is version.)
If the USB device is not recognized properly, USB device Not detected message is displayed. In
this case, disconnect the USB device and connect again within 3 minutes, or shut down the
equipment and connect the device properly. Then repeat the procedure from (4).
If any of the error messages below is displayed, confirm if the data file in the USB device is correct.
Then repeat the procedure from (4).
Error
number
01
02
03
04
Error message
Error Loadmodule
Machine Model Get Error
(6)
Cause
05
06
Item
1. SYSTEM FIRMWARE(OS Data)
2. SYSTEM SOFTWARE (HD Data)
Remarks
Updating System firmware (OS Data).
Updating System software (HD Data).
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 26
(7)
11
Fig.11-18
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 27
(8)
Patch Update Successful Restart the MFP is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen after
the updating is completed properly.
Fig.11-19
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 28
Notes:
Update Failed. is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not
completed properly. Failed appears next to the failed item on the status display. Even
though an update fails, do not turn the power OFF until other updates are finished. If "Update
Failed" appears at the bottom of the screen, turn OFF the power and then check the following
items. After confirming and clearing the problems, restart updating from the beginning.
- Does the USB device meet the conditions to be used for updating?
- Is the data file written properly on the USB device?
- Is the USB device installed properly?
- Do the USB device and equipment operate properly?
When an System firmware (OS Data) update error or System software (HD Data) update
error occurs, "Update Failed" or "Failed" appears on the screen and the error number appears
next to the message.
For details of each error, refer to the following tables.
(9)
Error number
O01
O02
O03
O04
O05
O06
Error number
H01
H02
H03
H00
11
Press the [ON/OFF] button to shut down the equipment, and then remove the USB device.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 29
Stored
System firmware
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F (16MB)
[1]
[2]
Fig.11-20
[1] Connector (for SYS board connection)
[2] Connector (for ROM writer adapter connection)
Important:
The download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F) is the jig in which the Flash ROM is mounted on the
board directly. Therefore, ROM writer adapter (PWA-DL-ADP-350) is required to write the data to
these Flash ROMs. Refer to the following to write the data.
Remarks: Useable jigs
Download jigs for this equipment are as follows:
No
1
2
3
4
Type of jig
ROM capacity
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2F
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2
16MB
48MB
16MB
48MB
Remarks
*Jigs No. 3 and 4 above can be used if a relay board is installed together even though the shape
of their connectors differ.
* Relay board: PWA-DWNLD-RELAY-50F
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 30
11.3.1
The download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F) is that in which the Flash ROM is mounted on the board
directly. The ROM writer adapter (PWA-DL-ADP-350) is required to write data to these Flash ROMs.
Connect the download jig with the ROM writer via ROM writer adapter to write data. For the procedure
to write data, refer to the downloading procedure, instruction manual of each ROM writer, or other
sources.
[2]
[3]
[1]
[4]
Fig.11-21
[1] PC
[2] Download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F)
[3] ROM writer adapter (PWA-DL-ADP-350)
[4] ROM writer
Notes:
There are two types of the ROM writer adapter. Use the proper one according to the ROM writer
to be used. Applicable type of the adapter for the ROM writer can be confirmed by the model
name indicated on the board. Confirm that the adapter is available for the ROM writer to be used
before connecting them. If an unapplied adapter is connected, the application of the ROM writer
judges it as an error and writing the data cannot be implemented. Applicable combinations of the
ROM writer and adapter are as follows.
ROM writer
model 1881
model 1931
(LV650)
[PWA-DL-ADP-350-1881]
[PWA-DL-ADP-350-1931]
Fig.11-22
Fig.11-23
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 31
11
[A-1]
Binary
From File
To Buffer
From File Address
To Buffer Address
Buffer Size
Clear Buffer Before Loading the file
Normal
Normal
0
0
800100
Clear buffer with blank state
System firmware
Rotary Switch
1
2
3
4
5
6
System firmware
File Name
ex-bpmash_jig_1.bin
ex-bpmash_jig_2.bin
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Flash ROM
ROM1
ROM2
ROM3
ROM4
ROM5
ROM6
Notes:
Be sure not to confuse different ROM Versions since the file name is identical although the ROM
version is different.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 32
11.3.2
System firmware
The firmware of the system firmware can be updated individually by using WA-DWNLD-350-JIG1.
Important:
Be sure to shut down the equipment before installing and removing the download jig.
Do not shut down the equipment during the update. The data could be damaged and not be able
to be operated properly.
[A] Update procedure
(1) Write the ROM data to be updated to the download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F).
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN104) on the SYS board.
(6)
Press the [ON/OFF] button while simultaneously holding down the [8] and [9] buttons.
(7)
(8)
(9)
Update Completed. is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen after the updating is
completed properly.
Notes:
Update Failed. is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not
completed properly. Failed appears next to the failed item on the status display. In this case,
shut down the equipment and check the following items. Then clear the problems and restart
updating from the beginning.
Is the download jig connected properly?
Is the updating data written to the download jig properly?
Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(10) Turn the power OFF using the main power switch, remove the download jig, and then install the
SYS board cover and rear cover.
(11) Perform the initialization of the updating data.
Turn the power ON using the main power switch while pressing the [0] and [8] buttons
simultaneously.
Key in 9030, and then press the [START] button.
Press the [INITIALIZE] button.
[B] Confirmation of the updated data
After the updating is completed, check each data version in the Setting Mode (08) to confirm that the
data was overwritten properly.
P. 11-39 "11.5 Confirmation of the updated data"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 33
11
Stored
Scanner firmware
Options
Model name
Firmware
Stored
RADF firmware
FAX firmware
FAX board
K-PWA-DLM-320F
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Fig.11-24
[1] Connector
[2] Mark for ROM installation direction
[3] LED
[4] ROM
Important:
Pay attention to the direction of the ROM.
Remarks: Useable jigs
Download jigs for this equipment are as follows:
No
1
2
Type of jig
Remarks
K-PWA-DLM-320F
K-PWA-DLM-320
*Jig No. 2 above can be used if a relay board is installed together even though the shape of its
connector differs.
* Relay board: PWA-DWNLD-RELAY-34F
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 34
11.4.1
Important:
Be sure to shut down the equipment before installing and removing the download jig.
Do not shut down the equipment during the update. The data could be damaged and not be
operated properly.
[A] Update Procedure
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig (K-PWA-DLM-320F).
Make sure the direction is correct.
(2)
(3)
Fig.11-25
(4)
Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN81) on the RADF control PC board.
11
Connector
Fig.11-26
(5)
Press the [ON/OFF] button while simultaneously holding down the [0] and [8] buttons.
Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(6)
After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks slowly (at an interval
of approx. 0.8 sec.).
The LED starts blinking approx. 15 sec. after the update starts. It is assumed that the update has
failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed or the LED blinks fast (at an
interval of approx. 0.1 sec.). In this case, shut down the equipment and check the following
items. Then clear the problems and restart updating from the beginning.
Is the download jig connected properly?
Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?
Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?
Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 35
(7)
Turn the power OFF using the main power switch, remove the download jig, and then install the
RADF rear cover.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 36
11.4.2
Important:
Before updating the FAX firmware, make sure to print out the current Function list for
maintenance, Function list (ADMIN), Address book list and Group number information. In
case the updating is failed and the registered information of the users is lost for some reason,
re-register the user information referring to the lists and recover it.
Confirm the following items before turning OFF the power of the equipment. Turning OFF the
power may clear the data below.
- Confirm that the MEMORY RX LED is OFF and there are no memory reception data.
- Press the [JOB STATUS] button to display the screen and then confirm that there are no
memory transmission data.
- Print the Mailbox/Relay box report and then confirm that there are no F code data.
[A] Update Procedure
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig (K-PWA-DLM-320F).
Make sure the direction is correct.
(2)
(3)
11
[1]
Fig.11-27
(4)
Connect the download jig [1] with the jig connector [2] on the FAX board.
[1]
[2]
Fig.11-28
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 37
(5)
Press the [ON/OFF] button while simultaneously holding down the [0] and [8] buttons.
Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(6)
After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks.
The LED starts blinking approx. 30 sec. after the update starts. It is assumed that the update has
failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed. In this case, shut down the
equipment and check the following items. Then clear the problems and restart updating from the
beginning.
Is the download jig connected properly?
Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?
Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?
Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(7)
Turn the power OFF using the main power switch on the right-hand surface of the equipment,
remove the download jig, and then install the cover plate.
(8)
Notes:
If the equipment does not work properly after the operation (8), follow the procedure below and
then perform the Clearing the image data in the FAX Clearing Mode to erase the image data in
the memory.
Confirm the destination setting is correct in the Setting Mode (08).
08-9000: Destination setting of the equipment
08-9001: Destination setting of the FAX machine
Turn ON the power while [1] button and [*] button are pressed simultaneously.
Key in 102.
Press the [START] button.
[B] Confirmation of the updated data
After the updating is completed, check each data version in Setting Mode (08) to confirm that the data
were overwritten properly.
P. 11-39 "11.5 Confirmation of the updated data"
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 38
Code
08-9930
08-9901
08-9902
08-8952
08-9900
08-9940
08-9903
08-9904
08-9944
08-9905
Remarks
11
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 39
11.6.1
Procedure
(1)
Update System firmware of the system control PC board (SYS board) using the download jig
(PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F).
Updating with the USB device becomes possible only after the System firmware has been
updated.
See the updating procedure below for details.
P. 11-30 "11.3 Firmware Updating with PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG1F"
(2)
Update System firmware, Engine firmware, Scanner firmware, System software, RADF
firmware, Punch firmware, Finisher firmware, and FAX firmware using the USB device.
See the updating procedure below for details.
P. 11-5 "11.1 Firmware Updating with USB Device"
(3)
When the update with the USB device for RADF firmware failed, update this firmware using the
respective download jigs in the table below.
Firmware
RADF firmware
Storage location
DLG board
Download jig
K-PWA-DLM-320F
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 40
11.6.2
Update USB.
NO
YES
NO
Update succeeded?
YES
NO
NO
Update USB.
YES
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 41
11
Update USB.
NO
YES
Update USB.
Update succeeded?
NO
YES
Replace HDD.
Update USB.
Check system software version.
(08-9900)
" 11.5 Confirmation of
the updated data "
YES
Update succeeded?
NO
NO
Is system software
version correct ?
YES
Update USB.
" 11.1 Firmware Updating with
USB media
Update completed
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 42
NO
Failed twice or more?
Update USB.
" 11.1 Firmware Updating with
USB media
YES
Clear [Update Error Flags].
Assist Mode :
Turn the power ON with [3] +
[CLEAR] + [ON/OFF]
Clear flags.
[1] -> [START]
11
YES
NO
Failed twice or more?
NO
Update USB.
" 11.1 Firmware Updating with
USB media
Update completed
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 43
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
FIRMWARE UPDATING
11 - 44
General description
Data cloning is a function that backs up user data, setting data and SRAM data into a USB media and
also restores these data into the equipment.
This function backs up or restores the data of the same equipment (same serial number), and is
performed in the following cases.
- When the SYS board and the SRAM board are mistakenly replaced at the same time
- When the SRAM board is replaced
Notes:
The SYS board and SRAM board should never be replaced together.
12.1.2
Precautions
In 20ppm/25ppm, pay attention to the following items since data files for cloning differ depending on
whether an HDD is installed or not.
- A data file, backed up with equipment in which an HDD has been installed, cannot be restored in
one in which there is no HDD.
- A data file, backed up with equipment in which an HDD has not been installed, cannot be restored
in one which has an HDD.
When the ADI-HDD (option) is initialized or replaced, back up the SRAM data afterwards.
It is assumed that data cloning is to be performed when equipment is installed or options are
installed. If the address book has been registered, do not perform restore. Registered / set data are
lost.
The USB media for the data cloning must meet the following conditions. A data cloning operation
with any devices other than the following will not be guaranteed.
- A combination USB media with a flash memory (to be connected directly to the USB port) and its
capacity is 1GB or more.
- A device compliant with the following specifications established by USB-IF (USB Implementers
Forum)
Class number:
8 (=08h)
(Mass storage class)
Sub-Class number: 6 (=06h)
(SCSI transfer command set)
Protocol number:
80 (=50h)
(Bulk-only)
The USB media should be formatted in the FAT or FAT32. (Correct operation cannot be
guaranteed if it is formatted in NTFS/exFAT.)
- Most of the common USB medias are compliant with the above specifications and are therefore
applicable to this data cloning. However, most of these devices were originally developed to be
used in an environment for PCs (e.g. Windows or Macintosh) and thus operations exclusively
with this equipment have not been fully guaranteed. Therefore, the user must thoroughly check
in advance whether there will be any problem in operating with this equipment when adopting
one of these devices.
The USB medias compliant with both USB 1.1 and USB 2.0 can be used for this data cloning.
Data cloning with any storage devices other than a flash memory (e.g. USB-connectable memory
card reader, CD/DVD drive, hard disk) will never be guaranteed. Therefore never use them for this
operation.
Be sure to unplug the LAN cable and Fax line before data are backed up / restored. Also, do not use
the RADF and open the cover, drawer, etc. during the data cloning.
Data can be backed up / restored only for the same model and version. If the version is different,
update the firmware and back up / restore data in the same version.
Restore data to equipment which has the same options as when the data are backed up.
Delete the backed up data in the USB media after the data cloning.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 1
12
12.1.3
Backup files
The following files are saved in the root directory of the USB media by backing up.
Filename
Remark
12.1.4
Cloning procedure
Connect the USB media [1] to the USB port [2] on the right upper cover.
[2]
[1]
Fig.12-1
Notes:
Backing up cannot be performed with multiple USB media [1] connected at the same time.
(3)
Turn the power ON while pressing [6] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(4)
When "SRAM Clear Mode" appears on the LCD, key in [0] to select "0. Set Serial Number" and
then press the [START] button.
(5)
Key in the serial number on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, and then press
the [OK] button.
(6)
(7)
(8)
Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] buttons simultaneously.
(9)
(10) Select "1. Backup SRAM Data to USB", and then press the [START] button.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 2
(11) Enter a password (max. 15 characters) set for the backup data.
(12) "Backup Successfully done Restore the MFP" is displayed on the LCD screen when the backup
has been properly completed.
(13) Press the [ON/OFF] button to shut down the equipment.
12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 3
Connect the USB media [1] to the USB port [2] on the right upper cover.
[2]
[1]
Fig.12-2
Notes:
Backing up cannot be performed with multiple USB media [1] connected at the same time.
(3)
Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] buttons simultaneously.
(4)
(5)
Select "2. Restore SRAM Data from USB", and then press the [START] button.
(6)
Enter the password (max. 15 characters) which has been set in (6) of "[A] Backup procedure".
(7)
(8)
"Restore successfully done Restart the MFP" is displayed on the LCD screen when the restoring
has been properly completed.
(9)
Notes:
To perform cloning with the SRAM data backed up before the ADI-HDD (option) is initialized or
replaced, follow the procedure below after the restoration is finished.
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [3] and the [CLEAR] button simultaneously.
(2) Enter the password, and then press the [OK] button.
(If no password is set for Service, press the [OK] button without entering anything.)
(3) Key in [5] to select "5. Key Backup Restore", and then press the [START] button.
(4) Key in [6] to select "6. ADIKey FROM to SRAM", and then press the [START] button.
(5) Wait until the restoring of the encryption key is completed. "Operation Complete" is displayed.
(6) Then turn the power OFF.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 4
Firmware Version : x. x. x. x
Update Mode
: 59 Mode
Backup Failed
USB device not detected
Fig.12-3
In this case, turn the power OFF and then check the following items. After confirming and solving the
problem, back up / restore the data again from the beginning.
Does the USB media meet the conditions being used for this cloning?
Is the updated program file written on the USB media properly?
Is the USB media installed properly?
Is the USB media or the equipment damaged?
12
Backup
Display content
Error content
Display content
Error content
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 5
Restore
Display content
Error content
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 6
General description
Data encryption is a function that encrypts data in the HDD or SSD to enhance the security.
Note that this function may affect the equipment performance.
12.2.2
Precautions
When the data encryption function is set enabled, data currently stored in the HDD or SSD will not be
retrieved. Therefore when data encryption function needs to be enabled after the installation of the
equipment, it is necessary to back up the data in the HDD or SSD before setting this function and then
recover them after the setting.
To ensure security, ask the user (machine administrator) to back up or restore the users data
and information in the HDD or SSD. A service technician can back up or restore them only
when the user (machine administrator) permits it.
Some data in the HDD or SSD cannot be backed up and can be left only on printouts.
When the data encryption function is enabled, the following items are restricted.
08-9112 (Auto Shut Off Mode timer setting (Sleep Mode)) is automatically set to 20: Not
used.
08-9113 (Screen setting for automatic energy saver/automatic power OFF) is automatically
set to 0: OFF.
When the [ENERGY SAVER] button is pressed on the control panel, the equipment does not
enter the sleep mode.
Since the energy saver mode cannot be set using the control panel, set it in TopAccess.
However, the setting of Sleep/Auto Shut Off cannot be changed in TopAccess and Disable
is displayed.
12
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 7
12.2.3
Setting procedure
Start
[A] Back up data in HDD or SSD
[B] Print out "FUNCTION FOR MAINTENANCE"
[C] Print out "FUNCTION" list
[D] Erase HDD or SSD
[E] Reset user's setting item and restore data/information
[F] Reset "FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE"
[G] Reset "FUNCTION" list
[H] Check actuation of data encryption function setting
Setting completed
Fig.12-4
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 8
Availability
Available
Available
Available
Role information
Available
Not available
Not available
Not available
Not available
Backup method
(3)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 9
12
Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.
(3)
(4)
Notes:
Explain the procedure to the user (machine administrator) and ask him/her to enter his/her
password.
[D] Enable data encryption function
Perform the setting of the data encryption function in the code 08-9379. The setting values are shown
below.
0: Encryption disabled
1: Encryption enabled (Security priority)
2: Encryption enabled (Performance priority)
Security priority: All user data are encrypted.
Performance priority: Encryption data are generated only in a copying or a printing process temporarily.
All user data except files which are deleted in a corresponding process are encrypted.
[E] Reset users setting items and restore data/information
Ask the user (machine administrator) to reset the users setting items and to restore data or information.
Refer to the following for the reset and restore:
Items to reset/restore
Printer driver
F-code information, Template
registering information, Address
book data
Department management data
Image data in the e-Filing
Role information
Method
Notes:
When the SSL is enabled, perform the setting of the following items again with Create selfcertificate of TopAccess.
Country Name
State or Province Name
Locality Name
Organization Name
Organizational Unit Name
Common Name
Email Address
When wireless LAN is used, perform the setting again on the LCD panel. (only when security
with a certificate is used) Also, upload the following certificate file with Install Certificate for
Wireless LAN of TopAccess.
-
CA certificate
User certificate
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 10
While pressing [1] and [3] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Function Mode)
(3)
Compare the lists which were printed before and after the formatting to check the setting items
having the different setting values. Set the value which was set before the formatting
Turn the power OFF.
(4)
Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.
(3)
Press the [FAX] button and then the [TERMINAL ID] button to set each item.
(4)
Notes:
Explain to the user (machine administrator) about the next operation and ask him/her to enter
his/her password.
[H] Check actuation of data encryption function setting
Check if the data encryption function is in operation.
Press the [COUNTER] button on the control panel. If a key-shaped icon is displayed at the top right of
the screen, the data encryption function is in operation.
12
Fig.12-5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 11
12.2.4
The basic procedure is the same as the one for enabling this function. To disable it, set 0 (Invalid) in
the code 08-9379 at step P. 12-10 "[D] Enable data encryption function".
12.2.5
Set the data encryption function disabled following the procedure shown in P. 12-12 "12.2.4
Procedure for disabling data encryption function". Then perform the code 3C->6 : Erase HDD Securely
(HDD securely erasing) to completely erase the data in the HDD.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 12
General description
The High Security Mode is a security mode complying with the IEEE2600.1 Security Standards
Requirement. To have the equipment enter this mode, follow the procedure and the precautions below.
12.3.2
Prior confirmation
Confirm that the administrator for the equipment is authorized and ask him/her to observe the
installation.
To have the equipment enter the High Security Mode, make sure that the HDD (opiton) is mounted.
To have the equipment enter the High Security Mode, the Data Overwrite Enabler GP-1070
(optional) is required. Confirm that this option is installed in advance. Follow the Unpacking
Instructions to install it.
To avoid physical security problems, such as hardware removal or inappropriate disassembly at the
installation site, take all necessary measures, such as checking who enters and leaves the site.
Confirm that no received fax data or print jobs in progress exist. If there are any, be sure to print
them all out before entering the High Security Mode.
The HDD is initialized in the High Security Mode. Be sure first to back up user data such as
documents, Address Book, templates or fax settings using the export function or the backup/restore
utility of the TopAccess. Refer to items noted in P. 12-7 "12.2 AES Data Encryption Function
Setting".
Make a note of the settings on the Administration tab page of the TopAccess in advance.
Compatibility of cloning data is lost between the High Security Mode and the normal mode;
therefore, cloning data cannot be imported.
Downloaded from
Normal mode
Normal mode
High Security Mode
High Security Mode
12.3.3
Compatibility
of cloning data
Yes
No
No
Yes
Downloaded to
Normal mode
High Security Mode
Normal mode
High Security Mode
(1)
Set the value of the code 08-8911 (Security mode level setting) to 3 (High). Then restart the
equipment.
(2)
A key-shaped icon appears at the bottom of the touch panel, indicating that it is now in the High
Security Mode.
(3)
Press [COUNTER] button on the control panel. If a key-shaped icon, indicating that the HDD
data are being encrypted, a paper-shaped icon indicating that the Data Overwrite Enabler is
operating normally and the version name of the installed system ROM (SYS V1.0) are displayed
on the top right of the counter menu, this means the mode is operating normally.
(4)
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 13
12
12.3.4
Precautions
In the High Security Mode, an integrity check system is operated at every restart. If F521 (integrity
check error) is displayed, take the necessary measures following the troubleshooting procedure.
When a self-diagnostic mode is started in the High Security Mode, an authentication screen
appears. Enter the default user name and password as follows:
Default user name: service
Default password: #1048#
If a password change screen appears, reset the password according to the rules below.
- It must not include the user name.
- It must be a combination of letters of the alphabet and numbers.
- It must be 6 characters or more. (Maximum 64 characters)
- The same character must not be repeated 4 times within the new password.
- The old and the new passwords must not be the same.
In the High Security Mode, restrictions are set to the following self-diagnostic codes:
Code
08-8910
08-8911
08-8924
08-9110
08-9193
08-9379
08-9819
Contents
The setting value is changed to 2. 0 is not settable.
The setting value is changed to 3.
The setting value is changed to 1. Values other than 1 are not settable.
0 is not settable.
If 0 is set for the value, the setting will not comply with IEEE2600.1 Security Standards
Requirement.
The setting value is changed to 1.
The setting value is changed to 1. If 0 is set for the value, the setting will not comply
with IEEE2600.1 Security Standards Requirement.
In the above case, the password is not reset. The password setting can be changed with the code
08-8919.
The HDD is initialized (and the saved user data are deleted) when the equipment returns to the
normal mode from the High Security Mode. Be sure to back up user data before having it do so.
After the equipment enters the High Security Mode, ask the administrator for the equipment to select
[FULL] and perform the Integrity check manually.
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
BACKUP FUNCTION
12 - 14
13.2 Signal
Notes:
Use 24V supplied from the main equipment as power for the output signals (CTRON) from the transistor.
Do not connect inductive loads, such as a mechanical counter or a relay coil.
13.2.1
Pin Layout
I/O
Signal
name
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
Power +24V
Out
CTRON
-
In
CTRCNT
Out
MCRUN
Out
EXTCTR
10
GND
11
Out
PG
BKCTR
12
Out
MNCTR
13
Out
FLCTR
14
GND
15
Out
SG
SIZE3
16
Out
SIZE2
17
Out
SIZE1
18
Out
SIZE0
19
Power
20
+5V
(Sleep)
N.C.
Function
Voltage level
24V line
Total Counter On
Signal
Copy permission
Signal 1
Ready to Copy
Signal
Exit Sensor On
Signal
Power ground
Black mode
Counter Signal
Mono color mode
Counter Signal
Full color mode
Counter On Signal
Signal Ground
Paper size Signal
3
Paper size Signal
2
Paper size Signal
1
Paper size Signal
0
5V line
-
Remarks
GQ1260
-
DC24V+10%, -5%
Open Collector
L: ON
In use
L=0V, H=DC3.3V
L: Allowed
In use
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
0V
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
0V
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
Open Collector
(Equiv. SN7407)
DC5.1V
L: Operating
In use
L: Operating
In use
In use
L: Operating
L: Operating
L: Operating
L: Operating
L: Operating
L: Operating
L: Operating
In use
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 1
13
I/O
Signal
name
Out
Out
Out
Out
Power
VDD
GND
GND
N.C.
Signal Ground
-
LARGE /
SMALL
FULL
COLOR
TWN/
MON
COLOR
B/W
Open Collector
(Equiv. 74LS07)
Open Collector
(Equiv. 74LS07)
Open Collector
(Equiv. 74LS07)
L: Large size
GQ1260
In use
L: Full color
In use
L: Twin colors
In use
Open Collector
(Equiv. 74LS07)
DC5.1V
L: Black
In use
In use
Function
Voltage level
Remarks
In use
-
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 2
13.2.2
<CTRON KCTRON>
Single count
OFF
ON
Fixed time
Fig.13-1
<MCRUN>
OFF
ON
<CTRON>
Fixed time
OFF
ON
Fixed time
<EXTCTR>
OFF
ON
13
Fig.13-2
ON
Fixed time
Fig.13-3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 3
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 4
13.3 Notices
13.3.1
Setting code
Each signal will be enabled by configuring the setting code 08-9016 (Counter installed externally).
08-9016
0: No external counter (Default)
1: Coin controller
2: Card controller (For Japan only)
13.3.2
1. Setting value
- 08-9016 (Counter installed externally): Set to 2 (Card controller).
- 08-9017 (Setting for counter installed externally): It should be charged precisely according to the
usage.
Example: To charge only when copies are made, set to 1.
- 08-6011 (Definition setting of large sized paper): Set to "0" if only A3 and LD are regarded as
large size. Set to "1" if B4, LG, FOLIO and COMP are done so as well.
13.3.3
1. Setting value
- 08-9016 (Counter installed externally): Set to 1 (Coin controller).
- 08-9017 (Setting for counter installed externally): It should be charged precisely according to the
usage.
Example: To charge only when copies are made, set to 1.
13.3.4
It is not allowed to install more than one external counter (Card Controller and Coin Controller) at the
same time.
13
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 5
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
EXTERNAL COUNTERS
13 - 6
[1]
Black
F1
14 - 1
White
Black
[9]
[16]
[17]
1 1
2 2
J948
1 1
2 2
J947
1 1
2 2
J901
1 1
2 2
J009
[14]
White AC-N(C-LAMP)
J903
AC(N: CST)
1 1
AC(L: CST)
2 2
White
Black
White
Black
White
Black
[4]
[12]
Black AC-L(LAMP)
J904
AC(N: DRM-R)
1 1
AC(L: DRM-R)
2 2
White
Black
White
Black
[10]
White AC-N(S-LAMP)
J906
White
2 2
Black
1 1
[7]
1 CN506
CN505
2
1
White
Black
3 3
2 2
[8]
CN504 1 2
PS-ACC
White
1 2 3 4 CN503
White
White
Black
Black
1 CN502
[5]
CN501 1
[2]
1 2 3 4
[3]
FG
Neutral
A
GND
B
Live
C
J628
1 1
[13]
[15]
[6]
[11]
14
Fig.14-1
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
WIRE HARNESS CONNECTION
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
[9]
[10]
[11]
[12]
[13]
[14]
[15]
[16]
[17]
e-STUDIO2050C/2051C/2550C/2551C
WIRE HARNESS CONNECTION
14 - 2
CN107
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
CNT
A17
SDA/SI
NC/SCS
SCL
INT/SO
/CS
A13
A12
A14
A11
A15
A10
A16
A9
/WR
/BLE
D7
D8
D6
D9
D5
D10
D4
D11
D3
D12
D2
D13
D1
D14
D0
D15
/BHE
/RD
A1
A8
A2
A7
A3
A6
A4
A5
+3.3V
SG
+3.3V
SG
A18
RESET
A19
WAKE #
+3.3V
COEX1
SG
COEX2
+1.5V
CLKREQ #
UIM PWR
SG
UIM DATA
REFCLKUIM CLK
REFCLK+
UIM RESET
SG
UIM VPP
RESERVED
SG
RESERVED
W-DIS #
SG
PERST #
PERn0
+3.3V
PERp0
SG
SG
+1.5V
SG
SMB-CLK
PETn0
SMB-DATA
PETp0
SG
SG
USB DSG
USB D+
+3.3V
SG
+3.3V
LED-WWAN #
SG
LED-WLAN #
RESERVED
LED-WPAN #
RESERVED
+1.5V
RESERVED
SG
RESERVED
+3.3V
DATA0
DATA2
DATA4
DATA6
DATA8
DATA10
DATA12
DATA14
A19
A17
A15
A13
A11
A9
A7
A5
A3
A1
/RD
/CS0-A
/CS0-B
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
SG
SG
DATA1
DATA3
DATA5
DATA7
DATA9
DATA11
DATA13
DATA15
A18
A16
A14
A12
A110
A8
A6
A4
A2
A0
A20
/CS0
+3.3VA
/RMSL
/WR
SG
SG
CN104
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
11
11
12
12
13
13
14
14
15
15
16
16
17
17
18
18
19
19
20
20
21
21
22
22
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
26
27
27
28
28
29
29
30
30
31
31
32
32
33
33
34
34
35
35
36
36
37
37
38
38
39
39
40
40
41
41
42
42
43
43
44
44
45
45
46
46
47
47
48
48
49
49
50
50
CN109
1
2
3
4
VBUS
DD+
SG
LL20ppm/LL25ppm
SG
SG
NC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
NC
DE
HSYNC
VSYNC
CLK
SG
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
B0
G7
G6
G5
G4
G3
G2
G1
G0
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
U/D
L/R
SG
CN6
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Option
20ppm/25ppm
SYS-FAN-MOT
(F1)
LAN Connector
(10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX)
CN103
VCC
1
ROCK
2
SG
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
CN105
1 +5VS
2 SG
3 +12VA
4 +12VA
5 SG
6 SG
7 +5VA
SG
8
+3.3VA
9
SG
10
/FX-INT
11
SG
12
FX-WKUP
13
SG
14
/FX-RST
15
SG
16
USB connector
(Side)
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN110
1
2
3
4
VBUS
DD+
SG
USB connector
(Inner)
USB connector
(FAX)
USB connector
(Device)
Bluetooth module
CN1
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN111
VCD
1
NC
2
NC
3
D4
D+
5
NC
6
NC
7
DETACH
8
NC
9
SG
10
NC
11
NC
12
/RESET
13
NC
14
NC
15
NC
16
NC
17
NC
18
NC
19
SG
20
CN114
1
2
3
4
VBUS
DD+
SG
CN106
NC
1
D2
D+
3
SG 4
CN115
1
2
3
4
+3.3V
TXD
RXD
SG
TXP
TXN
RXP
TXCT
RXCT
RXN
FG
FG
LEDG-A
LEDG-C
LEDY-C
LEDY-A
TCP
(TCP)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
/CK0
/CK1
VDD
VDD
A10, AP
BA1
BA2
/RAS
VDD
VDD
/WE
/S0
/CAS
ODT0
VDD
VDD
A13
ODT1
/S1
NC
VDD
VDD
TEST
VREFCA
VSS
VSS
DQ32
DQ36
DQ33
DQ37
VSS
VSS
/DQS4
DM4
DQS4
VSS
VSS
DQ38
DQ34
DQ39
DQ35
VSS
VSS
DQ44
DQ40
DQ45
DQ41
VSS
VSS
/DQS5
DM5
DQS5
VSS
VSS
DQ42
DQ46
DQ43
DQ47
VSS
VSS
DQ48
DQ52
DQ49
DQ53
VSS
VSS
/DQS6
DM6
DQS6
VSS
VSS
DQ54
DQ50
DQ55
DQ51
VSS
VSS
DQ60
DQ56
DQ61
DQ57
VSS
VSS
/DQS7
DM7
DQS7
VSS
VSS
DQ58
DQ62
DQ59
DQ63
VSS
VSS
SA0
/EVENT
VDDSPD
SDA
SA1
SCL
VTT
VTT
+5V
RET0
RET1
RET2
RET3
RET4
SCAN7
SCAN6
SCAN5
SCAN4
SCAN3
SCAN2
SCAN1
SCAN0
BZ-ON
ENERGY-SAVER
FUNCTION-CLEAR
MEMORY-RX
PRINT-DATA
ERROR
START
POWER-LED
POWER-SW
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
VDD
VDD
U/D
L/R
SG
R0
R1
R2
R3
SG
R4
R5
SG
R6
R7
SG
G0
G1
G2
G3
SG
G4
G5
SG
G6
G7
SG
B0
B1
B2
B3
SG
B4
B5
SG
B6
B7
SG
DCLK
SG
DE
TEST
SG
SG
LED-PWM
LED-EN
LED-POWER
LED-POWER
CN2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
CN6
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
CN5
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN5
1
2
3
PLTN1-SNR
(S21)
PLTN2-SNR
(S22)
HOME-SNR
(S23)
APS2-SNR
(S25)
APS1-SNR
(S24)
LCD
back light
+B
-A
-B
+A
2
3
J125
1
HRNS-SCN-MOT-210
J007
1
NC
2
3
6
NC
5
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
J005
1
2
3
J006
1
2
3
J002
3
2
1
J004
3
2
1
J003
3
2
1
13
14
15
16
10
11
12
7
8
9
4
5
6
J121
1
2
3
CN119
SG 1
+12VA 2
+12VA 3
+12VA 4
+5VS 5
SG 6
CP-CNT1 7
CP-CNT0 8
/CPPSW 9
SG
10
CP-RTS
11
SG
12
CP-CTS
13
SG
14
CP-RXD
15
SG
16
CP-TXD
17
RESET
18
SG
19
TXCLPK
20
TXCLKN
21
SG
22
TXD2P
23
TXD2N
24
SG
25
TXD1P
26
TXD1N
27
SG
28
TXD0P
29
TXD0N
30
SG
31
+12V
SG
SG
CN113
+5V
4
CN112
SG
1
A+ (TXp)
2
A- (TXn)
3
SG
4
B- (RXn)
5
B+ (RXp)
6
SG
7
CN120
L/S
1
FULL-C
2
MONO-C
3
B/W
4
VDD
SG 5
NC 6
7
SG
PLTNSL
+3.3V
NC
SG
PLTNON
+3.3V
SG
HOME
+3.3V
+5V
APSC
SG
+5V
APSR
SG
SCAN-MOT
(M1)
Coin controller/
Copy key card
Option
A4
series
only
J008
J123
DFAK
1
1
DFSCST
2
10
DFRXD
2
3
SG
11
4
DFTXD
3
5
SG
12
6
DFRAK
4
7
DFRRQ
13
8
DFRQ
5
9
DFCNT
14
10
SG
6
11
+5V
7
12
+24VGND
16
13
+24VGND
8
14
+24V
17
15
+24V
9
16
NC
15
FG
18
SYSRST0
SG
YDATA0
YDATA2
SG
YDATA4
YDATA6
SG
MDATA0
MDATA2
SG
MDATA4
MDATA6
SG
FSYNCY0
SG
WCLK1
SG
SCNENB
FSYNCC0
SG
CDATA0
CDATA2
SG
CDATA4
CDATA6
SG
KDATA0
KDATA2
SG
KDATA4
KDATA6
SG
CBSY0
SACK0
SBSY0
CACK0
SG
PWREN
NC
SYSLIFE
SG
YDATA1
YDATA3
SG
YDATA5
YDATA7
SG
MDATA1
MDATA3
SG
MDATA5
MDATA7
SG
FSYNCM0
SG
LSYNC0
SG
LSTB0J
FSYNCK0
SG
CDATA1
CDATA3
SG
CDATA5
CDATA7
SG
KDATA1
KDATA3
SG
KDATA5
KDATA7
SG
CMD0
SERR0
STS0
CERR0
SG
MMPI0
LGCEN1
Option
CN127
1 +24VD
2 PG
SYSRST0
SG
YDATA0
YDATA2
SG
YDATA4
YDATA6
SG
MDATA0
MDATA2
SG
MDATA4
MDATA6
SG
FSYNCY0
SG
WCLK1
SG
NC
FSYNCC0
SG
CDATA0
CDATA2
SG
CDATA4
CDATA6
SG
KDATA0
KDATA2
SG
KDATA4
KDATA6
SG
CBSY0
SACK0
SBSY0
CACK0
SG
PWREN
NC
SYSLIFE
SG
YDATA1
YDATA3
SG
YDATA5
YDATA7
SG
MDATA1
MDATA3
SG
MDATA5
MDATA7
SG
FSYNCM0
SG
LSYNC0
SG
LSTB0J
FSYNCK0
SG
CDATA1
CDATA3
SG
CDATA5
CDATA7
SG
KDATA1
KDATA3
SG
KDATA5
KDATA7
SG
CMD0
SERR0
STS0
CERR0
SG
DET1
LGCEN1
CN101
1 SYS-EN
2 PWR-EN
3 PWE-DN
4 SG
5 +5VS
6 +5VS
7 SG
8 SG
9 +12VA
10 +12VA
11 +12VA
12 SG
13 SG
14 SG
CN127
CN336
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
11
11
12
12
13
13
14
14
15
15
16
16
17
17
18
18
19
19
20
20
21
21
22
22
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
26
27
27
28
28
29
29
30
30
31
31
32
32
33
33
34
34
35
35
36
36
37
37
38
38
39
39
40
40
41
41
42
42
43
43
44
44
45
45
46
46
47
47
48
48
49
49
50
50
51
51
52
52
53
53
54
54
55
55
56
56
57
57
58
58
59
59
60
60
61
61
62
62
63
63
64
64
65
65
66
66
67
67
68
68
69
69
70
70
71
71
72
72
73
73
74
74
75
75
76
76
77
77
78
78
79
79
80
80
CN914
FAX Power
TCP
(TCP)
PWA-F-KEY
(KEY)
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
HRNS-PFU-570
CN102
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
CN513
1
2
CN511
COVER OPEN
3
CN510
+12VA
1
NC
2
HRNS-LVPS-INLCSW-210
HRNS-LVPS-INLCSW2-210
J591
S-COV-INTLCK-SW 1
(SW3)
2
J590
F-COV-INTLCK-SW 1
(SW2)
2
HRNS-LVPS-SYS-210
J937
CN102
CN514
PWREN
1
+12VA
2
SG
3
PG
4
+24VD4
5
+24VD5
6
PG
7
CN512
PWR-DN
1
RLY-ON
2
S LAMP-ON
3
C LAMP-ON
4
NC
5
+12VAF
6
+12VAF
7
NC
8
SG
9
SG
10
PG
11
PG
12
PG
13
NC
14
NC
15
NC
16
NC
17
+24VD1
18
+24VD2
19
+24VD3
20
25 3.3VL
23 CST2NEMP
21 SG
1
2
3
1
VREFDQ
2
VSS
3
VSS
4
DQ4
5
DQ0
6
DQ5
7
DQ1
VSS
8
VSS
9
/DQS0 10
DM0 11
DQS0 12
VSS 13
VSS 14
DQ2 15
DQ6 16
DQ3 17
DQ7 18
VSS 19
VSS 20
DQ8 21
DQ12 22
DQ9 23
DQ13 24
VSS 25
VSS 26
/DQS1 27
DM1 28
DQS1 29
/RESET 30
VSS 31
VSS 32
DQ10 33
DQ14 34
DQ11 35
DQ15 36
VSS 37
VSS 38
DQ16 39
DQ20 40
DQ17 41
DQ21 42
VSS 43
VSS 44
/DQS2 45
DM2 46
DQS2 47
VSS 48
VSS 49
DQ22 50
DQ18 51
DQ23 52
DQ19 53
VSS 54
VSS 55
DQ28 56
DQ24 57
DQ29 58
DQ25 59
VSS 60
VSS 61
/DQS3 62
DM3 63
DQS3 64
VSS 65
VSS 66
DQ26 67
DQ30 68
DQ27 69
DQ31 70
VSS 71
VSS 72
CKE0 73
CKE1 74
VDD 75
VDD 76
NC 77
A15 78
BA2 79
A14 80
VDD 81
VDD 82
A12, /BC 83
A11 84
A9 85
A7 86
VDD 87
VDD 88
A8 89
A6 90
A5 91
A4 92
VDD 93
VDD 94
A3 95
A2 96
A1 97
A0 98
VDD 99
VDD 100
CK0 101
CK1 102
J938
HRNS-PFU-EMP-552
3.3VL
FDS2
SG
PFUJAMCO
SG
PFUCNT
PS-ACC (PS)
CST2SIZEL0-0
CST2SIZEL1-0
SG
CST2SIZEL2-0
CST2SIZEL3-0
19
17
15
13
11
J934
1
2
3
4
5
HRNS-SCN-ADF-210L
HRNS-PFC-LVPS-210
PFU
CN410
1
2
3
4
5
ADU-L-SNR
(S15)
ADU-U-SNR
(S14)
ADU-MOT
(M12)
PWA-H-PFC
Finisher
J755 J755
PWREN
1
1
+12VA
2
2
SG
3
3
PG
4
4
+24VD4
5
5
+24VD5
6
6
PG
7
7
CST1-SW
(SW8)
SG
CST1PE
+3.3V
3
2
1
4
5
6
6
7
8
9
10
SG
4
5
CN401
SG
1
CST1PE
2
+3.3V
3
CST1SZW3-0
CST1SZW2-0
SG
CST1SZW1-0
CST1SZW0-0
CN402
CST1SZL3-0 1
CST1SZL2-0 2
SG
3
CST1SZL1-0
4
CST1SZL0-0
5
CN422
1
2
3
4
SG
ADUJAM2-0
+3.3V
SG
ADUJAM1-0
+3.3V
J754
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
NC
10
11
12
+24VD4
PG
F-CNT
CNT-GND
+5V
SG
FG
9
10
5
6
7
8
CN912
RXD
1
SG
2
TXD
3
SG
4
+3.3V
DLRXD
DLTXD
DLRST
DLROMCNT
BOOT
SG
CN916
1 +3.3V
2 TXD
3 RXD
4 SG
CN911
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
FG2
CN420
CNTOUT-0
1
+3.3V
2
SG
3
+24V
4
+24V
5
PG
6
PG
7
ADUI1B-1
8
ADUPHB-1
9
ADUPHA-1
10
ADUI1A-1
11
ADUVREF-1
12
ADUS1-1
13
ADUS2-1
14
CNTIN-0
15
HRNS-ADU-210
PFP/LCF
HRNS-LGC-PFC-210
CNTOUT-0
+3.3V
SG
+24V
+24V
PG
PG
ADUI1B-1
ADUPHB-1
ADUPHA-1
ADUI1A-1
ADUVREF-1
ADUS1-1
ADUS2-1
CNTIN-0
CN915
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
CN910
LCG Ver
16
PFCRXD-0
15
PFCTXD-0
14
PFCRTS
13
PFCCTS
12
PFCCNT-0
11
PFCSTART-0
10
PFCRST
9
PFCCTL-0
8
+3.3VLSW
7
PFCWDT-0
6
+3.3VL
5
SG
4
RXD
3
TXD
2
F-CNT
1
FG1
J640
1
15
2
14
3
13
4
12
5
11
6
10
7
9
8
8
9
7
10
6
11
5
12
4
13
3
14
2
15
1
HRNS-LGC-ADUCFD-210
CN400
+24V
1
SFBCLT-0C
2
SG
3
SG
4
+3.3V
5
+5VL
6
TBUJAM-1
7
FDS1-0
8
RGSTSNS-1
9
HISSOSFTA
10
HSSIODIA
11
HSSIOCK
12
HRNS-PFC-FIN-210
HRNS-PFC-LVPS2-210
4
5
6
CN421
1
2
3
HRNS-LVPS-LGC-210
J722
3
2
1
J721
3
2
1
HRNS-ADU-SNR-210
J723
ADUMA
1
ADUMAB
5
ADUMBB
6
ADUMB
2
NC
3
NC
4
CST1SW-0
HRNS-ADU-MOT-210
J771
3
2
1
J776
2
1
J854
5
4
3
2
1
J853
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-CFD-PCST-210
6
7
8
9
10
3
4
5
CN403
1
2
SG
RGSTSNS-1
+3.3V
HRNS-SFB-210
SG
SFBSIZE0
SFBSIZE1
SFBSIZE2
SFBSIZE3
CN405
1
2
3
CN404
SG
FDS1-0 1
2
+3.3V
3
SG
TBUJAM-1
+5V
HRNS-CFD-TRU-210
+24V
SFBCLT-0C
CST-SIZE1-SW
(SW6)
20ppm/25ppm
J645
3
2
1
SG
SFBPE
+3.3V
CST-SIZE2-SW
(SW7)
J735
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
J734
3
1
J732
3
2
1
HRNS-PFP-FED-210
J746
3
2
1
Option
CST1-EMP-SNR
(S5)
PWA-F-SFB
(SFB)
SFB-SNR
(S16)
SFB-FEED-CLT
(CLT4)
J790
3
2
1
J791
3
2
1
1
2
3
HRNS-CFD-SNR-210
HRNS-TRU-210
J746
SG
3
TBUJAM-1
2
+5V
1
HRNS-SFB-SIZE-210
RGST-SNR
(S19)
TRANS-SNR
(S20)
CLNG-SNR
(S18)
PWA-F-LGC (LGC)
NC
+24V
+24V
PFUCNT
3.3VL
CST2TRUMT
SG
3.3VL
CST2PE
SG
39
37
35
18
40
34
36
38
24
26
28
J933
1
2
3
4
5
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
22 SG
20 CST2SW
2
1
HRNS-PFU-COV-570
34
32
30
28
26
24
22
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
PFPPLL-0
SCSWB-0
SCSWC-0
SIZE3
SIZE2
SIZE1
SIZE0
PFPSIDECOV-1
PFPFEED1-1
PFPFEED2-1
SG
PFPRST
LCFCNT-0(LCF)
SIODI-1
SIOLD-1
NC
NC
NC
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
CN312
13
14
15
12
7
8
9
10
11
5
6
CN323
1
2
3
4
CN335
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN334
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
INOPTFED-1
INOPTFUL-1
SG
INOPTSEL-1
INOPTSEL-2
INOPTSEL-3
INOPTCOV-1
6
5
4
3
2
1
13
12
11
10
9
8
J696
3
2
1
J697
2
1
J706
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
J639
1
5
6
2
NC 3
NC
4
SIDE-COV-SW
(SW5)
J623
2
1
TRUCO-1
14 SG
15
BETHS-1+
BETHS-1-
BSTHS-1+
BSTHS-1-
SG
8
EXTS-1
9
+3.3V
10
NC
11
NC
12
FSRCNT-1
13
6
7
4
5
FSRCNT-1
BCTHS-1+
BCTHS-1-
THMS-HTR-210
J698
3
1ST-TRNS-SW-SNR
2
(S12)
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
10
9
J627
1
13
2
12
3
11
SG
TR1POS1-0
+3.3V
EXIT-MOT
(M5)
1ST-TRNS-CLT
(CLT3)
Q1
Option
CN422
1
2
HRNS-TR1POS-210
1
2
3
1
2
1
2
3
SG
8
EXTS-1
9
+3.3V
10
FSRNEW-0
11
SG
12
FSRCNT-1
13
BETHS-1+
BETHS-1-
BSTHS-1+
BSTHS-1-
CN301
1 FSRCNT-1
2 BCTHS-1+
3 BCTHS-1-
PWA-EXT
DRM/TBU-MOT
(M6)
HRNS-LGC-FUSER-210
SG
15
TR1POS1-0
16
+3.3V
17
+24V
13
TR1CLT-0C
14
CN333
DRMBRK-0
1
+24V
2
+24V
3
PG
4
PG
5
DRMGA-0
6
DRMPLL-0
7
DRMDIR-0C
8
DRMCK-0
9
DRMON-0
10
NC
11
NC
12
6
7
Q2
FUS-MOT
(M4)
NC
INOPTSOL-0A
+24V
NC
NC
NC
INOPTFED-1
INOPTFUL-1
SG
INOPTSEL-1
INOPTSEL-2
NC
INOPTCOV-1
BRDEXIT-1
+5V
HRNS-LGC-MOT-210
HRNS-LGC-DRM-210
CN337
EXITMA
1
EXITMAB
2
EXITMBB
3
EXITMB
4
10
11
12
13
14
15
3
4
5
6
7
8
CN423
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
HRNS-EXT-MOT-210
CN308
13 CNTOUT-0
12 +3.3V
11 SG
10 +24V
9 +24V
8 PG
7 PG
6 EXTI1B-1
5 EXTPHB-1
4 EXTPHA-1
EXTI1A-1
3
EXTVREF-1
2
CNTIN-0
1
4
5
J621
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-EXT-210
CN306
FSMBRK-0C
1
+24V
2
+24V
3
PG
4
PG
5
FSRGA
6
FSRPLL-0
7
FSMDIR-0C
8
FSMCK-0
9
FSMON-0C
10
SG
11
+5V
12
HRNS-LGC-FSRMOT-210
INOPTSNS
10
INOPTSOL-0A
11
+24V
12
PG
13
NC
14
NC
3
4
5
6
7
8
J691
15
1
2
14
HRNS-LGC-JSP-210
DVCNMTB-0C
DVCNMTA-0C
FDCLT1-0C
+24V
CN303
BRDEXIT-1
1 +5V
2
8
9
1
2
DRM-SW-SNR
(S11)
FEED/DEV-MOT
(M2)
HRNS-BRIDGE-MAIN-210
J661
3
2
1
J783
2
1
J748
3
NC
2
1
J705
2
1
+24V
RGSTCLT-0
CN305
SG
1
DEVPOS-0
2
+3.3V
3
4
5
J707
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN303
FDMBRK-0
1
+24V
2
+24V
3
PG
4
PG
5
FDMGA-0
6
FDMPLL-0
7
FDMDIR-0C
8
FDMCK-0
9
FDMON-0
10
NC
11
NC
12
HRNS-LGC-DEV-210
FEED-CLT
(CLT2)
RGST-CLT
(CLT1)
2
1
2
1
2
1
J826
3
2
1
J804
1
2
J805
1
2
3
J801
1
2
3
J802
1
2
3
J803
1
2
3
EXIT-SNR
(S13)
THMS-FR-E
(THM3)
THMS-FR-S
(THM2)
Option
THMS-FR-C
(THM1)
GATE-SOL
FEED-SNR
OPEN-SW
FULL-SNR
EXT-SNR
DRM-SW-MOT
(M3)
LP-LED-K
(LED4)
LP-LED-C
(LED3)
LP-LED-M
(LED2)
LP-LED-Y
(LED1)
CN327
HSRDY
1
HSCKY
2
HSTBY
3
HDDTY00
4
HDDTY01
5
HDDTY02
6
HDDTY03
7
HDDTY04
8
HDDTY05
9
HDDTY06
10
HDDTY07
11
HSYNCY
12
HOLDY
13
VSS
14
HDCLKYN
15
HDCLKYP
16
VSS
17
VSS
18
VSS
19
VDD3
20
CN326
VDD (5V)
1
VDD (5V)
2
VDD (5V)
3
Logic-G
4
LED-G
5
LED-G
6
LED-G
7
CN327
HSRDM
1
HSCKM
2
HSTBM
3
HDDTM00
4
HDDTM01
5
HDDTM02
6
HDDTM03
7
HDDTM04
8
HDDTM05
9
HDDTM06
10
HDDTM07
11
HSYNCM
12
HOLDM
13
VSS
14
HDCLKMN
15
HDCLKMP
16
VSS
17
VSS
18
VSS
19
VDD3
20
CN332
NC
1
VDD (5V)
2
VDD (5V)
3
VDD (5V)
4
Logic-G
5
LED-G
6
LED-G
7
LED-G
8
CN331
HSRDC
1
HSCKC
2
HSTBC
3
HDDTC00
4
HDDTC01
5
HDDTC02
6
HDDTC03
7
HDDTC04
8
HDDTC05
9
HDDTC06
10
HDDTC07
11
HSYNCC
12
HOLDC
13
VSS
14
HDCLKCN
15
HDCLKCP
16
VSS
17
VSS
18
VSS
19
VDD3
20
CN330
VDD (5V)
2
VDD (5V)
3
VDD (5V)
4
Logic-G
5
LED-G
6
LED-G
7
LED-G
8
CN595
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN329
HSRDK
1
HSCKK
2
HSTBK
3
HDDTK00
4
HDDTK01
5
HDDTK02
6
HDDTK03
7
HDDTK04
8
HDDTK05
9
HDDTK06
10
HDDTK07
11
HSYNCK
12
HOLDK
13
VSS
14
HDCLKKN
15
HDCLKKP
16
VSS
17
VSS
18
VSS
19
VDD3
20
HRNS-LGC-HEADK-210
CN599
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-KLEDP-210
CN594
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-HEADC-210
CN598
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-CLEDP-210
CN592
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-HEADM-210
CN597
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-MLEDP-210
CN592
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-HEADY-210
CN596
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CN328
NC
1
VDD (5V)
2
VDD (5V)
3
VDD (5V)
4
Logic-G
5
LED-G
6
LED-G
7
LED-G
8
HRNS-LGC-YLEDP-210
J-TAG
CN339
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
11
11
+3.3V
TRST
TD0
SG
TDI
TMS
SG
TCK
SRST
SG
+3.3V
CS
D0
WPN
DI
CLK
HOLDN
LED
ROMCNT
SG
NC
PWA-F-LGC (LGC)
PWA-F-SYS (SYS)
CIOCK-1
CLKB-1A
CLKC-1A(LCF)
DRV0
CST2SIZEW0-0
CST2SIZEW1-0
SG
CST2SIZEW2-0
CST2SIZEW3-0
9
7
5
3
1
J935
1
2
3
4
5
HRNS-PFU-CLT-570
10 CST2TUMFA-0
8 CST2TUMFB-0
J936
2
1
J944
1
2
3
1
2
3
J945
DRV1
DRV2
12
14
16
4
6
2
J931
1
2
3
4
5
5
4
3
2
1
J940
1
2
3
1
2
J937
DRV3
DRV4
DRV5
MDLCLT-0
+24V4
MDHCLT-0
+24V4
FDCLT2-0
+24V
J941
NC
NC
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
33
DRV6
DRV7
+5V
SG
PFPCLK
PG
33
31
29
27
30
32
J942
J932
1
2
3
4
5
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
3
1
3
1
3
1
J943
CN913
J949
Download jig
(PFC)
HRNS-PFC-PFP-570
HRNS-PFP-552
PG
PG
B20
B19
B18
B17
B16
B15
B14
B13
B12
B11
B10
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
A20
A19
A18
A17
A16
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15
B16
B17
B18
B19
B20
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
A18
A19
A20
NC
B20
+24V
B19
+24V
B18
PFPPLL-0
B17
SCSWB-0
B16
SCSWC-0
B15
SIZE3
B14
SIZE2
B13
SIZE1
B12
SIZE0
B11
PFPSIDECOV-1
B10
PFPFEED1-1
B9
PFPFEED2-1
B8
SG
B7
PFPRST
B6
NC
B5
SIODI-1
B4
SIOLD-1
B3
NC
B2
NC
B1
NC
A20
NC
A19
NC
A18
CIOCK-1
A17
CLKB-1A
A16
NC
A15
DRV0
A14
DRV1
A13
DRV2
A12
DRV3
A11
DRV4
A10
DRV5
A9
DRV6
A8
DRV7
A7
+5V
A6
SG
A5
PFPCLK
A4
PG
A3
PG
A2
PG
A1
CN241
MATCNT
MATSVR-1J
+24V
MATSN-1T
PG
SG
CATCNT
CATSVR-1J
+24V
CATSN-1T
PG
SG
NC
SG
KDRMNEW
SG
CDRMNEW
SG
MDRMNEW
HRNS-LGC-PSNR-210
TEMP
SG
HMS
+5V
HRNS-LGC-HVT-210
+24V
LVPSFAN-0C
CN324
+3.3VLTNR
1
SCL1-0
2
SOA1-0
3
SG
4
TNRMPK-0
5
TNRMK-0
6
TNRMPC-0
7
TNRMC-0
8
TNRMPM-0
9
TNRMM-0
10
TNRMPY-0
11
TNRMY-0
12
Y-DEV-SW
(SW13)
M-DEV-SW
(SW14)
C-DEV-SW
(SW15)
K-DEV-SW
(SW16)
K-DRUM-SW
(SW12)
C-DRUM-SW
(SW11)
13
14
15
11
12
CN440
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+24V
PDLM-0C
SG
PDLLOCK-0
+3.3V
1
2
1
2
OUT5
OUT4-K
OUT4-C
OUT4-M
OUT4-Y
OUT1-K
OUT2-K
OUT3-K
OUT1-C
OUT2-C
OUT3-C
OUT1-M
OUT2-M
OUT3-M
OUT1-Y
OUT2-Y
OUT3-Y
CN444
1
2
CN443
1
2
CN442
1
2
CN441
1
2
J682
1
2
J680
1
2
CTRG
TNR-MOT-K
(M11)
TNR-MOT-C
(M10)
1
2
3
4
CTRG
1
2
3
4
1
2
TNR-MOT-M
(M9)
1
2
CTRG
CTRG
1
2
3
4
1
2
TNR-MOT-Y
(M8)
1
2
1
2
3
4
Main charger-K
Grid-K
Developer roller-K
1
Main charger-C
Grid-C
1
Developer roller-C
1
Main charger-M
Grid-M
Developer roller-M
Main charger-Y
Grid-Y
Developer roller-Y
PS-FAN-MOT
(F3)
OZN-FAN-MOT
(F2)
J685
3
USD-TNR-LCK-SNR
2
(S9)
1
J686
J623
2
1
1
1
2
2
HRNS-UTNR-210
2
4
1
5
J782
TEMP/HUMI-SNR
4
3
(S10)
2
1
J683
FRONT-COV-SW
2
(SW1)
1
J687
1
5
2
4
3
3
J671
4 IMG-POS-SNR-F
3
(S7)
2
1
J673
4 IMG-POS-SNR-R
3
(S8)
2
1
J672
2
2
SNS-SHUT-SOL
1
1
(SOL1)
J785
3
RGST-PASS
2
(S6)
1
THMS-DRM
(THM4)
1
2
HRNS-PSNR-210
LP-ERS-K
(ERS-K)
LP-ERS-C
(ERS-C)
1
2
CN531
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HRNS-LGC-TNRIC-210
CN322
HVTREMOTE
1
HVTDPWM-C
2
HVTDPWM-M
3
HVTDPWM-Y
4
HVTDPWM-K
5
HVTSTS
6
HVTMPWM-C
7
HVTMPWM-M
8
HVTMPWM-Y
9
HVTMPWM-K
10
HVTM-C3
11
HVTM-K
12
PG
13
PG
14
+24V
15
+24V
16
Y-DRUM-SW
(SW9)
M-DRUM-SW
(SW10)
1
2
CN321
CN530
HVTREMOTE
12
1
HVTTR2_MON
11
2
TR2IV
10
3
HVTTR2CVPWM
9
4
HVTTR2CCPWM
8
5
HVTTR2
7
6
HVTTR1PWM-C
6
7
HVTTR1PWM-M
5
8
HVTTR1PWM-Y
4
9
HVTTR1PWM-K
3
10
PG
2
11
+24V
1
12
3
4
CN316
+24V
1
OZNFAN-0C
2
FRNTCO-1
10
SG
11
6
7
8
9
+24V
PDLM-0C
CN319
SG
1
PDLLOCK-0
2
+3.3V
3
4
5
5
4
J611
2
1
J613
2
1
J615
2
1
J617
2
1
J618
2
1
J616
2
1
J614
2
1
J612
2
1
LP-ERS-Y
(ERS-Y)
J781
15
1 NC
14
2
13
3
12
4
11
5
NC
10
6
9
7
8
8
7
9
6
10
3
2
1
ATTNR-SNR-K
(S1)
J701
4
ATTNR-SNR-C
3
(S2)
2
1
J701
4
3
2
1
LP-ERS-M
(ERS-M)
HRNS-LGC-FANUTNR-210
SG
13
RGST2SNS-0
14 +3.3V
15
TDSSOL-0C
11
+24V
12
CN318
1 NC(TNLVOP)
+5V
2
Vout(TNLVOS)
3
TNLVREF
4
SG
5
NC(RGFVOP)
6
+5V
7
Vout(RGFVOS)
8
RGFVREF
9 SG
10
ATTNR-SNR-Y
(S4)
J701
4
ATTNR-SNR-M
3
(S3)
2
1
J701
4
3
2
1
1
2
HRNS-ATTNR-210
1
2
J604
6
1
5
2
4
3
3
4
2
5
6
1
J603
6
1
5
2
4
3
3
4
2
5
6
1
J606
2
1
J607
+24V
3
2
DLEM-0C
1
4
J609
5 +24V
2
DLEK-0C
1
6
J608
7 +24
2
DLEC-0C
8
1
J605
DRMTHS-1
9
4
SG
10
3
NC
NC 2
1
CN317
+24V
1
DLEY-0C
2
HRNS-LGC-DLED-210
SG
15
YDEVNEW
16
13 SG
14 MDEVNEW
11 SG
CDEVNEW
12
SG
9
KDEVNEW
10
7
8
5
6
3
4
CN310
1 SG
YDRMNEW
2
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
CN311
1 KATCNT
2 KATSVR-1J
3 +24V
4 KATSN-1T
5 PG
6 SG
7
8
9
10
11
12
J601
6
1
5
2
4
3
3
4
2
5
1
6
J602
6
1
5
2
4
3
3
4
2
5
6
1
HRNS-LGC-ATEPU-210
CN313
1 YATCNT
2 YATSVR-1J
3 +24V
4 YATSN-1T
5 PG
6 SG
PS-HVT (HVT)
PWA-F-CITF (CITF)
USD-TNR-MOT
(M7)
PWA-F-LGC (LGC)
PWA-F-DSP
(DSP)
DDR3 SO-DIMM
M1
S23
CCD
S21
S22
KEY
M6
EXP
CTIF
TCP
S24
CLT3
M3
S12
SW10
S11
SW9
SW14
SW13
S3
S4
CTRG
M11
CTRG
M10
CTRG
M9
CTRG
S25
DSP
M8
SW12
LED3
LED2
LED1
S10
ERS-K
ERS-C
THM4
S9
M7
LED4
SW11
SW16
SW15
S1
S2
ERS-M
ERS-Y
M5
M12
M4
ADU
CLT2
THM2
LAMP1,
LAMP2
THM1
CLT1
S8
SOL1
S6
S13
THMO2
S15
S19
SW8
SW6
SW7
S7
THM3
S18
M2
THMO1
S14
S17
CLT4
S20
S5
S16
SW5
DH1
SSD
SW3
LGC
SYS
EEPROM
PS
SW2
HVT
SW1
F3
SW4
INLET
SRAM
F1
THMO4
DH3
DH2
Main Memory
F2
THMO3
CFD
Figure
Wire harness
location
Symbol
Name
Figure
Wire harness
location
SCAN-MOT
Scan motor
[A]
2-B / 3-B
S1
ATTNR-SNR-K
Auto-toner sensor-K
[C]
8-B
M2
FEED/DEV-MOT
Paper feeding/developer unit drive motor
[G]
6-A
6-B
S2
ATTNR-SNR-C
Auto-toner sensor-C
[C]
8-B
M3
DRM-SW-MOT
Mono/color switching motor
[C]
6-B
S3
ATTNR-SNR-M
Auto-toner sensor-M
[C]
8-A
M4
FUS-MOT
Fuser motor
[E]
6-C
6-D
S4
ATTNR-SNR-Y
Auto-toner sensor-Y
[C]
8-A
M5
EXIT-MOT
Exit motor
[E]
6-D
S5
CST1-EMP-SNR
1st drawer empty sensor
[G]
5-C
M6
DRM/TBU-MOT
Drum/TBU motor
[C]
6-E
S6
RGST-PASS-SNR
Registration pass sensor
[F]
8-D
M7
USD-TNR-MOT
Waste toner paddle motor
[B]
8-D
S7
IMG-POS-SNR-F
Image quality sensor (Front)
[F]
8-C
8-D
M8
TNR-MOT-Y
Toner motor-Y
[B]
8-F
S8
8-D
M9
[B]
8-F
IMG-POS-SNR-R
Image quality sensor (Rear) / Image position
aligning sensor
[F]
TNR-MOT-M
Toner motor-M
M10
TNR-MOT-C
Toner motor-C
[B]
8-F
M-DEV-SW
M developer unit old/new detection switch
[C]
SW15
C-DEV-SW
C developer unit old/new detection switch
[C]
SW16
K-DEV-SW
K developer unit old/new detection switch
[C]
M11
TNR-MOT-K
Toner motor-K
[B]
8-G
M12
ADU-MOT
ADU motor
[H]
5-C
F1
SYS-FAN-MOT
SYS/HDD cooling fan
[I]
2-D
F2
OZN-FAN-MOT
Ozone exhaust fan
[I]
8-D
F3
PS-FAN-MOT-1
Ozone suctioning fan
Name
S10
TEMP/HUMI-SNR
Temperature/humidity sensor
[D]
8-D
S11
DRM-SW-SNR
Drum switching detection sensor
[C]
6-B
S12
1ST-TRNS-SW-SNR
1st transfer roller status detection sensor
[C]
6-E
S13
EXIT-SNR
Exit sensor
[E]
6-F
S14
ADU-U-SNR
ADU entrance sensor
[H]
5-D
[B]
8-D
Name
Figure
RGST-CLT
Registration clutch
CLT2
FEED-CLT
Feed clutch
[G]
6-B
CLT3
1ST-TRNS-CLT
1st transfer contact/release clutch
[C]
6-E
CLT4
SFB-FEED-CLT
Bypass feed clutch
[H]
SOL1
Name
SNR-SHUT-SOL
Sensor shutter solenoid
Figure
[F]
S15
[H]
5-D
S16
SFB-FEED-SNR
Bypass feed sensor
[H]
5-B
S17
PWA-F-SFB
Paper width detection PC board (SFB board)
[H]
4-B / 5-B
S18
CLNG-SNR
Paper clinging detection sensor
[G]
5-A
S19
RGST-SNR
Registration sensor
[G]
5-A
5-B
S20
TRANS-SNR
Feed sensor
[G]
PLTN1-SNR
Platen sensor-1
[A]
S22
PLTN2-SNR
Platen sensor-2
[A]
S23
HOME-SNR
Carriage home position sensor
[A]
2-B / 3-B
S24
APS1
Automatic original detection sensor-1
[A]
2-B / 3-B
S25
APS2
Automatic original detection sensor-2
[A]
SW1
FRT-COV-SW
Front cover switch
[J]
SW2
F-COV-INTLCK-SW
Front cover interlock switch
[J]
SW3
S-COV-INTLCK-SW
Side cover interlock switch
[J]
4-E
SW4
MAIN-SW
Main power switch
[I]
AC Wire Harness
[J]
6-F
5-C
SW7
CST-SIZE2-SW
1st drawer size detection switch-2
[G]
5-B
5-C
SW8
CST1-SW
1st drawer detection switch
[G]
5-C
SW9
Y-DRUM-SW
Y drum old/new detection switch
[C]
8-B
SW10
M-DRUM-SW
M drum old/new detection switch
[C]
8-B
SW11
C-DRUM-SW
C drum old/new detection switch
[C]
8-B
SW12
K-DRUM-SW
K drum old/new detection switch
[C]
8-B
Wire harness
location
THM3
THMS-FR-E
Fuser roller HGJH thermistor
[E]
6-F
[B]
8-F
THM4
THMS-DRM
Drum thermistor
[C]
8-C
AC WIre harness
Symbol
Name
PWA-F-CTRG
Toner cartridge PC board (CTRG board)
[B]
8-F
8-G
THMO1
THERMO-FR-C
Fuser roller center thermostat
[E]
ADU
PWA-F-ADU
ADU control PC board (ADU board)
[H]
5-C
THMO2
THERMO-FR-S
Fuser roller rear thermostat
[E]
SFB
PWA-F-SFB
Paper width detection PC board (SFB board)
4-B
THMO3
THERMO-SCN-DH
Scanner damp heater thermostat
AC WIre harness
CFD
PWA-F-CFD
Feed control PC board (CFD board)
[I]
5-A
THMO4
THERMO-DRM-DH-L
Drum damp heater thermostat (Left)
AC WIre harness
SYS
PWA-F-SYS
System control PC board (SYS board)
[I]
2-A
THMO5
THERMO-DRM-DH-R
Drum damp heater thermostat (Right)
AC WIre harness
LGC
PWA-F-LGC
Logic PC board (LGC board)
[I]
6-D
PWA-F-SRAM
SRAM board
[I]
1-E
CTRG
SRAM
Name
Figure
Wire harness
location
EXP
LP-EXPO
Exposure lamp
[A]
LED1
LP-LED-Y
LED print head-Y
[D]
7-B
7-C
LED2
LP-LED-M
LED print head-M
[D]
7-C
7-D
LED3
LP-LED-M
LED print head-M
[D]
7-D
7-E
LED4
LP-LED-K
LED print head-K
[D]
7-E
7-F
ERS-Y
LP-ERS-Y
Discharge LED-Y
[D]
8-C
ERS-M
LP-ERS-M
Discharge LED-M
[D]
8-C
ERS-C
LP-ERS-C
Discharge LED-C
[D]
8-C
ERS-K
LP-ERS-K
Discharge LED-K
[D]
8-C
LAMP1
LP-HTR-C
Center heater lamp
[E]
AC Wire Harness
LP-HTR-S
Side heater lamp
[E]
AC Wire Harness
DH1
SCN-DH-L
Scanner damp heater
[J]
AC Wire Harness
DH2
DRM-DH-L
Drum damp heater (Left)
[J]
AC Wire Harness
DH3
DRM-DH-R
Drum damp heater (Right)
[J]
AC Wire Harness
AC WIre harness
Others
Symbol
TCP
8-D
[G]
2-F
PWA-F-CTIF
Toner cartridge interface PC board (CTIF board)
2-B / 3-B
SW6
6-F
[A]
CTIF
LAMP2
SIDE-COV-SW
Side cover switch
[E]
PWA-F-KEY
Key PC board (KEY board)
2-B / 3-B
CST-SIZE1-SW
1st drawer size detection switch-1
THMS-FR-S
Fuser roller side thermistor
KEY
2-C / 3-C
SW5
THM2
[A]
5-A
4-E
6-F
2-F
PWA-F-DSP
Display PC board (DSP board)
Symbol
ADU-L-SNR
ADU exit sensor
[E]
DSP
5-B
8-D
Wire harness
location
THMS-FR-C
Fuser roller center thermistor
[A]
6-B
Wire harness
location
Figure
THM1
Figure
PWA-F-CCD
CCD driving PC board (CCD board)
Solenoids
Symbol
Name
CCD
8-B
Wire harness
location
Symbol
8-B
CLT1
[G]
PC boards
8-C
USD-TNR-LCK-SNR
Waste toner paddle rotation detection sensor
S21
8-C
SW14
S9
8-E
Wire harness
location
[C]
SW13
M1
[I]
Figure
Y-DEV-SW
Y developer unit old/new detection switch
Symbol
Name
TCP
Touch panel
EEPROM
EEPROM Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
SSD
Main
memory
PS
HVT
Figure
Wire harness
location
[A]
2-E
[I]
SSD
Solid State Drive
[I]
Main memoryl
[I]
2-D/3-D
PS-ACC
Switching regulator
[I]
4-D
PS-HVT
High-voltage transformer
[I]
8-E
Digital
key
Button
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
[1]
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
[2]
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
[3]
[4]
[5]
Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
Normal display
e.g.
e.g.
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
No paper
-
Paper present
-
Not connected
Not connected
Connected
Not connected
Old
Old
Old
Old
Old
Old
Old
Old
Stop/Non-regular
rotation
Stop/Non-regular
rotation
Stop/Non-regular
rotation
Shielded
-
Connected
Connected
Not connected
Connected
New
New
New
New
New
New
New
New
Normal rotation
Normal rotation
Normal rotation
Transmissive
-
[6]
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
Normal
Open
Abnormal
Closed
Open
Closed
Fusing abnormality
ADU/transfer cover opening/closing
JSP cover open detection (JSP is
connected)/
Bridge unit cover open detection
(Bridge unit is connected)
Front cover opening/closing switch
Open
Normal
Closed
Open/Blowout of
24V fuse
[7]
Normal
Connected
Not connected
Connected
Connected
Normal
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
Black drive
Color drive
Paper present
Paper present
No paper
No paper
Paper present
Paper present
Paper present
Occurrence of
charging leak
Color drive
Black drive
No paper
No paper
Paper present
Paper present
No paper
No paper
No paper
Paper present
No paper
Paper present
No paper
Full
Not full
Full
-
Not full
-
Open
Closed
No paper
-
Paper present
-
A
B
[0]
Connected
[9]
Power on
Not connected
[8]
Power off/Not
connected
Power off/Not
connected/Firmware
abnormality
-
C
D
E
F
G
H
Digital
key
[1]
[2]
[3]
Button
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
B
C
D
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
[4]
[5]
Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
Normal display
e.g.
Toner present
Toner present
Old
Not connected
Not connected
Not connected
Closed
-
e.g.
Toner not present
Toner not present
New
Connected
Connected
Connected
Open
-
Open
Closed
Home position
[6]
[7]
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
B
C
D
E
F
G
PFP motor
A
B
[8]
C
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
[9]
D
E
F
G
H
A
[0]
No original
No original
Original present
Original present
Cover opened
RADF opened
Original present
Original present
Original present
Original present
Original present
Original present
No original
No original
Cover closed
RADF closed
No original
No original
No original
No original
OFF(H)
ON(L)
OFF(H)
ON(L)
OFF(H)
ON(L)
Original present
Original present
Original present
-
No original
No original
No original
-
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
Open
Closed
No paper
No paper
Accelerating/Deceler
ating/Stopped
Paper present
Paper present
Normal rotation
Digital
key
Button
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
A
B
C
[5]
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
C
[6]
D
E
F
G
H
Contents
Highlighted display
Normal display
Items to check
Temperature/humidity sensor (displays
temperature inside of the equipment)
Temperature/humidity sensor (displays
humidity inside of the equipment)
Drum thermistor temperature
-
e.g.
e.g.
Temperature [C]
Humidity [%RH]
Temperature [C]
Other than upper
limit position
Closed
Paper present
Transmissive
Other than upper
limit position
Closed
Paper present
Transmissive
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
A
B
C
[7]
D
E
F
G
H
A
B
[8]
C
D
E
F
G
H
[0]
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
LCF motor
A
B
C
D
Security enabler
Judgement for acceptable USB storage
device (*1)
-
E
F
G
H
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
[9]
Home position
Closed
No paper
Normal
Other than bottom
position
Other than position
after tray transport
Other than home
position
Closed
Open
Open
No paper
Properly loaded
No paper
Accelerating/Deceler
ating/Stopped
Connectable
Closed
Paper present
Paper misload
Paper present
Not connectable
Acceptable
Not acceptable
Normal rotation
*1
- Be sure to install the USB storage device to the equipment and check if the device can be used
with this code.
- Be sure to turn OFF the write protection (the function to prevent data from erasure by the accidental
recording or deleting) of the USB storage device before performing the check, otherwise this code
cannot be used.
- It may take some time (2 sec. to 10 sec.) before this check is completed depending on the USB
storage device.
Table 1. Relation between the status of the bypass paper width sensor and paper size (width)
Bypass paper width sensor
Paper width size
1
3
2
0
1
A3/LD
0
1
1
1
A4-R/LT-R
1
0
1
0
A5-R/ST-R
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
Card size
1
0
0
1
B4-R/LG
0
1
0
1
B5-R
Table 2. Option connection detection signal
A
B
Bridge unit is connected
L
L
JSP is connected
L
H
No option is connected
H
H
SIO read-in NG
H
L
Table 3. Relation between the status of the original tray width sensor and paper size (width)
Original tray width sensor
Paper width size Paper width size
TWID0S
(LT series)
(A4 series)
TWID2S
TWID1S
L
H
H
B5-R
H
A5-R
H
L
ST-R
L
A3 / A4
H
L
LD / LT
8.5x8.5 / LT-R /
L
L
H
A4-R / FOLIO
KLG / 13"LG
L
L
L
COMPUTER
B4 / B5
H (= high level): Open L (= low level): Short
Function
Drum motor ON
* Operational without process unit Y/M/C/K
Waste toner agitating motor ON
Registration clutch ON
PFP motor ON
ADU motor ON
Developer unit motor K ON
* Operational without process unit Y/M/C/K
Fuser motor ON
Developer unit motor ON + Drum motor ON (Normal speed)
* Remove the transfer belt before execution.
ADU motor ON (transport speed)
Exit motor (reversal rotation) ON (transport speed)
LED head ON
Exit motor (normal rotation) ON
Exit motor (reversal rotation) ON
LCF motor ON
Sensor shutter ON (open)
Image position aligning sensor (front/rear) LED ON
Code No.101 function OFF
Code No.102 function OFF
Code No.108 function OFF
Code No.109 function OFF
Code No.110 function OFF
Code No.112 function OFF
Code No.113 function OFF
Code No.114 function OFF
Code No.115 function OFF
Code No.116 function OFF
Code No.118 function OFF
Code No.120 function OFF
Code No.121 function OFF
Code No.122 function OFF
Code No.125 function OFF
Code No.126 function OFF
1st drawer feed clutch ON/OFF
2nd drawer feed clutch ON/OFF
Bypass feed clutch ON/OFF
LCF pickup solenoid ON/OFF
LCF end fence reciprocating movement
LCF feed clutch ON/OFF
Key copy counter count up
PFP transport clutch ON/OFF
PFP upper drawer feed clutch ON/OFF
PFP lower drawer feed clutch ON/OFF
Middle roller (lower) transport speed drive clutch ON/OFF
Bridge unit gate solenoid ON/OFF
JSP gate solenoid ON/OFF
Middle roller (lower) process speed drive clutch ON/OFF
Discharge LED (K) ON/OFF
* Do not let it radiate to the photoconductive drum for a long
time.
Discharge LED (Y/M/C) ON/OFF
* Do not let it radiate to the photoconductive drum for a long
time.
Drum switching motor
(switches position in the black/color mode)
Procedure
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
3
3
2
3
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
2
241
243
248
252
253
254
255
256
261
267
271
278
280
281
282
283
284
285
294
295
297
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
322
410
411
412
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
2
3
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
5
5
5
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
413
443
444
461
3
3
3
2
204
Grid pattern
205
Grid pattern
245
Halftone (3 pixels)
270
286
Remarks
Pattern width: 1 dot,
Pitch: 10 mm
Pattern width: 2 dot,
Pitch: 10 mm
For checking the image
quality control
SYS
LGC
LGC
LGC
LGC
LGC
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Developm Auto adj. for dev.
ent
material supply and
ATS
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0-255
M The value starts changing approx. 3 minutes after this
adjustment is started. The value is automatically set
during this adjustment (approx. 2 minutes).
(As the value increases, the sensor output increases
correspondingly.)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
5
Yes
2400
2401
Adjustment for Y
0-255
Yes
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2402
Adjustment for M
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2403
Adjustment for C
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2404
Adjustment for K
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2405
Adjustment of
(YMCK) Y
120
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2405
Adjustment of
(YMCK) M
120
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2405
Adjustment of
(YMCK) C
120
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Sub
Item
element
Developm Adjustment of autoent
toner initial
adjustment reference
setting value (YMCK)
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2406
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2627
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2627
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
05/08
Mode
Element
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2405
3 Adjustment of
(YMCK) K
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
120
0-255
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
0-255
Yes
Lower limit
200
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
Upper limit
900
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
2628
Lower limit
200
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
2628
Upper limit
900
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2629
Lower limit
200
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2629
Upper limit
900
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
2630
Lower limit
200
0-1000
(Unit: V)
Yes
Automatic adjustment
(Y, M, C)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2662
295
100-450
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2662
307
100-450
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2662
315
100-450
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2662
314
100-450
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2729
0-1023
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2730
0-1023
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2731
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2731
0-1023
10
Yes
Mode
Element
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2630
1 Upper limit
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
900
0-1000
M (Unit: V)
Sub
Item
element
Developm Developer bias DC(-) K
ent
calibration voltage
05/08
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2731
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2732
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2732
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2732
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2732
0-1023
10
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2734
Light amount
adjustment result of
image quality sensor
0-255
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2737
Relative humidity
display during latest
closed-loop control
0-100
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
2738
Enforced performing
in the short color
mode
Mode
Element
Item
Output value display
of image quality
sensor
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2731
2 1st pattern (C)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1023
M Displays the output value of image quality sensor when
the 1st pattern (high-density test pattern) is output. The
larger the value, the smaller the toner amount adhered
becomes.
Sub
element
Image
control
05/08
Code
Yes
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Sub
element
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE20
2757
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
M Performs the image quality closed-loop control in the
short black mode.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
6
Yes
2739
Enforced performing
in the short black
mode
2740
Enforced performing
of image quality openloop control
Yes
2742
Enforced performing
of image quality
control
Yes
2745
Enforced performing
of TRC control
Yes
2756
At the occurrence of
CE10
0-999
Detection value on
the belt
0-999
2757
Light intensity
adjustment bit value
0-999
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Detection value on
the belt
0-999
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Light intensity
adjustment bit value
0-999
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
First pattern M
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
First pattern C
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
First pattern K
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Second pattern Y
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Second pattern M
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Second pattern C
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Image
control
At the occurrence of
CE40
2758
Second pattern K
detection value
0-999
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2761
Temperature/humidity
sensor temperature
display
23
0-100
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2762
Temperature/humidity
sensor humidity
display
50
0-100
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
At the occurrence of
CE40
SubDetails
code
2758
2 First pattern Y
detection value
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-999
M Only "0" can be entered. (Unit: bit)
Sub
element
Image
control
05/08
Code
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Charger
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
2763
Details
Drum thermistor
temperature display 1
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
23
0-100
M (Unit: C)
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
Y normal speed
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
M normal speed
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
C normal speed
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
K normal speed
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
BK Normal speed
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
Y decelerating
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
M decelerating
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
C decelerating
0-10
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
1st transfer output
offset
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2905
9 K decelerating
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
5
0-10
M Sets the offset amount of the 1st transfer output.
4
Offsetting level
0: 0.75 1: 0.80 2: 0.85 3: 0.90 4: 0.95 5: 1.00 6: 1.05
7: 1.10 8: 1.15 9: 1.20 10: 1.25
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2905
11
BK decelerating
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Plain paper
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Thick paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Thick paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Overhead
transparencies
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Special paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
Special paper 2
0-10
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
Bias offset in the color
mode (Front side)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2934
7 Recycled paper
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
5
0-10
M Sets the bias offset amount of the 2nd transfer bias in
4
the color mode (Front side).
Offsetting level
0: 0 1: 0.2 2: 0.4 3: 0.6 4: 0.8 5: 1.0 6: 1.2 7: 1.4 8:
1.6 9: 1.8 10: 2.0
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2934
10
Envelope
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Plain paper
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Thick paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Thick paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Special paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Special paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2935
Recycled paper
0-10
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
Bias offset in the color
mode (Back side)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2935 10 Envelope
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
5
0-10
M Sets the bias offset amount of the 2nd transfer bias in
4
the color mode (Back side).
Offsetting level
0: 0 1: 0.2 2: 0.4 3: 0.6 4: 0.8 5: 1.0 6: 1.2 7: 1.4 8:
1.6 9: 1.8 10: 2.0
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Plain paper
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Thick paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Thick paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Overhead
transparencies
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Special paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Special paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2936
Recycled paper
0-10
10
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
Bias offset in the
black mode (Front
side)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2936 10 Envelope
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
5
0-10
M Sets the bias offset amount of the 2nd transfer bias in
4
the black mode (Front side).
Offsetting level
0: 0 1: 0.2 2: 0.4 3: 0.6 4: 0.8 5: 1.0 6: 1.2 7: 1.4 8:
1.6 9: 1.8 10: 2.0
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Plain paper
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Thick paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Thick paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Special paper 1
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Special paper 2
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
Recycled paper
0-10
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2937
10
Envelope
0-10
11
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
2nd transfer leading
edge bias correction
factor (Front side in
the color mode)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2938
0 Plain paper
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
0
0-16
M Corrects the 2nd transfer leading edge bias (Front side
in the color mode).
Offsetting level
0: 1.00 1: 0.95 2: 0.90 3: 0.85 4: 0.80 5: 0.75 6: 0.70
7: 0.65 8: 0.60 9: 0.55 10: 0.50 11: 0.45 12: 0.40 13:
0.35 14: 0.30 15: 0.25 16: 0.20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Thick paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Thick paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Overhead
transparencies
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Special paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Special paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2938
Recycled paper
0-16
12
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
2nd transfer leading
edge bias correction
factor (Front side in
the color mode)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2938 10 Envelope
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
0
0-16
M Corrects the 2nd transfer leading edge bias (Front side
in the color mode).
Offsetting level
0: 1.00 1: 0.95 2: 0.90 3: 0.85 4: 0.80 5: 0.75 6: 0.70
7: 0.65 8: 0.60 9: 0.55 10: 0.50 11: 0.45 12: 0.40 13:
0.35 14: 0.30 15: 0.25 16: 0.20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Plain paper
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Thick paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Thick paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Special paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Special paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2939
Recycled paper
0-16
13
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
2nd transfer leading
edge bias correction
factor (Back side in
the color mode)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2939 10 Envelope
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
0
0-16
M Corrects the 2nd transfer leading edge bias (Back side
in the color mode).
Offsetting level
0: 1.00 1: 0.95 2: 0.90 3: 0.85 4: 0.80 5: 0.75 6: 0.70
7: 0.65 8: 0.60 9: 0.55 10: 0.50 11: 0.45 12: 0.40 13:
0.35 14: 0.30 15: 0.25 16: 0.20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Plain paper
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Thick paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Thick paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Overhead
transparencies
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Special paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
Special paper 2
0-16
14
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
2nd transfer leading
edge bias correction
factor (Front side in
the black mode)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2940
7 Recycled paper
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
0
0-16
M Corrects the 2nd transfer leading edge bias (Front side
in the black mode).
Offsetting level
0: 1.00 1: 0.95 2: 0.90 3: 0.85 4: 0.80 5: 0.75 6: 0.70
7: 0.65 8: 0.60 9: 0.55 10: 0.50 11: 0.45 12: 0.40 13:
0.35 14: 0.30 15: 0.25 16: 0.20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2940
10
Envelope
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
Plain paper
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
Thick paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
Thick paper 2
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
Special paper 1
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
Special paper 2
0-16
15
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
2nd transfer leading
edge bias correction
factor (Back side in
the black mode)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2941
7 Recycled paper
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
0
0-16
M Corrects the 2nd transfer leading edge bias (Back side
in the black mode).
Offsetting level
0: 1.00 1: 0.95 2: 0.90 3: 0.85 4: 0.80 5: 0.75 6: 0.70
7: 0.65 8: 0.60 9: 0.55 10: 0.50 11: 0.45 12: 0.40 13:
0.35 14: 0.30 15: 0.25 16: 0.20
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2941
10
Envelope
0-16
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
Number of time of
cleaning at printing
end
2961
0-7
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
Number of time of
cleaning at printing
end
2961
Decelerating
0-7
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
Number of time of
cleaning at jam
recovery / bypass
non-standard printing
/ tab paper printing.
2962
0-7
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
Number of time of
cleaning at jam
recovery / bypass
non-standard printing
/ tab paper printing.
2962
Decelerating
0-7
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
Number of time of
cleaning at image
quality control end
2963
Normal speed
0-7
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2964
Normal speed
-20-20
(Unit: A)
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2964
Decelerating
-20-20
(Unit: A)
16
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
Enforced toner supply
/ Number of time of
cleaning at the end of
fusing-wait period
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2966
0 Normal speed / High
speed
Code
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Transfer
2966
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Image location
adjustment
3030
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Image location
adjustment
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Reproduction ratio
adjustment
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
05
Decelerating
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
2
0-7
M 0: Once 1: Twice 2: 3 times 3: 5 times 4: 7 times 5:
10 times 6: 12 times 7: 15 times
0-7
Primary scanning
direction
113
3031
Secondary scanning
direction
3032
0-255
Yes
130
67-189
Yes
Adj. secondary
scan.direction
128
0-255
Yes
3033
Distortion mode
Yes
Shading position
adjustment
3034
Original glass
117
71-186
SYS 0.08192mm/step
Scanner
Shading position
adjustment
3035
RADF
133
71-186
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
RADF
Adjustment of RADF
paper alignment
3040
12
0-30
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
RADF
Adjustment of RADF
paper alignment
3041
12
0-30
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
RADF
3042
Fine adjustment of
transport speed
50
0-100
17
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
RADF
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
RADF
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
05
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases by "1", the image of original
fed from the RADF shifts toward the rear side of paper
by approx. 0.0423 mm.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
3043
Sideways deviation
adjustment
3044
Front side
50
0-100
Yes
RADF
3045
Back side
50
0-100
Yes
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Carriage position
adjustment during
scanning from RADF
3046
Carriage position
adjustment during
scanning from RADF
(black)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Carriage position
adjustment during
scanning from RADF
3047
Carriage position
adjustment during
scanning from RADF
(color)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Data transfer of
characteristic value
3203
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Data transfer of
characteristic value
3209
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
3218
Shading correction
plate Automatic dust
detection adjustment
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Size detection of
original
3233
Position adjustment in
the primary scanning
direction
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
Scanner
Size detection of
original
3234
Waiting position
adjustment of carriage
100
0-255
SYS Adjusts the position where the carriage stops at the size
detection of the original.
Default value: 100 (10 mm from leading edge of
original)
Maximum value: 255 (25.5 mm from leading edge of
original)
Minimum value: 0 (0 mm from leading edge of original)
18
05/08
Mode
Element
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
05
Adjustmen Scanner
t mode
05
Sub
element
Scanner
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Adjusts the lighting time of the lamp at the size
detection of the original.
Maximum value: 255 (Minimum time + 2040ms)
Minimum value: 0 (Minimum time)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Size detection of
original
3236
Adjustment of lamp
lighting time
Scanner
Size detection of
original
3237
Starting time
adjustment of lamp
lighting
64
0-255
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4006
ALL
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
Transport speed:
Normal speed
133
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
Transport speed:
Decelerating
128
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
Transport speed1
128
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
Transport speed2
128
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
10
Transport speed3
128
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
system
Fine adjustment of
ADU motor rotational
speed
4016
11
Transport speed4
128
0-255
0.1%/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
4018
1st drawer
128
0-255
19
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
SubDetails
code
4018
1 2nd drawer
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts
toward the front side by 0.0423 mm.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
4018
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
4018
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
4018
LCF
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Adjustment of drawer
sideways deviation
4018
Bypass feeding
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Duplex feeding
4019
Long size
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Duplex feeding
4019
Short size
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Duplex feeding
4019
Middle size
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Margin adjustment
PPC
4050
Top margin
adjustment
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Margin adjustment
PPC
4052
Right margin
adjustment
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Margin adjustment
PPC
4053
Bottom margin
adjustment
0-255
Yes
20
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
Margin adjustment
PRT
4054
Top margin
adjustment (blank
area at the leading
edge of the paper)
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
24
0-255
M When the value increases by "1", the blank area
becomes wider by approx. 0.0423 mm.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Margin adjustment
PRT
4056
Right margin
adjustment (blank
area at the right of the
paper along the paper
feeding direction)
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Margin adjustment
PRT
4057
Bottom margin
adjustment (blank
area at the trailing
edge of the paper)
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4058
1st drawer
50
0-100
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4059
2nd drawer
50
0-100
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4060
50
0-100
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4061
Bypass feeding
50
0-100
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4062
Duplex feeding
50
0-100
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Bottom margin
adjustment (blank
area at the trailing
edge of the paper)
PPC
24
0-255
Reverse side at
duplexing
4064
21
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
Right margin
Reverse side at
adjustment (blank
duplexing
area at the right of the
paper along the paper
feeding direction)
SubDetails
code
4064
1 Plain paper (Black)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
18
0-255
M When the value increases, the blank area becomes
wider.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Bottom margin
adjustment (blank
area at the trailing
edge of the paper)
Reverse side at
duplexing
4064
24
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Right margin
Reverse side at
adjustment (blank
duplexing
area at the right of the
paper along the paper
feeding direction)
4064
18
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Bottom margin
adjustment (blank
area at the trailing
edge of the
paper)/Reverse side
at duplexing (color)
Reverse side at
duplexing
4064
18
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Reverse side at
Right margin
duplexing
adjustment (blank
area at the right of the
paper along the paper
feeding direction)
4064
Thick paper1
12
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4065
Common items
100
0-200
22
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
1st drawer
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
code
value
4100
0 Plain paper; Long size Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 34
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4100
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4100
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4100
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
23
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
1st drawer
SubDetails
code
4100
4 Plain paper; :Short
size3
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 34
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4101
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4101
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4101
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
24
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
2nd drawer
SubDetails
code
4101
3 Plain paper; :Short
size2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 19
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4101
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4103
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4103
0-63
Yes
25
Refer to
content
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4103
2 Plain paper; Short
size1
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 37
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4103
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4103
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4104
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
26
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4104
1 Thick paper1 ;Middle
size
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4104
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4104
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4104
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
27
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4105
0 Thick paper2 ;Long
size
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4105
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4105
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4105
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
28
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4105
4 Thick paper2 ;Short
size3
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4106
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4106
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4106
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
29
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4106
3 Thick paper3 ;Short
size2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 39
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4106
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4107
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4107
0-63
Yes
30
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
code
value
4107
2 OHP film ;Short size1 Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 30
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4107
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4107
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4108
0-63
Yes
31
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP upper drawer
SubDetails
code
4108
1 Plain paper; Middle
size
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 30
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4108
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4108
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4108
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
32
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP lower drawer
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
code
value
4109
0 Plain paper; Long size Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 34
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4109
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4109
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4109
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
33
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP lower drawer
SubDetails
code
4109
4 Plain paper; :Short
size3
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.5 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 24
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4110
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4110
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4110
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
34
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
ADU
SubDetails
code
4110
3 Plain paper; :Short
size2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases as follows:
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 0.6 mm
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 36
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
Plain paper
Refer to
content
0-63
Yes
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4110
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
LCF
4111
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Adjustment of paper
Feeding
system/Pa pushing amount at
bypass feeding
per
transport
4112
Plain paper/Recycled
paper
30
0-63
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Adjustment of paper
Feeding
system/Pa pushing amount at
bypass feeding
per
transport
4112
Thick paper/Special
paper/Transparencies
20
0-63
35
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Adjustment of paper
system/Pa pushing amount/1st
per
drawer
transport
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Adjustment of paper
Feeding
system/Pa pushing amount/1st
per
drawer
transport
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4113
0 Plain paper/Recycled
paper
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
10
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the paper pushing
4
amount at feeding from 1st drawer increases by approx.
0.9 mm.
4113
Thick paper/Special
paper
20
0-63
1st drawer
4115
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4115
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4115
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
36
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
1st drawer
SubDetails
code
4115
3 Thick paper1 ;Short
size2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 39
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
1st drawer
4115
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4116
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4116
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
37
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
2nd drawer
SubDetails
code
4116
2 Thick paper1 ;Short
size1
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 19
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4116
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
2nd drawer
4116
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4117
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
38
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP upper drawer
SubDetails
code
4117
1 Thick paper1 ;Middle
size
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 30
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4117
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4117
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4117
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
39
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP lower drawer
SubDetails
code
4118
0 Thick paper1 ;Long
size
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 34
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4118
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4118
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4118
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
40
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
PFP lower drawer
SubDetails
code
4118
4 Thick paper1 ;Short
size3
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 24
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4120
Thick paper/Special
paper; Long size
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4120
Thick paper/Special
paper; Middle size
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4120
Thick paper/Special
paper; Short size1
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
41
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
ADU
SubDetails
code
4120
3 Thick paper/Special
paper; Short size2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.8 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
ADU
4120
Thick paper/Special
paper; Short size3
Refer to
content
s
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4128
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4128
Special paper1
;Middle size
0-63
Yes
42
Refer to
content
s
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
code
value
4128
2 Special paper1 ;Short Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
size1
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4128
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4128
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4129
0-63
Yes
43
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Subitem
Bypass feeding
SubDetails
code
4129
1 Special paper2
;Middle size
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-63
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount
content
increases by approx. 0.6 mm.
s
<Paper length>
Long size: 330 mm or longer
Middle size: 220 mm to 329 mm
Short size 1: 205 mm to 219 mm
Short size 2: 160 mm to 204 mm
Short size 3: 159 mm or shorter
<Default value>
20/25/LL20/LL25ppm: 27
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4129
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4129
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Paper aligning
Feeding
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
Bypass feeding
4129
0-63
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4402
Common items
125
0-200
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adj. of
drum/transfer belt
motor speed
4526
Transport speed:
Normal speed
128
0-255
Yes
44
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Drive
Item
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
fuser roller rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
fuser roller rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
fuser roller rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
fuser roller rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
feed/transport motor
rotational speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
feed/transport motor
rotational speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
feed/transport motor
rotational speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
feed/transport motor
rotational speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4526
4 Transport speed:
Decelerating
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
M When the value increases, the motor speed becomes
faster. (0.1%/step)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
4529
Transport speed:
Normal speed
131
0-255
0.1%/step
4529
Transport speed:
Normal speed
128
0-255
0.1%/step
4529
Transport speed:
Decelerating
128
0-255
0.1%/step
4529
Transport speed:
Decelerating
128
0-255
0.1%/step
4532
Transport speed:
Normal speed
126
0-255
0.1%/step
4532
Transport speed:
Normal speed
128
0-255
0.1%/step
4532
Transport speed:
Decelerating
129
0-255
0.1%/step
4532
Transport speed:
Decelerating
128
0-255
0.1%/step
4535
Transport speed:
Normal speed
105
0-255
4535
Transport speed:
Normal speed
128
0-255
45
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Drive
Item
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Subitem
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
PRT (Long size)
SubDetails
code
4535
4 Transport speed:
Decelerating
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
M When the value increases, the motor speed becomes
faster. (0.1%/step)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
4535
Transport speed:
Decelerating
128
0-255
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
Transport speed1
128
0-255
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
Transport speed2
128
0-255
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
10
Transport speed3
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
11
Transport speed4
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
12
Transport speed:
Normal speed
(Transporting with
ADU)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
15
Transport speed:
Normal speed
(Transporting with
ADU)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
16
Transport speed:
Decelerating
(Transporting with
ADU)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Drive
Fine adjustment of
exit motor rotational
speed
4535
19
Transport speed:
Decelerating
(Transporting with
ADU)
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
50
0-100
4560
46
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
50
0-100
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts
1
Yes
toward the trailing edge of the paper by approx. 0.1 mm.
4561
T-LCF
Image
4562
1st drawer
56
0-100
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4563
2nd drawer
56
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4564
56
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4565
56
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4567
Thick paper 1
59
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4567
Thick paper 2
64
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4567
Thick paper 3
64
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4567
OHP film
56
0-100
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4567
Special paper 1
64
0-100
47
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4567
5 Special paper 2
Code
4568
ADU
Feeding
Paper aligning
system/Pa amount adjustment
per
transport
4579
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
control
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4731
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4731
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
64
0-100
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts
4
toward the trailing edge of the paper by approx. 0.1 mm.
56
0-100
Using icons
Yes
4719
Forced color
registration control
Yes
4720
Displaying parameters
for color regist.
0-255
Yes
Top margin
29
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
Top margin
48
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
4731
Top margin
29
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
4731
Top margin
29
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
4731
Bottom margin
24
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
48
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4731
5 Bottom margin
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
24
0-48
M (0.4mm/10step)
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4731
Bottom margin
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
4731
Bottom margin
0-48
(0.4mm/10step)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Setting method of
system/Pa drawer size
per
transport
4800
1st drawer
0-2
SYS 0: Manual
1: Automatic (mm)
2: Automatic (inch)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Feeding
Setting method of
system/Pa drawer size
per
transport
4800
2nd drawer
0-2
SYS 0: Manual
1: Automatic (mm)
2: Automatic (inch)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Setting method of
Feeding
system/Pa drawer size
per
transport
4800
3rd drawer
0-2
SYS 0: Manual
1: Automatic (mm)
2: Automatic (inch)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Setting method of
Feeding
system/Pa drawer size
per
transport
4800
4th drawer
0-2
SYS 0: Manual
1: Automatic (mm)
2: Automatic (inch)
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Plain paper
4808
Drawer
-20-20
0.5 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Plain paper
4808
Bypass feeding
-20-20
0.5 mm/step
49
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Sub
Item
element
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
-20-20
M 0.5 mm/step
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Plain paper
Subcode
4808
2 ADU
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 1
4809
Drawer
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 1
4809
Bypass feeding
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 1
4809
ADU
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 2
4810
Drawer
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 2
4810
Bypass feeding
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 2
4810
ADU
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 3
4811
Drawer
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Thick paper 3
4811
Bypass feeding
-20-20
0.6 mm/step
05/08
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
50
Contents
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Aligning
Batch conversion
adjustment
Subitem
Thick paper 3
Subcode
4811
2 ADU
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
-20-20
M 0.6 mm/step
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Saddle stitch
LD/A3
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Saddle stitch
LG/B4/8K/A4-R/LTR/16K-R
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Saddle stitch
Adjustment of paper
folding position
4821
LD/A3
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Saddle stitch
Adjustment of paper
folding position
4821
LG/B4/8K/A4-R/LTR/16K-R
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Alignment position
adjustment
4822
Front
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Alignment position
adjustment
4822
Rear
-17-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Stapling position
adjustment
4823
-25-25
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Stapling position
adjustment
4823
-17-25
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Stapling position
adjustment
4823
-25-25
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
Stapling position
adjustment
4823
-25-17
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
51
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Finisher
05
Adjustmen Printer
t mode
Image
05
Adjustmen Process
t mode
Item
Stapling position
adjustment
Stapling position
adjustment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4823
4 Center 2 places
Code
-15-12
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
4824
Adjustment of hole
punch center position
-15-15
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
4825
Adjustment of hole
punch position
-20-12
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
4826
Adjustment of
alignment position
-15-15
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
4827
Adjustment of ejection
position of gripper
-15-15
0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
4831
Non-standard paper
by bypass feeding
100
0-200
Adjusts the amount of void at the trailing edge of nonstandard paper by bypass feeding. When the value is
too small, stain may appear on the back side of paper.
0.1mm/step.
Yes
Fuser
5990
Enforced performing
of noncontact
thermistor correction
05
Adjustmen Image
Reproducti Primary scanning
direction
t mode
Processing on ratio
adjustment
7000
PPC
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Reproducti Primary scanning
direction
t mode
Processing on ratio
adjustment
7001
PRT/FAX
128
128-255
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
Center 2 places
(Pitch)
Saddle stitch
4823
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
-17-17
M 0.2mm/step
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
52
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC/SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d offset
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7025
ADF
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the adjustment value, the darker the
background becomes. The smaller the adjustment
value, the lighter the background becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC/SCN(color)
t mode
Processing d offset
adjustment
7026
ADF
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7056
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7057
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7058
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7061
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PPC(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7097
Text/Photo
0-4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PPC(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7098
Text
0-4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7100
Text/Photo
128
0-255
Yes
53
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7101
Text
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the background
becomes. The smaller the value, the lighter the
background becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7102
Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7105
Gray scale
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7106
User custom
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7114
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7115
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7116
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7123
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7124
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
54
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Automatic density
adjustment
7125
Photo
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7134
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7137
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7138
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7141
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7190
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7190
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7190
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7191
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
55
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Text
SubDetails
code
7191
1 Medium density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7191
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo
7192
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo
7192
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo
7192
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7212
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7212
63
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
56
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
LED
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
SubDetails
code
7212
2 Emission level 2/4
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
127
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7212
191
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
LED
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7212
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Range
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing correction
adjustment
05
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Black/Manual density
adjustment
7237
User custom
0-1
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7249
User custom
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PPC(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7252
User custom
0-4
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7276
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7276
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
57
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
User custom
SubDetails
code
7276
2 High density
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Range
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing correction
adjustment
Black/Manual density
adjustment
7286
Text/Photo
0-1
05
Adjustmen Image
Range
PPC(black)
t mode
Processing correction
adjustment
Black/Manual density
adjustment
7287
Text
0-1
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT(black/1200dpi)
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
7302
PS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT(black/600dpi)
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
7307
PS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT(black/600dpi)
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
7307
PCL
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT(black/600dpi)
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
7307
XPS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
Yes
58
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Smooth/1200dpi
SubDetails
code
7309
0 Low density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi
7309
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi
7309
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi
7310
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi
7310
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi
7310
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
7315
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
7315
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
59
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
7315
2 High density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
7316
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
7316
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
7316
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
7317
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
7317
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
7317
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
7318
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
60
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Detail/600dpi
SubDetails
code
7318
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
7318
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
7319
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
7319
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
7319
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
7320
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
7320
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
7320
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
61
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
Mode
Element
Subitem
Subcode
7322
0 PS
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
7322
PCL
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
7322
XPS
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
LED
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7330
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7330
63
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7330
127
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
05
PRT(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7330
191
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
62
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
LED
PRT(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
SubDetails
code
7330
4 Emission level 4/4
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7340
PS
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7341
PCL
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(black)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
7342
XPS
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7360
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Text
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7360
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7360
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Graphics
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7361
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
63
05/08
05
Sub
Item
Subitem
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
7361
1 Medium density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7361
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Image
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7362
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Image
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7362
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PS/Image
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7362
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7363
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7363
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7363
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
64
05/08
05
Sub
Item
Subitem
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
7364
0 Low density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7364
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7364
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Image
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7365
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Image
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7365
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ PCL/Image
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7365
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7366
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Text
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7366
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
65
05/08
05
Sub
Item
Subitem
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Text
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
7366
2 High density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7367
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7367
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Graphics
t mode
Processing balance
Auto
adjustment
7367
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Image
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7368
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Image
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7368
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Monochrome/600dpi/ XPS/Image
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
Auto
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7368
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7430
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
66
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7431
Text
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7432
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7433
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7436
Text/Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7437
Text
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7438
Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7439
Gray scale
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7441
User custom
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7444
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
67
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7445
Text
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
1
Yes
value becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7446
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7447
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7456
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7457
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7458
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7459
Gray scale
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7470
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
7475
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
68
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Automatic density
adjustment
7478
Subcode
Details
User custom
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
1
value becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7480
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7480
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7480
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Gamma
SCN(black)
Adjustmen Image
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7485
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
SCN(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7485
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
SCN(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7485
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
SCN(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo
7487
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
69
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Photo
SubDetails
code
7487
1 Medium density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo
7487
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7488
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
SCN(black)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7488
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
SCN(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7488
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Image
t mode
Processing
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the blank area around the
scanned image becomes wider. (e.g.: In network
scanning with 600 dpi, if the setting value is "1", the
blank area increases by 1 dot.)
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
05
05
NW scanning
7489
Amount of
surrounding void
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7533
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Adjustmen Image
Density
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7534
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the lighter the image at the center
value becomes.
Adjustmen Image
Density
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7535
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
70
Yes
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7542
Text/Photo
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7543
Photo
05
Adjustmen Image
LED
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7594
05
Adjustmen Image
LED
FAX(black)
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7594
05
FAX(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
05
05
05/08
05
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
63
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
7594
127
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
FAX(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7594
191
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
FAX(black)
Adjustmen Image
LED
t mode
Processing emission
level
adjustment
7594
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lower the emission level
becomes and the smaller the dots are reproduced.
Yes
71
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Blank
t mode
Processing page
judgment
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the more the original tends to be
judged as a blank page.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
7618
PPC/SCN
7630
PPC/SCN
70
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the more the original tends to be
judged as black even in the auto color mode.
The smaller value, the more it tends to be judged as
color.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
ACS
t mode
Processing judgment
threshold
05
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
Selected 2colors
7641
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
black in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than black becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
Selected 2colors
7641
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
black in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than black becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
Selected 2colors
7641
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
black in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than black becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
7642
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
red in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than red becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
7642
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
red in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than red becomes.
Yes
72
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Black area PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adj. in twin
color copy
mode
Mode
SubDetails
code
7642
2 Low density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the area recognized as
4
Yes
red in the original becomes.
The smaller the value, the larger the area recognized as
colors other than red becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Magenta
7644
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Magenta
7644
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Magenta
7644
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Magenta
7644
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Yellow
7645
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Yellow
7645
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Yellow
7645
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Yellow
7645
128
0-255
Yes
73
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Yellow green
Subcode
7646
0 Y
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS Performs the density adjustment for the specified color
4
Yes
during mono color copying. The larger the value, the
darker the density. The smaller the value, the lighter the
density.
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Yellow green
7646
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Yellow green
7646
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Yellow green
7646
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Cyan
7647
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Cyan
7647
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Cyan
7647
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Cyan
7647
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Pink
7648
128
0-255
Yes
74
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Pink
Subcode
7648
1 M
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS Performs the density adjustment for the specified color
4
Yes
during mono color copying. The larger the value, the
darker the density. The smaller the value, the lighter the
density.
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Pink
7648
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Pink
7648
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Red
7649
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Red
7649
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Red
7649
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Red
7649
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Orange
7650
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Orange
7650
128
0-255
Yes
75
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Orange
Subcode
7650
2 C
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS Performs the density adjustment for the specified color
4
Yes
during mono color copying. The larger the value, the
darker the density. The smaller the value, the lighter the
density.
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Orange
7650
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Green
7651
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Green
7651
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Green
7651
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Green
7651
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Blue
7652
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Blue
7652
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Blue
7652
128
0-255
Yes
76
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color / twin
t mode
Processing adjustment color
Mode
Blue
Subcode
7652
3 K
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS Performs the density adjustment for the specified color
4
Yes
during mono color copying / twin color copying. The
larger the value, the darker the density. The smaller the
value, the lighter the density.
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Purple
7653
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Purple
7653
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Purple
7653
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Copy color Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Purple
7653
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7656
Text/Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7657
Text
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7658
Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7659
Photo (developing
paper)
128
0-255
Yes
77
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7660
Map
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the background
becomes. The smaller the value, the lighter the
background becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7661
User custom
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
7662
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text/Photo
7665
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text/Photo
7665
Yellow
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text/Photo
7665
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text/Photo
7665
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text/Photo
7665
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
78
Yes
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Mode
Text/Photo
SubDetails
code
7665
5 Magenta
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Yellow
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Text
7666
Magenta
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo
7667
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
79
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Mode
Photo
SubDetails
code
7667
1 Yellow
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo
7667
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo
7667
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo
7667
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo
7667
Magenta
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo (developing
paper)
7668
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo (developing
paper)
7668
Yellow
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo (developing
paper)
7668
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
80
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Mode
Element
Subitem
Photo (developing
paper)
Subcode
7668
3 Cyan
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo (developing
paper)
7668
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Photo (developing
paper)
7668
Magenta
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Map
7669
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Map
7669
Yellow
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Map
7669
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Map
7669
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Map
7669
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
81
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Mode
Map
SubDetails
code
7669
5 Magenta
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Yellow
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
User custom
7670
Magenta
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
7671
Red
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the magenta
becomes.
82
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
7671
1 Yellow
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the green becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the red becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
7671
Green
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the cyan becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the yellow becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
7671
Cyan
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the blue becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the green becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
7671
Blue
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the magenta becomes.
The smaller the value, the darker the cyan becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of hue
7671
Magenta
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the red becomes. The
smaller the value, the darker the blue becomes.
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text/Photo
7675
Red
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text/Photo
7675
Yellow
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text/Photo
7675
Green
128
0-255
83
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Mode
Text/Photo
Subcode
7675
3 Cyan
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Input the larger value to increase the saturation, and
input the smaller value to decrease the saturation.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text/Photo
7675
Blue
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text/Photo
7675
Magenta
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text
7676
Red
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text
7676
Yellow
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text
7676
Green
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text
7676
Cyan
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Text
7676
Blue
128
0-255
84
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Mode
Text
SubDetails
code
7676
5 Magenta
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Input the larger value to increase the saturation, and
input the smaller value to decrease the saturation.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Red
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Yellow
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Green
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Cyan
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Blue
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo
7677
Magenta
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo (developing
paper)
7678
Red
128
0-255
85
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Mode
Element
Subitem
Photo (developing
paper)
SubDetails
code
7678
1 Yellow
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Input the larger value to increase the saturation, and
input the smaller value to decrease the saturation.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo (developing
paper)
7678
Green
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo (developing
paper)
7678
Cyan
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo (developing
paper)
7678
Blue
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Photo (developing
paper)
7678
Magenta
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Map
7679
Red
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Map
7679
Yellow
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Map
7679
Green
128
0-255
86
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Mode
Map
Subcode
7679
3 Cyan
Element
Subitem
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Input the larger value to increase the saturation, and
input the smaller value to decrease the saturation.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Map
7679
Blue
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Map
7679
Magenta
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
User custom
7680
Red
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
User custom
7680
Yellow
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
User custom
7680
Green
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
User custom
7680
Cyan
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
User custom
7680
Blue
128
0-255
87
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
Mode
Element
User custom
SubDetails
code
7680
5 Magenta
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS Input the larger value to increase the saturation, and
input the smaller value to decrease the saturation.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Red
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Yellow
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Green
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Cyan
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Blue
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of
saturation
7681
Magenta
128
0-255
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing reproducti
on
selection
0-4
7690
User custom
88
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing reproducti
on
selection
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7691
Reproduction of red
seal color
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
2
0-4
SYS 0: Text/Photo, printed photo, text, map
1: Photo (developing paper)
2: Reproduction of red seal color
3, 4: Text/Photo, printed photo, text, map
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mono color
7707
Text/Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mono color
7708
Text
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mono color
7709
Printed image
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Twin color
7710
Text/Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Twin color
7711
Text
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PPC(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Twin color
7712
Printed image
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7713
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7714
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
89
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7715
Printed image
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7716
Photo (developing
paper)
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7717
Map
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7718
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7719
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7720
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7721
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7722
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7723
Photo (developing
paper)
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
90
Automatic density
adjustment
7724
Map
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7725
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7726
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7727
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7728
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7729
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7730
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7731
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Mono color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7732
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
1
Yes
value becomes.
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
05/08
Details
91
Yes
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7733
Text/Photo
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7734
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
7735
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7736
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7737
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
Twin color
t mode
Processing adjustment
Automatic density
adjustment
7738
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image at the center
value becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7794
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7795
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7796
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
92
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color
7797
Text
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7798
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7799
Photo (developing
paper)
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
7800
Map
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mono color
7801
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mono color
7802
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mono color
7803
Printed image
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Twin color
7804
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Twin color
7805
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
93
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PPC(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Twin color
Code
Subcode
Details
7806
Printed image
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Black
t mode
Processing header
density
level
adjustment
7811
Text/Photo
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the header becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the header becomes
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing header
density
level
adjustment
7812
Text
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the header becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the header becomes
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black
PPC(color)
t mode
Processing header
density
level
adjustment
7816
User custom
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the header becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the header becomes
Yes
05
PPC(color)
Adjustmen Image
Black
t mode
Processing header
density
level
adjustment
7817
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the header becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the header becomes
05
Adjustmen Image
Text/Photo PPC(color)
t mode
Processing reproducti
on level
adjustment
7840
Text/Photo
0-9
SYS 1 to 4: Photo-oriented
0, 5: Default
6 to 9: Text-oriented
* Text is blurred if the value is to small. Noise increases
in the photo area if the value is to large.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Text/Photo PPC(color)
t mode
Processing reproducti
on level
adjustment
7841
User custom
0-9
SYS 1 to 4: Photo-oriented
0, 5: Default
6 to 9: Text-oriented
* Text is blurred if the value is to small. Noise increases
in the photo area if the value is to large.
Yes
94
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Text/Photo PPC(color)
t mode
Processing reproducti
on level
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
7842
Details
Red seal color
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-9
SYS 1 to 4: Photo-oriented
1
0, 5: Default
6 to 9: Text-oriented
* Text is blurred if the value is to small. Noise increases
in the photo area if the value is to large.
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "Y"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "M"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "C"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "R"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "G"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Marker
t mode
Processing color
adjustment
7850
PPC(color) "B"
0-6
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7869
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7871
Plain paper
SYS
Yes
95
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Mode
Element
Color/Black
SubDetails
code
7871
2 Recycled paper
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS When color deviation is found in gradation
7
Yes
reproduction, the gradation reproduction of 4 colors can
be corrected with the automatic gamma adjustment.
The result of the correction above will be applied for
each media type.
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7871
Thick paper1
SYS
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7871
Thick paper2
SYS
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7871
Special paper1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PPC(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Color/Black
7871
Special paper2
SYS
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing text
density
adjustment
7889
0-10
SYS The larger the value, the darker the text becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing text
density
adjustment
7890
0-10
SYS The larger the value, the darker the text becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing text
density
adjustment
7891
0-10
SYS The larger the value, the darker the text becomes.
96
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing text
density
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
7892
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
5
0-10
SYS The larger the value, the darker the text becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7901
Envelope
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7902
Plain paper
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7904
Recycled paper
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7905
Thick paper1
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7906
Thick paper2
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7909
Special paper1
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
97
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
255
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
7910
Special paper2
OHP film
240
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the less toner is adhered to the
high-density section of the image.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PPC(color)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
7911
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
Plain paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
Recycled paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
Thick paper 1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
Thick paper 2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
98
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
Mode
Element
PPC(color)
SubDetails
code
7913
7 Special paper 1
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
Special paper 2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
11
Envelope
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
setting
PPC(color)
7913
12
OHP film
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes. The smaller the value,
the smaller the maximum amount of toner to be
adhered becomes.
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7956
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7956
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
05
PPC(black)
Adjustmen Image
Gamma
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Gray scale
7956
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image of the area
surrounding the target area becomes.
Yes
99
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Text/Photo
SubDetails
code
7960
0 Low density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7960
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7960
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7961
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7961
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7961
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7962
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7962
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
100
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Printed image
SubDetails
code
7962
2 High density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7963
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7963
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7963
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7964
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7964
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7964
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7965
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
101
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Text/Photo
SubDetails
code
7965
1 Medium density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7965
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7966
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7966
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7966
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7967
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7967
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7967
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
102
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Photo (developing
paper)
SubDetails
code
7968
0 Low density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7968
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7968
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7969
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7969
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7969
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7970
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7970
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
103
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Text/Photo
SubDetails
code
7970
2 High density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7971
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7971
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7971
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7972
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7972
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7972
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7973
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
104
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Photo (developing
paper)
SubDetails
code
7973
1 Medium density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7973
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7974
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7974
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7974
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7975
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7975
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text/Photo
7975
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
105
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Text
SubDetails
code
7976
0 Low density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7976
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Text
7976
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7977
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7977
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Printed image
7977
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7978
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Photo (developing
paper)
7978
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
106
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Photo (developing
paper)
SubDetails
code
7978
2 High density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7979
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7979
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Map
7979
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7980
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7980
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7980
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7981
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
107
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
User custom
SubDetails
code
7981
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
Yes
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7981
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7982
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7982
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7982
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7983
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7983
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
05
PPC(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
User custom
7983
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
Yes
108
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
7984
0 Low density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7984
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7984
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7985
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7985
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
PPC(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7985
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7986
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
PPC(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7986
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
109
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
SubDetails
code
7986
2 High density
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
4
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7987
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7987
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PPC(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
7987
High density
128
0-255
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker
as the value increases.
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8004
Plain paper
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8004
Recycled paper
SYS
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8004
Thick paper1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8004
Thick paper2
Yes
110
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Mode
600dpi
SubDetails
code
8004
7 Special paper1
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS When color deviation is found in gradation reproduction,
7
Yes
the gradation reproduction of 4 colors can be corrected
with the automatic gamma adjustment.
The result of the correction above will be applied for
each media type.
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8004
Special paper2
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8005
Plain paper
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8005
Recycled paper
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8005
Thick paper1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8005
Thick paper2
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8005
Special paper1
Yes
111
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
Mode
1200dpi
SubDetails
code
8005
8 Special paper2
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
7
Yes
SYS When color deviation is found in gradation reproduction,
the gradation reproduction of 4 colors can be corrected
with the automatic gamma adjustment.
The result of the correction above will be applied for
each media type.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
600dpi
8008
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Automatic PRT(color)
t mode
Processing gamma
adjustment
1200dpi
8009
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Color/600dpi
8010
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Color/600dpi
8010
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Color/600dpi
8010
XPS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Twin
color/600dpi
8011
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Twin
color/600dpi
8011
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
112
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Smooth/Twin
color/600dpi
Subcode
8011
2 XPS
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the background
becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the background
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Monocolor/60 8012
0dpi
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Monocolor/60 8012
0dpi
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Smooth/Monocolor/60 8012
0dpi
XPS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Color/600dpi
8013
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Color/600dpi
8013
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Color/600dpi
8013
XPS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Twin
color/600dpi
8014
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Twin
color/600dpi
8014
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
113
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Detail/Twin
color/600dpi
Subcode
8014
2 XPS
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the background
becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the background
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Monocolor/600
dpi
8015
PS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Monocolor/600
dpi
8015
PCL
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Detail/Monocolor/600
dpi
8015
XPS
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8016
Smooth/Color/1200
dpi
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8017
Detail/Color/1200 dpi
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8018
Smooth/Black/1200
dpi
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun PRT(black)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8019
Detail/Black/1200 dpi
128
0-255
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "K"
8023
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
114
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "K"
Mode
Element
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "K"
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "C"
05
Subitem
SubDetails
code
8023
1 Medium density
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
8023
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
8024
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "C"
8024
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "C"
8024
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "C"
8025
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "C"
8025
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "C"
8025
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
115
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "C"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8026
0 Low density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "C"
8026
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "C"
8026
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "M"
8027
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "M"
8027
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "M"
8027
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "M"
8028
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "M"
8028
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
116
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "M"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8028
2 High density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "M"
8029
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "M"
8029
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "M"
8029
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Y"
8030
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Y"
8030
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Y"
8030
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Y"
8031
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
117
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Y"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8031
1 Medium density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Y"
8031
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Y"
8032
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Y"
8032
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Y"
8032
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Red"
8033
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Red"
8033
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Red"
8033
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
118
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Red"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8034
0 Low density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Red"
8034
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Red"
8034
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Red"
8035
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Red"
8035
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Red"
8035
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Green"
8036
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Green"
8036
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
119
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Green"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8036
2 High density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Green"
8037
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Green"
8037
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Green"
8037
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Green"
8038
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Green"
8038
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Green"
8038
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Blue"
8039
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
120
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Blue"
Mode
SubDetails
code
8039
1 Medium density
Element
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Blue"
8039
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Blue"
8040
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
t mode
Processing balance
printing/PRT(color)
adjustment "Blue"
8040
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
2 color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Blue"
8040
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Blue"
8041
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Blue"
8041
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
2 color
Adjustmen Image
Color
printing/PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment "Blue"
8041
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
121
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8042
0 Low density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8042
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8042
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8043
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8043
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8043
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8044
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8044
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
122
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8044
2 High density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8045
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8045
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Smooth/600dpi
8045
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8046
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8046
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8046
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8047
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
123
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
XPS/Detail/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8047
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8047
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8048
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8048
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8048
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8049
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8049
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
XPS/Detail/600dpi
8049
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
124
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8050
0 Low density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8050
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8050
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8051
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8051
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8051
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8052
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8052
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
125
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8052
2 High density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8053
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8053
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/600dpi
8053
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8054
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8054
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8054
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8055
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
126
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Detail/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8055
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8055
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8056
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8056
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8056
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8057
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8057
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/600dpi
8057
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
127
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8058
0 Low density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8058
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "Y"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8058
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8059
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8059
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8059
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8060
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8060
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
128
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8060
2 High density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8061
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8061
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "K"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Smooth/600dpi
8061
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8062
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8062
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "Y"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8062
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "M"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8063
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
129
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Detail/600dpi
SubDetails
code
8063
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "M"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8063
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8064
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color) "C"
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8064
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "C"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8064
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8065
Low density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8065
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color) "K"
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PCL/Detail/600dpi
8065
High density
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker only the target color
becomes.
Yes
130
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
SubDetails
code
8070
0 Plain paper
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
Yes
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
Recycled paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
Thick paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
Thick paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
Special paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
Special paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
131
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
SubDetails
code
8070 11 Envelope
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
Yes
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Detail
8070
12
OHP film
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
Plain paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
Recycled paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
Thick paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
Thick paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
132
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
SubDetails
code
8071
7 Special paper1
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
Yes
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
Special paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
11
Envelope
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/600 dpi)
Smooth
8071
12
OHP film
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
Plain paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
Recycled paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
133
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
SubDetails
code
8089
3 Thick paper1
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
Thick paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
Special paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
Special paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
11
Envelope
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Detail
8089
12
Overhead
transparencies
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
134
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
SubDetails
code
8090
0 Plain paper
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
Recycled paper
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
Thick paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
Thick paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
Special paper1
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
Special paper2
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
135
05/08
05
Sub
element
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
Mode
Element
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
SubDetails
code
8090 11 Envelope
PRT(color/1200 dpi)
Smooth
8090
12
Overhead
transparencies
Item
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
4
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
SYS The larger the value, the larger the maximum amount of
toner to be adhered becomes.
The smaller the value, the smaller the maximum
amount of toner to be adhered becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
Yes
XPS
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum
t mode
Processing toner
density
threshold
adj.
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
8102
PS
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
8102
PCL
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine line
t mode
Processing enhancem
ent
switchover
8102
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS/Twin
color
8108
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS/Twin
color
8108
136
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
e-BRIDGE/PS/Twin
color
SubDetails
code
8108
2 Photo
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS
8109
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS
8109
Red seal
color/Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS
8109
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
eBRIDGE/PS/General
8110
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
eBRIDGE/PS/General
8110
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
eBRIDGE/PS/General
8110
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8111
eBRIDGE/PS/Photogra
ph
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8111
eBRIDGE/PS/Photogra
ph
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
137
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
eBRIDGE/PS/Photogra
ph
SubDetails
code
8111
2 Photo
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e8112
BRIDGE/PS/Presenta
tion
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e8112
BRIDGE/PS/Presenta
tion
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e8112
BRIDGE/PS/Presenta
tion
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS
8118
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
If the value of 05-7322 is "0", the adjustment is applied
to text, and if the value is "1", the adjustment is applied
to text and others.
0: No adjustment
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
e-BRIDGE/PS
8118
Graphics
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
If the value of 05-7322 is "0", the adjustment is applied
to graphics, and if the value is "1", the adjustment is
applied to thin text.
0: No adjustment
Yes
138
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness PRT(black)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
e-BRIDGE/PS
SubDetails
code
8118
2 Photo
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(color)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
8130
PS
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(color)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
8131
PCL
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Smudged/f PRT(color)
t mode
Processing aint text
adjustment
8132
XPS
0-8
SYS The larger the value, the darker the small text and fine
lines become and the more faint text is suppressed.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PRT(color/600 dpi)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
8145
OHP film
200
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the image becomes.
* Image offset may occur if the value is too large.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Maximum PRT(color/1200 dpi)
t mode
Processing toner
density
adjustment
8149
OHP film
200
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the lighter the image becomes.
* Image offset may occur if the value is too large.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT color/Two-color
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
PS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
600 dpi
8160
139
Yes
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT color/Two-color
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
Mode
Element
600 dpi
Subcode
8160
1 PCL
Subitem
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
XPS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
8161
PS
176
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the printed image
becomes.
Yes
Adjustmen Image
Screen
t mode
Processing switchover
8176
PRT(color)
0-1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Screen
t mode
Processing switchover
8187
PRT(black)
0-1
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Text
8210
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Text
8210
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT color/Two-color
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
600 dpi
8160
05
Adjustmen Image
Upper limit PRT color
t mode
Processing value in
toner
saving
mode
1200 dpi
05
140
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Text
SubDetails
code
8210
2 Presentation
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
8
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Text
8210
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Graphic
8211
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Graphic
8211
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Graphic
8211
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Graphic
8211
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Image
8212
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
141
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
PCL/Image
SubDetails
code
8212
1 Photo
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Image
8212
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PCL/Image
8212
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Twin color
print/General
8213
Text
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Twin color
print/General
8214
Graphics
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Twin color
print/General
8215
Image
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Black
t mode
Processing selection
8218
Photo
0-1
Yes
PRT(color)
142
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Stroke
PS/PDF automatic
t mode
Processing adjustment stroke adjustment
Mode
600dpi
SubDetails
code
8239
0 Default setting
Element
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
4
1
0-3
SYS This code is used to change the width of fine lines in PS
and PDF printing. Automatic stroke adjustment is the
function that prevents the width from changing
according to the position.
This code sets whether automatic stroke adjustment is
enabled or disabled if it is not included in the print data.
If this setting is disabled, there will be an increase in
cases in which the width of fine lines becomes thicker
by 1 dot when they are printed.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
2: Forcibly disabled (Ignores command in printing data)
3: Forcibly enabled (Ignores command in printing data)
05
Adjustmen Image
Stroke
PS/PDF automatic
t mode
Processing adjustment stroke adjustment
600dpi
8239
1-2
05
Adjustmen Image
Stroke
PS/PDF automatic
t mode
Processing adjustment stroke adjustment
1200dpi
8239
Default setting
0-3
143
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Stroke
PS/PDF automatic
t mode
Processing adjustment stroke adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
1200dpi
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
dure e UI
code
value
4
8239
3 Minimum stroke width
1
1-2
SYS This code is used to change the width of fine lines in PS
when disabled
and PDF printing. Automatic stroke adjustment is the
function that prevents the width from changing
according to the position.
This code sets the minimum width of fine lines when the
automatic stroke adjustment is disabled. For example, if
automatic stroke adjustment is disabled and the width
of fine lines is set to "0" in the PS command, the width
of the lines becomes 1 dot if the value of this code is
set to "1"; equally, if it is set to 2, the width of the lines
becomes 2 dots.
1: 1 dot
2: 2 dots
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Code
05
Adjustmen Image
Line width PRT(color)
t mode
Processing minimum
value
adjustment
8240
600dpi
1-9
SYS The larger the value, the darker the fine lines become.
05
Adjustmen Image
Line width PRT(color)
t mode
Processing minimum
value
adjustment
8241
1200dpi
1-9
SYS The larger the value, the darker the fine lines become.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Line
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
1200dpi
8242
Gray (K)
0-5
SYS The larger the value, the darker the fine line becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Line
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
1200dpi
8242
Color (CMYK)
0-5
SYS The larger the value, the darker the fine line becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Line
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
1200dpi
8243
0-255
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Line
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
1200dpi
8243
200
0-255
144
Yes
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Line
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
1200dpi
SubDetails
code
8243
2 Color (CMYK) lower
limit value
Code
05
Adjustmen Image
Line
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing density
adjustment
1200dpi
8243
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Text
8249
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Text
8249
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Text
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-255
SYS Specifies the effective density range of 05-8242 from 0
to 255.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
255
0-255
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
8249
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
XPS/Text
8249
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
XPS/Text
8249
Advanced
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
145
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
XPS/Graphic
SubDetails
code
8250
0 General
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Graphic
8250
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Graphic
8250
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Graphic
8250
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Graphic
8250
Advanced
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Image
8251
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Image
8251
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
146
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
XPS/Image
SubDetails
code
8251
2 Presentation
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Image
8251
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
XPS/Image
8251
Advanced
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Text
8252
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Text
8252
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Text
8252
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Text
8252
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
147
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Text
SubDetails
code
8252
4 Advanced
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
8
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Graphic
8253
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Graphic
8253
Photo
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Graphic
8253
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Graphic
8253
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Graphic
8253
Advanced
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Image
8254
General
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
148
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Image
SubDetails
code
8254
1 Photo
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
4
Yes
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Pure
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Image
8254
Presentation
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Image
8254
Line art
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Pure
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing Black/Gray
threshold
adjustment
PS/Image
8254
Advanced
1-255
SYS The larger the value, the wider the range of colors to be
replaced with black becomes.
The smaller the value, the narrower the range becomes.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/Y 8268
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/Y 8268
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/Y 8268
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
149
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/
M
SubDetails
code
8269
0 Low density
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/
M
8269
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/
M
8269
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/C 8270
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/C 8270
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/C 8270
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/K 8271
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/K 8271
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
150
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
SubDetails
code
PS/Smooth/1200dpi/K 8271
2 High density
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/Y
8272
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/Y
8272
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/Y
8272
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/M
8273
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/M
8273
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/M
8273
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
PRT(color)
Adjustmen Image
Color
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/C
8274
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05/08
05
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
151
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
Mode
Element
PS/Detail/1200dpi/C
SubDetails
code
8274
1 Medium density
Subitem
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
4
Yes
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/C
8274
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/K
8275
Low density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/K
8275
Medium density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Color
PRT(color)
t mode
Processing balance
adjustment
PS/Detail/1200dpi/K
8275
High density
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area
becomes higher.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
05
NW SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
JPEG
t mode
Processing compressi
on level
8304
High quality
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the quality gets better, and
the file size gets larger.
05
NW SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
JPEG
t mode
Processing compressi
on level
8304
Standard
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the quality gets better, and
the file size gets larger.
05
NW SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
JPEG
t mode
Processing compressi
on level
8304
Low quality
128
0-255
SYS When the value increases, the quality gets better, and
the file size gets larger.
152
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
8309
Text/Photo
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The smaller the value, the lighter the background
becomes.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8310
Text
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8311
Photo
128
0-255
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of black
density
8314
Text/Photo
0-4
SYS The larger the value, the darker the black side of the
image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of black
density
8315
Text
0-4
SYS The larger the value, the darker the black side of the
image becomes.
Yes
05
SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
Fine
t mode
Processing adjustment
of black
density
8316
Photo
0-4
SYS The larger the value, the darker the black side of the
image becomes.
Yes
05
SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
RGB
t mode
Processing conversion
method
selection
8319
Text/Photo
0-3
Yes
05
SCN(color)
Adjustmen Image
RGB
t mode
Processing conversion
method
selection
8320
Text
0-3
Yes
153
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
RGB
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing conversion
method
selection
Mode
Element
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
8321
Photo
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-3
SYS Sets the color space format of the output image.
0: sRGB
1: AppleRGB
2: ROMMRGB
3: AdobeRGB
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Saturation SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8324
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the brighter the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the duller the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Saturation SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8325
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the brighter the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the duller the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Saturation SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8326
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the brighter the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the duller the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
8335
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
8336
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
8339
Text/Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
8340
Text
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
8341
Photo
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
Yes
154
05/08
05
Sub
Item
element
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Mode
Element
Subitem
Full color
Code
Subcode
Details
8354
Text/Photo
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
05
Adjustmen Image
Backgroun SCN(color)
t mode
Processing d
adjustment
8370
User custom
128
0-255
05
Adjustmen Image
Fine
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
of black
density
8371
User custom
0-4
SYS The larger the value, the darker the black side of the
image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
RGB
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing conversion
method
selection
8372
User custom
0-3
05
Adjustmen Image
Saturation SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
8373
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the brighter the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the duller the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen Image
Sharpness SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Full color
8375
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the sharper the image becomes.
The smaller the value, the softer the image becomes
and the less moire appears.
05
Adjustmen Image
Density
SCN(color)
t mode
Processing adjustment
Manual
adjustment/Center
value
8380
User custom
128
0-255
SYS The larger the value, the darker the image becomes.
05
Adjustmen System
t mode
Maintenan
ce
9043
Equipment number
(serial number)
display
05
Adjustmen System
t mode
Image
9104
Compression quality
of SLIM PDF
background
processing
0-10
SYS 0-10
0: High compression, low image quality
10: Low compression, high image quality
155
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
05
Adjustmen System
t mode
05
Adjustmen System
t mode
05
Adjustmen System
t mode
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-3
SYS 0: 75dpi
1: 100dpi
2: 150dpi
3: 200dpi
9107
Resolution of SLIM
PDF background
processing
Image
9149
Acquisition of image
location adjustment
log
Maintenan
ce
9960
Display of equipment
information (SRAM)
Refer to
content
s
0-2
156
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2010
At normal
temperatures (black)
Refer to
content
s
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2010
At normal
temperatures (color)
Refer to
content
s
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2010
At low temperatures
(black)
12
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2010
At low temperatures
(color)
12
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
Special paper 1
(except for long-sized
paper)
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
Special paper 2
(except for long-sized
paper)
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
Special paper 1
(except for long-sized
paper)
14
0-16
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
2002
2018
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
Fuser unit error status
0
0-71
M 0: No error 1: C411 error 2: C412 error 3: - 4: C412
counter
error 5: C445 error 6: C446 error 7: C447 error 8: - 9:
C449 error 10: - 11: - 12: - 13: - 14: - 15: - 16: - 17:
- 18: - 19: C449 error 20: - 21: - 22: C449 error 23:
C449 error 24: C447 error 25: C449 error 26: - 27:
C449 error 28: - 29: C449 error 30: - 31: - 32: - 33: 34: - 35: - 36: - 37: - 38: C450 error 39: - 40: - 41:
C451 error 42: - 43: - 44: - 45: - 46: - 47: - 48: C450
error 49: - 50: C452 error 51: - 52: - 53: - 54: - 55: 56: - 57: - 58: - 59: - 60: - 61: - 62: - 63: - 64: - 65:
- 66: - 67: - 68: - 69: - 70: - 71: -
Sub
element
Fuser
05/08
Details
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
dure e UI
code
value
2018
1 Special paper 2
14
0-16
M 0: 90 1: 95 2: 100 3: 105 4: 110 5: 115
4
(except for long-sized
6: 120 7: 125 8: 130 9: 135 10: 140 11:
paper)
145 12: 150 13: 155 14: 160 15: 165 16:
170
Code
Fusing temperature
Fuser
Special paper
2020
Special paper 1 /
Normal
0-16
Process
Fuser
Special paper
2020
Special paper 2 /
Normal
0-16
Setting
Mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature in
the low power mode
Center
0-25
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
13
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2051
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
2052
OHP film
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
2053
black
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
2053
color
0-16
2042
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-16
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec. 2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5
sec. 6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec. 8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec. 10: 12
sec. 11: 14 sec. 12: 16 sec. 13: 18 sec. 14: 20 sec.
15: 25 sec. 16: 30 sec.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Thick paper 1
SubDetails
code
2054
0 Normal length paper
Fuser
Thick paper 2
2055
0-16
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
to start process for
abnormality / Plain
paper/ Normal
temperature
2080
black
0-12
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
to start process for
abnormality / Plain
paper/ Normal
temperature
2080
color
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
to start process for
abnormality / Thick
paper 2
2081
black
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
to start process for
abnormality / Thick
paper 2
2081
color
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
Recycled paper
(black)
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
Recycled paper
(color)
0-11
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
8
0-11
M 0: Invalid (always ON) 1: 0 min. 2: 0.5 min. 3: 1 min.
4: 2 min. 5: 3 min. 6: 5 min. 7: 7 min. 8: 10 min. 9:
15 min. 10: 30 min. 11: 60 min.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
SubDetails
code
2085
8 Thick paper 1
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
Thick paper 2
0-11
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
12
OHP film
0-11
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
13
Special paper 1
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
14
Special paper 2
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
At low temperatures
2085
15
Envelope
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Abnormality process
starting temperature
setting
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2087
black
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Abnormality process
starting temperature
setting
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2087
color
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
to start process for
abnormality
OHP film
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Refer to
content
s
0-16
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
2088
2140
Normal
temperature/Black
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2140
1 Normal
temperature/Color
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
Refer to
0-16
M 0: 90 1: 95 2: 100 3: 105 4: 110 5: 115
4
content
6: 120 7: 125 8: 130 9: 135 10: 140 11:
s
145 12: 150 13: 155 14: 160 15: 165 16:
170
<Default value>
JPD: 11
Others: 12
Fusing temperature
during printing
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2140
Low
temperature/Black
12
0-16
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2140
Low
temperature/Color
12
0-16
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2141
13
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
2142
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
2143
Fusing temperature
during printing (Side /
Overhead
transparencies)
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Retention period of
temperature of print
operation at print end
2179
Plain paper/Recycled
paper/Thin paper
0-10
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Retention period of
temperature of print
operation at print end
2179
Thick paper 1,
2/OHP/Special paper
1, 2/Envelope
0-10
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
for envelop
2194
Center
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
for envelop
2195
Side
14
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2205
0 Black/Heat roller
(Center)
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
12
0-18
M 0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
4
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
Plain paper/Normal
temperature
Fuser
Plain paper/Normal
temperature
2205
Black/Heat roller
(Side)
12
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Normal
temperature
2205
Color/Heat roller
(Center)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 12
Others: 13
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Normal
temperature
2205
Color/Heat roller
(Side)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 12
Others: 13
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2206
Black/Heat roller
(Center)
12
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2206
Black/Heat roller
(Side)
12
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2206
Color/Heat roller
(Center)
13
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper/Low
temperature
2206
Color/Heat roller
(Side)
13
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
13
0-18
M 0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
4
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
Thick paper 1
SubDetails
code
2208
0 Heat roller (Center)
Fuser
Thick paper 1
2208
13
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
Process
Fuser
Thick paper 2
2209
14
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Thick paper 2
2209
14
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
for starting
abnormality handling
Envelope (Center/side
thermistor)
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
for starting
abnormality handling
Special paper
(Center/side
thermistor)
2246
Special paper 1
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature setting
for starting
abnormality handling
Special paper
(Center/side
thermistor)
2246
Special paper 2
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
2248
0-10
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature in
the low power mode
2250
Side
0-25
0: OFF 1: 40 2: 45 3: 50 4: 55 5: 60 6:
65 7: 70 8: 75 9: 80 10: 85 11: 90 12:
95 13: 100 14: 105 15: 110 16: 115 17:
120 18: 125 19: 130 20: 135 21: 140 22:
145 23: 150 24: 155 25: 160
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Fuser
2282
Envelope
0-15
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
2233
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Transfer
Item
Setting of 2nd transfer
bias table
Subitem
Code
2307
Subcode
Details
For each
destination/paper
thickness
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-5
M 0: 80 g/m2 (21.3 lb.)/EUR
content
1: 75 g/m2 (20 lb.)/UC
s
2: 64 g/m2 (17.1 lb.)/JPN
3: 4: 5: <Default value>
MJD: 0
NAD: 1
Others: 2
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Main
charger
2365
0-9
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Process
Cleaner
2370
0-10
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Process
General
2373
Enable/Disable setting
of new or old
detection of developer
and cleaner
0-1
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
Process
Cleaner
Control of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
2380
Control setting of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
0-1
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
Process
Cleaner
Control of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
2381
0-6
08
Setting
mode
Process
Cleaner
Control of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
2382
Time interval
0-7
08
Setting
mode
Process
Cleaner
Control of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
2383
Maximum number
0-6
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Cleaner
Item
Subitem
Control of
photoconductive drum
idling in standby mode
Code
2384
Subcode
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Developm
ent
2385
1-255
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Fuser
2386
Condition of shift to
pre-sleep mode
(temperature)
0-7
08
Setting
Mode
Process
2387
Synchronization
setting of notice for
cleaning
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
2486
Contrast voltage
0-1
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
2493
0-1
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
2495
Enable/Disable setting
of image quality close
IQC Short mode
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
Period of time
unattended
0-1
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
2497
Accumulated
copied/printed number
of sheets setting 2 for
start-up of short mode
IQC
50
0-500
Unit (Sheets)
Humidity setting
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
0-5
M 0: All humidity area
1: 60%RH or less
2: 50%RH or less
3: 40%RH or less
4: 30%RH or less
5: 20%RH or less
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
Image
control
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Accumulated print
volume
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
M Sets whether or not performing closed-loop control
automatically when the specified number of sheets has
been printed out from the previous control.
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Image quality
Image
control
Image quality
0-1
Process
Image
control
Image quality
Auto start
2505
Relative humidity
difference
0-6
Setting
Mode
Process
Developm
ent
2506
Enable/disable setting
of toner density
correction control
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
When setting the value of 08-2708 (Toner density ratio
manual offset control) to other than "0" (Disabled), set
the value of this code to "0" (Disabled).
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
Auto start
2507
Period of time
unattended
10
0-15
Sets the unattended period of time to perform closedloop control automatically at the start of operation when
the equipment has not been used for a specified period
of time in the energy saving mode.
0: 3 1: 5 2: 7 3: 10 4: 15 5: 20 6: 30 7: 45 8: 60
9: 90 10: 120
11: 150 12: 180 13: 240 14: 300 15: 360
(Unit: minute)
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
1000
100-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
2528
0-16
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
2529
0-16
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
2530
0-16
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
2531
0-16
Yes
Setting of
accumulated print
volume
10
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
control
Item
Subitem
Potential on white
Normal speed
background/Correctio
n setting
Subcode
2548
0 Y
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
6
0-12
M 0: -30 1: -25 2: -20 3: -15 4: -10 5: -5 6: 0 7: 5 8:
10 9: 15 10: 20 11: 25 12: 30
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Normal speed
Potential on white
background/Correctio
n setting
2548
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Potential on white
Normal speed
background/Correctio
n setting
2548
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Potential on white
Normal speed
background/Correctio
n setting
2548
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Potential on white
Reduced speed
background/Correctio
n setting
2549
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Potential on white
Reduced speed
background/Correctio
n setting
2549
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Reduced speed
Potential on white
background/Correctio
n setting
2549
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Image
control
Reduced speed
Potential on white
background/Correctio
n setting
2549
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Transfer
2556
1st transfer
environmental control
switchover
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Image
control
Image quality
2600
Enable/disable setting
of pattern formation of
image quality TRC
control
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Normal speed Y
15
8-36
11
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Normal speed C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Normal speed K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Decelerating Y
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Decelerating M
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Decelerating C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2620
Decelerating K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Normal speed Y
15
8-36
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2620
1 Normal speed M
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
15
8-36
M Use this code to change the reproducibility of the
isolated points and thickness of fine lines in the image.
The larger the value, the sharper the isolated points
become and the sharper and thicker the fine lines
become. Be sure to perform image quality control after
changing the value.
Sub
element
LED
05/08
Code
12
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Normal speed C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Normal speed K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Decelerating Y
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Decelerating M
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Decelerating C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2621
Decelerating K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Normal speed Y
15
8-36
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2621
1 Normal speed M
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
15
8-36
M Use this code to change the reproducibility of the
isolated points and thickness of fine lines in the image.
The larger the value, the sharper the isolated points
become and the sharper and thicker the fine lines
become. Be sure to perform image quality control after
changing the value.
Sub
element
LED
05/08
Code
13
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
Process
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Normal speed C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Normal speed K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Decelerating Y
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Decelerating M
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Decelerating C
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Process
LED
2622
Decelerating K
15
8-36
08
Setting
Mode
Scanner
Pre-scan setting
switchover
0-1
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
2622
1 Normal speed M
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
15
8-36
M Use this code to change the reproducibility of the
isolated points and thickness of fine lines in the image.
The larger the value, the sharper the isolated points
become and the sharper and thicker the fine lines
become. Be sure to perform image quality control after
changing the value.
Sub
element
LED
05/08
Code
3015
14
Yes
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
Mode
Element
Scanner
Sub
element
RADF
Item
Subitem
Code
3021
Subcode
Details
Set for switchbackmixed size copy
15
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-1
SYS This setting is whether the original length is detected or
1
Yes
not by transporting without scanning in reverse when
A4-R/FOLIO paper or LT-R/LG paper is detected in a
mixed size copying.
0: Disabled AMS:
A series - Judges as A4-R without transporting in
reverse with no scanning.
LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG by its length
without transporting in reverse with no scanning.
APS:
A series - Judges whether it is A4-R or FOLIO without
transporting in reverse with no scanning.
LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG without
transporting in reverse with no scanning.
1: Enable 1
AMS:
A series - Judges whether it is A4-R or FOLIO by
Transporting without scanning in reverse to detect its
length.
LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG by
transporting without scanning in reverse to detect its
length.
APS:
The same as that of APS in 0: Disabled.
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Sub
element
User
interface
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
3500
3501
Subcode
Details
Device setting
16
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0SYS To enable the e-Bridge ID Gate, a card reading device
5
Yes
429496729
should be set in the order of "ABYYZZZZ". (Enter the
5
corresponding values to "A", "B", "YY" and "ZZZZ".)
- AB: Special setting
- A: Debugging NIC
0: Not used 1: Used
- B: Interface
0: USB connection 1: Serial connection (KP-2003 only)
- YY: Authentication
00: No authentication using card
02: FeliCa (KP-2003 only)
03: Mifare (KP-2005 only)
04: HID (KP-2004 only)
07: USB keyboard emulation authentication device
08: Q-tag
09: Magnetic card I/F
10: NFC (Common setting for Felica/Mifare)
11: NFC (Separate setting for Felica/Mifare)
12: NFC (Dedicated setting for Felica)
13: NFC (Dedicated setting for Mifare)
- ZZZZ: Sub-code (Specifies the usage type of card ID)
0000: No authentication using card
0001: IDm (Felica/NFC-Felica) and (or) UID
(Mifare/NFC-Mifare)
0002: Data (Felica/NFC-Felica/Mifare/NFC-Mifare)
0003: SSFC mode
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Sub
element
User
interface
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
3502
3503
Subcode
Details
Card reader format
information -2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0SYS The data of the block number in the noncontact IC is
429496729
set.
5
KP-2003: <PPQRSSTU (hexadecimal number)>
PP: 1st block
Q: 1st block beginning byte
R: 1st block ending byte
SS: 2nd block
T: 2nd block beginning byte
U: 2nd block ending byte
KP-2005: <RRBSEbse (hexadecimal number)>
RR: 00 (Fixed)
B: 1st area block number
S: 1st area beginning byte offset
E: 1st area ending byte offset
b: 2nd area block number
s: 2nd area beginning byte offset
e: 2nd area ending byte offset
* If the 2nd block/area is not used, set the SSTU to
"FFFF" (hexadecimal number), the bse to"FFF"
(hexadecimal number).
Refer to
contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
5
Yes
Yes
Yes
<Acceptable value>
0-0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
3504
Card authentication
LDAP server
0-100
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_00.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_00.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_01.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_01.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_02.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_02.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
17
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3600
3 LL_IS34_03.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_03.icc
(20/25ppm)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_04.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_04.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_05.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_05.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_06.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_06.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_07.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_07.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_08.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_08.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
LL_IS34_09.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_09.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
10
LL_IS34_10.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_10.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
11
LL_IS34_11.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_11.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
18
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3600 12 LL_IS34_12.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_12.icc
(20/25ppm)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
13
LL_IS34_13.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_13.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
14
LL_IS34_14.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_14.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
15
LL_IS34_15.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_15.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
16
LL_IS34_16.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_16.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
17
LL_IS34_17.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_17.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
18
LL_IS34_18.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_18.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
19
LL_IS34_19.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_19.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
20
LL_IS34_20.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_20.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
19
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3600 21 LL_IS34_21.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_21.icc
(20/25ppm)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
22
LL_IS34_22.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_22.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
23
LL_IS34_23.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_23.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
24
LL_IS34_24.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_24.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
25
LL_IS34_25.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_25.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
26
LL_IS34_26.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_26.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
27
LL_IS34_27.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_27.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
28
LL_IS34_28.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_28.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
29
LL_IS34_29.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_29.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
20
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3600 30 LL_IS34_30.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_30.icc
(20/25ppm)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
31
LL_IS34_31.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_31.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
32
LL_IS34_32.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_32.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
33
LL_IS34_33.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_33.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
34
LL_IS34_34.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_34.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
35
LL_IS34_35.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_35.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
36
WL_IS34_36.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
37
WL_IS34_37.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
38
WL_IS34_38.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
39
WL_IS34_39.icc
14
21
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
SubDetails
code
3600 40 WL_IS34_40.icc
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
41
WL_IS34_41.icc
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
42
WL_IS34_42.icc
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
43
WL_IS34_43.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
44
WL_IS34_44.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
45
WL_IS34_45.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
46
WL_IS34_46.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
47
WL_IS34_47.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
48
WL_IS34_48.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
49
WL_IS34_49.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
50
WL_IS34_50.icc
14
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
22
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays PG Device Pure Gray TRC attribute for the
current RGB Ink Sim profile and the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Available profile
display
PRT
SubDetails
code
3600 51 WL_IS34_51.icc
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
52
WL_IS34_52.icc
14
System
General
Available profile
display
PRT
3600
53
WL_IS34_53.icc
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Recovery of the
PRT
profile at the shipment
3601
Recovery of the
profile at the shipment
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3602
0-53
SYS Copies the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
Pure Gray TRC in the same sub-code to the USB
memory.
<20/25ppm>
0: WL_IS34_00 1: WL_IS34_01 2: WL_IS34_02 .....
51: WL_IS34_51 52: WL_IS34_52 53: WL_IS34_53
<LL20/25ppm>
0: LL_IS34_00 1: LL_IS34_01 2: LL_IS34_02 ..... 33:
LL_IS34_33 34: LL_IS34_34 35: LL_IS34_35
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3603
0-53
SYS Uploads the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC in the same sub-code from the USB
memory.
<20/25ppm>
0: WL_IS34_00 1: WL_IS34_01 2: WL_IS34_02 .....
51: WL_IS34_51 52: WL_IS34_52 53: WL_IS34_53
<LL20/25ppm>
0: LL_IS34_00 1: LL_IS34_01 2: LL_IS34_02 ..... 33:
LL_IS34_33 34: LL_IS34_34 35: LL_IS34_35
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_00.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_00.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
23
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_02.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_02.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_03.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_03.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_04.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_04.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_05.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_05.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_06.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_06.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_07.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_07.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_08.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_08.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
LL_IS34_09.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_09.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3604
1 LL_IS34_01.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_01.000
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
24
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
11
LL_IS34_11.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_11.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
12
LL_IS34_12.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_12.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
13
LL_IS34_13.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_13.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
14
LL_IS34_14.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_14.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
15
LL_IS34_15.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_15.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
16
LL_IS34_16.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_16.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
17
LL_IS34_17.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_17.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
18
LL_IS34_18.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_18.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3604 10 LL_IS34_10.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_10.000
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
25
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
20
LL_IS34_20.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_20.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
21
LL_IS34_21.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_21.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
22
LL_IS34_22.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_22.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
23
LL_IS34_23.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_23.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
24
LL_IS34_24.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_24.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
25
LL_IS34_25.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_25.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
26
LL_IS34_26.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_26.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
27
LL_IS34_27.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_27.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3604 19 LL_IS34_19.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_19.000
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
26
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
29
LL_IS34_29.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_29.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
30
LL_IS34_30.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_30.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
31
LL_IS34_31.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_31.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
32
LL_IS34_32.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_32.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
33
LL_IS34_33.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_33.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
34
LL_IS34_34.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_34.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
35
LL_IS34_35.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_35.000
(20/25ppm)
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
36
WL_IS34_36.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
37
WL_IS34_37.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3604 28 LL_IS34_28.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_28.000
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
27
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
39
WL_IS34_39.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
40
WL_IS34_40.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
41
WL_IS34_41.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
42
WL_IS34_42.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
43
WL_IS34_43.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
44
WL_IS34_44.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
45
WL_IS34_45.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
46
WL_IS34_46.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
47
WL_IS34_47.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
48
WL_IS34_48.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3604 38 WL_IS34_38.000
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
28
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
50
WL_IS34_50.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
51
WL_IS34_51.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
52
WL_IS34_52.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3604
53
WL_IS34_53.000
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
3605
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3606
0-53
SYS Copies the adjusted RGB Ink Sim profile and PG CIE
Based Pure Gray TRC in the same sub-code to USB
memory.
<20/25ppm>
0: WL_IS34_00 1: WL_IS34_01 2: WL_IS34_02 .....
51: WL_IS34_51 52: WL_IS34_52 53: WL_IS34_53
<LL20/25ppm>
0: LL_IS34_00 1: LL_IS34_01 2: LL_IS34_02 ..... 33:
LL_IS34_33 34: LL_IS34_34 35: LL_IS34_35
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
3604 49 WL_IS34_49.000
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the default RGB Ink Sim profile and PG Device 14
PureGray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
29
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Uploading the
adjusted profile from
USB memory
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Uploading the
adjusted profile from
USB memory
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-53
SYS Uploads the adjusted RGBInkSim profile and PG CIE
Based PureGray TRC in the same sub-code from the
USB memory.
<20/25ppm>
0: WL_IS34_00 1: WL_IS34_01 2: WL_IS34_02 .....
51: WL_IS34_51 52: WL_IS34_52 53: WL_IS34_53
<LL20/25ppm>
0: LL_IS34_00 1: LL_IS34_01 2: LL_IS34_02 ..... 33:
LL_IS34_33 34: LL_IS34_34 35: LL_IS34_35
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
PRT
3607
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_00.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_00.001
(20/25ppm)
14
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_01.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_01.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_02.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_02.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_03.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_03.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_04.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_04.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_05.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_05.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_06.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_06.001
(20/25ppm)
14
30
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_08.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_08.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
LL_IS34_09.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_09.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
10
LL_IS34_10.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_10.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
11
LL_IS34_11.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_11.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
12
LL_IS34_12.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_12.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
13
LL_IS34_13.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_13.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
14
LL_IS34_14.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_14.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
15
LL_IS34_15.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_15.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3608
7 LL_IS34_07.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_07.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure Gray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
31
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
17
LL_IS34_17.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_17.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
18
LL_IS34_18.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_18.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
19
LL_IS34_19.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_19.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
20
LL_IS34_20.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_20.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
21
LL_IS34_21.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_21.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
22
LL_IS34_22.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_22.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
23
LL_IS34_23.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_23.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
24
LL_IS34_24.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_24.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3608 16 LL_IS34_16.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_16.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure Gray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
32
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
26
LL_IS34_26.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_26.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
27
LL_IS34_27.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_27.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
28
LL_IS34_28.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_28.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
29
LL_IS34_29.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_29.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
30
LL_IS34_30.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_30.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
31
LL_IS34_31.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_31.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
32
LL_IS34_32.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_32.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
33
LL_IS34_33.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_33.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3608 25 LL_IS34_25.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_25.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure Gray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
33
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
35
LL_IS34_35.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_35.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
36
WL_IS34_36.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
37
WL_IS34_37.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
38
WL_IS34_38.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
39
WL_IS34_39.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
40
WL_IS34_40.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
41
WL_IS34_41.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
42
WL_IS34_42.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
43
WL_IS34_43.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
44
WL_IS34_44.001
14
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3608 34 LL_IS34_34.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_IS34_34.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure Gray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
34
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
46
WL_IS34_46.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
47
WL_IS34_47.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
48
WL_IS34_48.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
49
WL_IS34_49.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
50
WL_IS34_50.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
51
WL_IS34_51.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
52
WL_IS34_52.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
3608
53
WL_IS34_53.001
14
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
3612
Date of unpacking
13 digits
SYS Year/month/date/day/hour/minute/second
Example:03 07 01 3 13 27 48
"Day" - "0" is for "Sunday".
Proceeds Monday through Saturday from "1" to "6".
11
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3615
0-1
Mode
Element
Item
Displaying the
PRT
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Subitem
SubDetails
code
3608 45 WL_IS34_45.001
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure Gray TRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
35
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Clearing of service
history list file
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Initializes the service history list file.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
3
Clearing of service
history list file
3619
General
3623
System
General
3624
Setting
Mode
System
General
3626
Department
information
transmission setting
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3628
Enable/Disable setting
of standard data
overwrite function
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
* This code is valid for NAD only.
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
3635
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3702
MFP's
serial
number
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3704
PDC2 of user
authentication
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3705
BDC2 of user
authentication
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3706
PDC3 of user
authentication
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3707
BDC3 of user
authentication
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3719
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3720
12
36
0-511
214748
0SYS Changes the target type of logs for notification in real
3921 429496729
time log notification function.
5
12
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3722
PDC/BDC timeout
value of Windows
Domain
Authentication (Unit:
Seconds)
60
1-180
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3723
User authentication
PDC/BDC time-out
period (Unit: Seconds)
30
1-180
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3724
Windows Domain
Authentication
method of Windows
Domain/User
Authentication
1-3
NIC 1: Auto
2: Kerberos
3: NTLMv2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3725
16
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3726
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3727
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3728
LPD active
connection
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3729
ATalk PS max
Connection
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3730
ATalk PS active
Connection
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3731
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3732
10
1-16
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3736
1-180
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3739
30
1-180
12
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
3721
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
MFP's
Maximum 32 letters
serial
"MFP's serial number" is set as default. Perform 08number
9083 to set the default value.
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
AppleTalk device
name
37
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3754
Switching printer
setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3755
Switching scanner
setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3757
Discovery Port
Number
3702
1-65535
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3758
Metadata Exchange
Port Number
50081
1-65535
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3759
50082
1-65535
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3760
50083
1-65535
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3765
10
1-20
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DPWS
3766
10
1-20
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3767
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3768
Switching address
acquisition
1-3
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3770
IPv6 Address
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3771
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3772
Default Gateway
setting
12
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
3743
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
5
1-180
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at LDAP client connection 12
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
LDAP client TimeOut
38
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3777
Stateless Address
setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3778
Acquiring DHCPv6
Option
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3779
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3780
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3781
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPv6
3782
Secondary DNS
Server Address
Registration
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3793
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3802
Paper size
NAD: 2
Others:
6
0-13
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3803
Enable/disable setting
0-1
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
3774
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
2
1-2
NIC DHCPv6 Option is switched when the Manual is set.
1: Enabled
2: Disabled
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
DHCPv6 Option
setting
39
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
System
Sub
element
Scanner
Item
Subitem
Code
3805
Subcode
Details
Department
Management setting
by Remote Scan
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
3
0-3
SYS Sets the department management with remote scanning
1
as follows:
0: w/o GUI OFF, w/ GUI OFF
1: w/o GUI ON, w/ GUI OFF
2: w/o GUI OFF, w/ GUI ON
3: w/o GUI ON, w/ GUI ON
w/o GUI:
Remote scanning is operated on SSOP application of
eCOPY Inc.
w/ GUI:
Remote scanning is operated on TTEC-specific GUI.
This setting is only for department management with
remote scanning. When GUI is set ON, a department
code dialog is displayed at the start-up of remote
scanning. This code is valid only when the code 089120 is set "1 (Valid)".
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Direct SMTP
3810
Communication
setting
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Direct SMTP
3811
Image encrypting at
the Direct SMTP
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Internet Fax
3812
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Scanner
XPS file
3815
Thumbnail addition
0-1
40
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Scanner
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3833
Home directory
function
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3837
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
License control
3840
Registration/ deletion
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
3847
FAX mis-transmission
prevention
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
3848
Restriction on
Address Book
destination
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
3849
Restriction on
destination direct
entry
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3851
08
Setting
mode
System
General
3852
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS The paper size of the XPS file produced by the Scan
function is set.
0: Scanned image size
1: Standard size
Sub
element
Scanner
05/08
Details
XPS file
3816
PDF file
3817
Version setting
0-1
Summer time
Yes
Yes
0-1
Yes
0-1
Yes
Template display
0-1
Summer time
Automatic change
function
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
41
<Default value>
MJD, NAD: 1
Others: 0
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
General
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Summer time
Summer time
Subitem
Code
3853
Start
3854
Subcode
Details
Time to shift
Month
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
2
0-7
SYS 0: +2:00 1: +1:30 2: +1:00 3: +0:30 4: -0:30 5: -1:00 6: 1
1:30 7: -2:00
Refer to
content
s
1-12
<Default value>
MJD, NAD: 3
Others: 1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Summer time
Start
3856
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Summer time
Start
3857
Hours
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Summer time
Start
3858
Minutes
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Summer time
End
3859
Month
08
08
Setting
mode
System
Setting
mode
System
General
General
General
Summer time
Summer time
Summer time
Start
End
End
3855
3860
3861
Week
Week
42
Refer to
content
s
1-5
0-6
Refer to
content
s
0-23
SYS 0 to 23
0-59
SYS 0 to 59
Refer to
content
s
1-12
Refer to
content
s
1-5
0-6
<Default value>
MJD: 5
NAD: 2
Others: 1
<Default value>
MJD, NAD: 2
Others: 0
<Default value>
MJD: 10
NAD: 11
Others: 1
SYS 1: 1st 2: 2nd 3: 3rd 4: 4th 5: Last
<Default value>
MJD: 5
Others: 1
SYS 0: Sun1: Mon2: Tue3: Wed4: Thu5: Fri6: Sat
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3864
Disclosure of telnet
function
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
3865
Availability of telnet
server
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Default setting of
paper source
PPC
4010
Default setting of
paper source
0-5
SYS 0: A4/LT
1: LCF
2: 1st drawer
3: 2nd drawer
4: PFP upper drawer
5: PFP lower drawer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Automatic change of
paper source
Auto
4011
PPC
1-2
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Laser
4012
Pre-running of print
device
0-2
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to
0-23
SYS 0 to 23
content
s
<Default value>
MJD: 3
NAD: 2
Others: 0
Sub
element
General
05/08
Details
Hours
Contents
Summer time
End
3862
Summer time
End
3863
Minutes
0-59
SYS 0 to 59
43
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Laser
Item
Subitem
Code
4015
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
Time to shift to energy
0
0-6
SYS Switches the status of print device from the ready for
1
saving of print device
print to the standby when a certain period of time has
passed from the pre-running. This code sets the period
to switch the status to the standby.
0: 15 sec. 1: 20 sec. 2: 25 sec. 3: 30 sec. 4: 35 sec.
5: 40 sec. 6: 45 sec.
This setting is effective when the value of 08-4012 is set
to "0" or "2."
Details
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Automatic change of
paper source
When a drawer is
specified
4016
PPC
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Automatic change of
paper source
When a drawer is
specified
4016
Printing/BOX printing
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4020
Plain paper/recycled
paper/Thin paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4020
Other paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4021
Plain paper/recycled
paper/Thin paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4021
Other paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4022
Plain paper/recycled
paper/Thin paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4022
Other paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4023
Plain paper/recycled
paper/Thin paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4023
Other paper
0-5
Yes
44
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4024
0 Plain paper/recycled
paper/Thin paper
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
5
0-5
M Sets the number of times feeding retry occurs from the
bypass tray.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4024
Other paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4025
Plain paper
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4100
1st drawer
Refer to
content
s
0-255
<Default value>
NAD: 64
Others: 4
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4101
2nd drawer
Refer to
content
s
0-255
<Default value>
NAD: 81
Others: 19
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4102
Refer to
content
s
0-255
<Default value>
NAD: 80
Others: 20
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4103
Refer to
content
s
0-255
45
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Printer
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Paper size setting
Subitem
Code
4104
Subcode
Details
LCF
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-255
M Press the button on the LCD to select the size. This
content
code is reset every time a paper size is detected
s
automatically.
4: A4
64: LT
Proce Servic
dure e UI
9
<Default value>
NAD: 64
Others: 4
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
PFP/LCF installation
4105
PFP/LCF installation
0-4
0: Automatic
1: PFP single-drawer type installed
2: PFP dual-drawer type installed
3: LCF installed
4: Not installed
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4106
A3-R
420/29
7
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4107
A4-R
297/21
0
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4108
A5-R
210/14
8
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4109
B4-R
364/25
7
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4110
B5-R
257/18
2
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4111
LT-R
279/21
6
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4112
LD-R
432/27
9
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4113
LG-R
356/21
6
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4114
ST-R
216/14
0
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4115
COMPUTER-R
356/25
7
182432/140297
10
46
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
10
4116
Paper
feeding
4117
13"LG-R
330/21
6
182432/140297
10
Printer
Paper
feeding
4118
8.5"X8.5"-R
216/21
6
182432/140297
10
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4119
Non-standard
432/27
9
148432/105297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4120
8K-R
390/27
0
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4121
16K-R
270/19
5
182432/140297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4122
A3-wide-R
457/30
5
182457/140305
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4123
A6-R
148/10
5
148432/105297
10
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4131
0-1
0: ON
1: OFF
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4140
Bypass feed
255
0-391
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4143
Envelop: Monarch-R
191/98
148432/98-297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4144
Envelop: 120x235-R
235/12
0
148432/105297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4145
Envelop: 105x235-R
235/10
5
148432/105297
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4205
LD-wide
457/30
5
148457/105305
10
PPC
FOLIO-R
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
330/21
182M Value of feeding/widthwise direction
0
432/140297
47
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
Details
Post card
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
148/10
148M Value of feeding/widthwise direction.
0
432/100* Post card is supported only for JPN model.
297
Proce Servic
dure e UI
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Fuser
Fusing error
temperature
Temperature of the
fuser roller center
thermistor
4530
0-255
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Fuser
Fusing error
temperature
Temperature of the
fuser roller center
thermistor
4530
0-255
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Fuser
Fusing error
temperature
Temperature of the
fuser roller rear
thermistor
4531
0-255
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Fuser
Fusing error
temperature
Temperature of the
fuser roller rear
thermistor
4531
0-255
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Fuser
Fusing error
temperature
4532
Temperature of the
fuser roller front
thermopiles
0-255
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4542
0-1
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
transport
4546
Execution mode
setting
0-6
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Finisher
4547
15
0-30
3-30sec.
(In increments of 1sec.)
Color registration
control
4206
Subcode
48
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Finisher
Item
Subitem
Code
4548
Subcode
Details
Finisher model
switching setting
value
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-1
M 0: 1: MJ-1036/1037
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
transport
Color registration
control
4550
1st startup
3-255
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
transport
Color registration
control
4550
2nd or subsequent
startups
30
3-255
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Printer
During printing
4551
Mixing start
0-6
0: 100 counts
1: 200 counts
2: 300 counts
3: 600 counts
4: 1200 counts
5: 2400 counts
6: 3600 counts
08
Setting
mode
Printer
During printing
4551
Rotation period
0-6
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Pausing of pushing
paper
4553
2nd drawer
0-7
0: Disabled
1: Enabled (recycled paper only)
2: Enabled (plain paper only)
3: Enabled (plain paper and recycled paper)
4: Enabled (thin paper only)
5: Enabled (recycled paper and thin paper)
6: Enabled (plain paper and thin paper)
7: Enabled (plain paper, recycled paper, and thin paper)
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Pausing of pushing
paper
4553
0-7
0: Disabled
1: Enabled (recycled paper only)
2: Enabled (plain paper only)
3: Enabled (plain paper and recycled paper)
4: Enabled (thin paper only)
5: Enabled (recycled paper and thin paper)
6: Enabled (plain paper and thin paper)
7: Enabled (plain paper, recycled paper, and thin paper)
49
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Pausing of pushing
paper
SubDetails
code
4553
3 PFP lower drawer
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
0-7
M 0: Disabled
4
1: Enabled (recycled paper only)
2: Enabled (plain paper only)
3: Enabled (plain paper and recycled paper)
4: Enabled (thin paper only)
5: Enabled (recycled paper and thin paper)
6: Enabled (plain paper and thin paper)
7: Enabled (plain paper, recycled paper, and thin paper)
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
Printer
During warming-up
4554
At normal status
0-5
08
Setting
mode
Printer
During warming-up
4554
During warming-up
after used toner full
status detection
0-5
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
transport
Color registration
control
4562
Time of pausing
continuous printing
1-60
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4567
SRA3
450/32
0
148460/105320
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4568
460 mm x 320 mm
460/32
0
148460/105320
10
08
Setting
mode
Printer
General
4586
210-231
<Default value>
210: e-STUDIO2050C
211: e-STUDIO2550C
212: 213: 214: 215: 216: 230: e-STUDIO2051C
231: e-STUDIO2551C
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
transport
4605
Accumulated counter
value
8 digits
Color registration
control
50
Yes
Yes
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Once
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Twice
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
3 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 5 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 10 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 20 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 50 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 100 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 250 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
8 digits
Up to 500 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
10
8 digits
Up to 1000 times
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4615
11
8 digits
Up to 2000 times
Mode
Element
Item
Destination
Subitem
Code
4608
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-9
M For EEPROM on LGC board
content
0: NAD 1: MJD 2: JPD 3: ASD 5: TWD 6: CND 8:
s
AUD 9: ARD
<Default value>
MJD: 1 NAD: 0 JPD: 2 ASD: 3 AUD: 8 TWD: 5
CND: 6 ARD: 9
Sub
element
General
05/08
Details
Destination
categorized code
51
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4616
Latest
0-255
14
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
4616
Once earlier
0-255
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4615 12 Counter for job
number of sheets
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M 2001 times or more
Sub
element
Counter
05/08
Code
52
Contents
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Sub
element
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
History storing area of
fusing error counter
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4616
2 Twice earlier
Code
4616
3 times earlier
53
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-255
M 0:No error 1: C411 error
2: C412 error 3: C443 error
4: Not used 5: C445, C465 error
6: C446, C466 error 7: C447 error
8: C468 error 9: C449 error
10 to 17: Not used 18: C468 error
19: C449 error 20: C468 error
21: C449 error 22: C449 error
23: C449 error 24: C447 error
25: C449 error 26: C468 error
27: C449 error 28: C468 error
29: C449 error 30: Not used
31: C4D0 error 32: C448 error
33: C467 error 34: C467 error
35 to 37: Not used 38: C450 error
39: C450 error 40: Not used
41: C451 error 42: C451 error
43 to 47: Not used
48: C450 error 49: C450 error
50: C452 error 51: C452 error
52 to 255: Not used
0
0-255
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
14
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Sub
element
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
History storing area of
fusing error counter
Subitem
SubDetails
code
4616
4 4 times earlier
Code
4616
4621
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-255
M 0:No error 1: C411 error
2: C412 error 3: C443 error
4: Not used 5: C445, C465 error
6: C446, C466 error 7: C447 error
8: C468 error 9: C449 error
10 to 17: Not used 18: C468 error
19: C449 error 20: C468 error
21: C449 error 22: C449 error
23: C449 error 24: C447 error
25: C449 error 26: C468 error
27: C449 error 28: C468 error
29: C449 error 30: Not used
31: C4D0 error 32: C448 error
33: C467 error 34: C467 error
35 to 37: Not used 38: C450 error
39: C450 error 40: Not used
41: C451 error 42: C451 error
43 to 47: Not used
48: C450 error 49: C450 error
50: C452 error 51: C452 error
52 to 255: Not used
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
5 times earlier
0-255
14
0-1
54
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
Printer
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
All clear
Destination
Item
Subitem
PPC/PRT
Code
4622
4659
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-65535
M This is a counter for bypass paper size detection
1
setting. If the printing is executed with the paper size
that differs from the paper size set on the control panel,
the counter is counted up.
Refer to
content
s
Details
0-255
<Default value>
JPD: 2
NAD: 1
MJD: 0
ASD: 9
AUD: 3
TWD: 6
CND: 4
ARD: 10
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Maintenan
ce
4661
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4675
0-2
0: Disabled
1: Position change of jammed paper
2: Ejects paper
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
4676
Counter of paper
ejection for size error
of bypass feeding
0-65535
55
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
IC chip
Board information of
toner cartridge
4689
0-255
0: Normal
1: Access abnormality 1
2: Access abnormality 2
3: Access abnormality 3
4: Access abnormality 4
5: Occurrence of C911
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
IC chip
Board information of
toner cartridge
4689
0-255
0: Normal
1: Access abnormality 1
2: Access abnormality 2
3: Access abnormality 3
4: Access abnormality 4
5: Occurrence of C911
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
IC chip
Board information of
toner cartridge
4689
0-255
0: Normal
1: Access abnormality 1
2: Access abnormality 2
3: Access abnormality 3
4: Access abnormality 4
5: Occurrence of C911
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
IC chip
Board information of
toner cartridge
4689
0-255
0: Normal
1: Access abnormality 1
2: Access abnormality 2
3: Access abnormality 3
4: Access abnormality 4
5: Occurrence of C911
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Finisher
Batch writing of
adjustment value
4695
MJ-1036/1037
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Finisher
Batch read-in of
adjustment value
4696
MJ-1036/1037
Yes
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
4686
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
M Displays the low 2 or 3 digits of the printer ROM version
2
(08-9901) when printer all clear (08-9090) is performed.
The version number is described by alphanumeric
characters.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Details
Printer ROM version
display at printer all
clear
56
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Waste toner box
ce
Subitem
Code
4700
Subcode
Details
Detection setting of
nearly-full status
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
6
0-6
M Select the appropriate value if the detection error
occurs.
0: 140000 (Transfer efficiency 70%/equivalent to 12k
sheets)
1: 448100 (Transfer efficiency 70%/equivalent to 38k
sheets)
2: 198400 (Transfer efficiency 80%/equivalent to 12k
sheets)
3: 634900 (Transfer efficiency 80%/equivalent to 38k
sheets)
4: 375900 (Transfer efficiency 90%/equivalent to 12k
sheets)
5: 1203000 (Transfer efficiency 90%/equivalent to 38k
sheets)
6: Nearly-full detection is disabled
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Printer
08
Setting
mode
Printer
4706
0-15
08
Setting
mode
Printer
4706
0-15
08
Setting
mode
Printer
4706
0-15
08
Setting
mode
Printer
4706
0-15
08
Setting
mode
Printer
General
4708
Switchover setting of
transport control for
custom size
(297x431.8mm)
0-1
57
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Developm Toner near empty
ent
Subitem
Code
5155
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Pre-running starting
time at warm-up
5204
Warm-up
0-60
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Pre-running starting
time at warm-up
5204
0-60
08
Setting
Mode
Process
Fuser
Sleep
Paper
0-2
0: Disabled
1: 60 to 80g paper
2: 81 to 1050g paper
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Temperature drop
control during printing
2
Black
0-8
0: Disabled
1: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR and PR of
normal/low temperature)
2: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR of
normal/low temperature)
3: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR of normal/low
temperature)
4: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR of normal temperature)
5: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR of normal
temperature)
6: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR and PR of normal/low
temperature)
7: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR and PR of normal
temperature)
8: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR and PR of
normal temperature)
Temperature
5244
correction for allowing
ready at recovery
from sleep mode
5284
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-2
M Sets the timing for when the toner near empty display
appears. The larger the value, the later the display
appears.
0: Longer *1
1: Center (normal)
2: Shorter *2
*1: The period of time (number of counts) from the
appearance of the near empty display to actually
running out of toner is longer (larger) than that of
"center".
*2: The period of time (number of counts) from the
appearance of the near empty display to actually
running out of toner is shorter (smaller) than that of
"center".
58
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled
paper/Center
5293
At normal
temperatures/Black
10
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled
paper/Center
5293
At normal
temperatures/Color
10
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled
paper/Center
5293
At low
temperatures/Black
11
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled
paper/Center
5293
At low
temperatures/Color
11
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled paper/Side
5294
At normal
temperatures/Black
10
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled paper/Side
5294
At normal
temperatures/Color
10
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled paper/Side
5294
At low
temperatures/Black
11
0-16
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Temperature drop
control during printing
2
Subcode
5284
1 Color
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-8
M 0: Disabled
4
1: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR and PR of
normal/low temperature)
2: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR of
normal/low temperature)
3: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR of normal/low
temperature)
4: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR of normal temperature)
5: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR of normal
temperature)
6: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR and PR of normal/low
temperature)
7: Enabled; Thick paper 2 (HR and PR of normal
temperature)
8: Enabled; Thick paper 2/Thick paper 3 (HR and PR of
normal temperature)
Sub
element
Fuser
05/08
Code
Details
59
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
5294
3 At low
temperatures/Color
Code
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
11
0-16
M 0: 90 1: 95 2: 100 3: 105 4: 110 5: 115
4
6: 120 7: 125 8: 130 9: 135 10: 140 11:
145 12: 150 13: 155 14: 160 15: 165 16:
170
Fusing temperature
during printing
Recycled paper/Side
Fuser
Black
0-16
Process
Fuser
Color
0-16
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled
paper/Normal
temperature
5300
Black/Heat roller
(Center)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 10
Others: 11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled
paper/Normal
temperature
5300
Black/Heat roller
(Side)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 10
Others: 11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled
paper/Normal
temperature
5300
Color/Heat roller
(Center)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 10
Others: 11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled
paper/Normal
temperature
5300
Color/Heat roller
(Side)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 10
Others: 11
60
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
5301
0 Black/Heat roller
(Center)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
Refer to
0-18
M 0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
4
content
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
s
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 11
Others: 12
Code
Recycled paper/Low
temperature
Fuser
Recycled paper/Low
temperature
5301
Black/Heat roller
(Side)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 11
Others: 12
Process
Fuser
Recycled paper/Low
temperature
5301
Color/Heat roller
(Center)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 11
Others: 12
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled paper/Low
temperature
5301
Color/Heat roller
(Side)
Refer to
content
s
0-18
0: 80 1: 85 2: 90 3: 95 4: 100 5: 105 6:
110 7: 115 8: 120 9: 125 10: 130 11:
135 12: 140 13: 145 14: 150 15: 155 16:
160 17: 165 18: 170
<Default value>
JPD: 11
Others: 12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper / At
normal temperatures
5308
Plain paper/Black
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Plain paper / At
normal temperatures
5308
Plain paper/Color
0-16
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Recycled paper / At
normal temperatures
5309
Black
0-16
61
08
Setting
mode
Process
Sub
element
Fuser
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Subcode
5309
1 Color
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-16
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec. 2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5
sec. 6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec. 8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec. 10: 12
sec. 11: 14 sec. 12: 16 sec. 13: 18 sec. 14: 20 sec.
15: 25 sec. 16: 30 sec.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Recycled paper / At
normal temperatures
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
5310
Black
0-11
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
5310
Color
0-11
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
Recycled paper/At
normal temperatures
5310
Black
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Applicable period of
pre-running time for
first printing
Recycled paper/At
normal temperatures
5310
Color
0-11
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
At normal
temperatures (Black)
Refer to
content
s
0-12
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
5412
0-15
0: None 1: 30 2: 40 3: 50 4: 60 5: 70 6:
80 7: 90 8: 100 9: 110 10: 120 11: 130
12: 140 13: 150 14: 160 15: 170
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
5455
Small-sized paper
0-10
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Time of control
between paper at
paper feeding
5456
Small-sized paper
0-15
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Control between
paper at paper
feeding
Small-sized paper
0-1
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
5316
Temperature setting
for starting
abnormality handling
Recycled paper
Normal temperature
5409
5457
62
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Process
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Noncontact thermistor
correction amount
5461
Center thermistor
18
5-50
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
Noncontact thermistor
correction amount
5461
Side thermistor
18
5-50
08
Setting
mode
Process
Fuser
5462
Temperature at
correction
20
0-100
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
5550
Setting value
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
5551
Setting value
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
5552
Setting value
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
5553
Setting value
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5554
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
<Default>
20/LL20ppm: 56000
25/LL25ppm: 70000
[Unit: page]
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Developer material
5555
145000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5556
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
<Default>
20/LL20ppm: 56000
25/LL25ppm: 70000
[Unit: page]
Mode
Element
Item
Control between
paper at paper
feeding
Subitem
Low temperature
SubDetails
code
5457
1 Small-sized paper
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1
M 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Sub
element
Fuser
05/08
Code
63
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan PM drive counter
ce
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Setting value (Y)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
145000
8 digits
M Time accumulating counter
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Developer material
5557
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5558
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
<Default>
20/LL20ppm: 56000
25/LL25ppm: 70000
[Unit: page]
Counter
Developer material
5559
145000
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5560
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
<Default>
20/LL20ppm: 56000
25/LL25ppm: 70000
[Unit: page]
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Developer material
5561
145000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Parts
5562
Setting value
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
<Default value>
20ppm: 112000
25ppm: 140000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
[Unit. page]
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Parts
5563
Setting value
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
5564
Current value
8 digits
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
5565
Current value
8 digits
64
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Current value
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON.
0: clear
(Unit: page)
same as 08-6256-0
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
5566
5567
Current value
8 digits
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5568
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Developer material
5569
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5570
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Developer material
5571
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5572
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Developer material
5573
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Developer material
5574
8 digits
65
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan PM drive counter
ce
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Current value (C)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Counts the drum driving time.
0: clear
[Unit]
1 count = 2 seconds (Normal), 1 count = 3 seconds
(Decelerating mode)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Developer material
5575
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Parts
5576
Current value
8 digits
Counter
Parts
5577
Current value
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5578
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5579
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5580
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5581
Developer material
(K)
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5582
Developer material
(Y)
0-2
66
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Subitem
Code
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5583
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5584
Developer material
(C)
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
5585
Parts
0-2
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
Paper size
6010
Large-sized paper
Refer to
content
s
0-2
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
2: Counted as 1 (Mechanical counter is double counter)
Yes
Developer material
(M)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-2
M Selects the reference to notify the PM timing. (The
message is displayed on the LCD screen.)
0: PM counter (The number of output pages is set at
08-6190.)
1: PM time counter (The timing is set at 08-6191.)
2: Whichever comes faster
<Default value>
JPD: 0
Others: 1
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
Paper size
6011
Definition setting of
large sized paper
0-1
0: A3/LD
1: A3/LD/B4/LG/FOLIO/COMP
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper size
6012
Large-sized paper
0-1
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper size
6013
Definition setting of
large sized paper
0-1
0: A3/LD
1: A3/LD/B4/LG/FOLIO/COMP
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper type
6014
Thick paper
0-1
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper type
6015
OHP
0-1
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper type
6016
Envelope
0-1
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For PM
Paper type
6017
Tab paper
0-1
0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Yes
67
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Sub
element
Double
count
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Count setting of
special paper
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-1
M 0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
For PM
Paper type
6018
Copy
Full color
6060
Large
8 digits
14
Counter
Copy
Full color
6060
Small
8 digits
14
Setting
mode
Counter
Printer
Full color
6061
Large
8 digits
14
Setting
mode
Counter
Printer
Full color
6061
Small
8 digits
14
68
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Small
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Black
6063
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Black
6063
Small
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Printer
Black
6064
Large
8 digits
14
Mode
Element
SubDetails
code
Twin Color/Monocolor 6062
0 Large
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
14
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Twin Color
Mode in the Copier Function according to its size
(large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
Sub
element
Copy
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
69
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
List print
Black
6065
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
List print
Black
6065
Small
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Black
6066
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Black
6066
Small
8 digits
14
Mode
Element
Black
SubDetails
code
6064
1 Small
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
14
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Black Mode
in the Printer Function according to its size
(large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
Sub
element
Printer
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
70
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
14
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Full Color
Mode in the Copier Function according to its size
(large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Sub
element
Copy
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Scanning
08
Setting
mode
Counter
NW
Scanning
Full color
6068
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
NW
Scanning
Full color
6068
Small
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Scanning
Large
8 digits
14
05/08
Mode
Element
Scanning
Full color
SubDetails
code
6067
0 Large
Full color
6067
Small
8 digits
14
Item
Subitem
Code
71
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Scanning
Black
6070
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Copy
Scanning
Black
6070
Small
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Scanning
Black
6071
Large
8 digits
14
08
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Scanning
Black
6071
Small
8 digits
14
Mode
Element
Scanning
SubDetails
code
Twin Color/Monocolor 6069
1 Small
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Twin Color 14
Mode in the Copier Function according to its size
(large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
Sub
element
Copy
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
72
05/08
Black
NW
Scanning
Black
6072
Small
8 digits
14
Counter
FAX
Transmission
Black
6073
Large
8 digits
14
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Transmission
Black
6073
Small
8 digits
14
Setting
mode
Counter
FAX
Reception
Black
6074
Large
8 digits
14
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Sub
element
NW
Scanning
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages in the Scanning
14
Function according to its size (large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
SubDetails
code
6072
0 Large
Mode
Item
Subitem
Code
73
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
FAX
Item
Reception
Subitem
Black
SubDetails
code
6074
1 Small
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Scanning
6081
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Scanning
6081
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For charging
Paper type
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Double
count
For charging
Paper type
6080
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of received pages in the FAX
14
Function according to its size (large/small).
Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at
08-6011
Small:
Number of output pages other than set as large-sized
paper
0-1
Yes
Black
100
0-9999
Yes
Full Color
100
0-9999
Yes
6083
Thick1/2/3/4 (Back)
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets the weight of fee charging count for printing per
page. Scan counter and fax counter are not influenced.
0: Single
1: Double
<Default value>
JPD/CND: 0
Others: 1
Yes
6083
Special1/2 (Back)
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets the weight of fee charging count for printing per
page. Scan counter and fax counter are not influenced.
0: Single
1: Double
<Default value>
JPD/CND: 0
Others: 1
Yes
74
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Yes
For charging
Paper type
Double
count
For charging
Paper type
6083
Envelope
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets the weight of fee charging count for printing per
page. Scan counter and fax counter are not influenced.
0: Single
1: Double
<Default value>
JPD/CND: 0
Others: 1
Yes
Counter
Double
count
For charging
Paper type
6083
Tab paper
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets the weight of fee charging count for printing per
page. Scan counter and fax counter are not influenced.
0: Single
1: Double
<Default value>
JPD/CND: 0
Others: 1
Yes
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
0-1
SYS Sets the type of Quota. When the value of this code is
set to "1", the value of 08-9116 is set to "0" (Black free
function is OFF).
0: Color/Black Quota
1: Job Quota
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Black/Small
100
0-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Black/Large
100
0-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Full color/Small
100
0-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Full color/Large
100
0-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Twin
Color/Monocolor/Smal
l
100
0-9999
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Custom
counter
Quota control
Weighting/Print
6085
Twin
Color/Monocolor/Larg
e
100
0-9999
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
Double
count
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-1
SYS Sets the weight of fee charging count for printing per
content
page. Scan counter and fax counter are not influenced.
s
0: Single
1: Double
<Default value>
JPD/CND: 0
Others: 1
SubDetails
code
6083
3 Transparency
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
6084
75
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Custom
counter
Item
Subitem
Counter Settings
Code
6086
Subcode
Details
Display in TopAccess
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-1
SYS Sets whether the counter settings (screen of weighting
1
Yes
setting of custom counter) are displayed in TopAccess
for administrator, or set by code 08-6081 and 6085 only.
0: OFF (Not displayed in TopAccess)
1: ON (Displayed in TopAccess)
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6110
1st drawer
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6111
2nd drawer
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6112
Bypass feed
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6113
LCF
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6114
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6115
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6116
ADU
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Counter of
Paper feed
6117
RADF
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
6190
Setting value
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
6191
Setting value
225000
8 digits
76
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
6192
6193
Setting value
225000
8 digits
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
6194
Current value
8 digits
Yes
Setting
Mode
Counter
6195
Current value
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
6196
Current value
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
6197
Current value
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Maintenan PM counter
ce
Switching of output
pages/ driving counts
at PM
6198
0-2
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Process
6211
Accumulated counter
of output pages since
the performing of
image quality control
4 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Process
6225
Thick paper 1
8 digits
Number of output
pages
Setting value
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M Sets the threshold for displaying a message for PM
content
timing.
s
0: Not displayed
<Default>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
[Unit: page]
77
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Sub
element
Process
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Process
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Main
charger
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Thick paper 2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON in the
thick paper 2 mode.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Number of output
pages
6226
Number of output
pages
6228
OHP film
8 digits
6229
8 digits
6230
1st drawer
8 digits
Yes
Paper
feeding
6231
2nd drawer
8 digits
Yes
Counter
Paper
feeding
6232
8 digits
Yes
Setting
Mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6233
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6234
Bypass feed
8 digits
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6235
LCF
8 digits
Yes
78
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Counter
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6236
Subcode
Details
1st drawer
79
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
20
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Counter
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6237
Subcode
Details
2nd drawer
80
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
20
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Counter
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6238
Subcode
Details
PFP upper drawer
81
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
20
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Counter
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6239
Subcode
Details
PFP lower drawer
82
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
20
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
Counter
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6240
Subcode
Details
Bypass feed
83
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
6241
Subcode
Details
LCF
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
20
8 digits
M When the number of feeding retry (08-6230 to 6235)
1
exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be
performed subsequently. In case "0" is set as a setting
value, however, the feeding retry continues regardless
of the counter setting value.
* Feeding retry counter upper limit value
In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the
transfer belt prior to a paper feeding. When the feeding
retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the
toner image on the transfer belt is cleaned off without
the 2nd transfer since the paper cannot be reached for
the 2nd transfer process. After that, the toner image
formation is retried while the paper is waited. In this
case, the toner for this image formation is consumed
wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is
already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally
completed.
Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be
consumed consequently when the upper limit value of
feeding retry counter is set larger or set as 0 (no limit).
The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper
misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if
the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6243
Special paper
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6244
Tab paper
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Paper
feeding
6247
Envelope
8 digits
(Unit: Sheets)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
84
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6250
3 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6250
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6251
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
8 digits
85
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6252
7 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
for control
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6252
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6253
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6254
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6254
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6255
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
86
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6256
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
s
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6256
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6257
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
87
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6258
5 Driving counts at the
last replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6258
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6259
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6260
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
88
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
6261
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Date of previous
replacement
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6262
Present number of
output pages
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6262
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6262
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
6262
8 digits
6262
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
PM
counter
6262
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6262
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6262
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6262
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6263
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
89
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6264
3 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6264
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6265
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
8 digits
90
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Charger grid (K)
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6274
7 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
for control
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6274
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6275
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6276
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6276
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
6276
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6276
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6276
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6276
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6276
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6276
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6276
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6277
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
91
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Charger grid (M)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6278
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
s
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6278
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6279
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
92
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Charger grid (C)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6280
5 Driving counts at the
last replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6280
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6281
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6282
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
93
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(K)
6283
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Date of previous
replacement
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
Present number of
output pages
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
6284
8 digits
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6284
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(Y)
6285
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
94
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6286
3 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6286
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(M)
6287
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
8 digits
95
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6288
7 Present rotation
counts for control
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6288
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Charger
(Wire/needle)(C)
6289
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6290
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6290
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
6290
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6290
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6290
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6290
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6290
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6290
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6290
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6291
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
96
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6292
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
s
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6292
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6293
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
97
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6294
5 Driving counts at the
last replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6294
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6295
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Present rotation
counts for control
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6296
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
98
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
6297
Date of previous
replacement
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
Present number of
output pages
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
6298
8 digits
Ozone filter
6298
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6298
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Ozone filter
6299
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
99
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6300
2 Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
8 digits
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
145000
8 digits
8 digits
6300
8 digits
Developer material
(K)
6300
8 digits
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6300
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(K)
6301
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
145000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
8 digits
100
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6302
6 Present output pages
for control
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6302
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(Y)
6303
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
145000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6304
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(M)
6305
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
101
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6306
0 Present number of
output pages
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
145000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6306
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Developer material
(C)
6307
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
8 digits
102
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
PM
counter
6314
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6314
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6314
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6315
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
8 digits
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
PM
counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm: 600750
s
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
SubDetails
code
6314
4 Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
103
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
Contents
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
1st transfer Y roller
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6316
6 Present output pages
for control
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6316
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6317
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6318
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
104
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
6319
Date of previous
replacement
PM
counter
6320
Present number of
output pages
Counter
PM
counter
6320
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6320
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
6320
8 digits
6320
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
PM
counter
6320
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6320
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6320
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6320
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6321
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
105
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Transfer belt
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6328
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm: 150000
s
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6328
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Transfer belt
6329
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
106
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6332
3 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
675000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6332
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6333
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
107
<Default value>
20ppm: 600750
25ppm: 731250
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
<Default value>
20ppm: 112000
25ppm: 140000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20/25ppm: 450000
LL20ppm: 360000
LL25ppm: 443250
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
2nd transfer roller
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6340
5 Driving counts at the
last replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6340
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6341
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6346
8 digits
108
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 665000
25ppm: 1010000
LL20ppm: 400000
LL25ppm: 610000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Heat roller
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6346
8 Number of times
replaced
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Heat roller
6347
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6350
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Pressure roller
6350
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6350
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
6351
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
109
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
<Default value>
20ppm: 665000
25ppm: 1010000
LL20ppm: 400000
LL25ppm: 610000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6368
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to 8 digits
M <Default value>
content
20ppm: 150000
s
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6368
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6369
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
110
<Default value>
20ppm: 665000
25ppm: 1010000
LL20ppm: 400000
LL25ppm: 610000
<Default value>
20ppm: 150000
25ppm: 228000
LL20ppm: 90000
LL25ppm: 138000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
Item
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
6370
3 Present driving counts
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6370
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Pressure roller
separation finger
6371
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6382
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6382
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
120000
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6382
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6382
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6383
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6384
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
SYS
111
<Default value>
20ppm: 665000
25ppm: 1010000
LL20ppm: 400000
LL25ppm: 610000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Feed roller (RADF)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6384
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
120000
8 digits
SYS
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6384
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6384
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6385
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(RADF)
6386
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(RADF)
6386
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
120000
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(RADF)
6386
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(RADF)
6386
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(RADF)
6387
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
SYS
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6390
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6390
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6390
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6390
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
112
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
6391
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Date of previous
replacement
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6392
Present number of
output pages
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6392
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6392
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6392
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6393
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6394
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6394
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
160000
8 digits
6394
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6394
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6395
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6398
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6398
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
113
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6398
2 Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6398
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6399
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6400
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6400
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
6400
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6400
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6401
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6402
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6402
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
160000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6402
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6402
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6403
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6406
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
114
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6406
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
80000
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6406
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6406
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6407
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6408
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6408
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6408
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6408
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6409
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(LCF)
6410
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(LCF)
6410
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
160000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(LCF)
6410
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation roller
(LCF)
6410
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
115
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Separation roller
(LCF)
6411
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Date of previous
replacement
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6412
Present number of
output pages
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6412
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6412
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6412
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6413
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6414
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6414
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
6414
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6414
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6415
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation pad
(Bypass unit)
6416
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation pad
(Bypass unit)
6416
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
116
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Separation pad
(Bypass unit)
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6416
2 Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation pad
(Bypass unit)
6416
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
Separation pad
(Bypass unit)
6417
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6420
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6420
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
6420
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6420
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6421
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6422
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6422
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6422
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6422
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6423
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6424
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
117
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6424
1 Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
80000
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6424
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6424
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6425
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6428
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6428
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6428
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6428
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6429
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6430
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6430
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6430
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6430
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
118
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
6431
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Date of previous
replacement
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6432
Present number of
output pages
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6432
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6432
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6432
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Setting
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
8 digits
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
80000
8 digits
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
6433
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
6500
Refer to
content
s
0-1
<Default value>
NAD: 1
Others: 0
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Clearing
6501
All clearing
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Clearing
6502
Service technician
reference counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Clearing
6503
Toner cartridge
reference counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Setting
6504
0-1
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Setting
6505
Displayed reference
0-1
119
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Setting
Item
Subitem
Code
6506
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Toner empty
0
0-1
SYS Selects the counter to determine toner empty.
determination counter
0: Output pages
1: Pixel counter
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Setting
6507
Output pages
500
0-999
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Setting
6508
Pixel counter
21500
0-60000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Clearing
Flag
6509
Service technician
reference
0-1
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Cleared date
6510
Service technician
reference
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Cleared date
Toner cartridge
reference
6511
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Cleared date
Toner cartridge
reference
6512
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Cleared date
Toner cartridge
reference
6513
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Cleared date
Toner cartridge
reference
6514
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Toner cartridge
reference
6519
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Toner cartridge
reference
6520
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Toner cartridge
reference
6521
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Display
Toner cartridge
reference
6522
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PPC
6557
Full color
8 digits
120
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Number of Service technician
output
reference
pages
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Black
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of output pages converted to the
standard paper size in the copy function, black mode
and service technician reference.
[Unit. page]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
PPC
6558
PRT
6559
Full color
8 digits
Pixel
counter
PRT
6560
Black
8 digits
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
FAX
6561
Black
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PPC
6562
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PPC
6563
Black
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PRT
6564
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PRT
6565
Black
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
FAX
6566
Black
8 digits
121
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Number of Toner cartridge
output
reference
pages
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
PPC
6567
PRT
6568
8 digits
Pixel
counter
PPC
6569
8 digits
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PRT
6570
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PPC
6571
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
PRT
6572
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Toner cartridge
replacement counter
6573
3 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Toner cartridge
replacement counter
6574
3 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Toner cartridge
replacement counter
6575
3 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Toner cartridge
replacement counter
6576
3 digits
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
6587
0-10000
PPC
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS Counts the number of output pages converted to the
standard paper size in the copy function, full color
mode, toner Y and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit. page]
122
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color (Y)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function,
full color mode, toner Y and service technician
reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6588
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6589
0-10000
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6590
0-10000
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6591
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6592
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6593
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6594
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6595
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6596
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT
6597
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT
6598
0-10000
123
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color (M)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer
2
function, full color mode, toner M and service technician
reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT
6599
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT
6600
0-10000
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT
6601
0-10000
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6602
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6603
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
FAX
6604
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC/PRT/FAX
6605
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6606
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, all toner and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6607
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner Y and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6608
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner M and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6609
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner C and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
124
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color (K)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner K and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6610
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6611
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, all toner and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6612
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner Y and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6613
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner M and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6614
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner C and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6615
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner K and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PPC
6616
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
PRT
6617
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
count/Service
technician reference
FAX
6618
Black
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the FAX function, black
mode and service technician reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PPC
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6619
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PPC
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6620
0-10000
125
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color (C)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function,
full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
Average pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6621
Counter
PPC
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6622
0-10000
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6623
Black
0-10000
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6624
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
PRT
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6625
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
PRT
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6626
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6627
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6628
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6629
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6630
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PPC/PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6631
0-10000
126
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full color (M)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer
function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge
reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
Average pixel
PPC/PRT
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6632
Counter
PPC/PRT
Average pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6633
0-10000
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
PPC/PRT/FAX
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6634
0-10000
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Average pixel
FAX
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6635
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6636
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit:0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6637
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner M and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PPC
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6638
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner C and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PPC
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6639
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy function, full
color mode, toner K and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6640
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6641
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner M and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6642
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
color mode, toner C and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
127
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Item
Subitem
Code
Latest pixel
PRT
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6643
Counter
FAX
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6644
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Subcode
Details
Full color (K)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full
2
color mode, toner K and toner cartridge reference.
[Unit: 0.01%]
Black
0-10000
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the FAX function, black
mode and toner cartridge reference. [Unit: 0.01%]
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
6713
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
PPC (color)
6713
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
128
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PPC (color)
6713
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
14
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6713
8 60.1-80%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
129
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PPC (color)
6714
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
14
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6714
7 40.1-60%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
130
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PPC (color)
6715
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
14
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6715
6 30.1-40%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
131
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PPC (color)
6716
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
14
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function, full color
mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6716
5 25.1-30%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
132
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(Y)
PRT (color)
6717
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6717
4 20.1-25%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
133
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(M)
PRT (color)
6718
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6718
3 15.1-20%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
134
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(C)
PRT (color)
6719
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6719
2 10.1-15%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
135
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/full color
(K)
PRT (color)
6720
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function, full
color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6720
1 5.1-10%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
136
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
Subcode
6721
0 0-5%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
Details
137
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PPC (black)
6721
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
20.1-25%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the copy function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6721
8 60.1-80%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
138
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
PRT (black)
6722
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
0-5%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
5.1-10%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
10.1-15%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
15.1-20%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the printer function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6722
6 30.1-40%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
139
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
25.1-30%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
30.1-40%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
40.1-60%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
60.1-80%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Pixel count
distribution/black
FAX (black)
6723
80.1-100%
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
14
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
Latest pixel
PPC
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6724
Black
0-10000
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
Counter
PRT
Latest pixel
count/Toner cartridge
reference
6725
Black
0-10000
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
Pixel
counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The
number of output pages in each range is displayed. In
this code, the distributions in the FAX function and
black mode are displayed.
[Unit: page]
SubDetails
code
6723
4 20.1-25%
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
140
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Item
Subitem
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
6817
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6905
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (K)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
Subcode
6900
Details
Calibration counter
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
8 digits
SYS Displays the number of times a calibration chart is
1
printed. When "0" is set for this code, and also when in
the line adjustment mode or when the fee charging
counter is reset, this counter is reset. The counter value
goes up every time a calibration chart is printed,
regardless of the setting value of the code 08-9894
(Calibration chart charging method).
Thick paper
decelerating mode
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6905
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6905
8 digits
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (K)
6905
8 digits
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6906
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6906
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
6906
8 digits
141
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6906
3 Drive counts at the
last replacement
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Drive counts at the last replacement: Displays the total
driving time in the decelerating mode (mode for thick
paper, special paper, and etc.) at the last replacement.
"0" is displayed if no replacement was performed. (1
count = 3 seconds)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (Y)
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6907
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6907
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6907
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (M)
6907
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6908
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6908
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6908
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Photoconductive
drum (C)
6908
8 digits
142
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6925
0 Present number of
output pages
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Present number of output pages: Displays the
accumulated number of sheets that have been printed
in the decelerating mode (mode for thick paper, special
paper, and etc.) at present. Only "0" is acceptable.
When "0" is entered, the counter is reset.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(K)
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(K)
6925
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(K)
6925
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(K)
6925
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(Y)
6926
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(Y)
6926
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(Y)
6926
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(Y)
6926
8 digits
143
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6927
0 Present number of
output pages
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Present number of output pages: Displays the
accumulated number of sheets that have been printed
in the decelerating mode (mode for thick paper, special
paper, and etc.) at present. Only "0" is acceptable.
When "0" is entered, the counter is reset.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(M)
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(M)
6927
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(M)
6927
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(M)
6927
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(C)
6928
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(C)
6928
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(C)
6928
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Developer material
(C)
6928
8 digits
144
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6929
0 Present number of
output pages
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Present number of output pages: Displays the
accumulated number of sheets that have been printed
in the decelerating mode (mode for thick paper, special
paper, and etc.) at present. Only "0" is acceptable.
When "0" is entered, the counter is reset.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6929
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6929
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6929
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6930
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6930
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6930
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6930
8 digits
145
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6931
0 Present number of
output pages
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Present number of output pages: Displays the
accumulated number of sheets that have been printed
in the decelerating mode (mode for thick paper, special
paper, and etc.) at present. Only "0" is acceptable.
When "0" is entered, the counter is reset.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6931
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6931
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6931
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6932
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6932
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6932
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6932
8 digits
146
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Total
counter
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6933
0 Present number of
output pages
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
8 digits
M Present number of output pages: Displays the
accumulated number of sheets that have been printed
in the decelerating mode (mode for thick paper, special
paper, and etc.) at present. Only "0" is acceptable.
When "0" is entered, the counter is reset.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Decelerating mode
Transfer belt
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Transfer belt
6933
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Transfer belt
6933
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
Transfer belt
6933
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6935
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6935
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6935
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Total
counter
Decelerating mode
6935
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Counter
8 digits
6984
147
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
LED gap spacer (K)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6985
0 Present number of
output pages
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Code
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6985
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6986
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
8 digits
148
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
PM
counter
6987
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6987
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6987
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6988
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6989
8 digits
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
PM
counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
225000
8 digits
M
SubDetails
code
6987
4 Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
05/08
Item
Subitem
Code
149
Contents
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
PM
counter
Item
LED gap spacer (M)
Subitem
SubDetails
code
6989
8 Number of times
replaced
Code
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6990
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6991
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
08
Setting
mode
Counter
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
8 digits
M
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
Present number of
output pages
8 digits
6991
Recommended
number of output
pages for
replacement
Refer to
content
s
8 digits
6991
Number of output
pages at the last
replacement
8 digits
PM
counter
6991
8 digits
Counter
PM
counter
6991
Recommended
driving counts to be
replaced
225000
8 digits
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6991
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6991
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6991
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6991
Number of times
replaced
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
PM
counter
6992
Date of previous
replacement
8 digits
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Cleaning
Main charger
6993
Cleaning counter
8 digits
(Unit: times)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Cleaning
LED head
6994
Cleaning counter
8 digits
(Unit: times)
08
Setting
mode
Counter
Cleaning
LED head
6995
Number of times of
cleaning/0 clear
8 digits
(Unit: times)
150
<Default value>
20ppm/LL20ppm: 56000
25ppm/LL25ppm: 70000
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
Image
Processing
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Image
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
PPC related codes
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Clears the values of the following codes:
05-7000 to 7296
05-7618 to 7987
08-7021 to 7052
08-7601 to 7618
08-8103
All clearing
Adjustment values of
all 05/08 image
process codes
7000
Image
Image
Processing
All clearing
Gamma correction
table
7001
Setting
mode
Image
User
Processing interface
PPC
7034
Black
0-2
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
Color PPC
7052
Plain paper
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
Color PPC
7052
Recycled paper
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
Color PPC
7052
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
Color PPC
7052
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
Color PPC
08
Setting
Mode
Color PPC
Proce Servic
dure e UI
3
SYS 0: Unused
1: Text/Photo base
1: Text base
Yes
14
Yes
14
Yes
Thick paper1
14
Yes
Thick paper2
14
Yes
7052
Special paper1
14
Yes
7052
Special paper2
14
Yes
151
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Image
08
Setting
mode
Image
Processing
08
Setting
mode
Image
Image
Processing
08
Setting
Mode
08
Item
Subitem
Code
All clearing
Adjustment values of
all 05/08 image
process codes
7300
All clearing
Gamma correction
table
7301
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/600dpi
7352
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
NW printer/600dpi
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
08
Setting
Mode
08
Subcode
Details
NW PRT related
codes
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Clears the values of the following codes:
05-7302 to 7385
05-8001 to 8275
08-8005, 08-8103
NW PRT related
codes
Plain paper
14
Yes
7352
Recycled paper
14
Yes
NW printer/600dpi
7352
Thick paper1
14
Yes
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/600dpi
7352
Thick paper2
14
Yes
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/600dpi
7352
Special paper1
14
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/600dpi
7352
Special paper2
14
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/1200dpi
7354
Plain paper
14
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
NW printer/1200dpi
7354
Recycled paper
14
Yes
152
Proce Servic
dure e UI
3
NW printer/1200dpi
Image
Automatic Last updated date
and time
Processing tone
correction
data
NW printer/1200dpi
7354
Thick paper2
14
Yes
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
NW printer/1200dpi
7354
Special paper1
14
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
NW printer/1200dpi
7354
Special paper2
14
Yes
08
Setting
mode
Image
Image
Processing
All clearing
Adjustment values of
all 05/08 image
process codes
7400
NW SCN related
codes
08
Setting
mode
Image
User
Processing interface
NW SCN
7401
Black
0-3
08
Setting
mode
Image
Image
Processing
All clearing
Adjustment values of
all 05 image process
codes
7500
08
Setting
mode
Image
Image
Processing
7612
08
Setting
mode
Image
User
Processing interface
PPC
7614
Color
Mode
08
Setting
Mode
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
Item
element
Image
Automatic Last updated date
Processing tone
and time
correction
data
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0SYS Last updated date and time of automatic tone correction 14
Yes
421231235
data.
9
YYMMDDHHMM
YY: year, MM: month, DD: day, HH: hour, MM: minute
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
SubDetails
code
7354
3 Thick paper1
05/08
Element
Subitem
Code
153
SYS 0: Unused
1: Black TEXT/PHOTO base
2: Black TEXT base
3: Black PHOTO base
0-10
SYS Unit: mm
0-5
SYS 0: Unused
1: TEXT/PHOTO base
2: TEXT base
3: Printed image base
4: Photo base
5: Map base
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Sub
element
Image
User
Processing interface
Element
Item
User custom mode
setting
Subitem
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8504
Feeding method of
odd page number in
duplex printing (Raw
print)
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8506
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8508
0-2
SYS 0: No control
1: Cuts the image
2: Shifts the image
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8509
12
0-36
SYS 0-36
08
Setting
mode
System
General
PRT
Menu display for
controlling print image
position adjustment in
secondary scanning
direction
8510
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8511
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8512
Number of jobs in
batch processing
10
2-10
08
Setting
mode
System
General
0-2
8513
Color
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
0-4
SYS 0: Unused
1: Text/Photo base
2: Text base
3: Photo base
4: e-document base
Setting
mode
PRT
8303
Subcode
08
Overprint function
setting
NW SCN
Code
154
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Overprint function
setting
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
code
value
8513
1 For PostScript printing
0
0-1
SYS Enables or disables the overprinting function setting for
PostScript printing.
0: OFF
1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
8514
Threshold value
setting for RIP
standard paper
judgment
20
5-30
SYS This code is used for changing the range in which nonstandard paper sizes are judged as standard ones. If
the page size data are within the standard paper size
the setting value, the page size is judged as a standard
paper size in PS/PDF printing. If the page size data are
out of the range, the page size is judged as a nonstandard paper size. The unit for the setting value is PS
points. 1 PS point is approx. 0.35 mm.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Outside erase
Judgment threshold
(Default)
8515
PPC
-3-3
Outside erase
Judgment threshold
(Default)
8516
SCN
-3-3
General
8517
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
(A user always enters manually (current method))1: ON
(Previous authentication information will be used)
System
General
8518
0-3
Setting
mode
System
General
8519
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Display setting
8523
Toner near-empty
status Message
0-1
SYS 0: ON
1: OFF
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Screen setting
8524
No paper Message
0-1
SYS 0: ON 1: OFF
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8526
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8527
0-1
155
Yes
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
8529
0 Number of pages
released (Copier)
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
4
0-9
SYS Sets a threshold (the number of pages) for switching
from ACS to the black mode. When the specified
number of pages has been printed in the black mode
only, the transfer belt is released and ACS shifts to the
black mode.
[Unit. page]
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Short size
General
Short size
8529
Number of pages
released (Printer)
0-9
System
General
Short size
8529
Number of pages
released (Box print)
0-9
Setting
mode
System
General
8532
Control panel
Brightness level
adjustment
1-7
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8533
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8534
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
General
8537
0-1
SYS Changes the sorting order for print jobs on the private
print list.
0: Descending order
1: Ascending order
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8538
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8540
Date/time format in
the Meta Scan XML
file
0-1
SYS 0: YYYY/MM/DDhh:mm:ss.mmm
1: YYYY-MMDDThh:mm:ss.mmmTZD
Scanning
PRT
156
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
8543
Subcode
Details
Switching to the low
power consumption
mode in the Sleep
mode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Not switched
1: Switched under certain conditions
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8544
Tolerance for
switching to Super
Sleep mode
5-600
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8546
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Paper feeding
8548
Operation of drawer
size change when
printing is interrupted
by size mismatch
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Counter
8549
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
Yes
0-1
Yes
0-1
0-1
SYS 0: No control
1: Mode switch key is disabled.
8585
0-1
Network
8586
0-1
System
Network
8587
Character string of
email subject
0-1
Setting
Mode
System
User
control
LDAP authentication
8592
Sender address
11
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
control
LDAP authentication
8593
Sender name
uid
11
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8597
Automatic update of
private/hold print job
list
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
8600
Change of default
value
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Outside erase
157
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
8603
Subcode
Details
Special usage of
external options I/F
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
0-2
SYS 0: None
1: Usage 1
2: Usage 2
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Prioritized
authentication server
8608
Windows
0-100
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Prioritized
authentication server
8609
LDAP
0-100
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
Prioritized
authentication server
8610
Card
0-100
Yes
08
Setting
System
User
interface
8622
0-1
08
Setting
System
FAX
8700
Secret reception
setting
0-2
SYS When the value of 08-8924 is "0", the value of this code
can be set to "1" or "2".
0: Always Off
1: Always On
2. Scheduled reception
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8704
Email/FAX address
restriction
0-1
SYS 0: No restriction
1: Search for external LDAP only
Use this code to restrict address of emal/fax to specified
LDAP server. If the value of this code is set to "1", the
addresses of emal/fax are restricted to the LDAP server
specified with TopAccess, and the direct input of
addresses and selecting addresses from the local
address book are not available. If the value of this code
is set to "1", this setting is given priority over the setting
value of 08-9299, 08-3848, 08-3849.
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8709
Display setting of
Service Notification
Refer to
content
s
0-1
158
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Sub
element
Scanning
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
8710
Subcode
Details
Japanese character
code of ScanToFTP
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-2
SYS 0: Automatic selection
1: UTF8
2: Shift-JIS
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
8711
Enable/Disable setting
of watermark
information tracking
application
0-1
8712
0-1
8715
#10481
09
11
User
interface
8718
0-17
SYS Use this code to shorten the time to switch the function
on the control panel for the first time immediately after
start-up. However, the start-up time becomes longer
(about 1 to 3 seconds per screen). When selecting
multiple screens, enter the total value.
0: Disabled
1: Copy
16: Fax
System
Network
8719
MTU setting of
network
communication
1500
576-1500
12
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8720
Department code
display with asterisk
0-1
Yes
Setting
Mode
System
FAX
8721
Automatic FAX
sending at AutoClear
when scanning
original put on the
glass
0-1
Yes
Hardcopy security
printing
Service notification
information
159
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
8722
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8723
Pop-up display of
logging out of user
authentication and
department
management on the
control panel
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8724
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8725
Display setting of
[USER FUNCTIONS]> CHANGE
LANGUAGE button
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
8726
0-1
SYS Use this code to enable the job deletion on the [Job
Status] screen. When "3: High level" is set for code 088911, be sure to disable this setting.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8727
Display of dedicated
screen for card
authentication
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
8737
Restart behavior
when the out of paper
is solved
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8738
0-1
Display setting
Display method of
"Cannot find the
Home Directory" on
the control panel
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-1
SYS Sets the display method of error if the Home Directory
1
Yes
for user cannot be obtained from the server when
setting the Home Directory for scanning. Use this code
to disable the pop-up display when the Home Directory
cannot be obtained depending on the user.
0: Displays the pop-up dialogue when user logs in
1: Displays the message in the guidance area when the
Scan to File screen is displayed
160
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
General
Item
Subitem
Code
8750
Subcode
Details
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan
ce
8752
Switchover of display
of notice on the
control panel when
the time to replace the
unit has come
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
8754
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
* This code is not supported by 20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
ce
remaining amount of
toner
8755
Enable/Disable setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
ce
remaining amount of
toner
8756
Remaining amount at
first notification
25
0-100
SYS 0 to 100%
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
ce
remaining amount of
toner
8756
Notification interval
10
1-25
SYS 1 to 25%
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Display setting
8757
Cleaning button
0-2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8758
Overwriting of login at
authentication
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
8759
SYS Executes the batch setting for the optional HDD when
installing it.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
8760
LED head/Main
charger
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-1
SYS Sets whether the drum idling is executed or not when
1
the waiting for print image occurred. If there is the stain
on the back side of the paper, set the value of this code
to "1". When the value is set to "1", the number of times
the equipment stops printing may increase.
0: Waiting is enabled (8 sec.)
1: Waiting is disabled (0 sec.)
161
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
General
Item
Subitem
Code
8761
Subcode
Details
Retention of print
(spooling) data
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1
SYS Use this code to retain and obtain the print data
(spooling data) if problem occurs. After obtaining the
data, be sure to disable the setting.
0: Disabled (print data is deleted)
1: Enabled (print data is retained)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
8762
0-100
SYS 0100%
14
08
Setting
Mode
System
8762
0-100
SYS 0100%
14
08
Setting
Mode
System
8762
0-100
SYS 0100%
14
08
Setting
Mode
System
8762
0-100
SYS 0100%
14
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8763
0-1
SYS If thick paper is set to the 1st drawer, this code sets
whether the notification to set the thick paper to the
drawer is displayed or not when the drawer is opened.
0: Not displayed
1: Displayed
08
Setting
Mode
System
Scanning
8767
Default value of
original size when
scanning original put
on the glass
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets the default value of original size for the network
scanning and fax/Internet Fax transmission when
scanning original put on the glass.
0: A4
1: Letter
<Default value>
NAD: 1
Others: 0
* This code is not supported by 20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IEEE802.1X
8800
Enable/Disable setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPsec
8802
Enable/Disable setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SNMPv3
8803
Enable/Disable setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IP Filtering
8804
Enable/Disable setting
1-2
162
Yes
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPsec
NAT-Traversal
8820
Enable/Disable setting
1-3
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPsec
CRL
8821
Enable/Disable setting
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Registration number
for workflow
8900
Total
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Registration number
for workflow
8900
Number of interrupt
copy
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Registration number
for workflow
8900
Number of
transmission and
calling of
Fax/InternetFax
50
10-100
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Registration number
for workflow
8900
Number of printing
500
150-1000
08
Setting
Mode
System
Preview
Fax
8901
Default setting
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Preview
Fax
8902
Default display
method
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Printer
8904
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
System
8905
Forcible printing
against unacceptable
paper error
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
8906
Copy
0-1
Mode
Element
Finisher
Item
Subitem
MAC Address
Filtering
Continuous print
setting when punching
dust box is full
Code
8805
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Enable/Disable setting
2
1-2
SYS 1: Enabled 2: Disabled
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
1000
163
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
8910
Time to auto-clearing
when in the selfdiagnostic mode
0-5
SYS 0: None
1: 1 min.
2: 5 min.
3: 10 min.
4: 30 min.
5: 99 min.
08
Setting
Mode
System
Security
8911
1-4
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
8912
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
8913
15
0-30
08
Setting
mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
Copy
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
e-Filing
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
Mode
Element
Item
Continuous print
setting when punching
dust box is full
Subitem
Code
8907
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: OFF (copying not continued)
1: ON (copying continued by canceling punching
setting)
Sub
element
Finisher
05/08
Details
Printer/e-Filing
Yes
SYS 0: None
1-30: Remaining days until the password expiration for
warning start.
Yes
0-1
Refer to
content
s
0-1
Fax
0-1
InternetFAX
0-1
164
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
MFP
function
setting
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
8914
4 Email
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS Sets whether the email function is enabled or disabled.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Code
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets whether the function that saves data to HDD in the
equipment is enabled or disabled.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
<Default value>
20/25ppm: 0 (When HDD is not installed), 1 (When
HDD is installed)
LL20/25ppm: 0
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS Sets whether the function that saves data to HDD in the
equipment using print function is enabled or disabled.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
<Default value>
20/25ppm: 0 (When HDD is not installed), 1 (When
HDD is installed)
LL20/25ppm: 0
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
0-1
SYS Sets whether the function that saves data to HDD in the
equipment using Fax function is enabled or disabled.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
Save as FTP
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
10
Save as FTPS
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
11
Save as SMB
0-1
165
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
MFP
function
setting
Item
Subitem
SubDetails
code
8914 12 Save as Netware
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS Sets whether the function that saves scanned data of
originals to the Netware server is enabled or disabled.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
13
Web Service
Scanning (WS Scan)
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
14
Twain Scanning
(Remote Scan)
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
15
Send to External
Controller
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
16
Network Fax
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
MFP
function
setting
8914
17
Network InternetFAX
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
8915
Automatic output of
jobs at login
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Security
8919
Service password
11
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
8920
0-2
Yes
FAX
166
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Departmen
t
managem
ent
Item
Subitem
Code
8921
Subcode
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8922
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8923
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8924
Registration of the
received FAX /
Internet Fax / Email
jobs to hold queue
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
8925
Data tampering
checking at start-up
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Departmen
t
managem
ent
8926
Clearing of all
department counters
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Departmen
t
managem
ent
8927
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Password
8929
Administrator
password reset
SYS The default password is set. When "3: High level" is set
for code 08-8911, the default password is set as a
temporary password.
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8931
Output Management
Service setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Off Device
Customization
Architecture
Clearing of the
user/department
counter
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Not allowed
1: Allowed
167
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
8932
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Availability of Netware
2
1-2
NIC 1: Enabled
2: Disabled
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
SSL
8933
1-3
12
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
SSL
8934
1-2
NIC 1: STARTTLS
2: Over SSL
12
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Remote Scan
8935
Enable/Disable setting
0-1
NIC 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
12
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Remote Scan
8936
0-1
NIC 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
12
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Remote Scan
8937
Port number
20080
0-65535
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Remote Scan
8938
20443
0-65535
NIC
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
8946
Acquisition starting
time for RDMS
099999999
14
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
8946
Acquisition ending
time for RDMS
099999999
14
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
8947
Automatic user
registration for card
authentication
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
8948
Language package
information
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
8952
External version of
HD data
168
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Feeding
system /
Paper
transport
Item
Subitem
Code
8967
Subcode
Details
Rotation printing by
guides width of
bypass feed tray
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS If the printing size and the guides width of the bypass
feed tray are different, it is judged that paper is set in
the wrong direction. The occurrence frequency of
interruption by the error of the guides width may be
decreased. However, this code does not work
depending on the conditions, such as when stapling is
selected. Set this code when requested by user or the
guides width sensor is broken. Related code: 08-4621.
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
General
Language package
information
8968
Panel Help
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
General
Language package
information
8969
WebHelp
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
General
Language package
information
8970
Service UI
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
General
8971
Installation of
language package
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
Self-certificate
8973
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
Self-certificate
8974
Signature algorithm
0-4
SYS 0: SHA1
1: SHA224
2: SHA256
3: SHA384
4: SHA512
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
8975
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
Detection of originals
prohibited from
duplication
8977
Copy
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
Detection of originals
prohibited from
duplication
8977
Scan
0-1
169
08
Setting
Mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
Scanning
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Setting
Mode
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Detection of originals
prohibited from
duplication
Subitem
Subcode
8977
2 FAX
Code
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS Sets whether the originals that are prohibited from
duplication are detected or not.
0: Detection disabled
1: Detection enabled
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
12
0-255
SYS Sets the condition and day of the week for scheduled
automatic reboot. Input the condition and day of the
week to each bit as follows (0: disabled, 1: enabled)
bit8: Set the condition of reboot
0: Reboots when in the sleep or super sleep mode
1: Reboots regardless of the sleep mode
bit7: Sunday, bit6: Saturday, bit5: Friday, bit4:
Thursday, bit3: Wednesday, bit2: Tuesday, bit1:
Monday
<Input value>
Reboots when in the sleep or super sleep mode: 0
Reboots regardless of the sleep mode: 128
Monday: 1 Tuesday: 2 Wednesday: 4 Thursday: 8
Friday: 16 Saturday: 32 Sunday: 64
e.g.)
Monday: 1
Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday,
Saturday, Sunday: 127
(1+2+4+8+16+32+64=127)
0-23
Time (Minute)
0-59
Usage type
8980
Execution of Remote
Scan while control
panel is operated
0-1
Scheduled automatic
reboot
8981
General
Scheduled automatic
reboot
8982
Time (Hour)
System
General
Scheduled automatic
reboot
8983
System
User
interface
NFC reader
8986
170
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Format information 1
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0SYS 000ASSSS (hexadecimal, first 3 digits are fixed)
429496729
-A:
5
0: A key
1: B key
-SSSS:
Sector number (first 2 digits are fixed to "0")
Proce Servic
dure e UI
5
Yes
NFC reader
8987
User
interface
NFC reader
8988
Format information 2
Yes
System
User
interface
NFC reader
8989
Format information 3
Yes
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Notification setting
ce
equipment information
8991
Notification setting
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Notification day 1
ce
equipment information
8992
Notification day 1
0-31
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Notification day 2
ce
equipment information
8993
Notification day 2
0-31
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Notification day of the 8994
ce
equipment information week
0-127
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Notification time
ce
equipment information
8995
Notification time
300
0-2359
SYS (Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Email address 1 for
ce
equipment information notification
8996
11
Yes
171
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
Subitem
element
Maintenan Notification of
Email address 2 for
ce
equipment information notification
Code
08
Setting
Mode
System
8997
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Email address 3 for
ce
equipment information notification
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Adjustment mode (05) 8999
ce
equipment information data list
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Setting mode (08)
ce
equipment information data list
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Subcode
8998
Details
Email address 2 for
notification
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Maximum 192 characters.
8999
Maintenan Notification of
PM support mode
ce
equipment information data list
8999
System
Maintenan Notification of
Pixel counter list
ce
equipment information
8999
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Pixel counter list
ce
equipment information
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
Yes
11
Yes
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
PM support mode
data list
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
Toner cartridge
reference
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
8999
Service engineer
reference
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
Maintenan Notification of
Error history list
ce
equipment information
8999
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
System
Maintenan Notification of
Error history list
ce
equipment information
8999
Latest 80 items
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Firmware upgrade log 8999
ce
equipment information
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Power ON/OFF log
ce
equipment information
8999
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Version list
ce
equipment information
8999
10
Version list
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Engine firmware log
ce
equipment information
8999
11
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Notification of
Total counter list
ce
equipment information
8999
12
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
172
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
System
Sub
element
General
Item
Subitem
Code
9000
Subcode
Details
Destination selection
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to
0-3
M 0: Europe
content
1: North America
s
2: Japan
3: Others
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
<Default value>
NAD/NAC: 1
JPC: 2
Others: 0
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
FAX
9001
Destination setting
General
9010
System
General
9012
System
User
interface
9016
Externally installed
counter
173
Refer to
content
s
0-25
0-1
0-3
0: No external counter
1: Coin controller (If the value of 08-9979 is "0" (ACS), it
is changed to "2" (Full color).)
2: Copy key card (This value is valid only when "2" is
set for 08-9000.)
3: Key copy counter
11
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Counter
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
9017
Memory
Subcode
Details
Setting for counter
installed externally
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-5
M Selects the job to count up for the external counter.
0: Not selected
1: Copier
4: Printer
5: Copier/Printer
9020
Size information of
memory
9022
Production process
management status
for easy setup
99
0-99
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
SYS Perform this code when an error occurs during the easy
setup (unpacking manual adjustment) and you want to
finish the easy setup, or when you want to restart the
unpacking manual adjustment from the beginning. Only
0 to 8 and 99 are available for this code.
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Initializatio
n
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
Counter installed
externally
9030
Initialization after
software version up
9037
Job handling-short
paid-coin controller
0-1
9050
Performing panel
calibration
174
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Display setting
Maintenan General
ce
Subitem
Code
9051
9059
Subcode
Details
Panel calibration
setting value
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1
SYS Switches whether the screen for displaying panel
calibration setting values is displayed or not.
0: Disabled (screen not displayed)
1: Enabled (screen displayed)
0-1
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
Yes
<Default value>
MJD: 1
Others: 0
08
Setting
mode
System
9060
08
Setting
Mode
System
HDD
9065
08
Setting
Mode
System
HDD
9072
Performing HDD
testing
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9081
08
Setting
Mode
System
Initializatio
n
08
Setting
mode
System
All clear
08
Setting
mode
System
General
LGC-SRAM board
Initialization of
department
management
information
9083
Initialization of NIC
information
Yes
9090
Yes
9100
13 digits
Year/month/date/day/hour/minute/second
Example:
03 07 01 3 13 27 48
"Day" - "0" is for "Sunday". Proceeds Monday through
Saturday from "1" to "6".
175
0-255
Yes
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
mode
Element
System
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
9102
Subcode
Details
Date display format
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
Refer to
0-2
SYS 0: YYYY.MM.DD
content
1: DD.MM.YYYY
s
2: MM.DD.YYYY
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
<Default value>
MJD: 1
JPD: 0
Others: 2
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9103
Time differences
Refer to
content
s
0-47
<Default value>
MJD: 24
NAD: 40
JPD: 6
Others: 0
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9110
Auto-clear timer
setting
0-10
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9111
0, 4, 6-15
176
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
9112
Subcode
Details
Auto Shut Offtimer
setting (Sleep Mode)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
21
0-21
SYS Timer to automatically switch to the auto sleep mode
when the equipment has not been used
0: 3 min.
1: 5 min.
2: 10 min.
3: 15 min.
4: 20 min.
5: 25 min.
6: 30 min.
7: 40 min.
8: 50 min.
9: 60 min.
10: 70 min.
11: 80 min.
12: 90 min.
13: 100 min.
14: 110 min.
15: 120 min.
16: 150 min.
17: 180 min.
18: 210 min.
19: 240 min.
20: Invalid
21: 1 min.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Power save
9113
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON
<Default value>
JPD/NAD/MJD: 1
Others: 0
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
General
9116
Black-free function
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
When "1" (enabled) is set at this code, "1" (black) is
automatically set at the code 08-9979. In this case "0"
(ACS) and "2" (full color) are not selectable for 08-9979.
When "0" (OFF) is set at 08-9120 and "1" (ON) is set at
08-9264, the value for this code becomes "0" (disabled)
automatically ("1" is not selectable).
When the value of 08-6084 is "1" (Quota type = Job
Quota), the value of this code cannot be set to "1".
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9117
0-1
SYS 0: OFF 1: ON
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Department setting
9120
Enable/Disable setting
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Department setting
9121
Refer to
content
s
0-2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Department setting
9122
Copy
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Department setting
9123
FAX
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
177
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
Department setting
9124
User
interface
Department setting
9125
Scanning
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
System
User
interface
Department setting
9126
List print
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Yes
Setting
mode
System
Counter
Counting method in
Twin Color Mode
PPC
9128
Counting method in
Twin Color Mode
0-2
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
External counter
Coin controller
9129
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9130
Highlighting display
on LCD
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9132
Default setting of
screen (Function)
0-99
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9133
0-2
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Default setting of
RADF mode
9134
Default setting
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9135
0-1
Default setting
PPC
Printer/e-Filing
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
178
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Maximum number of
copy volume
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
1-3
SYS 1: 999
2: 99
3: 9
Maximum number of
copy volume
PPC
9136
User
interface
Default setting
9137
0-3
User
interface
PPC
9140
Refer to
content
s
0-391
System
User
interface
Default setting of
RADF mode
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Single-sided to duplex copying
2: Two-sided to duplex copying
3: User selection
<Default value>
NAD: COMP
JPD: A5-R
Others: FOLIO
9142
Default setting of
RADF original size
0-1
9143
10
0-10
SYS Sets the time taken to add paper feeding when paper in
the bypass tray has run out during the bypass feed
copying.
0: Paper is not drawn in unless the [START] button is
pressed.
1-10: Setting value x 0.5sec.
PPC
Blank copying
prevention mode
during RADF jamming
9144
Blank copying
prevention mode
during RADF jamming
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON (Start printing when the scanning of each page is
finished)
User
interface
Rotation printing
9146
Rotation printing at
the non-sorting
0-1
System
User
interface
Direction priority of
original image
9147
Direction priority of
original image
0-1
SYS 0: Automatic
1: Portrait
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9148
0-1
SYS 0: Normal
1: Inner receiving tray
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9149
0-1
SYS 0: ON
1: OFF
PPC
PPC
179
Yes
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Automatic Sorting
PPC
Mode setting (RADF)
9150
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Automatic Sorting
Mode setting (RADF)
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
2
0-4
SYS 0: Invalid
1: STAPLE
2: SORT
3: GROUP
4: ROTATE SORT
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Default setting of
Sorter Mode
PPC
9151
Default setting of
Sorter Mode
0-4
SYS 0: NON-SORT
1: STAPLE
2: SORT
3: GROUP
4: ROTATE SORT
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Correction of
reproduction ratio in
editing copy
PPC
9152
Correction of
reproduction ratio in
editing copy
10
0-10
SYS Sets the reproduction ratio for the "X in 1" printing
(including magazine sort) to the "Reproduction ratio x
Correction ratio".
0: 90% 1: 91%
2: 92% 3: 93%
4: 94% 5: 95%
6: 96% 7: 97%
8: 98% 9: 99%
10: 100%
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9153
Image position in
editing
0-3
SYS Sets the page pasted position for "X in 1" to the upper
left corner/center.
0: Cornering (PPC)/Cornering (PRT)
1: Centering (PPC)/Cornering (PRT)
2: Cornering (PPC)/Centering (PRT)
3: Centering (PPC)/Centering (PRT)
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9155
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
2 in 1/4 in 1 page
allocating order
setting
PPC
9156
2 in 1 / 4 in 1 page
allocating order
setting
0-1
SYS 0: Horizontal
1: Vertical
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9157
0-1
SYS Hyphen
0: OFF
1: ON
Note:
Hyphen printing format
ON: -1- OFF: 1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Cascade operation
setting
PPC / FAX
9158
Enable/Disable setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Cascade operation
setting
PPC / FAX
9158
Operation setting
0-1
SYS 0: Once
1: Circulation (Loop)
180
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Cascade operation
setting
Printer/Box
Cascade operation
setting
Printer/Box
Item
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Paper Feed
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Paper Feed
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
08
Subitem
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Details
value
code
value
9159
0 Enable/Disable setting
0
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Code
0-1
SYS 0: Once
1: Circulation (Loop)
9163
Default setting of
printing direction for
Time Stamp and Page
Number
0-1
9164
Remote
0-1
9165
Local
0-1
9178
0-6
SYS 0: K 1: Y 2: M 3: C 4: R 5: G 6: B
User
interface
9179
0-6
SYS 0: K 1: Y 2: M 3: C 4: R 5: G 6: B
System
Option
FAX
9183
Application of paper
source
0-1
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9184
Centering printing of
primary/secondary
direction at AMS
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Copier
1-3
9185
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
Operation setting
9159
Contents
181
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
Electronic
filing
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
1
SYS Sets a media type to print on plain paper in the
printer/box functions. This setting is used for drawer
searching or media type inconsistency judgment. The
setting result does not affect other media types, other
than plain paper.
Acceptable value (decimal number): 1 only
Each bit 0: Excluded from feeding target media
Each bit 1: Feeding target media
bit 0: Plain paper
bit 1: N/A (Always set "0")
bit 2: N/A (Always set "0")
bit 3: N/A (Always set "0")
10
3 digits
SYS When a certain period of time has passed without
operation after accessing TopAccess, the data being
registered is automatically reset. This period is set at
this code.
(Unit: minute)
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
SubDetails
code
9185
1 Printer/Box
Retention period
9193
9199
Automatic interruption
page number setting
for printing
500
0-9999
Retention period
9200
30
0-999
SYS 0: No limits
1 to 999: 1 to 999 days
Yes
9201
Max. size in
email/InternetFAX
transmission
30
2-100
Yes
9203
e-Filing document
guarantee mode
0-1
Item
Subitem
Code
182
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
When judging as
black in the ACS
Mode
Code
9204
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Electronic
filing
9207
0-999
SYS Sets the data retention period when creating a user box.
0: Not deleted
1 to 999: Retention period (Unit: Day)
08
Setting
Mode
System
HDD
9208
90
0-100
08
Setting
mode
System
Scanning
9209
Notification setting of
E-mail saving time
limit
0-99
SYS Sets the days left the notification of E-mail saving time
limit appears
0 to 99: 0 to 99 days
08
Setting
mode
System
Scanning
9210
Default setting of
partial size when
transmitting E-mail
0-6
SYS Sets the default value for the partial size of E-mail to be
transmitted when creating a template.
0: Not divided
1: 64 2: 128
3: 256 4: 512
5: 1024
6: 2048 (Unit: KB)
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
9211
Default setting of
page by page-I FAX
0-4
SYS Sets the default value for the page by page of Internet
FAX to be transmitted when creating a template.
0: Not divided
1: 256
2: 512
3: 1024
4: 2048 (Unit: KB)
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9213
0-11
Yes
Binarizing level
selection
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
3
1-5
SYS 1: Step -2
2: Step -1
3: Step 0 (center)
4: Step 1
5: Step 2
The binarizing level of each step is set at 08-9230.
183
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Full Color
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
5
1-9
SYS 1: Step -4
2: Step -3
3: Step -2
4: Step -1
5: Step 0 (center)
6: Step +1
7: Step +2
8: Step +3
9: Step +4
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Default setting of
background
adjustment
9214
User
interface
9215
Color mode
0-4
SYS 0: Black
1: Gray Scale
2: Unused
3: Full Color
4: Auto Color
Yes
System
User
interface
Default setting of
resolution (SCN)
9216
Full Color
0-5
Yes
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Default setting of
resolution (SCN)
9217
Gray Scale
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
Default setting of
resolution (SCN)
9218
Black
0-5
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9219
0-3
SYS 0: Text
1: Text/Photo
2: Photo
3: Custom (Valid only when a setting other than "0" is
set for 08-8303)
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9220
0-3
SYS 0: Text
1: Text/Photo
2: Photo
3: Custom
The value other than "0" needs to be set for 08-7401 to
select "3: Custom."
Yes
184
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Default setting of
scanning mode
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
0-2
SYS 0: Single
1: Book
2: Tablet
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
9221
User
interface
9222
Default setting of
rotation mode
0-3
SYS 0: 0 degree
1: 90 degrees
2: 180 degrees
3: 270 degrees
System
User
interface
9223
Default setting of
original paper size
0-22
SYS 0: Automatic
1: A3 2: A4
3: LD 4: LT
5: A4-R 6: A5-R
7: LT-R 8: LG
9: B4 10: B5
11: ST-R 12: COMP
13: B5-R 14: FOLIO
15: 13"LG 16: 8.5"x 8.5"
18: A6-R
19: Size mixed20: 8K 21: 16K
22: 16K-R
Setting
mode
System
General
9225
Searching interval of
deleting expired files
and checking capacity
of HDD partitions
12
1-24
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9226
Default setting of
background
adjustment
(Gray Scale)
1-9
SYS 1: Step -4
2: Step -3
3: Step -2
4: Step -1
5: Step 0 (Center)
6: Step +1
7: Step +2
8: Step +3
9: Step +4
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9227
Black
0-6
185
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
9228
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9229
08
Setting
mode
System
Image
9230
08
Setting
mode
System
Image
9230
08
Setting
mode
System
Image
08
Setting
mode
System
Image
08
Setting
mode
System
Image
08
Setting
mode
System
Scanning
Details
Color/ACS
MJD: 1
Others:
0
0-6
Step -2
115
Step -1
9230
9230
9230
9233
Black
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-8
SYS 0: TIFF (Multi)
1: PDF (Multi)
2: JPG
3: TIFF (Single)
4: PDF (Single)
5: SLIM PDF (Multi)
6: SLIM PDF (Single)
7: XPS (Multi)
8: XPS (Single)
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Yes
0-255
145
0-255
Step 0 (center)
175
0-255
Step +1
205
0-255
Step +2
235
0-255
0-2
186
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Default screen setting
Subitem
Code
9236
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
Default setting of print
1
1-4
SYS 1: Private print screen (Job list of log-in user is
1
screen
displayed if user authentication is enabled.)
2: Hold print screen (Job list of log-in user is displayed if
user authentication is enabled.)
3: Private print screen (If the private print screen is
displayed when user authentication is enabled, user list
is displayed if user logs in as GUEST, and job list of
log-in user is displayed if user logs in as general user.)
4: Hold print screen (If the private print screen is
displayed when user authentication is enabled, user list
is displayed if user logs in as GUEST, and job list of
log-in user is displayed if user logs in as general user.)
* If user data department management (08-9264) is
changed from OFF to ON, the value in this code
changes from "1" to "2", and "3" to "4". The value does
not change if it is "2" or"4". Reset this value as
necessary when changing user data department
management (08-9264) from OFF to ON.
Details
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Data
overwrite
enabler
9240
0-3
SYS Select the type of the overwriting level for deleting HDD
data. (This setting is enabled only when the GP-1070 is
installed.)
0: LOW
Standard overwriting method.
1: MEDIUM
More secure overwriting method than LOW. The
overwriting time is between LOW and HIGH.
2: HIGH
The most secure overwriting method. The overwriting
time is the longest.
3: SIMPLE
Simple overwriting method. The time for overwriting is
the shortest.
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
9248
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9250
0-3
SYS 0: General
1: Photograph
2: Presentation
3: Line art
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9251
0-1
187
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
9252
Subcode
Details
Clearing timing for
files and Electronic
Filing Agent
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Immediately after the completion of scanning
1: Cleared by Auto Clear
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
9253
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9261
Maximum number of
time job build
performed
1000
5-1000
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9264
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
9267
Detection method of
13" LG for single-size
document
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
9268
08
Setting
Mode
System
Option
FAX
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
SYS Sets the maximum number of time a job build has been
performed.
5-1000: 5 to 1000 times
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
0-1
Yes
9269
Tab/cover sheet-FAX
Printing stop function
0-1
Yes
Network
9271
Authentication
method of "Scan to
Email"
0-2
SYS 0: Disabled
1: SMTP authentication
2: LDAP authentication
System
Network
9272
0-1
Setting
mode
System
Network
9274
"From" address
assignment method at
the time of
authentication
0-2
Setting
mode
System
Network
9276
0-1
188
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
Network
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
9278
Domain name
User
interface
Sound
9280
Error sound
System
User
interface
Sound
9281
Setting
mode
System
General
Color
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS 96 + 2 (delimiter) character
ASCll sequence only
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON
Yes
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON
<Default value>
JPD: 0
Others: 1
Yes
9288
User data
management
limitation setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
9289
User data
management
limitation Setting by
number of printouts
7 digits
SYS 0-9,999,999:
0-9,999,999 sheets
General
9293
User authentication
method
0-2
System
General
9295
User data
management
limitation setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Setting
mode
System
General
9296
User data
management
limitation Setting by
number of printouts
7 digits
SYS 0-9,999,999:
0-9,999,999 sheets
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9298
Restriction on
Address book
operation by
administrator
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9299
Restriction on "To"
("cc") address
0-3
SYS 0: No restriction
1: Can be set from both of the Address book and LDAP
server
2: Can be set only from the Address book
3: Can be set only from the LDAP server
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
9300
Drawer 1
0-8
Paper information
189
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Paper
feeding
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Paper information
9301
Paper
feeding
Paper information
9302
PFP 1
0-8
System
Paper
feeding
Paper information
9303
PFP 2
0-8
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
Paper information
9304
LCF
0-8
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
Paper information
9305
Bypass tray
0-135
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
Size conversion
9306
LT <-> A4 / LD <-> A3
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
9307
14
0-35
SYS 0: No limits
1 to 30: 1 to 30 days
31: 1 hour
32: 2 hours
33: 4 hours
34: 8 hours
35: 12 hours
Retention period
Drawer 2
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-8
SYS 0: Plain paper
1: Thick paper 1
8: Recycled paper
* Only 0, 1, 8 are acceptable.
* Do not set the paper type that is not supported.
190
Yes
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9309
Paper size
Refer to
content
s
0 -13
SYS 0: LD 1: LG
2: LT 3: COMP
4: ST 5: A3
6: A4 7: A5
8: A6 9: B4
10: B5 11: FOLIO
12: 13"LG
13: 8.5" x 8.5"
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
<Default value>
NAD: 2
Others: 6
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9310
Paper type
0-7
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9311
Paper direction
0-1
SYS 0: Portrait
1: Landscape
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9312
Staple
0-1
SYS 0: Valid
1: Invalid
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9313
Exit tray
0-6
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9314
1200
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9315
1000
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
9308
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Valid
1: Invalid
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
Duplex
191
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
9318
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
08
Setting
mode
System
Paper
feeding
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
9316
9317
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1200 400-99975 SYS Sets the font size from 4 to 999.75. (A hundredfold of
the font size is defined as the setting value.)
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
0
0-9999
Memory 1
148/10
0
9319
Memory 2
9320
Paper
feeding
System
User
interface
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
148432/100297
10
148/10
0
148432/100297
10
Memory 3
148/10
0
148432/100297
10
9321
Memory 4
148/10
0
148432/100297
10
Sound
9325
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON
Yes
User
interface
Display setting
9326
Size indicator
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
System
General
Banner advertising
9327
Setting of banner
advertising display
0-1
Setting
mode
System
General
Banner advertising
9328
Banner advertising
display 1
11
Setting
mode
System
General
Banner advertising
9329
Banner advertising
display 2
11
192
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9331
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9332
Original counter
display
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Banner advertising
Code
9330
Subcode
Details
Display of [BANNER
MESSAGE] button
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1
SYS 0: Not displayed
1: Displayed
This button enables the entry of "Banner advertising
display 1 (08-9328)" and "Banner advertising display 2
(08-9329)" on the control panel.
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
1-50
Refer to
content
s
0-4
<Default value>
MJD: 2
Others: 0
9334
0-3
Paper
feeding
9336
Default setting of
drawers (Printer/BOX)
1-5
SYS 1: LCF
2: 1st drawer
3: 2nd drawer
4: PFP upper drawer
5: PFP lower drawer
System
User
interface
9337
Restriction of the
template function with
the administrator
privilege
0-1
System
Network
9338
0-5
SYS 0: AUTO
1: 1st drawer
2: 2nd drawer
3: PFP upper drawer
4: PFP lower drawer
5: LCF
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
193
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
Network
Item
Subitem
Code
9339
Subcode
Details
User
interface
Copy
0-100
Yes
System
User
interface
Copy
0-100
Yes
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Copy
0-100
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Copy
0-100
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Copy
14
0-30
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
Printer
Paper
feeding
Automatic change of
paper source
Auto
Printing/BOX printing
1-2
Yes
9343
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-39
SYS 0: Roman-8 1: ISO 8859/1 Latin 1 2: ISO 8859/2 Latin
1
2 3: ISO 8859/9 Latin 5 4: PC-8, Code Page 437 5:
PC-8 D/N, Danish/Norwegian 6: PC-850, Multilingual
7: PC-852, Latin2 8: PC-8 Turkish 9: Windows 3.1
Latin 1 10: Windows 3.1 Latin 2 11: Windows 3.1 Latin
5 12: DeskTop 13: PS Text 14: Ventura International
15: Ventura US 16: Microsoft Publishing 17: Math-8
18: PS Math 19: Ventura Math 20: Pi Font 21: Legal
22: ISO 4: United Kingdom 23: ISO 6: ASCII 24: ISO
11 25: ISO 15: Italian 26: ISO 17 27: ISO 21: German
28: ISO 60: Danish/Norwegian 29: ISO 69: French 30:
Windows 3.0 Latin 1 31: MC Text 32: PC Cyrillic 33:
ITC Zapf Dingbats 34: ISO 8859/10 Latin 6 35: PC-775
36: PC-1004 37: Symbol 38: Windows Baltic 39:
Wingdings
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
194
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
User
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
9344
Subcode
9352
Private-print-only
mode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-3
SYS 0: Normal
1: Private-print-only mode
2: Hold-print-only mode
3: Private/Hold-print-only mode
Refer to
content
s
0-1
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
<Default value>
MJD, JPD: 0
Others: 1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9357
0-1
SYS 0: OFF
1: ON (Enhanced bold for PCL6.)
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9359
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_00.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_00.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_01.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_01.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_02.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_02.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_03.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_03.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_04.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_04.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_05.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_05.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
195
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_07.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_07.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_08.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_08.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
LL_OP_09.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_09.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
10
LL_OP_10.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_10.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
11
LL_OP_11.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_11.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
12
LL_OP_12.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_12.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
13
LL_OP_13.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_13.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
14
LL_OP_14.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_14.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
SubDetails
code
9361
6 LL_OP_06.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_06.icc
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
196
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
16
LL_OP_16.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_16.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
17
LL_OP_17.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_17.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
18
LL_OP_18.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_18.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
19
LL_OP_19.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_19.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
20
LL_OP_20.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_20.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
21
LL_OP_21.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_21.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
22
LL_OP_22.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_22.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
23
LL_OP_23.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_23.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
SubDetails
code
9361 15 LL_OP_15.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_15.icc
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
197
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
25
LL_OP_25.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_25.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
26
LL_OP_26.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_26.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
27
LL_OP_27.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_27.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
28
LL_OP_28.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_28.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
29
LL_OP_29.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_29.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
30
LL_OP_30.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_30.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
31
LL_OP_31.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_31.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
32
LL_OP_32.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_32.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
SubDetails
code
9361 24 LL_OP_24.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_24.icc
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
198
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
34
LL_OP_34.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_34.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
35
LL_OP_35.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_35.icc
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
36
WL_OP_36.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
37
WL_OP_37.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
38
WL_OP_38.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
39
WL_OP_39.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
40
WL_OP_40.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
41
WL_OP_41.icc
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
SubDetails
code
9361 33 LL_OP_33.icc
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_33.icc
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
199
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
43
WL_OP_43.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
44
WL_OP_44.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
45
WL_OP_45.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
46
WL_OP_46.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
47
WL_OP_47.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
48
WL_OP_48.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
49
WL_OP_49.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
50
WL_OP_50.icc
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
SubDetails
code
9361 42 WL_OP_42.icc
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
200
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
52
WL_OP_52.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Available profile
display
9361
53
WL_OP_53.icc
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
9362
Recovery of the
profile at the shipment
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
9363
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
9364
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
LL_OP_00.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_00.000
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Available profile
display
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9361 51 WL_OP_51.icc
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displaying the current Output Profile and PG CIE Based 14
Pure GrayTRC attribute (PG CIE Based PureGray TRC
attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the same
time.)
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
9365
201
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_02.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_02.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_03.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_03.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_04.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_04.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_05.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_05.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_06.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_06.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_07.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_07.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_08.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_08.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
LL_OP_09.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_09.000
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365
1 LL_OP_01.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_01.000
(20/25ppm)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
202
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
11
LL_OP_11.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_11.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
12
LL_OP_12.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_12.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
13
LL_OP_13.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_13.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
14
LL_OP_14.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_14.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
15
LL_OP_15.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_15.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
16
LL_OP_16.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_16.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
17
LL_OP_17.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_17.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
18
LL_OP_18.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_18.000
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365 10 LL_OP_10.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_10.000
(20/25ppm)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
203
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
20
LL_OP_20.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_20.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
21
LL_OP_21.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_21.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
22
LL_OP_22.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_22.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
23
LL_OP_23.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_23.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
24
LL_OP_24.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_24.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
25
LL_OP_25.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_25.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
26
LL_OP_26.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_26.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
27
LL_OP_27.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_27.000
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365 19 LL_OP_19.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_19.000
(20/25ppm)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
204
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
29
LL_OP_29.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_29.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
30
LL_OP_30.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_30.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
31
LL_OP_31.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_31.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
32
LL_OP_32.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_32.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
33
LL_OP_33.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_33.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
34
LL_OP_34.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_34.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
35
LL_OP_35.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_35.000
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
36
WL_OP_36.000
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365 28 LL_OP_28.000
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_28.000
(20/25ppm)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
205
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
38
WL_OP_38.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
39
WL_OP_39.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
40
WL_OP_40.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
41
WL_OP_41.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
42
WL_OP_42.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
43
WL_OP_43.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
44
WL_OP_44.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
45
WL_OP_45.000
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365 37 WL_OP_37.000
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
206
Proce Servic
dure e UI
14
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
47
WL_OP_47.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
48
WL_OP_48.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
49
WL_OP_49.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
50
WL_OP_50.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
51
WL_OP_51.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
52
WL_OP_52.000
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9365
53
WL_OP_53.000
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9365 46 WL_OP_46.000
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS Displays the default Output Profile and PG CIE Based
Pure Gray TRC attribute. (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC attribute in the same sub-code is displayed at the
same time.)
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
207
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
9367
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
9368
Uploading the
adjusted profile from
USB memory
0-53
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_00.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_00.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_01.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_01.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_02.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_02.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_03.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_03.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Color profile
9366
Subcode
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
0
0-53
SYS Selecting a profile Overwrites the adjusted Output
Profile on the current area (PG CIE Based Pure Gray
TRC in the same sub-code is replaced with the adjusted
profile at the same time.)
<20/25ppm>
0: WL_OP_00 1: WL_OP_01 2: WL_OP_02 ... 51:
WL_OP_51 52: WL_OP_52 53: WL_OP_53
<LL20/25ppm>
0: LL_OP_00 1: LL_OP_01 2: LL_OP_02 ... 33:
LL_OP_33 34: LL_OP_34 35: LL_OP_35
Sub
element
General
05/08
Details
Making the profile
available
208
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_05.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_05.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_06.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_06.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_07.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_07.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_08.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_08.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
LL_OP_09.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_09.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
10
LL_OP_10.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_10.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
11
LL_OP_11.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_11.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
12
LL_OP_12.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_12.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369
4 LL_OP_04.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_04.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
209
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
14
LL_OP_14.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_14.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
15
LL_OP_15.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_15.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
16
LL_OP_16.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_16.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
17
LL_OP_17.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_17.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
18
LL_OP_18.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_18.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
19
LL_OP_19.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_19.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
20
LL_OP_20.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_20.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
21
LL_OP_21.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_21.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369 13 LL_OP_13.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_13.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
210
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
23
LL_OP_23.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_23.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
24
LL_OP_24.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_24.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
25
LL_OP_25.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_25.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
26
LL_OP_26.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_26.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
27
LL_OP_27.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_27.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
28
LL_OP_28.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_28.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
29
LL_OP_29.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_29.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
30
LL_OP_30.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_30.001
(20/25ppm)
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369 22 LL_OP_22.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_22.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
211
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
32
LL_OP_32.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_32.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
33
LL_OP_33.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_33.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
34
LL_OP_34.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_34.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
35
LL_OP_35.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_35.001
(20/25ppm)
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
36
WL_OP_36.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
37
WL_OP_37.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
38
WL_OP_38.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
39
WL_OP_39.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
40
WL_OP_40.001
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369 31 LL_OP_31.001
(LL20/25ppm)
WL_OP_31.001
(20/25ppm)
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
212
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
42
WL_OP_42.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
43
WL_OP_43.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
44
WL_OP_44.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
45
WL_OP_45.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
46
WL_OP_46.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
47
WL_OP_47.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
48
WL_OP_48.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
49
WL_OP_49.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
50
WL_OP_50.001
14
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
9369
51
WL_OP_51.001
14
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369 41 WL_OP_41.001
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
213
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Color profile
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Security
9379
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Color profile
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
Displaying the
attribute of the profile
at the shipment
SubDetails
code
9369 52 WL_OP_52.001
Code
9369
53
WL_OP_53.001
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
SYS Displays the adjusted Output Profile and PG CIE Based
14
Pure GrayTRC attribute in the same sub-code.
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
-
14
Refer to
content
s
0-2
9380
Converting 1-byte
katakana into 2 bytekatakana at e-mail
transmission
0-1
9381
User
interface
9384
Color/ACS
0-8
System
Network
Notification of scan
job
9386
0-1
System
Network
Notification of scan
job
9386
On error
0-1
214
10
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Scanning
9387
Scanning
9388
Subcode
Details
File name format of
"Save as file" and
Email transmission
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
1
0
0-6
SYS Sets the file naming method for "Save as file" and Email
transmission.
0: [FileName]-[Data]-[Page]
1: [FileName]-[Page]-[Data]
2: [Data]-[FileName]-[Page]
3: [Data]-[Page]-[File-Name]
4: [Page]-[FileName]-[Data]
5: [Page]-[Data]-[File-Name]
6: [HostName]_[Data]-[Page]
0
0-5
SYS Sets the data display format of the file for "Save as file"
and Email transmission.
0: [YYYY][MM][DD][HH][mm][SS]
1: [YY][MM][DD][HH][mm][SS]
2: [YYYY][MM][DD]
3: [YY][MM][DD]
4: [HH][mm][SS]
5: [YYYY][MM][DD][HH][mm][SS][mm0]
Setting
mode
System
Network
Scanning
9389
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Scanning
9390
3-6
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Scanning
9391
Extension (suffix)
format of the file of
"Save as file"
3-6
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Scanning
9394
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
LDAP authentication
9397
Execution of user
authentication when
the user ID is not
entered
0-2
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9398
eBMUs
erCard
11
LDAP authentication
215
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Role Based Access
LDAP search index
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0SYS This code is used to specify the ID for the LDAP server
429496729
to implement Role-Based Access Control.
5
LDAP authentication
9399
Network
Ethernet
9403
Communication speed
and settings of
Ethernet
1-7
System
Network
TCP/IP
9406
Method of acquiring
IP address
1-3
Setting
Mode
System
Network
TCP/IP
9408
IP address
Refer to
content
s
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
TCP/IP
9409
Subnet mask
08
Setting
Mode
System
Network
TCP/IP
9410
Gateway
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPX/SPX
9411
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
AppleTalk
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
1: Auto
2: 3: 10MBPS Full Duplex
4: 5: 100MBPS Full Duplex
6: 7: 1000MBPS Full Duplex
Proce Servic
dure e UI
5
12
12
Yes
Refer to
contents
12
Yes
Refer to
content
s
Refer to
contents
12
Yes
Refer to
content
s
Refer to
contents
12
Yes
Enable/disable setting
of IPX/SPX
1-2
NIC 1: Enabled
2: Disabled
12
9414
Availability of
AppleTalk
1-2
NIC 1: Enabled
2: Disabled
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
12
LDAP
9416
Availability of LDAP
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
Network
DNS
9417
Availability of DNS
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
Yes
Network
DNS
9418
IP address to DNS
server (Primary)
Refer to
contents
12
Yes
216
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
NetWare
9421
Availability of SLP
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
NetWare
9426
Availability of Bindery
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
NetWare
9427
Availability of NDS
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
HTTP
9430
Availability of HTTP
server
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMTP
9437
Availability of SMTP
client
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMTP
9440
Availability of SMTP
server
1-2
UTY 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
POP3
9446
Availability of POP3
clients
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9459
Availability of FTP
server
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SNMP
9463
Availability of MIB
function
1-2
NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Raw TCP
9473
Availability of
Raw/TCP
1-2
NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
LPD
9475
Availability of LPD
client
1-2
NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPP
9478
Availability of IPP
1-2
NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPP
9481
MFPser
ial
12
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
DNS
9419
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
NIC <Acceptable value>
contents
0.0.0.0-255.255.255.255
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
IP address to DNS
server (Secondary)
217
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPP
9483
IPP printer
information
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPP
9484
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
IPP
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
IPP
9482
Subcode
Details
IPP printer location
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
NIC Maximum 127 letters
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
12
Refer to
content
s
12
9485
12
IPP
9486
12
Network
IPP
9487
IPP printer
information (more)
MFGR
12
System
Network
IPP
9488
12
Setting
mode
System
Network
FTP
9489
Availability of FTP
print
1-2
NIC 1: Available
2: Not available
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9499
Page number
limitation for printing
text of received Email
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9505
Bonjour setting
1-2
NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Windows
authentication
9515
Windows domain
No.1 of user
authentication
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Windows
authentication
9516
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
Windows
authentication
9517
12
218
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SSL
9548
1-2
1: Enabled
2: Disabled
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SSL
9550
1-2
1: Enabled
2: Disabled
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SSL
9552
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SSL
9556
1-3
OFF/ON
1: Valid
(Accepts all the certification of the server)
2: Invalid
3: Use the imported certification.
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
TCP/IP
9563
IP Conflict Detect
1-2
OFF/ON
1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SNTP
9564
SNTP Enable
1-2
OFF/ON
1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DHCP
9580
Enabling server's IP
address acquired by
DHCP
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
DHCP
9581
Enabling server's IP
address acquired by
DHCP
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMTP
9584
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
POP3
9585
1-2
12
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
9525
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
SYS (**:**:**:**:**:**)
The address is displayed as above. 6-byte data is
divided by colon.
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
Display of MAC
address
219
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMB
9599
Samba server
ON/OFF setting
Refer to
content
s
1-4
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMB
9599
Samba server
ON/OFF setting
(When HDD is
installed)
Refer to
content
s
1-4
12
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
9601
Equipment number
(serial number)
display
9 digits
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan
ce
9602
Dealer's name
11
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9603
Login name
20 letters
11
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9604
0-1
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9605
Sending error
contents of equipment
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9606
SYS (Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
DHCP
9587
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
2
1-2
SNTP Server Option (42) NTP Server Address
1: Enabled
2: Disabled
This value is used only when DHCP is enabled.
Sub
element
Network
05/08
Details
Enabling server's IP
address acquired by
DHCP
220
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Subitem
Code
9607
Subcode
Details
Destination E-mail
address 2
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
SYS Maximum 192 letters
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9608
Destination E-mail
address 3
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9610
0-31
SYS 0: OFF
1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9611
0-31
SYS 0: OFF
1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9612
0-31
SYS 0: OFF
1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9613
0-31
SYS 0: OFF
1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9614
Sunday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9615
Monday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9616
Tuesday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9617
Wednesday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9618
Thursday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9619
Friday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Remote-controlled
service polling day
9620
Saturday
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
Yes
221
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information of
supplies
9621
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information of
supplies
9622
Setting of toner
cartridge M
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information of
supplies
9623
Setting of toner
cartridge Y
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information of
supplies
9624
Setting of toner
cartridge K
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information of
supplies
9625
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9626
Setting of polling at
the end of month
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
InternetFAX
9627
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
SMTP
9628
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
Wireless
LAN
9649
1-2
12
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9694
Enabling server's IP
address acquired by
DHCP
1-2
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9698
Color mode
notification setting at
ACS
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
9700
Service technician
telephone number
32 digits
DHCP
Setting of toner
cartridge C
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
222
12
SYS 0: Color
1: Black
11
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
9702
Subcode
Details
Automatic calibration
disclosure level
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
0-2
SYS Sets the disclosing level of automatic calibration.
0: Service technician
1: Administrator
2: User
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan General
ce
9703
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9709
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
General
9710
Remote-controlled
service function
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9711
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9715
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
(Remote)
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
0-2
0-2
Yes
Remote-controlled
service URL setting
11
Yes
Initially-registered
server URL setting
Refer to
content
s
11
Yes
9718
24
1-48
9719
60
General
9723
Periodical polling
timing
Maintenan RDMS
ce
General
9724
Maintenan RDMS
ce
General
9726
Scanning
Yes
<Default value>
https://device.mfpsupport.com:443/device/firstregist.ashx
SYS Sets the time interval to recover from the Emergency
Mode to the Normal Mode.
(Unit: Hour)
30-360
1000
0-2359
SYS (Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
0 (0:00) to 2359 (23:59)
Yes
0-1
SYS 0: Prohibited
1: Accepted
Yes
Remote-service initial
registration
0-3
SYS 0: OFF
1: Start
2: Only certification is scanned
3: RDMS communication starts
Yes
223
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
Sub
element
Maintenan RDMS
ce
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
Yes
General
9727
Maintenan RDMS
ce
General
9729
0-1
Yes
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9730
0-2
SYS 0: OFF
1: Notifies all service calls
2: Notifies all but paper jams
Yes
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9732
11
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Counter
9736
Interrupt copying
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
9739
Toner-end notification
0-2
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9740
0-1
SYS 0: Valid
1: Invalid
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9741
HTTP proxy IP
address setting
Refer to
content
s
11
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9742
0-65535
SYS
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9743
11
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9744
11
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan RDMS
ce
HTTP
9745
0-1
SYS 0: Valid
1: Invalid
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9746
802.1X/Dynamic WEP
selecting button
display
0-1
External counter
Security
Remote-controlled
service tentative
password
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
10 letters SYS Maximum 10 letters
224
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
Network
Item
Subitem
Scanning
Code
9749
Subcode
Details
WIA Scan Driver
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
1-2
NIC Selects WIA Scan Driver.
1: TTEC
2: Microsoft
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9750
Ordering method
0-3
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9751
FAX number
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9752
E-mail address
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9756
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Proce Servic
dure e UI
12
11
11
User's name
11
9757
User's telephone
number
11
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9758
11
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9759
User's address
11
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9760
Service number
11
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9761
Service technician's
name
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9762
Service technician's
telephone number
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9763
Service technician's
E-mail address
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9764
Supplier's name
11
225
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9765
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Supplier's address
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
SYS Maximum 100 letters
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9766
Notes
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9767
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9768
Order quantity of
toner cartridge C
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9769
Condition number of
toner cartridge C
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9770
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9771
Order quantity of
toner cartridge M
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9772
Condition number of
toner cartridge M
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9773
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9774
Order quantity of
toner cartridge Y
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9775
Condition number of
toner cartridge Y
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9776
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9777
Order quantity of
toner cartridge K
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9778
Condition number of
toner cartridge K
1-99
SYS
226
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9779
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Part number of waste
toner box
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
SYS Maximum 20 digits
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
11
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9780
Order quantity of
waste toner box
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Information about
supplies
9781
Condition number of
waste toner box
1-99
SYS
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic supply
ordering
9782
0-2
SYS 0: OFF
1: Always
2: ON Error
08
Setting
Mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic supply
ordering
9783
Refer to
content
s
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Automatic supply
ordering
9784
Counter notification
Remote FAX setting
11
08
Setting
Mode
System
Counter
9787
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan
ce
9788
0-12
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9789
2-8
227
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
Item
element
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
Subitem
Code
9793
Subcode
Details
Service Notification
setting
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
dure e UI
value
0
0-2
SYS Enables to set up to 3 E-mail addresses to be sent. (081
9794, 9607, 9608)
0: Invalid
1: Valid (E-mail)
2: Valid (FAX)
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9794
Destination E-mail
address 1
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9795
Total counter
information
transmission setting
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9796
Total counter
transmission date
setting
08
Setting
mode
System
Maintenan Remote-controlled
ce
service
9797
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
11
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
0-31
SYS 0 to 31
PM counter
notification setting
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
9798
Temporary
communication
password setting
99999
11
User
Local authentication
managem
ent
9799
Switchover of mode
0-1
System
Image
processing
9804
0-2
System
Finisher
Copying
0-1
Interruption of stapling
operation (no staple)
9810
228
Proce Servic
Default Acceptable
SubRAM
Contents
Details
value
dure e UI
code
value
9810
1 Printing / BOX printing
0
0-1
SYS When staple runs out while printing in the stapling
4
mode, sets whether printing is interrupted or printing is
continued by switching to sorting. This code is valid only
when printing in the stapling mode. However, printing is
always interrupted when staple for saddle stitch runs
out.
0: Continues printing by switching to sort setting
1: Interrupts printing
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Finisher
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Stapling setting:
Long size
Maximum number of
sheets acceptable
exceeding upper limit
9811
Plain/Recycled
-50-50
SYS -50 to 50
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Stapling setting:
Long size
Maximum number of
sheets acceptable
exceeding upper limit
9811
Thick1
-50-50
SYS -50 to 50
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Stapling setting:
Long size
Maximum number of
sheets acceptable
exceeding upper limit
9811
Thick2
-50-50
SYS -50 to 50
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Number of output
pages for pausing
continuous printing for
2nd transfer
resistance detection
control
9814
At normal
temperatures
0-100
SYS When the setting value of this code is "1" or higher, the
2nd transfer resistance detection is performed every
time the number of pages of (setting value X 100) have
output.
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Number of output
pages for pausing
continuous printing for
2nd transfer
resistance detection
control
9815
At low temperatures
10
0-100
SYS When the setting value of this code is "1" or higher, the
2nd transfer resistance detection is performed every
time the number of pages of (setting value X 10) have
output.
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9816
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9817
Maximum number of
decimals in the
extension fields
0-6
SYS 0 to 6 digits
08
Setting
mode
System
General
9818
0-1
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Interruption of stapling
operation (no staple)
Code
229
05/08
Mode
Element
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Off Device
Customization
Architecture
9819
STAGE SSL
User
interface
Off Device
Customization
Architecture
9820
STAGE I/F
System
User
interface
Off Device
Customization
Architecture
9821
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Off Device
Customization
Architecture
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-1
SYS Sets whether SSL communication is enabled or
disabled for remote scanning.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SYS Sets whether interface is enabled or disabled for remote
scanning.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
0-65535
49630
0-65535
0-2
9825
0-1
SYS 0: Black
1: Gray scale
9829
Limitation setting
0-3
9847
0-1
SYS 0: Invalid
1: Valid
9848
Registration
disclosure level
setting
0-2
9880
0-31
SYS 0 to 31
0-1
Port number
49629
9822
Network
9823
System
Image
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Display setting
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Remote-controlled
service
Department
management
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
230
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
General
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
Setting
mode
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Code
Subcode
Details
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Remote-controlled
service
Automatic ordering
function of supplies
9881
General
Security
Hardcopy security
printing
9883
Enable/Disable setting
0-1
SYS 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
System
General
Security
Hardcopy security
printing
9884
Counting method
switchover
0-1
SYS 0: Counted as 1
1: Counted as 2
System
General
9886
Decimal point
indication for
Enhanced Scan
Template
Refer to
content
s
0-1
SYS 0: Comma
1: Full stop
08
Setting
mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
General
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
08
08
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
0
0-127
SYS 1 byte 00000000(0)-01111111(127)From the 2nd bit Sunday, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday,
Friday, Saturday
<Default value>
MJD: 0
Others: 1
9888
0-1
Data cloning
9889
0-1
SYS 0: Accepted
1: Prohibited
Yes
Display setting
9891
Warning message
when PM time has
come
0-1
Yes
General
9892
Monocolor counting
method
0-2
System
General
9894
Calibration chart
charging method
0-1
Setting
mode
System
Image
Background peak
adjustment
9897
Black
1-9
SYS 1: -4 2: -3 3: -2 4: -1 5: 0 6: +1 7: +2 8: +3 9: +4
Setting
mode
System
Image
9898
Color
0-11
SYS 0: Auto 1: -5 2: -4 3: -3 4: -2 5: -1 6: 0 7: +1 8: +2
9: +3 10: +4 11: +5
231
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
System
9900
System firmware
ROM version
T210SY0WXXXX
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
Engine
9901
Engine firmware
version
210M-XXX
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
System
9902
Scanner firmware
version
210S-XXX
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
Engine
9903
RADF firmware
version
DF-XXXX
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
Finisher
9904
Finisher firmware
version
FIN-XXX
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
FAX
9905
F670-XXX
Yes
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
System
9930
System firmware
version
T210SF0WXXXX
Yes
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
LDAP authentication
9933
Domain participation
confirmation of
printing when LDAP
authentication is used
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
General
S-ACS operation
setting
9934
Copy
1-9
Mode
Element
Item
Default value setting
Subitem
Density in the scan
mode
Code
9899
Subcode
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
6
0-11
SYS 0: Auto 1: -5 2: -4 3: -3 4: -2 5: -1 6: 0 7: +1 8: +2
9: +3 10: +4 11: +5
Sub
element
Image
05/08
Details
Grayscale
232
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
mode
System
General
S-ACS operation
setting
9934
Box, Others
1-9
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Short size
Stapling setting
Acceptable number of
sheets exceeding
upper limit
9937
Plain/Recycled
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Short size
Stapling setting
Acceptable number of
sheets exceeding
upper limit
9937
Thick1
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Stapling setting
Short size
Acceptable number of
sheets exceeding
upper limit
9937
Thick2
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
S-ACS operation
setting
Subcode
9934
1 Print
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
1
1-9
SYS 1: The number of contact control: 1
Continuous color control: 1 sheet
2: The number of contact control: 2
Continuous color control: 2 sheets
3: The number of contact control: 3
Continuous color control: 3 sheets
4: The number of contact control: 4
Continuous color control: 4 sheets
5: The number of contact control: 5
Continuous color control: 5 sheets
6: The number of contact control: 6
Continuous color control: 6 sheets
7: The number of contact control: 7
Continuous color control: 7 sheets
8: The number of contact control: 8
Continuous color control: 8 sheets
9: The number of contact control: 9
Continuous color control: 9 sheets
Sub
element
General
05/08
Code
Details
233
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
-100-100
-100-100
-100-100
08
Setting
mode
System
Sub
element
Finisher
08
Setting
mode
System
Finisher
Saddle stitch
Stapling setting
Acceptable number of
sheets exceeding
upper limit
9938
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
Engine
08
Setting
Mode
System
Version
08
Setting
Mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
08
05/08
Mode
Element
Item
Subitem
Stapling setting
Saddle stitch
Acceptable number of
sheets exceeding
upper limit
SubDetails
code
9938
0 Plain/Recycled
Code
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
0
-15-15
SYS -15 to 15
Contents
Thick1
-15-15
9940
210F-XXX
Yes
Finisher
9944
Punch firmware
version
PUN-XXX
* This code is not supported by LL20/25ppm model.
Yes
Network
9946
Number of Email
transmission retries
Refer to
content
s
0-14
SYS 0 to 14 times
<Default value>
20/25ppm: 3 (When HDD is installed), 0 (When HDD is
not installed)
LL20/25ppm: 0
Yes
System
Network
9947
E-mail transmission
retry interval
0-15
SYS 0 to 15 min.
Yes
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9955
Name of
[EXTENSION] button
EXTEN
SION
11
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9958
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9959
0-1
234
SYS -15 to 15
Proce Servic
dure e UI
4
05/08
08
Mode
Setting
Mode
Element
System
Sub
element
Maintenan
ce
Item
Subitem
Code
9960
Subcode
Details
Display of equipment
information (SRAM)
Default Acceptable
RAM
Contents
value
value
Refer to
0-2
SYS Displays the equipment information in SRAM.
content
0: Not set
s
1: Destinations other than NAD
2: NAD
Proce Servic
dure e UI
2
<Default value>
NAD: 2
Others: 1
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9970
0-4
SYS 0: Text/Photo
1: Text
2: Photo
3: Gray Scale
4: User custom mode
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Default setting
9971
PPC (black)
0-1
SYS 0: Auto
1: Manual
08
Setting
mode
System
General
Default setting
PPC
-3-3
SYS The larger the value, the more the paper is judged as a
blank page. The smaller the value, the less the paper is
judged as a blank page.
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Default setting
SCN
-3-3
SYS The larger the value, the more the paper is judged as a
blank page. The smaller the value, the less the paper is
judged as a blank page.
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Default setting
ACS judgment
adjustment: Default
setting
9974
PPC
-3-3
SYS The larger the value, the more the original is judged as
color data. The smaller the value, the less the original is
judged as black data.
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Default setting
ACS judgment
adjustment: Default
setting
9975
SCN
-3-3
SYS The larger the value, the more the original is judged as
color data. The smaller the value, the less the original is
judged as black data.
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9976
0-6
SYS 0: Text/Photo
1: Text
2: Printed image
3: Photo
4: Map
5: Custom
6: Reproduction of red seal color
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
Default setting
9977
PPC
0-2
SYS 0: Text/Photo
1: Text
2: Printed image
235
Yes
Yes
05/08
Mode
Element
Sub
element
User
interface
Item
Subcode
Details
Default Acceptable
RAM
value
value
1
0-1
SYS 0: Auto
1: Manual
Contents
Proce Servic
dure e UI
1
Subitem
Code
Default setting
9978
9979
Color mode
0-2
08
Setting
mode
System
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9980
Receiver's address
fixing function at
authentication
0-4
08
Setting
mode
System
Network
9981
0-1
08
Setting
mode
System
User
interface
9982
Switch of display
attribute of
[EXTENSION] icon
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
User
interface
9984
Document or file
name display form for
the PRINT screen,
JOB STATUS screen,
Job Status tab and
Logs tab
0-1
08
Setting
Mode
System
Fax
9987
Retention of fax
sending settings
0-3
236
Yes
REVISION RECORD
Ver01
Page
2-2
3-19
3-46
4-28
7-10
7-11
7-15
7-40
7-41, 42
9-20
14-3
14-4
Ver01 <2012.06.04>
Contents
The descriptions of paper size for bypass feeding and automatic duplexing unit have been
changed.
The names of thermistor have been changed.
The description has been changed.
The note has been added.
The items for sub-screen of 2nd CST., RADF, LCF, and 3rd CST. have been changed.
The items for sub-screen of 4th CST. have been changed.
The title of 7.6.2 has been changed.
The descriptions of PM Kit have been changed.
The harness holding jig has been added.
The description has been changed.
The names of thermistor have been changed.
The names of thermistor have been changed.